Инструкция по эксплуатации hyundai palisade

  • Bookmarks

Quick Links

OWNER’S MANUAL

Operation

Maintenance

Specifications

All information in this Owner’s Manual is current at the time

of publication. However, HYUNDAI reserves the right to make

changes at any time so that our policy of continual product

improvement may be carried out.

This manual applies to all HYUNDAI models and includes

descriptions and explanations of optional as well as standard

equipment. As a result, you may find material in this manual

that does not apply to your specific vehicle.

loading

Summary of Contents for Hyundai Palisade 2023


Автосервис АвтоМиг в Коптево

Автосервис САО — МЦД Красный Балтиец:

Ближайшие для подъезда улицы – Космонавта Волкова, Приорова, Новая Ипатовка, Большая Академическая.


Автосервис АвтоМиг в Лефортово

Автосервис ЮВАО, ВАО — метро Авиамоторная:

Ближайшие станции метро — Авиамоторная, Площадь Ильича, Шоссе Энтузиастов, Чкаловская, Бауманская, Семеновская. Ближайшие для подъезда улицы — третье транспортное кольцо (ТТК), проезд завода Серп и Молот, Лефортовский вал, Красноказарменная улица.


Автосервис АвтоМиг в Щукино

Автосервис СЗАО, САО — метро Октябрьское поле, станция Зорге МЦК (район Щукино, Хорошёво—Мнёвники)


Ближайшие станции метро — Октябрьское поле, Полежаевская. Станция Московского Центрального Кольца — Зорге. Ближайшие для подъезда улицы — Маршала Бирюзова, Берзарина, Народного ополчения, Зорге, Куусинена, Расплетина.


Автосервис АвтоМиг в Измайлово

Автосервис ВАО — метро Соколиная гора (район Измайлово)
Ближайшие станции метро — Соколиная гора, Партизанская, Измайлово, Шоссе Энтузиастов, Черкизовская. Ближайшие для подъезда улицы — Вернисажная, Шоссе Энтузиастов, проспект Будённого, Северо-Восточная хорда, Щербаковская улица, Большая Черкизовская улица.


Автосервис АвтоМиг в Гольяново

Автосервис ВАО — метро Щелковская (район Гольяново)
Ближайшие станции метро — Щелковская, Черкизовская, Бульвар Рокоссовского, Первомайская, Партизанская, Измайловская. Ближайшие для подъезда улицы — Щелковское шоссе, Амурская, Сиреневый бульвар, Монтажная улица, Байкальская улица, Открытое шоссе.


AUTO-TEXCENTER.RU


Франшиза автосервиса, Вакансии автосервиса, Инструкции к корейским авто, Инструкции к китайским авто


Ремонт (сервис) корейских автомобилей. Специализированный техцентр (автосервис) в Москве. Copyright © 2000-2023. Все права сохранены. Обращаем Ваше внимание на то, что данный сайт носит исключительно информационный характер и ни при каких условиях не является публичной офертой, определяемой положениями Статьи 437 (2) Гражданского кодекса Российской Федерации.


Компания «АвтоМиг» является НЕОФИЦИАЛЬНЫМ техническим центром по обслуживанию и ремонту автомобилей марок KIA и HYUNDAI. Никакого отношения ни к официальным представителям (дилерам), ни к самим производителям транспортных средств автосервис не имеет! Все упоминания торговых знаков (марок автомобилей) на данном сайте носят исключительно ИДЕНТИФИЦИРУЮЩИЙ характер (используются не в качестве средства индивидуализации), указывают, какие именно автомобили обслуживает техцентр (в соответствии со ст. 1474, 1487 Гражданского Кодекса РФ).

Логотип HYUNDAIПАЛИСАД 2022 Автомобиль
инструкции
HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль

Из-за тебя.

В Hyundai мы верим, что только с заботой о вас мы сможем обеспечить прогресс, инновации, экологичность и мобильность, которые улучшат впечатления от вождения.
Мы уделяем приоритетное внимание исследованиям и разработкам в области подключенных и экологически чистых мобильных решений, продолжая раздвигать границы и бросать вызов традиционному мышлению, чтобы предоставить вам опыт подключения и устойчивое видение будущего.
Мы вдохновлены созданием платформ и технологий, которые предоставят вам больше способов приятно провести время с нашими автомобилями. Жить комфортной и связанной жизнью, где вам нравится путешествие, а не только пункт назначения.
Мы также адаптируем наши автомобили с характеристиками, которые соответствуют требованиям нашего канадского ландшафта, чтобы вы могли с комфортом и уверенностью преодолевать наши экстремальные зимы и удивительное лето. И, конечно же, мы обеспечиваем наши автомобили одной из лучших автомобильных гарантий в отрасли. Мы делаем все это из-за вас.

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - 1

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - 2

Комната, чтобы переместить вас.HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - номерPALISADE 2022 года предлагает 8 сидячих мест премиум-класса в элегантном современном и интуитивно понятном интерьере, который думает о каждом в каждом ряду. Технологии невероятного удобства и множество инноваций безопасности Hyundai SmartSense™ делают PALISADE 2022 года действительно замечательным внедорожником, который идеально подходит для семейной жизни.

Исследуйте с уверенностью.

Двигатель 3.8 л GDI V6 мощностью 291 л.с. и крутящим моментом 262 фунт-фут. крутящего момента обеспечивает изобилие мощности и отзывчивости. Технология Shift-by-Wire означает, что вы можете легко переключать передачи нажатием кнопки благодаря плавному переключению 8-ступенчатой ​​автоматической коробки передач.

Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - уверенностьВыбор стандартного режима вождения
С помощью Drive Mode Select выберите режим вождения, который соответствует вашему предпочтительному стилю вождения.
Используйте циферблат для переключения между различными режимами, которые будут регулировать параметры двигателя, трансмиссии и рулевого управления.

Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - Режим КОМФОРТКОМФОРТНЫЙ режим
Сбалансированное и стабильное управление отлично подходит для повседневной езды.
Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - режим ECOECO режим 
Эко-режим предназначен для экономии топлива, поддержания эффективности использования топлива за счет передачи мощности в основном на передние колеса.
Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - режим SPORTРежим СПОРТ
Спортивный режим регулирует реакцию дроссельной заслонки и рулевого управления для большей маневренности и более отзывчивого вождения.
Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - режим SMARTУМНЫЙ режим
Интеллектуальный режим автоматически настраивается между всеми доступными режимами в зависимости от действий водителя, чтобы оптимизировать вашу поездку.

Стандартный полный привод HTRAC™ с режимами управления по пересеченной местности
Для максимальной управляемости, производительности и тяги воспользуйтесь нашей системой полного привода HTRAC™. Это позволяет вам выбрать соответствующую настройку тяги, которая лучше всего соответствует вашим текущим условиям вождения, с тремя специальными режимами местности.
Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - режим SNOWСНЕЖНЫЙ режим
Оптимизирован для заснеженных и скользких дорог. Этот режим распределяет движущую силу автомобиля в зависимости от дорожных условий, чтобы предотвратить проскальзывание колес.
Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - режим ГРЯЗИГрязевой режим
Оптимизирован для грязной, колейной или неровной местности.
В режиме грязи датчики могут мгновенно определять проскальзывание колес и автоматически перенаправлять крутящий момент на колесо с наибольшим сцеплением, чтобы вы могли продолжать движение, несмотря на опасные условия вождения.
Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - режим ПЕСОКПЕСОЧНЫЙ режим
Оптимизирован для рыхлого песка или глубокого гравия. Специальные алгоритмы, разработанные для вождения по песку, обеспечивают правильную передачу и помогают гарантировать, что каждое колесо получает необходимое количество крутящего момента в нужный момент для обеспечения оптимального сцепления шин.

Будьте стильными каждый день.

Независимо от того, что предстоит напряженный день, универсальный PALISADE проведет вас через все это с высоким стилем. Доминирующая широкая каскадная решетка и доступный 20-дюймовый сплав.
колеса подчеркивают силу и роскошное качество, которые скрыты внутри. Фирменный компонент светодиодных дневных ходовых огней и вертикально расположенных фар бросается в глаза и оставляет неизгладимое впечатление.

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - стиль

Командуйте дорогой с комфортом.

Ни одна деталь не была упущена из виду. Все в салоне изготовлено из высококачественных материалов и предназначено для максимального комфорта. Богатство впечатляющих функций окутает вас непревзойденной роскошью, где бы вы ни сидели. Устройтесь поудобнее в передних сиденьях с подушками, обтянутыми доступной кожей Nappa со стегаными деталями премиум-класса, и насладитесь индивидуальным комфортом благодаря доступному водительскому сиденью с электроприводом, регулируемому по 12 параметрам, с электроприводом для бедер.

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - Командование

Продуманные функции по всему салону.

PALISADE делает исключительную работу по удовлетворению потребностей каждого, начиная с семи стандартных USB-разъемов, разбросанных по всему салону.

Универсальность груза.
Пространство салона можно легко настроить различными способами в соответствии с потребностями момента. Наслаждайтесь общим объемом багажника до 2,447 литров при сложенных задних сиденьях.

Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 – характеристики

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - 3

В наличии капитанские кресла второго ряда
Доступные капитанские кресла второго ряда дополняют ощущение роскоши и оснащены сиденьями с подогревом и вентиляцией.

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - 4

Стандартные задние вентиляционные отверстия
Инновационные задние вентиляционные отверстия поддерживают поток воздуха и позволяют задним пассажирам выбирать между сфокусированным, частично или полностью рассеянным потоком воздуха.

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - 5

В наличии трехзонный климат-контроль
Благодаря доступному трехзонному климат-контролю желаемую температуру могут выбирать как водитель, так и передний пассажир, а также пассажиры второго ряда.

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - 6

Доступная бортовая система внутренней связи
Легко общайтесь с теми, кто сидит в третьем ряду, с помощью бортовой системы внутренней связи.

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - 7

Стандартный тихий режим для задних пассажиров
Обеспечьте дополнительную тишину для спящих детей, установив аудиосистему в тихий режим, чтобы отключить задние динамики.

Технологии окружают вас.

Apple CarPlay™ ∆ , Android Auto™ ◊ и Bluetooth® входят в стандартную комплектацию, чтобы облегчить доступ к вашим любимым приложениям для смартфонов и принимать телефонные звонки. Доступный 10.25-дюймовый сенсорный дисплей предлагает встроенную навигационную систему и систему объемного звучания.view монитор, который отображает 360 градусов view PALISADE для дополнительной навигации при парковке в ограниченном пространстве. Доступные технологии, такие как 12.3-дюймовая полностью цифровая приборная панель и проекционный дисплей на лобовом стекле, предлагают различные информационные дисплеи для уверенного управления дорогой.

Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - Технологии

Доступна интеллектуальная задняя дверь с электроприводом

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - 8

Доступна 12.3-дюймовая полностью цифровая приборная панель со шторкой. View монитор

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - 9

Доступный проекционный дисплей

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - 10

Доступная аудиосистема Harman/Kardon®

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - 11

В наличии объемный-view монитор

Максимальное удобство.
Максимальное подключение.

Bluelink® Ω — это наша доступная автомобильная система, которая позволяет вам оставаться на связи с вашим Hyundai через приложение для смартфона и предлагает набор услуг одним нажатием кнопки.
Эта инновационная подключенная система дает вам возможность удаленно запирать/отпирать и запускать автомобиль, настраивать климат-контроль, отслеживать состояние вашего автомобиля с помощью интеллектуальных диагностических инструментов и многое другое.

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - 12

Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - Дистанционный запуск Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - SOS Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - уведомление
Дистанционный запуск с климат-контролем Экстренная помощь SOS и помощь на дороге Автоматическое уведомление о столкновении
Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - разблокировать HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - Найди мою машину HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - Локальный поиск
Удаленная блокировка / разблокировка Найди мою машину Локальный поиск
Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 — в реальном времени HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - Найти дилера Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 г. - Бесплатно
Диагностика в реальном времени Найти дилера бесплатная подписка на 3 года на
оборудованные модели

Hyundai SmartSense™

Путешествуйте с уверенностью и спокойствием благодаря обширному списку технологий безопасности Hyundai SmartSense™, предлагаемых в PALISADE.

Стандартные функции:

Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - Стандартные характеристики

Доступные функции:

Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - Доступные функции

Найдите PALISADE, который подходит именно вам.

существенный
Стандартное оборудование включает в себя:
Характеристики производительности:

  • Двигатель 3.8 л GDI V6 с системой старт-стоп на холостом ходу (291 л.с., крутящий момент 262 фунт-фут)
  • 8-ступенчатая автоматическая коробка передач с подрулевыми лепестками SHIFTRONIC®
  • Кнопочное переключение по проводам
  • Выбор режима движения
  • Полноприводная система HTRAC™ с режимами движения по пересеченной местности
  • Электронный стояночный тормоз
  • Пакет подготовки прицепа (полная проводка и охладитель трансмиссии)

Внешние особенности:

  • 18-дюймовые легкосплавные диски
  • Светодиодные дневные ходовые и габаритные огни
  • Светодиодные фары (ближний и дальний свет)
  • Акустически многослойное ветровое стекло
  • Акустически ламинированные передние окна
  • Боковые рейлинги на крыше
  • Автоматические фары
  • Боковые зеркала с электрорегулировкой и обогревом
  • Переднее солнцезащитное стекло и заднее защитное стекло

Особенности интерьера:

  • 8-местная вместимость
  • 8.0-дюймовый сенсорный дисплей с поддержкой беспроводной связи Apple CarPlay™ ∆ и Android Auto™ ◊
  • Подогрев передних сидений
  • Тактильный кожаный руль с подогревом
  • Телефонная система громкой связи Bluetooth® с распознаванием голоса
  • USB-порты 7
  • заднийview камера с динамическими направляющими
  • Смарт-сиденья второго ряда, складывающиеся и выдвигающиеся одним касанием
  • Электрические стеклоподъемники с автоподъемом/опусканием со стороны водителя и переднего пассажира
  • Тихий режим для задних пассажиров
  • Багажник и сетка

Сохранность Особенности:

  • Адаптивный круиз-контроль с функцией остановки и движения в пробках
  • Система предотвращения столкновений вперед с обнаружением пешеходов
  • Предупреждение о выходе из полосы движения с помощью системы удержания в полосе движения
  • Помощь при следовании по полосе
  • Оповещение о пассажирах сзади
  • Ассистент дальнего света
  • Внимание водителя
  • Предупреждение о расстоянии парковки — задний ход
  • Система контроля давления в шинах
  • 7 подушек безопасности (включая коленную подушку безопасности водителя)

Привилегированный
Включает базовое стандартное оборудование, а также:
Характеристики производительности:

  • Задняя подвеска с автоматическим выравниванием

Внешние особенности:

  • 20-дюймовые легкосплавные диски с механической обработкой
  • Передняя решетка с темным хромированным покрытием
  • Боковые зеркала с указателями поворота

Особенности интерьера:

  • Бесконтактный вход без ключа с кнопочным зажиганием и дистанционным запуском
  • Одинарная передняя подъемно-сдвижная крыша с электроприводом
  • 7.0-дюймовая ЖК-панель приборов
  • Сиденье водителя с электрорегулировкой по 8 параметрам и поясничной опорой по 2 параметрам
  • Сиденье пассажира с электроприводом, 8 направлений
  • Интегрированная система памяти водителя — сиденье и боковые зеркала
  • Двухзонный автоматический климат-контроль с ионизатором CleanAir и системой автоматического отпотевания ветрового стекла.
  • Задняя однозонная автоматическая регулировка температуры
  • Подогрев задних сидений
  • Электрохромное автоматическое затемнение сзадиview зеркало с HomeLink®
  • Задние солнцезащитные шторки с ручным управлением

Безопасности:

  • Помощь в предотвращении столкновений в слепых зонах
  • Система предотвращения столкновений при перекрёстном движении сзади
  • Помощь при безопасном выходе
  • Ультразвуковое оповещение о пассажирах сзади
  • Блокировка от детей с электроприводом

Роскошь
Включает предпочтительное стандартное оборудование, а также:

Внешние особенности:

  • Умная задняя дверь с электроприводом
  • Сатинированные хромированные наружные дверные ручки

Особенности интерьера:

  • Кожаные сиденья
  • Объемныйview монитор
  • 10.25-дюймовый сенсорный экран с проводным подключением AppleCarPlay™ ∆ и Android Auto™ ◊ и навигационной системой
  • Подключенная автомобильная система Bluelink° Ω
  • Аудиосистема премиум-класса Harman/kardon® с 12 динамиками
  • SiriusXMSiriusXM™ ‡ и HD-радио
  • Вентилируемые передние сиденья
  • Складывающиеся, раскладывающиеся и откидывающиеся сиденья третьего ряда с электроприводом
  • Электроудлиняемая подушка сиденья водителя
  • Роскошный дверной потертости
  • Отделка обтянутой кожей краш-панели
  • Система внутренней связи в автомобиле
  • Светодиодное освещение салона

Безопасности:

  • Слепой View монитор
  • Предупреждение о расстоянии парковки — спереди
  • Адаптивный круиз-контроль на основе навигации

Дополнительно:

  • 7-местный салон с капитанскими креслами второго ряда

Абсолютная каллиграфия
Включает стандартную комплектацию Luxury на 7 пассажиров, а также:

Внешние особенности:

  • 20-дюймовые легкосплавные диски
  • Эксклюзивная каллиграфия на передней решетке
  • Эксклюзивная каллиграфия на передней панели
  • Эксклюзивные передние и задние защитные пластины с надписью Calligraphy
  • Светодиодные задние фонари
  • Чувствительные к дождю дворники
  • Колесные арки и отделка передней панели в цвет кузова
  • Лужа лamps
    Особенности интерьера:
  • Поверхности сидений из кожи Nappa премиум-класса
  • Фиксированный широкопанельный люк второго ряда
  • 12.3-дюймовая полностью цифровая приборная панель
  • Водительское сиденье с электрорегулировкой поясничной опоры в 4 направлениях
  • Head-дисплей
  • Беспроводная зарядная панель ▼
  • Вентилируемые сиденья второго ряда
  • Замшевый потолок
  • Инвертор 115 ВА/Кл.

Цвета и колеса.
Цвета экстерьера ♦

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - Цвета кузова

Цвета салона ♦

HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - Цвета салона 2 HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - Цвета салона 1 HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - Цвета салона 5
Обсидиановая черная ткань Стандартно для моделей Essential и Preferred полночная черная кожа
Стандарт на модели класса люкс
Кожа серого цвета гавани
Доступно для модели Luxury (только цвета кузова Hyper White, Steel Graphite и Moonlight Cloud)
HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - Цвета салона 2 HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - Цвета салона 6 HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 Автомобиль - Цвета салона 3
Кожа наппа цвета «черный полночь» Стандартно для модели Ultimate Calligraphy (недоступно для Gaia Brown) Кожа наппа серого цвета Доступно для модели Ultimate Calligraphy (только цвета кузова Hyper White, Steel Graphite и Moonlight Cloud) Жемчужно-бежевая кожа наппа
Доступно на Ultimate Calligraphy
модель (только цвета кузова Abyss Black и Sierra Burgundy, стандартно с цветом кузова Gaia Brown)

Колеса

♦ Варианты цвета кузова и салона и/или доступность могут быть изменены без предварительного уведомления. Выбор цвета салона зависит от модели и/или выбора цвета кузова. Представленные цвета приведены только для справки и могут отличаться от реального оттенка.
Посетите hyundaicanada.com или обратитесь к своему дилеру для получения подробной информации. *Доступно по состоянию на август 2021 года.

Аксессуары.

Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - Аксессуары 1 Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - Аксессуары 2 Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - Аксессуары 3
Комплект сцепки для прицепа
Сцепное устройство Hyundai, разработанное для удовлетворения ваших потребностей в буксировке, может вмещать широкий спектр аксессуаров, устанавливаемых на сцепное устройство.
Поперечные рельсы
Эта прочная, быстрозапирающаяся система поперечных направляющих позволяет перевозить
груз легко, не жертвуя внутренним пространством.
Всепогодные напольные покрытия премиум-класса
Всепогодные напольные покрытия премиум-класса были разработаны для покрытия коврового покрытия в салоне, обеспечивая максимальную защиту от
элементы, которые другие маты не могут предложить. Снимите коврики перед установкой.
Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - Аксессуары 4 Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - Аксессуары 5 Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - Аксессуары 6
Боковые подножки
Прочные хромированные ступени из нержавеющей стали с нескользящими накладками для ног обеспечат прочную ступеньку и уникальный привлекательный дизайн, эксклюзивный для Hyundai.
Складной грузовой лоток премиум-класса
Максимальная защита вашего грузового отсека и спинок сидений 3-го ряда; предотвращает попадание грязи и копоти вне зависимости от конфигурации сидений.
Пластиковый протектор капота
Помогите предотвратить вмятины и царапины, вызванные дорожным и автомобильным мусором, с помощью привлекательного пластикового протектора капота.

Для получения дополнительной информации о дополнительных аксессуарах посетите сайт hyundaicanada.com или обратитесь к своему дилеру. Изображения продуктов и транспортных средств могут не совпадать с показанными.Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - Аксессуары

Одна из лучших гарантий в Канаде.
Вы увидите, что ряд наших автомобилей получил несколько наград от самых авторитетных сторонних организаций, поэтому вы можете поверить им на слово, когда речь идет о качестве наших автомобилей. Это качество в равной степени соответствует качеству нашей гарантии. Мы уверенно стоим за нашими продуктами, чтобы дать вам полное спокойствие благодаря всеобъемлющей ограниченной гарантии на 5 лет или 100,000 5 километров пробега †. Мы также предоставляем 24-летнюю/безлимитную программу помощи на дороге ††, включающую замену спущенных шин, блокировку и многое другое. Всего один бесплатный звонок XNUMX часа в сутки.

Дилерская ул.amp

Hyundai Auto Canada Corp.
hyundaicanada.com Автомобиль HYUNDAI PALISADE 2022 - ФК

™/®Название, логотипы, названия продуктов, названия функций, изображения и слоганы Hyundai являются товарными знаками, принадлежащими или лицензированными Hyundai Auto Canada Corp.. Технические характеристики, функции, иллюстрации, аксессуары, материалы и оборудование, а также вся другая информация, приведенная брошюры основаны на самой последней информации, доступной на момент публикации. Хотя описания считаются правильными, точность не может быть гарантирована.
Hyundai Auto Canada Corp. оставляет за собой право вносить любые изменения или модификации в любое время без предварительного уведомления или обязательств, включая, помимо прочего, цвет, технические характеристики, функции, аксессуары, материалы, оборудование и модели. Некоторые автомобили показаны с дополнительным оборудованием. Все гарантии Hyundai не имеют франшизы. † Всеобъемлющая ограниченная гарантия Hyundai распространяется на большинство компонентов автомобиля в случае дефектов изготовления при нормальных условиях эксплуатации и технического обслуживания. †† Программа круглосуточной помощи на дорогах Hyundai является ограниченной услугой и не покрывает определенные затраты или расходы. Помощь на дороге не является гарантией. ∆ Apple CarPlay™ может быть доступен не на всех устройствах и не во всех странах и регионах. Посетите www.apple.com для получения дополнительной информации и любых применимых ограничений. Apple и Apple CarPlay являются товарными знаками Apple Inc.. ◊ Android Auto™ может быть доступен не на всех устройствах и не во всех странах и регионах. Визит www.android.com для получения дополнительной информации и любых применимых ограничений. Android и Android Auto являются товарными знаками Google Inc.. ‡ Автомобиль оборудован возможностью доступа к радио SiriusXM. Не включает подписку. Название SiriusXM™ является товарным знаком SiriusXM Satellite Radio Inc. Bluelink® включает 3 года бесплатного обслуживания. Услуга Bluelink доступна для покупки и аренды новых автомобилей в соответствии с условиями подписки Bluelink. Используйте Bluelink и соответствующие устройства только тогда, когда это безопасно. Необходимо покрытие сотовой связи и GPS. Функции, технические характеристики и сборы могут различаться в зависимости от модели и могут быть изменены. Для получения более подробной информации и ограничений посетите сайт hyundaicanada.com или
официальный дилер Hyundai. Словесный товарный знак и логотипы Bluetooth® являются зарегистрированными товарными знаками, принадлежащими Bluetooth SIG, Inc. Harman/kardon® — зарегистрированный товарный знак Harman International, Inc. HomeLink® — зарегистрированный товарный знак. Доступно только на некоторых моделях. товарный знак Johnson Controls Inc. Все остальные товарные знаки и торговые наименования принадлежат их соответствующим владельцам. Некоторые изображения показаны со специальными графическими эффектами.

Документы / Ресурсы

  • Contents

  • Table of Contents

  • Bookmarks

Quick Links

O O W W N N E E R R ‘ ‘ S S M M A A N N U U A A L L

O O p p e e r r a a t t i i o o n n

M M a a i i n n t t e e n n a a n n c c e e

S S p p e e c c i i f f i i c c a a t t i i o o n n s s

All information in this Owner’s Manual is current at the time of pub-

lication. However, HYUNDAI reserves the right to make changes at

any time so that our policy of continual product improvement may be

carried out.

This manual applies to all HYUNDAI models and includes descrip-

tions and explanations of optional as well as standard equipment.

As a result, you may find material in this manual that does not apply

to your specific vehicle.

Chapters

loading

Summary of Contents for Hyundai Palisade 2020

Hyundai Palisade 2022 SUV Owner's Manual PDF

Summary of Content for Hyundai Palisade 2022 SUV Owner’s Manual PDF

OWNER’S MANUAL Operation Maintenance Specifications

All information in this Owner’s Manual is current at the time of pub- lication. However, HYUNDAI reserves the right to make changes at any time so that our policy of continual product improvement may be carried out.

This manual applies to all HYUNDAI models and includes descrip- tions and explanations of optional as well as standard equipment. As a result, you may find material in this manual that does not apply to your specific vehicle.

F2

Your HYUNDAI should not be modified in any way. Such modifications may adversely affect the per- formance, safety or durability of your HYUNDAI and may, in addition, violate conditions of the limit- ed warranties covering the vehicle. Certain modifi- cations may also be in violation of regulations established by the U.S. Department of Transportation and other federal or state agencies.

Your vehicle is equipped with electronic fuel injec- tion and other electronic components. It is possible for an improperly installed/adjusted two-way radio or cellular telephone to adversely affect electronic systems. For this reason, we recommend that you carefully follow the radio manufacturer’s instruc- tions or consult your HYUNDAI dealer for precau- tionary measures or special instructions if you choose to install one of these devices.

CAUTION: MODIFICATIONS TO YOUR HYUNDAI

TWO-WAY RADIO OR CELLULAR TELEPHONE INSTALLATION

This manual includes information titled as DAN- GER, WARNING, CAUTION and NOTICE. These titles indicate the following:

SAFETY AND VEHICLE DAMAGE WARNING

DANGER indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.

DANGER

WARNING indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.

CAUTION indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in minor or moderate injury.

CAUTION

NOTICE indicates a situation which, if not avoided, could result in vehicle damage.

NOTICE

WARNING

F3

Your Hyundai vehicle may be equipped with technologies and services that use information collected, generated, recorded or stored by the vehicle. Hyundai has created a Vehicle Owner Privacy Policy to explain how these technologies and services collect use and share this information.

You may read our Vehicle Owner Privacy Policy on the Hyundaiusa.com website at: https://www.hyundaiusa.com/owner-privacy-policy.aspx If you would like to receive a hard copy of our Vehicle Owner Privacy Policy, please contact our Customer Connect Center at:

Hyundai Customer Care P.O. Box 20850 Fountain Valley, CA 92728 800-633-5151 consumeraffairs@hmausa.com

Hyundai’s Customer Connect Center representatives are available Monday through Friday, between the hours of 6:00 AM and 5:00 PM PST and Saturday and Sunday between 6:30 AM and 3:00 PM PST (English). For Customer Connect Center assistance in Spanish or Korean, representatives are available Monday through Friday between 6:30 AM and 3:00 PM PST.

HYUNDAI VEHICLE OWNER PRIVACY POLICY

F4

INTRODUCTION

Congratulations, and thank you for choosing HYUNDAI. We are pleased to welcome you to the growing number of dis- cerning people who drive HYUNDAIs. We are very proud of the advanced engineering and high-quality construction of each HYUNDAI we build. Your Owner’s Manual will introduce you to the features and operation of your new HYUNDAI. To become familiar with your new HYUNDAI, so that you can fully enjoy it, read this Owner’s Manual carefully before driving your new vehicle. This manual contains important safety information and instructions intended to familiarize you with your vehicle’s con- trols and safety features so you can safely operate your vehicle. This manual also contains information on maintenance designed to enhance safe operation of the vehicle. It is recom- mended that all service and maintenance on your car be performed by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. HYUNDAI deal- ers are prepared to provide high-quality service, maintenance and any other assistance that may be required. This Owner’s Manual should be considered a permanent part of your vehicle, and should be kept in the vehicle so you can refer to it at any time. The manual should stay with the vehicle if you sell it to provide the next owner with impor- tant operating, safety and maintenance information.

HYUNDAI MOTOR AMERICA

Copyright 2021 HYUNDAI Motor America. All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in any retrieval system or transmitted in any form or by any means without the prior written permission of HYUNDAI Motor America.

Severe engine and transmission damage may result from the use of poor quality fuels and lubricants that do not meet HYUNDAI specifications. You must always use high quality fuels and lubricants that meet the specifications listed on Page 8-7 in the Vehicle Specifications section of the Owner’s Manual.

CAUTION

F5

1. What are HYUNDAI Genuine Parts? HYUNDAI Genuine Parts are the same parts used by HYUNDAI Motor Company to manufacture vehicles. They are designed and tested for the optimum safety, per- formance, and reliability for our customers.

2. Why should you use genuine parts? HYUNDAI Genuine Parts are engineered and built to meet rigid manufacturing requirements. Damage caused by using imita- tion, counterfeit or used salvage parts is not covered under the HYUNDAI New Vehicle Limited Warranty or any other HYUNDAI warranty. In addition, any damage to or fail- ure of HYUNDAI Genuine Parts caused by the installation or fail- ure of an imitation, counterfeit or used salvage part is not covered by any HYUNDAI Warranty.

3. How can you tell if you are pur- chasing HYUNDAI Genuine Parts? Look for the HYUNDAI Genuine Parts Logo on the package (see below). HYUNDAI Genuine Parts export- ed to the U.S. are packaged with labels written only in English. HYUNDAI Genuine Parts are only sold through authorized HYUNDAI Dealerships.

GUIDE TO HYUNDAI GENUINE PARTS

F6

Introduction

We want to help you get the greatest possible driving pleasure from your vehicle. Your Owner’s Manual can assist you in many ways. To gain an overview of the contents of your Owner’s Manual, use the Table of Contents in the front of the manual. The first page of each Chapter includes a detailed Table of Contents of the topics in that Chapter. To quickly locate information about your vehicle, use the Index in the back of the manual. It is an alphabet- ical list of what is in this manual and the page number where it can be found. For your convenience, we have incorporated tabs on the right-hand page edges. These tabs are coded with the Chapter titles to assist you with navigating through the manual.

Your safety, and the safety of others, is very important. This Owner’s Manual provides you with many safe- ty precautions and operating proce- dures. This information alerts you to potential hazards that may hurt you or others, as well as damage to your vehicle. Safety messages found on vehicle labels and in this manual describe these hazards and what to do to avoid or reduce the risks. Warnings and instructions contained in this manual are for your safety. Failure to follow safety warnings and instructions can lead to serious injury or death.

Throughout this manual DANGER, WARNING, CAUTION, NOTICE and the SAFETY ALERT SYMBOL will be used.

This is the safety alert sym- bol. It is used to alert you to potential physical injury haz- ards. Obey all safety mes- sages that follow this symbol to avoid possible injury or death. The safety alert sym- bol precedes the signal words DANGER, WARNING and CAUTION.

HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL

DANGER indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.

DANGER

WARNING indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.

WARNING

SAFETY MESSAGES

F7

Introduction

FUEL REQUIREMENTS

NOTICE indicates a situation which, if not avoided, could result in vehicle damage.

Your new vehicle is designed to obtain maximum performance with UNLEADED FUEL, as well as mini- mize exhaust emissions and spark plug fouling.

Your new vehicle is designed to use only unleaded fuel having an octane number ((R+M)/2) of 87 (Research Octane Number 91) or higher. (Do not use methanol blended fuels)

To prevent damage to the engine and engine components, never add any fuel system cleaning agents to the fuel tank other than what has been specified. Consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for additional information.

Gasoline containing alcohol or methanol Gasohol, a mixture of gasoline and ethanol (also known as grain alco- hol) are being marketed along with or instead of leaded or unleaded gaso- line. For example, «E15» is a gasohol comprised of 15% ethanol and 85% gasoline. Do not use gasohol containing more than 15% ethanol, and do not use gasoline or gasohol containing any methanol. Either of these fuels may cause drivability problems and dam- age to the fuel system, engine con- trol system and emission control sys- tem. Discontinue using gasohol of any kind if drivability problems occur.

NOTICE

NOTICE

CAUTION indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in minor or moder- ate injury.

CAUTION

Do not «top off» after the noz- zle automatically shuts off when refueling.

Always check that the fuel cap is installed securely to pre- vent fuel spillage in the event of an accident.

WARNING

F8

Introduction

«E85» fuel is an alternative fuel com- prised of 85 percent ethanol and 15 percent gasoline, and is manufac- tured exclusively for use in Flexible Fuel Vehicles. «E85» is not compati- ble with your vehicle. Use of «E85» may result in poor engine perform- ance and damage to your vehicle’s engine and fuel system. HYUNDAI recommends that customers do not use fuel with an ethanol content exceeding 15 percent.

To prevent damage to your vehicles engine and fuel system: Never use gasohol which con-

tains methanol. Never use gasohol containing

more than 15% ethanol. Never use leaded fuel or leaded

gasohol. Never use «E85» fuel. Your New Vehicle Limited Warranty does not cover damage to the fuel system or any perform- ance problems caused by the use of «E85» fuel.

Using Fuel Additives (except Detergent Fuel Additives) Using fuel additives such as: — Silicone fuel additive — Ferrocene (iron-based) fuel additive — Other metallic-based fuel additives may result in cylinder misfire, poor acceleration, engine stalling, dam- age to the catalyst, or abnormal cor- rosion, and may cause damage to the engine resulting in a reduction in the overall life of the powertrain. — The Malfunction Indicator Lamp

(MIL) may illuminate.

Damage to the fuel system or per- formance problem caused by the use of these fuels or fuel additives may not be covered by your New Vehicle Limited Warranty.

Gasoline containing MMT Some gasoline contains harmful manganese-based fuel additives such as MMT (Methylcyclopentadienyl Manganese Tricarbonyl). HYUNDAI does not recommend the use of gasoline containing MMT. This type of fuel can reduce vehicle performance and affect your emis- sion control system. The malfunction indicator lamp on the cluster may come on.

Detergent Fuel Additives HYUNDAI recommends that you use good quality gasolines treated with detergent additives such as TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline, which help pre- vent deposit formation in the engine. These gasolines will help the engine run cleaner and enhance performance of the Emission Control System. For more information on TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline, please go to the website (www.toptiergas.com).

NOTICE

NOTICE

F9

Introduction

For customers who do not use TOP Tier Detergent Gasoline regularly, and have problems starting or the engine does not run smoothly, deter- gent-based fuel additives that you can purchase separately may be added to the gasoline. If TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is not available, one bottle of additive added to the fuel tank according to the mainte- nance schedule is recommended (refer to the Maintenance Schedule in chapter 7). Additives are available from your authorized HYUNDAI dealer along with information on how to use them. Do not mix other additives.

Operation in foreign countries If you are going to drive your vehicle in another country, be sure to: Observe all regulations regarding

registration and insurance. Determine that acceptable fuel is

available.

This vehicle should not be modi- fied. Modification of your vehicle could affect its performance, safety or durability and may even violate governmental safety and emis- sions regulations. In addition, damage or perform- ance problems resulting from any modification may not be covered under warranty.

If you use unauthorized electronic devices, it may cause the vehicle to operate abnormally, wire damage, battery discharge and fire. For your safety, do not use unauthorized electronic devices.

By following a few simple precautions for the first 600 miles (1,000 km) you may add to the performance, econo- my and life of your vehicle. Do not race the engine. While driving, keep your engine

speed (rpm, or revolutions per minute) between 2,000 rpm and 4,000 rpm.

Do not maintain a single speed for long periods of time, either fast or slow.Varying engine speed is need- ed to properly break-in the engine.

Avoid hard stops, except in emer- gencies, to allow the brakes to seat properly. Do not tow a trailer during the first 1,200 miles (2,000 km) of operation.

Do not tow a trailer during the first 1,200 miles (2,000 km) of opera- tion.

Fuel economy and engine perform- ance, engine oil consumption may vary depending on vehicle break-in process and be stabilized after driving about 4,000 miles. New engines may consume more oil during the vehicle break-in period.

VEHICLE BREAK-IN PROCESSVEHICLE MODIFICATIONS

F10

Introduction

This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder (EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air bag deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a vehicles systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related to vehicle dynamics and safety sys- tems for a short period of time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record such data as: How various systems in your

vehicle were operating; Whether or not the driver and

passenger safety belts were buckled/fastened;

How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator and/or brake pedal; and,

How fast the vehicle was travel- ing.

These data can help provide a bet- ter understanding of the circum- stances in which crashes and injuries occur.

NOTE: EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data are recorded by the EDR under normal driving conditions and no personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash location) are recorded. However, other parties, such as law enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash investigation. To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that have the special equipment, can read the information if they have access to the vehicle or the EDR. Vehicle break-in process Fuel economy and engine performance may vary depending on vehicle break-in process and be stabilized after 4,000 miles (6,000 km). New engines may consume more oil during the vehicle break-in period.

VEHICLE DATA COLLECTION AND EVENT DATA RECORDERS

CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65 WARNING

Items contained in motor vehi- cles or emitted from them are known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or reproductive harm. These include: Gasoline and its vapors Engine exhaust Used engine oil Interior passenger compart-

ment components and materi- als

Component parts which are subject to heat and wear

In addition, battery posts, termi- nals and related accessories contain lead, lead compounds and other chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and reproductive harm. For more information go to https://www.p65warnings.ca.go v/passenger-vehicle

WARNING

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8

I

Your Vehicle at a Glance

Safety System of Your Vehicle

Convenience Features

Multimedia System

Driving Your Vehicle

What to Do in an Emergency

Maintenance

Specifications, Consumer Information and Reporting Safety Defects

Index

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Your vehicle at a glance

1

Your vehicle at a glance

Exterior Overview…………………………………………..1-2 Interior Overview ……………………………………………1-4 Instrument Panel Overview …………………………….1-5 Engine Compartment ………………………………………1-6

1-2

EXTERIOR OVERVIEW

Your vehicle at a glance

1. Hood………………………………………………3-66

2. Front lamps …………………………..3-145, 7-61

3. Tires and wheels……………………….7-33, 8-5

4. Side view mirror ………………………………3-52

5. Sunroof…………………………………………..3-59

6. Wiper blade ……………………………………7-27

7. Windows …………………………………………3-55

8. Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning system …………………………….3-170

OLX2019001N

Front view

The actual shape may differ from the illustration.

1-3

Your vehicle at a glance

1

1. Door ………………………………………………3-16

2. Fuel filler door ………………………………..3-79

3. Rear lamps……………………………………..7-64

4. Liftgate …………………………………………..3-67

5. High mounted stop lamp ………………….7-66

6. Wiper blade ……………………………………7-28

7. Reverse Parking Distance Warning system …………………………………………3-166

8. Antenna …………………………………………..4-2

9. Rear View Camera …………………………3-162 OLX2018002L

Rear view

The actual shape may differ from the illustration.

1-4

Your vehicle at a glance

INTERIOR OVERVIEW

1. Inside door handle …………………………..3-17

2. Central door lock/unlock switch …………3-18

3. Power window switches ……………………3-55

4. Power window lock button/ ………………..3-58 Electronic child safety lock button……….3-21

5. Side view mirror control switch …………..3-53

6. Instrument panel illumination control switch ………………………………….3-84

7. Blind-spot Collision Warning system ………………………………….5-85, 5-96

8. Lane Keeping Assist system………………5-78

9. ESC OFF button ………………………………5-35

10. Power liftgate button ……………………….3-69

11. EPB(Electronic Parking Brake) …………5-24

12. Hood release lever …………………………3-66

13. Steering wheel tilt/telescopic lever ……3-37

14. Steering wheel ………………………………3-36

15. Seat………………………………………………..2-4

16. Fuse box ……………………………………….7-51

OLX2019003N

The actual shape may differ from the illustration.

INSTRUMENT PANEL OVERVIEW (I)

The actual shape may differ from the illustration.

1-5

Your vehicle at a glance

1

OLX2019004N

1. Instrument cluster………………………………..3-82 2. Driver’s front air bag…………………………….2-59 3. Key ignition switch/………………………………..5-7

Engine Start/Stop button ……………………..5-10 4. Hazard warning flasher switch ………………..6-2 5. Audio/Video/Navigation System ………………4-4 6. Manual climate control system/ …………..3-184

Automatic climate control system…………3-196 7. Automatic transmission shift button ……….5-15 8. Auto Hold …………………………………………..5-29 9. Drive mode knob…………………………5-55, 5-59 10. DBC button……………………………………….5-39 11. Forward/Reverse Parking Distance

Warning button ………………………………..3-166 12. Idle stop and go (ISG) OFF button ……..5-51 13. Surround view monitor ……………………..3-176 14. Air ventilation seat …………………………….2-27 15. Seat warmer……………………………………..2-26 16. Heated steering wheel ……………………….3-32 17. Air ventilation seat (2nd row) ………………..2-27 18. Seat warmer (2nd row) ……………………….2-26 19. Climate control system (rear)…………….3-188 20. Power outlet ……………………………………3-222 21. AC inverter ……………………………………..3-223 22. Passenger’s front air bag ……………………2-59 23. Glove box ……………………………………….3-217 24. Light control/Turn signals ………………….3-147 25. Wiper/Washer………………………………….3-158 26. Steering wheel audio controls ………………4-3 27. Smart Cruise Controls ……………………..5-151 28. Wireless cellular phone charging

system …………………………………………..3-226

1-6

Your vehicle at a glance

ENGINE COMPARTMENT

1. Engine coolant reservoir ……………….7-18

2. Radiator cap ……………………………….7-19

3. Brake fluid reservoir……………………..7-21

4. Air cleaner…………………………………..7-22

5. Engine oil filler cap ………………………7-16

6. Engine oil dipstick ………………………..7-16

7. Windshield washer fluid reservoir …..7-22

8. Fuse box …………………………………….7-55

9. Battery terminal [+] ………………………7-29

10. Battery terminal [-] …………………….7-29

OLX2078002L

The actual engine compartment in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.

Gasoline 3.8 GDI

Safety system of your vehicle

Important Safety Precautions…………………………2-2 Always Wear Your Seat Belt ……………………………………2-2 Restrain All Children …………………………………………………2-2 Air Bag Hazards………………………………………………………..2-2 Driver Distraction ……………………………………………………..2-2 Control Your Speed…………………………………………………..2-3 Keep Your Vehicle in Safe Condition……………………….2-3

Seats ………………………………………………………………2-4 Safety Precautions …………………………………………………..2-5 Front Seats ……………………………………………………………….2-6 Rear Seats……………………………………………………………….2-13 Head Restraints ………………………………………………………2-21 Seat Warmers and Air Ventilation Seats……………….2-26

Seat Belts ……………………………………………………..2-29 Seat Belt Safety Precautions…………………………………2-29 Seat Belt Warning Light …………………………………………2-30 Seat Belt Restraint System…………………………………….2-33 Additional Seat Belt Safety Precautions……………….2-41 Care of Seat Belt…………………………………………………….2-44

Child Restraint System (CRS)………………………..2-45 Children Always in the Rear…………………………………..2-45 Selecting a Child Restraint System (CRS) ……………..2-47 Installing a Child Restraint System (CRS)………………2-49

Air Bag — Advanced Supplemental Restraint System ………………………………………………………….2-57

Where Are the Air Bags?……………………………………….2-59 How Does the Air Bag System Operate?………………2-63 What to Expect After an Air Bag Inflates…………….2-67 Occupant Classification System (OCS)…………………..2-68 Why Didn’t My Air Bag Go Off in a Collision? ……..2-73 SRS Care………………………………………………………………….2-78 Additional Safety Precautions ……………………………….2-79 Air Bag Warning Label……………………………………………2-79

This chapter provides you with important information about how to protect yourself and your passengers. It explains how to properly use your seats and seat belts, and how your air bags work. Additionally, this chapter explains how to properly restrain infants and children in your vehicle.

2

2-2

You will find many safety precautions and recommendations throughout this section, and throughout this manual. The safety precautions in this section are among the most important.

Always Wear Your Seat Belt A seat belt is your best protection in all types of accidents. Air bags are designed to supplement seat belts, not replace them. So even though your vehicle is equipped with air bags, ALWAYS make sure you and your passengers wear your seat belts, and wear them properly.

Restrain All Children All children under age 13 should ride in your vehicle properly restrained in a rear seat, not the front seat. Infants and small children should be restrained in an appropriate child restraint. Larger children should use a booster seat with the lap/shoulder belt until they can use the seat belt properly without a booster seat.

Air Bag Hazards While air bags can save lives, they can also cause serious or fatal injuries to occupants who sit too close to them, or who are not prop- erly restrained. Infants, young chil- dren, and shorter adults are at the greatest risk of being injured by an inflating air bag. Follow all instruc- tions and warnings in this manual.

Driver Distraction Driver distraction presents a serious and potentially deadly danger, espe- cially for inexperienced drivers. Safety should be the first concern when behind the wheel and drivers need to be aware of the wide array of potential distractions, such as drowsiness, reaching for objects, eating, personal grooming, other passengers, and using cellular phones. Drivers can become distracted when they take their eyes and attention off the road or their hands off the wheel to focus on activities other than driv- ing. To reduce your risk of distraction or getting into an accident: ALWAYS set up your mobile

devices (i.e., MP3 players, phones, navigation units, etc.) when your vehicle is parked or safely stopped.

IMPORTANT SAFETY PRECAUTIONS

Safety system of your vehicle

2-3

Safety system of your vehicle

ONLY use your mobile device when allowed by laws and when conditions permit safe use. NEVER text or email while driving. Most states have laws prohibiting drivers from texting. Some states and cities also prohibit drivers from using handheld phones.

NEVER let the use of a mobile device distract you from driving. You have a responsibility to your passengers and others on the road to always drive safely, with your hands on the wheel as well as your eyes and attention on the road.

Control Your Speed Excessive speed is a major factor in crash injuries and deaths. Generally, the higher the speed, the greater the risk, but serious injuries can also occur at lower speeds. Never drive faster than is safe for current condi- tions, regardless of the maximum speed posted.

Keep Your Vehicle in Safe Condition Having a tire blowout or a mechani- cal failure can be extremely haz- ardous. To reduce the possibility of such problems, check your tire pres- sures and condition frequently, and perform all regularly scheduled maintenance.

2

2-4

Safety system of your vehicle

SEATS

Front seats (1) Seat sliding forward or rearward (2) Seatback angle adjustment (3) Seat cushion angle adjustment (4) Seat height adjustment (5) Lumbar support adjustment

(Drivers seat)* (6) Seat cushion length adjustment* (7) Seat warmer* (8) Air ventilation seat* (9) Head restraint

2nd row seat (10) Seat sliding forward or rearward (11) Seatback angle adjustment /

seat folding (12) Walk-in switch (13) Head restraint (14) Head restraint (8 passengers) (15) Seat warmer* (16) Air ventilation seat* (17) Seat folding strap

3rd row seat (18) Head restraints (19) 2nd row seat remote folding switch (20) 3rd row seat remote folding/

unfolding switch* (21) Seatback angle adjustment

(for 3rd row seat)*

* : if equipped OLX2039001N

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Safety Precautions Adjusting the seats so that you are sitting in a safe, comfortable position plays an important role in driver and passenger safety together with the seat belts and air bags in an acci- dent.

Air bags You can take steps to reduce the risk of being injured by an inflating air bag. Sitting too close to an air bag greatly increases the risk of injury in the event the air bag inflates. The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) recom- mends that drivers allow at least 10 inches (25 cm) between the center of the steering wheel and their chest.

Seat belts Always fasten your seat belt before starting any trip. At all times, passengers should sit upright and be properly restrained. Infants and small children must be restrained in appropriate child restraint systems. Adults and chil- dren who have outgrown a booster seat must be restrained using the seat belts.

Do not use a cushion that reduces friction between the seat and the passenger. The passenger’s hips may slide under the lap portion of the seat belt during an accident or a sudden stop. Serious or fatal internal injuries could result because the seat belt cannot operate properly.

WARNING

To reduce the risk of serious injury or death from an inflating air bag, take the following pre- cautions: Adjust the driver’s seat as far

to the rear as possible while maintaining the ability to maintain full control of the vehicle.

Adjust the front passenger seat as far to the rear as pos- sible.

Hold the steering wheel by the rim with hands at the 9 o’clock and 3 o’clock positions to minimize the risk of injuries to your hands and arms.

NEVER place anything or any- one between the steering wheel and the air bag.

Do not allow the front passen- ger to place feet or legs on the dashboard to minimize the risk of leg injuries.

WARNING

2-5

2-6

Safety system of your vehicle

Front Seats

Take the following precautions when adjusting your seat: NEVER attempt to adjust the

seat while the vehicle is mov- ing. The seat could respond with unexpected movement and may cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an acci- dent.

Do not place anything under the front seats. Loose objects in the driver’s foot area could interfere with the operation of the foot pedals, causing an accident.

Do not allow anything to inter- fere with the normal position and proper locking of the seat- back.

Do not place a cigarette lighter on the floor or seat. When you operate the seat, gas may exit out of the lighter causing a fire.

WARNING

To prevent injury:

Do not adjust your seat while wearing your seat belt. Moving the seat cushion for- ward may cause strong pres- sure on your abdomen.

Do not allow your hands or fingers to get caught in the seat mechanisms while the seat is moving.

CAUTION

Use extreme caution when picking up small objects trapped under the seats or between the seat and the cen- ter console. Your hands might be cut or injured by the sharp edges of the seat mechanism.

Take the following precautions when adjusting your seat belt: NEVER use one seat belt for

more than one occupant. Always position the seatback

upright with the lap portion of the seat belt snug and low across the hips.

NEVER allow children or small infants to ride on a pas- senger’s lap.

Do not route the seat belt across your neck, across sharp edges, or reroute the shoulder strap away from your body.

Do not allow the seat belt to become caught or jammed.

WARNING

2-7

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Manual adjustment (if equipped) The front seat can be adjusted by using the levers located on the out- side of the seat cushion. Before driv- ing, adjust the seat to the proper position so that you can easily con- trol the steering wheel, foot pedals and controls on the instrument panel.

Forward and rearward adjustment

To move the seat forward or rearward: 1. Pull up the seat slide adjustment

lever and hold it. 2. Slide the seat to the position you

desire. 3. Release the lever and make sure

the seat is locked in place. Move forward and rearward without using the lever. If the seat moves, it is not locked properly.

Seatback angle

To recline the seatback: 1. Lean forward slightly and lift up

the seatback lever. 2. Carefully lean back on the seat

and adjust the seatback to the position you desire.

3. Release the lever and make sure the seatback is locked in place. (The lever MUST return to its orig- inal position for the seatback to lock.)

OLX2038070 OLX2038072

2-8

Safety system of your vehicle

Reclining seatback Sitting in a reclined position when the vehicle is in motion can be dan- gerous. Even when buckled up, the protection of your restraint system (seat belts and air bags) is greatly reduced by reclining your seatback.

Seat belts must be snug against your hips and chest to work properly. When the seatback is reclined, the shoulder belt cannot do its job because it will not be snug against your chest. Instead, it will be in front of you. During an accident, you could be thrown into the seat belt, causing neck or other injuries. The more the seatback is reclined, the greater chance the passenger’s hips will slide under the lap belt or the passenger’s neck will strike the shoulder belt.

Seat cushion height

To change the height of the seat cushion: Push down on the lever several

times, to lower the seat cushion. Pull up on the lever several times,

to raise the seat cushion.

OLX2038071 NEVER ride with a reclined seatback when the vehicle is moving. Riding with a reclined seatback increases your chance of seri- ous or fatal injuries in the event of a collision or sudden stop. Drivers and passengers should ALWAYS sit well back in their seats, properly belted, and with the seatbacks upright.

WARNING

2-9

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Power adjustment (if equipped) The front seat can be adjusted by using the control switches located on the outside of the seat cushion. Before driving, adjust the seat to the proper position so that you can easily control the steering wheel, foot pedals and controls on the instrument panel.

To prevent damage to the seats: Always stop adjusting the seats

when the seat has moved as far forward or rearward as possible.

Do not adjust the seats for longer than necessary when the vehicle is turned off. This may result in unnecessary battery drain.

Do not operate two or more seats at the same time.This may result in an electrical malfunc- tion.

Forward and rearward adjustment

To move the seat forward or rearward: 1. Push the control switch forward or

rearward. 2. Release the switch once the seat

reaches the desired position.

NOTICE

NEVER allow children in the vehicle unattended. The power seats are operable when the vehicle is turned off.

WARNING OLX2038003

2-10

Safety system of your vehicle

Cushion extension (for driver’s seat, if equipped)

To move the front part of cushion for- ward: 1. Push the front part of control

switch to move the seat cushion to the desired length.

2. Release the switch once the seat cushion reaches the desired length.

To move the front part of cushion rearward: 1. Push the rear part of control

switch to move the seat cushion to the desired length.

2. Release the switch once the seat cushion reaches the desired length.

Seatback angle

To adjust the seatback: 1. Rotate the top of control switch

forward or rearward. 2. Release the switch once the seat-

back reaches the desired position.

Reclining seatback Sitting in a reclined position when the vehicle is in motion can be dan- gerous. Even when buckled up, the protection of your restraint system (seat belts and air bags) is greatly reduced by reclining your seatback.

OLX2038004 OLX2038005 NEVER ride with a reclined seatback when the vehicle is moving. Riding with a reclined seatback increases your chance of seri- ous or fatal injuries in the event of a collision or sudden stop. Driver and passengers should ALWAYS sit well back in their seats, properly belted, and with the seatbacks upright.

WARNING

2-11

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Seat belts must be snug against your hips and chest to work properly. When the seatback is reclined, the shoulder belt cannot do its job because it will not be snug against your chest. Instead, it will be in front of you. During an accident, you could be thrown into the seat belt, causing neck or other injuries. The more the seatback is reclined, the greater chance the passengers hips will slide under the lap belt or the passenger’s neck will strike the shoulder belt.

Seat cushion tilt (1)

To change the angle of the front part of the seat cushion: Push the front portion of the control switch up to raise or down to lower the front part of the seat cushion. Release the switch once the seat reaches the desired position.

Seat cushion height (2)

To change the height of the seat cushion: Push the rear portion of the control switch up to raise or down to lower the height of the seat cushion. Release the switch once the seat reaches the desired position.

Lumbar support (2way) (for dri- vers seat)

The lumbar support can be adjusted by pressing the lumbar support switch. The lumbar support can be adjust-

ed by pressing the lumbar support switch.

Press the front portion of the switch (1) to increase support or the rear portion of the switch (2) to decrease support.

OLX2038006 OLX2038007

2-12

Safety system of your vehicle

Lumbar support (4way) (for dri- vers seat) (if equipped)

The lumbar support can be adjusted by pressing the lumbar support switch. Press the front portion of the

switch (1) to increase support or the rear portion of the switch (2) to decrease support.

To move the support position up or down, press switch (3) or (4).

Seatback pocket

The seatback pocket is provided on the back of the front passenger’s seatback.

To prevent the Occupant Classification System from mal- functioning: Do not hang onto the front pas- senger’s seatback.

WARNING

OLX2038013

Do not put heavy or sharp objects in the seatback pockets. In an accident they could come loose from the pocket and injure occupants.

CAUTION

2-13

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Rear Seats Rear seat adjustment

Above picture shows a 7-seater vehicle.

Forward and rearward (2nd row seat)

To move the seat forward or rear- ward: 1. Pull the seat slide adjustment

lever up and hold it. 2. Slide the seat to the position you

desire. 3. Release the lever and make sure

the seat is locked in place. Adjust the seat before driving, and make sure the seat is locked secure- ly by trying to move forward and rear- ward without using the lever. If the seat moves, it is not locked properly.

Seatback angle (2nd row seat)

To recline the seatback: 1. Pull up the seatback recline lever. 2. Hold the lever and adjust the seat-

back of the seat to the position you desire.

3. Release the lever and make sure the seatback is locked in place.

(The lever MUST return to its original position for the seatback to lock.)

Seatback angle (3rd row seat) (Type A)

To recline the seatback: 1. Pull up the seatback recline strap. 2. Hold the strap and adjust the seat-

back of the seat to the position you desire.

3. Release the strap and make sure the seatback is locked in place. (The strap MUST return to its orig- inal position for the seatback to lock.)

OLX2038074

OLX2038075 OLX2039078N

2-14

Seatback angle (3rd row seat) (Type B)

To recline the seatback: 1. Push the control switch to recline

the seat back. 2. Release the switch once the seat-

back reaches the desired position.

To get in or out of the 3rd row seat, 1. Routing the seat belt webbing

through the rear seat belt guide clip. After inserting the seat belt, tighten the belt webbing by pulling it up.

2. Push the walk-in switch located on top (1) of the 2nd row seat or the side (2) of the seat bottom cush- ion.

3. The 2nd row seatback will be fold- ed and push the seat to the far- thest forward position.

After getting in or out, slide the 2nd row seat to the farthest rearward position and pull the seatback firmly backward until it clicks into place. Make sure that the seat is locked in place.

Safety system of your vehicle

OLX2039015N

OLX2038018

OLX2038019

OLX2038020

Walk-in seat (2nd row seat)

2-15

Safety system of your vehicle

Folding the rear seat The rear seatbacks can be folded to facilitate carrying long items or to increase the luggage capacity of the vehicle. 2

Never allow passengers to sit on top of the folded down seatback while the vehicle is moving. This is not a proper seating position and no seat belts are available for use. This could result in serious injury or death in case of an accident or sudden stop.

Objects carried on the folded down seatback should not extend higher than the top of the front seatbacks. This could allow cargo to slide for- ward and cause injury or dam- age during sudden stops.

WARNING

Never attempt to adjust while the vehicle is moving or the 2nd row seat is occupied as the seat may suddenly move and cause the passenger on the seat to be injured.

WARNING

If the walk-in switch does not work, pull the strap (1) located on the lower left side of the seat. Then you can move the 2nd row seat forward. (7 passenger vehicle — Left seat : lower right side — Right seat : lower left side 8 passenger vehicle — Right seat : lower left side)

Never attempt to pull the strap (1) while the 2nd row seat is occupied as the seat may sud- denly move and cause the passenger on the seat to be injured. Use only the strap when the walk-in switch does not work.

WARNING

OLX2038021

2-16

Safety system of your vehicle

To fold down the rear seatback: 1. Set the front seatback to the

upright position and if necessary, slide the front seat forward.

2. Lower the rear head restraints to the lowest position.

3. Locate the seatbelt webbing in the guide before folding down the seatback to avoid the seatbelt sys- tem interfering with the seatback.

4. Pull up the seatback recline lever, then fold the seat toward the front of the vehicle.

OLX2038018 OLX2038022N

2nd row seat

OLX2039079N

3rd row seat

2-17

Safety system of your vehicle

2

5. To use the rear seat, lift and unfold the seatback to the upright posi- tion by pulling up the recline lever. Push the seatback firmly until it clicks into place. Make sure the seatback is locked in place.

6. Return the rear seat belt to the proper position.

Do not place objects in the rear seats, since they cannot be properly secured and may hit vehicle occupants in a collision causing serious injury or death.

WARNING

When returning the rear seat- back from a folded to an upright position, hold the seatback and return it slowly. Ensure that the seatback is completely locked into its upright position by pushing on the top of the seat- back. In an accident or sudden stop, the unlocked seatback could allow cargo to move for- ward with great force and enter the passenger compartment, which could result in serious injury or death.

WARNING

OLX2039024N

2nd row seat

OLX2039096N

3rd row seat

Make sure the vehicle is off, the shift button is in P (Park), and the parking brake is securely applied whenever loading or unloading cargo. Failure to take these steps may allow the vehicle to move if the shift button is inadvertently shifted to another position.

WARNING

Be careful when loading cargo through the rear pas- senger seats to prevent dam- age to the vehicle interior.

When cargo is loaded through the rear passenger seats, ensure the cargo is properly secured to prevent it from moving while driving.

Unsecured cargo in the pas- senger compartment can cause damage to the vehicle or injury to it’s occupants.

CAUTION

2-18

Safety system of your vehicle

2nd row seat folding (from outside)

Push the 2nd row seat back folding switch (1) located on the left side of the cargo area. (L : Left seatback folding, R : Right seatback folding)

3rd row seat remote folding/unfolding (if equipped)

Push the 3rd row seat back folding switch (1) located on the left side of the cargo area. (L : Left seatback folding/unfolding, R : Right seatback folding/unfolding) You can also fold or unfold the left or right seatback of the 3rd row seat by touching the menu (All menus Setup Vehicle in the Infotainment system). For more details, refer to the sep- arately supplied Multimedia manu- al with your vehicle.

The 3rd row seat that is remotely folded or unfolded, is controlled only when the shift button is in P with Start ON, or the shift button is in N and the parking brake is in ON. However, the seat is controlled at any condition in Start OFF state. When the vehicle moves or shifts while the seat is being controlled, the seat may stop operation. When you press the switch once more while folding and unfolding the seat, operation stops. When you press the switch again, the operation resumes. With the seat folded, when you press the angle adjusting switch, the seat is unfolded.

OLX2039026N OLX2039030N

Rear seat folding

Do not fold the rear seats(2nd & 3rd row seats), if passengers, pets or luggage are on the rear seats. It may cause injury or damage to passengers, pets, luggage.

WARNING

2-19

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Detection of object caught While folding or unfolding the 3rd row seat, when a consistent force is detected, the seat returns to its orig- inal position or stops operation. However, this function may not work when the detected resistance is below a specific level or the seat is almost folded or unfolded. When a strong impact is applied to the seat, the object detection function may be activated even if no obstacle is pres- ent. When any object caught is detected multiple times while operating the seat once, folding and unfolding are repeated consecutively and then the operation may stop. In this case, check that any object is caught and then operate the switch again to check for abnormality. When the object detection is enabled, the angle of the seat back may be changed. When you operate the seat once by pressing the folding button, the angle of the seat back is reset.

Do not place any part of your body or anything in the operat- ing area to intentionally check the detection of any object caught. For safety, when folding or unfolding the 3rd row seat, make sure that there is no part of body or object. To prevent damage to the seatbelt, insert it into its holder and store it in the retractor inside a seat. When the child restraint system (CRS) is installed on the 3rd row seat, remove the CRS and then operate the seat. When there is any object on the cushion of the 3rd row seat, remove it and then operate the seat. To avoid interference with a front seat, keep the backrest of the front seat straight and move it forward for smooth operation.

WARNING

Without starting the engine, the 3rd row seat can be folded or unfolded. When this is attempt- ed more than 10 times, the bat- tery may discharge premature- ly. Do not apply excessive force to the 3rd row seat while in opera- tion. It may damage the seat. When you operate the seat over 5 times with no rest, the electric motor may be overloaded. In this case, the seat changes to overheat prevention mode. Then you cannot operate the seat by pressing the switch. Leave the seat for over 1 minute for later operation.

CAUTION

2-20

Armrest (2nd row, 8 passengers vehicle)

The armrest is located in the center of the rear seat. Use the strap in the center of the armrest to pull it down.

Armrest (2nd row, 7 passengers vehicle)

Pull the armrest down from the seat- back to use it.

Rear occupant alert system (if equipped) This function alerts the driver when exiting the vehicle to check the 2nd row seat. If the rear doors are open prior to driving the vehicle, after driving when the vehicle is turned off, a warning message appears in the cluster to give a first warning. If the movement is detected in the 2nd row seat after you lock all doors, a second warning alerts you. Make sure to check for passengers in the 2nd row seat before you get out. For more details, refer to the Rear Occupant Alert System in chap- ter 3.

Safety system of your vehicle

OLX2039077N OLX2038017

2-21

Safety system of your vehicle

Head Restraints The vehicle’s front and rear seats have adjustable head restraints. The head restraints provide comfort for passengers, but more importantly they are designed to help protect passengers from whiplash and other neck and spinal injuries during an accident, especially in a rear impact collision.

To prevent damage, NEVER hit or pull on the head restraints.

NOTICE

2

To help reduce the risk of seri- ous injury or death in an acci- dent, take the following precau- tions when adjusting your head restraints: Always properly adjust the

head restraints for all passen- gers BEFORE starting the vehicle.

NEVER let anyone ride in a seat with the head restraints removed or reversed.

Adjust the head restraints so the middle of the head restraint is at the same height as the height of the top of the eyes.

NEVER adjust the head restraint position of the dri- ver’s seat when the vehicle is in motion.

Adjust the head restraint as close to the passenger’s head as possible. Do not use a seat cushion that holds the body away from the seatback.

Make sure the head restraint locks into position after adjusting it.

WARNING

OLF034072N

When there is no occupant in the rear seats, adjust the height of the head restraint to the low- est position. The rear seat head restraint can reduce the visibili- ty of the rear area.

CAUTION

2-22

Safety system of your vehicle

Front seat head restraints

The vehicle’s front and passenger’s seats are equipped with adjustable head restraints for the passengers safety and comfort.

Adjusting the height up and down

To raise the head restraint: 1. Pull it up to the desired position

(1).

To lower the head restraint: 1. Push and hold the release button

(2) on the head restraint support. 2. Lower the head restraint to the

desired position (3).

If you recline the seatback towards the front with the head restraint and seat cushion raised, the head restraint may come in contact with the sunvisor or other parts of the vehicle.

NOTICEOLX2038097L

OLX2038010 OLF034015

2-23

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Removal/Reinstallation

To remove the head restraint: 1. Recline the seatback (2) rearward

using the seatback angle lever/ switch (1).

2. Raise the head restraint as far as it can go.

3. Press the head restraint release button (3) while pulling the head restraint up (4).

To reinstall the head restraint: 1. Put the head restraint poles (2) into

the holes while pressing the release button (1).

OLX2038073

OLX2038011L

Type A

Type B

OLX2038095

OLX2038012L

Type A

Type B

2-24

Safety system of your vehicle

2. Adjust the head restraint to the appropriate height.

3. Adjust the seatback (4) forward using the seatback angle lever/ switch (3).

Rear seat head restraints

* : For 8 passengers vehicle

The rear seats are equipped with head restraints in all the seating positions for the passenger’s safety and comfort.

OLX2038098L

Adjust the head restraint so the middle of the head restraint is at the same height as the height of the top of the eyes.

When seated on the rear seat, do not adjust the height of the head restraint to the lowest position.

CAUTION

2-25

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Adjusting the height up and down

To raise the head restraint: 1. Pull it up to the desired position (1).

To lower the head restraint: 1. Push and hold the release button

(2) on the head restraint support. 2. Lower the head restraint to the

desired position (3).

Removal/Reinstallation

To remove the head restraint: 1. Raise the head restraint as far as

it can go. 2. Press the head restraint release

button (1) while pulling the head restraint up (2).

To reinstall the head restraint: 1. Put the head restraint poles into

the holes (3) while pressing the release button (1).

2. Adjust the head restraint to the appropriate height.

Folding 3rd row headrest (except for center)

The headrest will fold down automat- ically when folding the seatback. To fold the headrest manually: — Pull the strap. To unfold the headrest manually: — Raise the headrest manually.

Always be sure the headrest has locked into position after you return the seatback.

OLX2039016NOLX2039014N

OLX2039103N

2-26

Safety system of your vehicle

Seat Warmers and Air Ventilation Seats Seat warmers (if equipped) Seat warmers are provided to warm the seats during cold weather.

To prevent damage to the seat warmers and seats: Never use a solvent such as

paint thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline to clean the seats.

Do not place heavy or sharp objects on seats equipped with seat warmers.

Do not change the seat cover. It may damage the seat warmer.

While the engine is running, push either of the switches to warm the driver’s seat or front passenger’s seat. During mild weather or under condi- tions where the operation of the seat warmer is not needed, keep the switches in the OFF position.

NOTICE

OLX2038031

Front seat

OLX2038076

Rear seat (2nd row)

People taking medication that can cause drowsiness or sleepiness.

NEVER place anything on the seat that insulates against heat when the seat warmer is in oper- ation, such as a blanket or seat cushion. This may cause the seat warmer to overheat, caus- ing a burn or damage to the seat.

WARNING

The seat warmers can cause a SERIOUS BURN, even at low temperatures and especially if used for long periods of time. Passengers must be able to feel if the seat is becoming too warm so they can turn it off, if needed. People who cannot detect tem- perature change or pain to the skin should use extreme cau- tion, especially the following types of passengers: Infants, children, elderly or

disabled persons, or hospital outpatients.

People with sensitive skin or who burn easily.

Fatigued individuals. Intoxicated individuals.

WARNING

2-27

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Each time you push the switch, the temperature setting of the seat changed as shown below:

When pressing the switch for more than 1.5 seconds with the seat warmer operating, the seat warmer will turn OFF.

The seat warmer defaults to the OFF position whenever the vehi- cle is turned on.

Information With the seat warmer switch in the ON position, the heating system in the seat turns off or on automatically depending on the seat temperature.

Front air ventilation seat (if equipped)

The air ventilation seats are provided to cool the front seats by blowing air through small vent holes on the sur- face of the seat cushions and seat- backs.

When the operation of the air ventila- tion seat is not needed, keep the switches in the OFF position. While the engine is running, push the switch to cool the driver’s seat or the front passenger’s seat. Each time you push the switch,

the airflow changes as follows:

When pressing the switch for more than 1.5 seconds with the air ventilation seat operating, the operation will turn OFF.i

OFF HIGH ( )

LOW ( ) MIDDLE ( )

OFF HIGH ( )

LOW ( ) MIDDLE ( )

OLX2038028

Front seat

OLX2038029

Rear seat (2nd row)

2-28

Safety system of your vehicle

The air ventilation seat defaults to the OFF position whenever the vehicle is turned on.

Information If the outside temperature is under

approximately 33F (2C), the air ventilation seat may not operate.

Use the air ventilation seat when the climate control system is on. Using the air ventilation seat for prolonged periods of time with the climate con- trol system off could cause the cli- mate control seat performance to be reduced.

To prevent damage to the air ven- tilation seat: Use the air ventilation seat ONLY

when the climate control system is on. Using the air ventilation seat for prolonged periods of time with the climate control system off could cause the air ventilation seat to malfunction.

Never use a solvent such as paint thinner, benzene, alcohol or gasoline to clean the seats.

Avoid spilling liquids on the sur- face of the front seats and seat- backs; this may cause the air vent holes to become blocked and not work properly.

Do not place materials such as plastic bags or newspapers under the seats. They may block the air intake causing the air vents to not work properly.

Do not change the seat covers. It may damage the air ventilation seat.

If the air vents do not operate, restart the vehicle. If there is no change, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

NOTICE

i

2-29

Safety system of your vehicle

2

This section describes how to use the seat belts properly. It also describes some of the things to avoid when using seat belts.

Seat Belt Safety Precautions Always fasten your seat belt and make sure all passengers have fas- tened their seat belts before starting any trip. Air bags are designed to supplement the seat belt as an addi- tional safety device, but they are not a substitute. Most states require all occupants of a vehicle to wear seat belts.

SEAT BELTS

Seat belts must be used by ALL passengers whenever the vehi- cle is moving.Take the following precautions when adjusting and wearing seat belts: ALWAYS properly restrain

children under age 13 in the rear seats.

WARNING

NEVER allow children to ride in the front passenger seat. If a child age 13 or older must be seated in the front seat, move the seat as far back as possi- ble and properly restrain them in the seat.

NEVER allow an infant or child to be carried on an occupants lap.

NEVER ride with the seatback reclined when the vehicle is moving.

Do not allow children to share a seat or seat belt.

Do not wear the shoulder belt under your arm or behind your back.

Always wear both the shoul- der portion and lap portion of the lap/shoulder belt.

Do not use the seat belt if it is twisted. A twisted seat belt will not protect you properly in an accident.

Do not use a seat belt if the webbing or hardware is dam- aged.

Do not latch the seat belt into the buckles of other seats.

NEVER unfasten the seat belt while driving. This may cause loss of vehicle control result- ing in an accident.

Make sure there is nothing in the buckle interfering with the seat belt latch mechanism. This may prevent the seat belt from fastening securely.

No modifications or additions should be made by the user which will either prevent the seat belt adjusting devices from operating to remove slack, or prevent the seat belt assembly from being adjusted to remove slack.

2-30

Safety system of your vehicle

Seat Belt Warning Light Seat belt warning light

Driver’s seat belt warning

As a reminder to the driver, the seat belt warning light will illuminate for approximately 6 seconds each time you place the ignition switch to the ON position regardless of belt fas- tening. At this time, if the seat belt is not fastened a warning chime will sound for 6 seconds. If you continue not to fasten the seat belt and you drive over 6 mph (9 km/h), the warning light will stay illuminated.

If you continue not to fasten the seat belt and you drive over 12 mph (20 km/h) the seat belt warning chime will sound for approximately 100 sec- onds and the corresponding warning light will blink. If you unfasten the seat belt while driving under 12 mph (20 km/h), the seat belt warning light will illuminate until the seat belt is fastened. If you unfasten the seat belt while driving over 12 mph (20 km/h), the seat belt warning chime will sound for approximately 100 seconds and the corresponding warning light will blink.

Damaged seat belts and seat belt assemblies will not operate properly. Always replace: Frayed, contaminated, or dam-

aged webbing Damaged hardware The entire seat belt assembly

after it has been worn in an accident, even if damage to webbing or assembly is not apparent

WARNING

OLX2039032L

2-31

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Front passenger’s seat belt warning

As a reminder to the front passenger, the front passenger’s seat belt warn- ing lights will illuminate for approxi- mately 6 seconds each time you place the ignition switch to the ON position regardless of belt fastening.

If you continue not to fasten the seat belt and you drive over 6 mph (9 km/h), the warning light will stay illuminated. If you continue not to fasten the seat belt and you drive over 12 mph (20 km/h) the seat belt warning chime will sound for approximately 100 sec- onds and the corresponding warning light will blink. If you unfasten the seat belt while driving under 12 mph (20 km/h) the seat belt warning light will illuminate until the seat belt is fastened. If you unfasten the seat belt while driving over 12 mph (20 km/h), the seat belt warning chime will sound for approximately 100 seconds and the corresponding warning light will blink.

Information Although the front passenger seat is

not occupied, the seat belt warning light will blink or illuminate for 6 seconds.

Also, when the front passenger gets off the vehicle while the warning is activating, the warning may contin- ue for 6 seconds even after the pas- senger gets off.

The front passenger’s seat belt warning light may not properly operate if the front passenger does not sit properly in the seat.

The front passenger’s seat belt warning may operate when luggage, electronic device, etc. are placed on the front passenger seat.

i

OLX2039033L

2-32

Rear passenger’s seat belt warning

7 passengers (A)

— 2nd row : 1, 3

— 3rd row : 4, 5, 6

8 passengers (B)

— 2nd row : 1, 2, 3

— 3rd row : 4, 5, 6

As a reminder to the rear passenger, the rear passenger’s seat belt warn- ing lights will illuminate for approxi- mately 6 seconds each time you turn the ignition switch ON regardless of belt fastening.

If the seat belt is not fastened when the ignition switch is turned ON or if it is disconnected after the ignition switch is turned ON, the seat belt warning light will illuminate until the belt is fastened. If you start to drive without the seat belt fastened or you unfasten the seat belt when you drive under 12 mph (20 km/h), the corresponding warning light will continue to illumi- nate until you fasten the seat belt. If you continue to drive without the seat belt fastened or you unfasten the seat belt when you drive over 12 mph (20 km/h), the seat belt warning chime will sound for approximately 35 seconds and the corresponding warning light will blink.

Information Although the rear passenger’s seat

is not occupied, the seat belt warn- ing light will blink or illuminate for 6 seconds.

The rear passenger’s seat belt warn- ing may operate when luggage, lap- top or other electronic device is placed on the rear passenger seat.

i

Safety system of your vehicle

OLX2039105N

Riding in an improper position adversely affects the rear passen- ger’s seat belt warning system. It is important for the driver to instruct the passenger to proper- ly be seated as instructed in this manual.

WARNING

2-33

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Seat Belt Restraint System Seat Belt-Driver’s 3-point sys- tem with emergency locking retractor

To fasten your seat belt:

Pull the seat belt out of the retractor and insert the metal tab (1) into the buckle (2). There will be an audible «click» when the tab locks into the buckle.

You should place the lap belt (1) por- tion across your hips and the shoul- der belt (2) portion across your chest. The seat belt automatically adjusts to the proper length after the lap belt portion is adjusted manually so that it fits snugly around your hips. If you lean forward in a slow, easy motion, the belt will extend and move with you. If there is a sudden stop or impact, the belt will lock into position. It will also lock if you try to lean forward too quickly.

OHSS038101

Improperly positioned seat belts may increase the risk of serious injury in an accident.Take the fol- lowing precautions when adjust- ing the seat belt: Position the lap portion of the

seat belt as low as possible across your hips, not on your waist, so that it fits snugly.

Position one arm under the shoulder belt and the other over the belt, as shown in the illus- tration.

Always position the shoulder belt anchor into the locked position at the appropriate height.

Never position the shoulder belt across your neck or face.

WARNING

OHSS038102L

2-34

Safety system of your vehicle

If you are not able to smoothly pull enough of the seat belt out from the retractor, firmly pull the seat belt out and release it. After release, you will be able to pull the belt out smoothly.

Height adjustment

You can adjust the height of the shoulder belt anchor to one of the three different positions for maximum comfort and safety. The shoulder portion should be adjusted so it lies across your chest and midway over your shoulder near- est the door, not over your neck.

To adjust the height of the seat belt anchor, lower or raise the height adjuster into an appropriate position. To raise the height adjuster, pull it up (1). To lower it, push it down (3) while pressing the height adjuster button (2). Release the button to lock the anchor into position. Try sliding the height adjuster to make sure that it has locked into position.

To release your seat belt:

Press the release button (1) in the locking buckle. When it is released, the belt should automatically draw back into the retractor. If this does not happen, check the belt to be sure it is not twisted, then try again.

NOTICE

OLX2038102L OHSS038103

2-35

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Rear Seat Belt Passenger’s 3- point system with convertible locking retractor This type of seat belt combines the features of both an emergency locking retractor seat belt and an automatic locking retractor seat belt. Convertible retractor type seat belts are installed in the rear seat positions to help accom- modate the installation of child restraint systems. Although a convert- ible retractor is also installed in the front passenger seat position, NEVER place any infant/child restraint system in the front seat of the vehicle.

To fasten your seat belt:

Pull the seat belt out of the retractor and insert the metal tab into the buck- le. There will be an audible «click» when the tab locks into the buckle. When not securing a child restraint, the seat belt operates in the same way as the driver’s seat belt (Emergency Locking Retractor Type). It automati- cally adjusts to the proper length only after the lap belt portion of the seat belt is adjusted manually so that it fits snugly across your hips. When the seat belt is fully extended from the retractor to allow the installa- tion of a child restraint system, the seat belt operation changes to allow the belt to retract, but not to extend (Automatic Locking Retractor Type). Refer to the «Using a Child Restraint System» section in this chapter.

Although the seat belt retractor provides the same level of protec- tion for seated passengers in either emergency or automatic locking modes, the emergency locking mode allows seated pas- sengers to move freely in their seat while keeping some tension on the belt. During a collision or sudden stop, the retractor auto- matically locks the belt to help restrain your body. To deactivate the automatic lock- ing mode, unbuckle the seat belt and allow the belt to fully retract.

NOTICE

2-36

Safety system of your vehicle

To release your seat belt:

Press the release button (1) in the locking buckle. When it is released, the belt should automatically draw back into the retractor. If this does not happen, check the belt to be sure it is not twisted, then try again.

Rear center seatbelt (3rd row)

To fasten your seatbelt:

1.Extract the tongue plate (A) from the hole on the belt assembly cover.

2.Insert the tongue plate (A) into the buckle (A) until an audible click» is heard, indicating the latch is locked. Make sure the belt is not twisted.

OHSS038103

OLX2038081

OLX2038082

2-37

Safety system of your vehicle

2

3. Pull out the tongue plate (B) from the pocket. Pull the tongue plate (B) and insert it into the buckle (B) until an audible click is heard, indicating the latch is locked. Make sure the belt is not twisted.

When using the rear center seat belt, the buckle with the CENTER mark must be used.

Information If you are not able to pull out the safe- ty belt from the retractor, firmly pull the belt out and release it. After release, you will be able to pull the belt out smoothly.

To release your seatbelt:

1.Press the release button on the buckle (B) and remove the tongue plate (B).

2. To retract the rear center seatbelt, insert the tongue plate into the web release hole (A’ ). Pull up on the seat belt web and allow the web- bing to retract automatically. Insert the tongue plate (A) into the hole on the belt assembly cover.

i

OLX2038083 OLX2038084 OLX2038085

2-38

Stowing the rear seat belt

The rear seat belt buckles can be stowed in the pocket between the rear seatback and cushion when not in use.

Routing the seat belt webbing through the rear seat belt guides will help keep the belts from being trapped behind or under the seats. After inserting the seat belt, tighten the belt webbing by pulling it up.

Safety system of your vehicle

OLX2038018

OLX2038069L

2nd row seat

3nd row seat (if equipped) OTM038042

OLX2038035

2nd row seat (8 passenger vehicle)

3nd row seat

When using the seat belt, use it after taking it out of the guides.

If you pull the seat belt when it is stored in the guides, it may damage the guides and/or belt webbing.

CAUTION

2-39

Safety system of your vehicle

Pre-tensioner seat belt (Driver and front passenger)

Your vehicle is equipped with driver’s and front passenger’s Pre-tensioner Seat Belts (Retractor Pretensioner). The purpose of the pre-tensioner is to make sure the seat belts fit tightly against the occupant’s body in cer- tain frontal or side collision(s).

When the vehicle stops suddenly, or if the occupant tries to lean forward too quickly, the seat belt retractor will lock into position. In certain frontal or side collision(s), the pre-tensioner will activate and pull the seat belt into tighter contact against the occu- pant’s body.

(1) Retractor Pretensioner The purpose of the retractor pre- tensioner is to make sure that the shoulder belts fit in tightly against the occupant’s upper body in cer- tain frontal or side collision(s).

If the system senses excessive ten- sion on the driver or passenger’s seat belt when the pre-tensioner sys- tem activates, the load limiter inside the retractor pre-tensioner will release some of the pressure on the affected seat belt.

2 Always wear your seat belt and

sit properly in your seat. Do not use the seat belt if it is

loose or twisted. A loose or twisted seat belt will not pro- tect you properly in an acci- dent.

Do not place anything near the buckle. This may adversely affect the buckle and cause it to function improperly.

Always replace your pre-ten- sioners after activation or an accident.

NEVER inspect, service, repair or replace the pre-tensioners yourself. This must be done by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Do not hit the seat belt assem- blies.

WARNING

OTL035053

2-40

Safety system of your vehicle

The Pre-Tensioner Seat Belt System consists mainly of the following com- ponents. Their locations are shown in the illustration above: 1. SRS air bag warning light 2. Retractor pre-tensioner 3. SRS control module

The sensor that activates the SRS air bag is connected with the pretensioner seat belts. The SRS air bag warning light on the instru- ment panel will illuminate for approximately 6 seconds after the ignition switch is in the ON posi- tion, and then it should turn off. If the pre-tensioner is not working properly, the warning light will illu- minate even if the SRS air bag is not malfunctioning. If the warning light does not illuminate, stays illuminated or illuminates when the vehicle is being driven, have an authorized HYUNDAI dealer inspect the pre-tensioner seat belts and SRS air bags as soon as possible.

NOTICE

OLMB033040/Q

Do not touch the pre-tensioner seat belt assemblies for several minutes after they have been activated. When the pre-ten- sioner seat belt mechanism deploys during a collision, the pre-tensioners become hot and can burn you.

WARNING

2-41

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Both the driver’s and front pas- senger’s pre-tensioner seat belts may be activated in certain frontal or side collisions or rollovers.

When the pre-tensioner seat belts are activated, a loud noise may be heard and fine dust, which may appear to be smoke, may be visible in the passenger compartment. These are normal operating conditions and are not hazardous.

Although it is non-toxic, the fine dust may cause skin irritation and should not be inhaled for prolonged periods. Wash all exposed skin areas thoroughly after an accident in which the pre-tensioner seat belts were activated.

Additional Seat Belt Safety Precautions Seat belt use during pregnancy The seat belt should always be used during pregnancy. The best way to protect your unborn child is to protect yourself by always wearing the seat belt. Pregnant women should always wear a lap-shoulder seat belt. Place the shoulder belt across your chest, rout- ed between your breasts and away from your neck. Place the lap belt line so that it fits snugly and as low as pos- sible across the hips, not across the abdomen.

NOTICE

A pregnant woman or a patient is more vulnerable to any imapcts on the abdomen during an abrupt stop or acci- dent. If you are in an accident while pregnant, we recom- mend you consult your doc- tor.

To reduce the risk of serious injury or death to an unborn child during an accident, pregnant women should NEVER place the lap portion of the seat belt above or over the area of the abdomen where the unborn child is located.

WARNING

2-42

Safety system of your vehicle

Seat belt use and children Infant and small children

All 50 states have child restraint laws which require children to travel in approved child restraint devices, including booster seats. The age at which seat belts can be used instead of child restraints differs among states, so you should be aware of the specific requirements in your state, and where you are travelling. Infant and child restraints must be properly placed and installed in a rear seat. For more information refer to the «Child Restraint Systems» section in this chapter.

Small children are best protected from injury in an accident when prop- erly restrained in the rear seat by a child restraint system that meets the requirements of the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards. Before buying any child restraint system, make sure that it has a label certify- ing that it meets Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard FMVSS 213. The restraint must be appropriate for your childs height and weight. Check the label on the child restraint for this information. Refer to the «Child Restraint Systems» section in this chapter.

ALWAYS properly restrain infants and small children in a child restraint appropriate for the child’s height and weight. To reduce the risk of serious injury or death to a child and other passengers, NEVER hold a child in your lap or arms when the vehicle is moving.The violent forces created during an acci- dent will tear the child from your arms and throw the child against the interior of the vehicle.

WARNING

2-43

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Larger children

Children under age 13 and who are too large for a booster seat must always occupy the rear seat and use the available lap/shoulder belts. A seat belt should lie across the upper thighs and be snug across the shoul- der and chest to restrain the child safely. Check belt fit periodically. Children are afforded the most safe- ty in the event of an accident when they are restrained by a proper restraint system and/or seat belts in the rear seat. Always have the LATCH system inspected by your authorized HYUNDAI dealer after an accident. An accident can damage the LATCH system and may not properly secure the child restraint. If a larger child over age 13 must be seated in the front seat, the child must be securely restrained by the available lap/shoulder belt and the seat should be placed in the rear- most position.

If the shoulder belt portion slightly touches the child’s neck or face, try placing the child closer to the center of the vehicle. If the shoulder belt still touches their face or neck they need to be returned to an appropriate booster seat in the rear seat.

Transporting an injured person A seat belt should be used when an injured person is being transported. Consult a physician for specific rec- ommendations.

One person per belt Two people (including children) should never attempt to use a single seat belt. This could increase the severity of injuries in case of an accident.

Do not lie down Sitting in a reclined position when the vehicle is in motion can be dan- gerous. Even when buckled up, the protections of your restraint system (seat belts and air bags) is greatly reduced by reclining your seatback. To reduce the chance of injuries in the event of an accident and to achieve the maximum effectiveness of the restraint system, all passengers should be sitting up and the front and rear seats should be in an upright position when the car is moving. A seat belt cannot provide proper protection if the person is lying down in the rear seat or if the front or rear seats are in a reclined position.

Always make sure children are wearing their seat belts and that they are properly adjusted before driving.

NEVER allow the shoulder belt to contact the childs neck or face.

Do not allow more than one child to use a single seat belt.

WARNING

2-44

Safety system of your vehicle

Care of Seat Belts Seat belt systems should never be disassembled or modified. In addi- tion, care should be taken to assure that seat belts and belt hardware are not damaged by seat hinges, doors or other abuse.

Periodic inspection All seat belts should be inspected periodically for wear or damage of any kind. Any damaged parts should be replaced as soon as possible by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Keep belts clean and dry Seat belts should be kept clean and dry. If belts become dirty, they can be cleaned by using a mild soap solu- tion and warm water. Bleach, dye, strong detergents or abrasives should not be used because they may damage and weaken the fabric.

When to replace seat belts The entire seat belt assembly or assemblies should be replaced if the vehicle has been involved in an acci- dent. This should be done even if no damage is visible. Additional ques- tions concerning seat belt operation should be directed to an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

NEVER ride with a reclined seatback when the vehicle is moving.

Riding with a reclined seatback increases your chance of seri- ous or fatal injuries in the event of a collision or sudden stop.

Drivers and passengers should always sit well back in their seats, properly belted, and with the seatbacks upright.

WARNING

2-45

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Children Always in the Rear Children under age 13 must always ride in the rear seats and must always be properly restrained to min- imize the risk of injury in an accident, sudden stop or sudden maneuver. According to accident statistics, chil- dren are safer when properly restrained in the rear seats than in the front seat. Even with air bags, children can be seriously injured or killed. Children too large for a child restraint must use the seat belts provided. All 50 states have child restraint laws which require children to travel in approved child restraint devices. The laws governing the age or height/ weight restrictions at which seat belts can be used instead of child restraints differs among states, so you should be aware of the specific requirements in your state, and where you are travelling.

Child restraint systems must be prop- erly placed and installed in the rear seat. You must use a commercially available child restraint system that meets the requirements of the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards (FMVSS 213). Child restraint systems are generally designed to be secured in a vehicle seat by lap belt portion of a lap/shoulder belt, or by a LATCH sys- tem in the rear seats of the vehicle.

CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEM (CRS)

Always properly restrain chil- dren in the rear seats of the vehicle. Children of all ages are safer when restrained in the rear seat. A child riding in the front pas- senger seat can be forcefully struck by an inflating air bag resulting in SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH.

WARNING

2-46

Safety system of your vehicle

Child restraint system (CRS) Infants and younger children must be restrained in an appropriate rear-fac- ing or forward-facing CRS that has first been properly secured to the rear seat of the vehicle. Read and comply with the instructions for installation and use provided by the manufacturer of the child restraint.

Always properly restrain your child in the child restraint.

If the vehicle head restraint prevents proper installation of a child seat (as described in the child restraint system manual), the head restraint of the respective seating posi- tion shall be readjusted or entirely removed.

Do not use an infant carrier or a child safety seat that «hooks» over a seatback, it may not provide adequate protection in an accident.

After an accident, have a HYUNDAI dealer check the child restraint system, seat belts, lower anchors and upper tether anchors.

An improperly secured child restraint can increase the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH in an accident. Always take the following precautions when using a child restraint system: NEVER install a child or infant

restraint in the front passen- ger’s seat.

Always properly secure the child restraint to a rear seat of the vehicle.

Always follow the child restraint system manufactur- er’s instructions for installa- tion and use.

WARNING

Be especially careful when installing a child restraint on the center seating position in the second row as it is narrow- er than the outboard positions. A wide child restraint installed on the center seat may cover the safety belt buckles for the other seating positions. Do not allow someone to ride in a seating position where the safety belt buckle is covered by a child restraint.

A child restraint in the center seating position may also con- tact or push up against the safety belt buckles, which can damage the buckles and make them unusable or unsafe. Always check that the child restraint does not contact any of the safety belt buckles. Check the placement of the child restraint regularly to make sure that it has not shift- ed and come into contact with any of the safety belt buckles.

WARNING

2-47

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Selecting a Child Restraint System (CRS) When selecting a CRS for your child, always: Make sure the CRS has a label

certifying that it meets applicable Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards (FMVSS 213).

Select a child restraint based on your child’s height and weight. The required label or the instructions for use typically provide this infor- mation.

Select a child restraint that fits the vehicle seating position where it will be used.

Read and comply with the warn- ings and instructions for installa- tion and use provided with the child restraint system.

Child restraint system types There are three main types of child restraint systems: rearward-facing seats, forward-facing seats, and booster seats. They are classified according to the child’s age, height and weight.

Rearward-facing child seats

A rearward-facing child seat provides restraint with the seating surface against the back of the child. The har- ness system holds the child in place, and in an accident, acts to keep the child positioned in the seat and reduce the stress to the neck and spinal cord. All children under age one must always ride in a rearward-facing infant child restraint. Convertible and 3-in-1 child seats typ- ically have higher height and weight limits for the rearward-facing position, allowing you to keep your child rear- ward-facing for a longer period of time.

NEVER install a child or infant restraint in the front passen- ger’s seat. Placing a rearward-facing child restraint in the front seat can result in SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH if the child restraint is struck by an inflating air bag.

WARNING OLX2039036N

2-48

Safety system of your vehicle

Continue to use a rearward-facing child seat for as long as your child will fit within the height and weight limits allowed by the child seat man- ufacturer. It’s the best way to keep them safe. Once your child has out- grown the rearward-facing child restraint, your child is ready for a for- ward-facing child restraint with a har- ness.

Forward-facing child restraints

A forward-facing child seat provides restraint for the child’s body with a harness. Keep children in a forward- facing child seat with a harness until they reach the top height or weight limit allowed by your child restraints manufacturer. Once your child outgrows the forward- facing child restraint, your child is ready for a booster seat.

Booster seats

A booster seat is a restraint designed to improve the fit of the vehicle’s seat belt system. A booster seat positions the seat belt so that it fits properly over the lap of your child. Keep your child in a booster seat until they are big enough to sit in the seat without a booster and still have the seat belt fit properly. For a seat belt to fit properly, the lap belt must lie snug- ly across the upper thighs, not the stomach. The shoulder belt should lie snug across the shoulder and chest and not across the neck or face. Children under age 13 must always ride in the rear seats and must always be properly restrained to minimize the risk of injury.

OLX2039002N

Do NOT adjust the seat when child seat is fitted. Adjusting the seat during driving can result in SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH.

WARNING

2-49

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Installing a Child Restraint System (CRS)

After selecting a proper child seat for your child, check to make sure it fits properly in your vehicle. Follow the instructions provided by the manu- facturer when installing the child seat. Note these general steps when installing the seat to your vehicle: Properly secure the child

restraint to the vehicle. All child restraints must be secured to the vehicle with the lap part of a lap/shoulder belt or with the LATCH system. If using the lap/shoulder belt for your child restraint, the convertible locking retractor should be pulled all the way out to engage the «automatic locking» mode. (See page 2-54.)

Make sure the child restraint is firmly secured. After installing a child restraint to the vehicle, push and pull the seat forward-and- back and side-to-side to verify that it is securely attached to the seat. A child restraint secured with a seat belt should be installed as firmly as possible. However, some side-to-side movement can be expected.

Secure the child in the child restraint. Make sure the child is properly strapped in the child restraint according to the manu- facturer instructions.

Before installing your child restraint system always: Read and follow the instruc-

tions provided by the manu- facturer of the child restraint.

Read and follow the instruc- tions regarding child restraint systems in this manual.

Failure to follow all warnings and instructions could increase the risk of the SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH if an accident occurs.

WARNING

If the vehicle head restraint pre- vents proper installation of a child seat (as described in the child seat system manual, the head restraint of the respective seating position shall be read- justed or entirely removed.

WARNING

A child restraint in a closed vehicle can become very hot.To prevent burns, check the seat- ing surface and buckles before placing your child in the child restraint.

CAUTION

2-50

Safety system of your vehicle

Lower Anchors and Tether for Children (LATCH System) The LATCH system holds a child restraint during driving and in an acci- dent. This system is designed to make installation of the child restraint easier and reduce the possibility of improperly installing your child restraint. The LATCH system uses anchors in the vehicle and attach- ments on the child restraint. The LATCH system eliminates the need to use seat belts to secure the child restraint to the rear seats. Lower anchors are metal bars built into the vehicle. There are two lower anchors for each LATCH seating position that will accommodate a child restraint with lower attachments. To use the LATCH system in your vehicle, you must have a child restraint with LATCH attachments. The child seat manufacturer will pro- vide you with instructions on how to use the child seat with its attachments for the LATCH lower anchors.

LATCH anchors have been provided in the left and right outboard rear seating positions. Their locations are shown in the illustration. There are no LATCH anchors provided for the cen- ter rear seating position.

OLX2038039

Do not attempt to install a child restraint system using LATCH anchors in the rear center seat- ing position.There are no LATCH anchors provided for this seat. Using the outboard seat anchors can damage the anchors which may break or fail in a collision resulting in serious injury or death.

WARNING

2-51

Safety system of your vehicle

2

[1] : Lower Anchor Position Indicator,

[2] : Lower Anchor

The lower anchor position indicator symbols are located on the left and right rear seat backs to identify the position of the lower anchors in your vehicle (see arrows in illustration). The LATCH anchors are located between the seatback and the seat cushion of the rear seat left and right outboard seating positions.

Securing a child restraint with the LATCH anchors system To install a LATCH-compatible child restraint in either of the rear outboard seating positions: 1. Move the seat belt buckle away

from the lower anchors. 2. Move any other objects away from

the anchors that could prevent a secure connection between the child restraint and the lower anchors.

3. Place the child restraint on the vehicle seat, then attach the seat to the lower anchors according to the instructions provided by the child restraint manufacturer.

4. Follow the child restraint instruc- tions for properly adjusting and tightening the lower attachments on the child restraint to the lower anchors.

OLX2038040L

Take the following precautions when using the LATCH system: Read and follow all installation

instructions provided with your child restraint system.

To prevent the child from reaching and taking hold of unretracted seat belts, buckle all unused rear seat belts and retract the seat belt webbing behind the child. Children can be strangled if a shoulder belt becomes wrapped around their neck and the seat belt tightens.

NEVER attach more than one child restraint to a single anchor. This could cause the anchor or attachment to come loose or break.

Always have the LATCH sys- tem inspected by your author- ized HYUNDAI dealer after an accident. An accident can damage the LATCH system and may not properly secure the child restraint.

WARNING

2-52

Safety system of your vehicle

The recommended weight for the LATCH system is under 65 lb (30 kg). How to determine an appropriate child restraint weight: Child weight + Child restraint weight < 65 lb (30kg)

Securing a child restraint seat with «Tether Anchor» system

First secure the child restraint with the LATCH lower anchors or the seat belt. If the child restraint manufactur- er recommends that the top tether strap be attached, attach and tighten the top tether strap to the top tether strap anchor.

Child restraint hook holders are located on the rear of the seatbacks.

NOTICE

OLX2039087N

2nd row passenger seat

OLX2039101N

3rd row passenger seat

Take the following precautions when installing the tether strap: Read and follow all installation

instructions provided with your child restraint system.

NEVER attach more than one child restraint to a single teth- er anchor. This could cause the anchor or attachment to come loose or break.

Do not attach the tether strap to anything other than the cor- rect tether anchor. It may not work properly if attached to something else.

Do not use the tether anchors for adult seat belts or harness- es, or for attaching other items or equipment to the vehicle.

WARNING

2-53

Safety system of your vehicle

2

To install the tether anchor: 1. Route the child restraint tether

strap over the child restraint seat- back. Route the tether strap under the head restraint and between the head restraint posts, or route the tether strap over the top of the vehicle seatback. Make sure the strap is not twisted.

2. Connect the tether strap hook to the tether anchor, then tighten the tether strap according to the child seat manufacturer’s instructions to firmly secure the child restraint to the seat.

3. Check that the child restraint is securely attached to the seat by pushing and pulling the seat for- ward-and-back and side-to-side.

Securing a child restraint with lap/shoulder belt When not using the LATCH system, all child restraints must be secured to a vehicle rear seat with the lap part of a lap/shoulder belt.

Automatic locking mode

Since all passenger seat belts move freely under normal conditions and only lock under extreme or emer- gency conditions (emergency locking mode), you must manually pull the seat belt all the way out to shift the retractor to the «Automatic Locking» mode to secure a child restraint. The «Automatic Locking» mode will help prevent the normal movement of the child in the vehicle from caus- ing the seat belt to loosen and com- promise the child restraint system. To secure a child restraint system, use the following procedure.

ALWAYS place a rear-facing child restraint in the rear seat of the vehicle. Placing a rear-facing child restraint in the front seat can result in serious injury or death if the child restraint is struck by an inflating air bag.

WARNING

OLX2039038N OLMB033044

2-54

Safety system of your vehicle

To install a child restraint system on the rear seats, do the following: 1. Place the child restraint system on

a rear seat and route the lap/ shoul- der belt around or through the child restraint, following the restraint manufacturer’s instructions. Be sure the seat belt webbing is not twisted.

When using the rear center seat belt, you should also refer to the «Rear Seat Belt Passenger’s 3- point system» section in this chapter.

2. Fasten the lap/shoulder belt latch into the buckle. Listen for the dis- tinct «click» sound.

Information Position the release button so that it is easy to access in case of an emergency.

3. Pull the shoulder portion of the seat belt all the way out. When the shoulder portion of the seat belt is fully extended, it will shift the retrac- tor to the «Automatic Locking» (child restraint) mode.

i

NOTICE OLMB033045 OLMB033097

2-55

Safety system of your vehicle

2

4. Slowly allow the shoulder portion of the seat belt to retract and listen for an audible «clicking» or «ratch- eting» sound. This indicates that the retractor is in the «Automatic Locking» mode. If no distinct sound is heard, repeat steps 3 and 4.

5. Remove as much slack from the belt as possible by pushing down on the child restraint system while feeding the shoulder belt back into the retractor.

6. Push and pull on the child restraint system to confirm that the seat belt is holding it firmly in place. If it is not, release the seat belt and repeat steps 2 through 6.

7. Double check that the retractor is in the «Automatic Locking» mode by attempting to pull more of the seat belt out of the retractor. If you cannot, the retractor is in the «Automatic Locking» mode.

If your CRS manufacturer instructs or recommends you to use a tether anchor with the lap/shoulder belt, refer to the previous pages for more information.

When the seat belt is allowed to retract to its fully stowed position, the retractor will automatically switch from the «Automatic Locking» mode to the emergency lock mode for normal adult usage.

NOTICE

OLMB033098

If the retractor is not in the «Automatic Locking» mode, the child restraint can move when your vehicle turns or stops sud- denly. A child can be seriously injured or killed if the child restraint is not properly anchored in the car, including manually pulling the seat belt all the way out to shift the rectractor to the «Automatic Locking» mode.

WARNING

2-56

To remove the child restraint, press the release button on the buckle and then pull the lap/shoulder belt out of the restraint and allow the seat belt to retract fully.

Safety system of your vehicle

2-57

Safety system of your vehicle

2

AIR BAG — ADVANCED SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM

OLX2039041N

The actual air bags in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.

1. Driver’s front air bag

2. Passenger’s front air bag

3. Side air bag

4. Curtain air bag

5. Drivers knee airbag

2-58

Safety system of your vehicle

This vehicle is equipped with an Advanced Supplemental Air Bag System for the driver’s seat and front passenger’s seats. The front air bags are designed to supplement the three-point seat belts. For these air bags to provide protection, the seat belts must be worn at all times when driving. You can be severely injured or killed in an accident if you are not wearing a seat belt. Air bags are designed to supplement seat belts, but do not replace them. Also, air bags are not designed to deploy in every collision. In some accidents, the seat belts are the only restraint protecting you.

AIR BAG SAFETY PRECAUTIONS

ALWAYS use seat belts and child restraints — every trip, every time, everyone! Even with air bags, you can be seriously injured or killed in a collision if you are improperly belted or not wearing your seat belt when the air bag inflates. NEVER place a child in any child restraint or booster seat in the front passenger seat. An inflating air bag could forcefully strike the infant or child causing serious or fatal injuries. ABC — Always Buckle Children under age 13 in the back seat. It is the safest place for children of any age to ride. If a child age 13 or older must be seated in the front seat, he or she must be properly belted and the seat should be moved as far back as possible. All occupants should sit upright with the seatback in an upright posi- tion, centered on the seat cushion with their seat belt on, legs com- fortably extended and their feet on the floor until the vehicle is parked and is turned off. If an occupant is out of position during an accident, the rapidly deploying air bag may forcefully contact the occupant causing serious or fatal injuries. You and your passengers should never sit or lean unnecessarily close to the air bags or lean against the door or center console. Move your seat as far back as possible from front air bags, while still maintaining control of the vehicle. The U.S. National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) recommends that drivers allow at least 10 inches (25 cm) between the center of the steering wheel and the chest.

WARNING

2-59

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Where Are the Air Bags? Driver’s and passenger’s front air bags Your vehicle is equipped with a Advanced Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) and lap/shoulder belts at both the driver and passenger seating positions. The SRS consists of air bags which are located in the center of the steer- ing wheel, and the passenger’s side front panel pad above the glove box. The air bags are labeled with the let- ters «AIR BAG» embossed on the pad covers.

The purpose of the SRS is to provide the vehicle’s driver and front passen- gers with additional protection than that offered by the seat belt system alone. The advanced SRS offers the ability to control the air bag inflation within two levels. A first stage level is pro- vided for moderate-severity impacts. A second stage level is provided for more severe impacts. According to the impact severity, the SRS Control Module (SRSCM) con- trols the air bag inflation. Failure to properly wear seat belts can increase the risk or severity of injury in an accident.

OLX2038045OLX2038044

Passengers front air bag Drivers front air bag

OLX2039043N

Drivers knee air bag

2-60

Safety system of your vehicle

Side air bags

Your vehicle is equipped with a side air bag in each front seat. The pur- pose of the air bag is to provide the vehicle’s driver and the front passen- ger with additional protection than that offered by the seat belt alone.

OLX2038048

OLX2038049L

No objects (such as crash pad cover, cellular phone holder, cup holder, air freshers or stickers) should be placed over or near the air bag mod- ules on the steering wheel, instrument panel, windshield glass, and the front passen- ger’s panel above the glove box. Such objects could cause harm if the vehicle is in a crash severe enough to cause the air bags to deploy.

To reduce the risk of serious injury or death from an inflating front air bags, take the following precautions: Seat belts must be worn at all

times to help keep occupants positioned properly.

Move your seat as far back as possible from front air bags, while still maintaining control of the vehicle.

Never lean against the door or center console.

Do not allow the front passen- ger to place their feet or legs on the dashboard.

WARNING

2-61

Safety system of your vehicle

2

The side air bags are designed to deploy during certain side impact collisions, depending on the crash severity. The side and curtain air bags on both sides of the vehicle may deploy if a rollover or possible rollover is detected. The side air bags are not designed to deploy in all side impact or rollover situations.

Do not allow passengers to lean their heads or bodies onto doors, put their arms on the doors, stretch their arms out of the window, or place objects between the doors and seats.

Hold the steering wheel at the 9 o’clock and 3 o’clock posi- tions, to minimize the risk of injuries to your hands and arms.

Do not use any accessory seat covers.This could reduce or prevent the effectiveness of the system.

Do not place any objects over the air bag or between the air bag and yourself. Also, do not attach any objects around the area the air bag inflates such as the door, side door glass, front and rear pillar.

Do not place any objects between the door and the seat. They may become dan- gerous projectiles if the side air bag inflates.

Do not install any accessories on the side or near the side air bags.

Do not put any objects between the side airbag label and seat cushion. It could cause harm if the vehicle is in a crash severe enough to cause the air bags to deploy.

Do not cause impact to the doors when the ignition switch button is in the ON position as this may cause the side air bags to inflate.

If the seat or seat cover is damaged, have the vehicle checked and repaired by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

To reduce the risk of serious injury or death from an inflating side air bag, take the following precautions: Seat belts must be worn at all

times to help keep occupants positioned properly.

WARNING

2-62

Safety system of your vehicle

Curtain air bags

Curtain air bags are located along both sides of the roof rails above the front and rear doors.

They are designed to help protect the heads of the front seat occupants and the rear outboard seat occupants in certain side impact collisions. The curtain air bags are designed to deploy during certain side impact collisions, depending on the crash severity. The side and curtain air bags on both sides of the vehicle may deploy if a rollover or possible rollover is detected. The curtain air bags are not designed to deploy in all side impact or rollover situations.

To reduce the risk of serious injury or death from an inflating curtain air bag, take the follow- ing precautions: All seat occupants must wear

seat belts at all times to help keep occupants positioned properly.

Properly secure child restraints as far away from the door as possible.

Do not place any objects over the air bag. Also, do not attach any objects around the area the air bag inflates such as the door, side door glass, front and rear pillar, roof side rail.

Do not hang other objects except clothes, especially hard or breakable objects. In an accident, it may cause vehicle damage or personal injury.

Do not allow passengers to lean their heads or bodies onto doors, put their arms on the doors, stretch their arms out of the window, or place objects between the doors and seats.

Do not open or repair the side curtain air bags.

WARNING

OLX2038050

OLX2038051

2-63

Safety system of your vehicle

2

How Does the Air Bag System Operate?

The SRS consists of the following components: 1. Driver’s front air bag module 2. Passenger’s front air bag module 3. Side air bag modules 4. Curtain air bag modules 5. Retractor pre-tensioner 6. Air bag warning light 7. SRS control module (SRSCM)/

Rollover sensor 8. Front impact sensors 9. Side impact sensors (acceleration) 10.Side impact sensors (pressure)

11. Occupant classification system 12. Drivers knee airbag module

The SRSCM (Supplemental Restraint System Control Module) continually monitors all SRS components while the ignition switch is in the ON position to determine if a crash impact is severe enough to require air bag deployment or pre-tensioner seat belt deployment.

SRS warning light

The SRS (Supplement Restraint System) air bag warning light on the instrument panel displays the air bag symbol depicted in the illustration. The system checks the air bag elec- trical system for malfunctions. The light indicates that there is a potential malfunction with your air bag system, which could include your side and curtain air bags used for rollover pro- tection.

OLX2039042N

2-64

Safety system of your vehicle

During a frontal collision, sensors will detect the vehicle’s deceleration. If the rate of deceleration is high enough, the control unit will inflate the front air bags. The front air bags help protect the driver and front passenger by responding to frontal impacts in which seat belts alone cannot pro- vide adequate restraint. When need- ed, the side air bags help provide protection in the event of a side impact or rollover. Air bags are activated (able to

inflate if necessary) only when the ignition switch is in the ON posi- tion.

Air bags inflate in the event of cer- tain frontal or side collisions to help protect the occupants from serious physical injury.

Generally, air bags are designed to inflate based upon the severity of a collision, its direction, etc. These two factors determine whether the sensors produce an electronic deployment/inflation signal.

The front air bags will completely inflate and deflate in an instant. It is virtually impossible for you to see the air bags inflate during an acci- dent. It is much more likely that you will simply see the deflated air bags hanging out of their storage compartments after the collision.

In addition to inflating in certain side collisions, vehicles equipped with a rollover sensor, side and curtain air bags will inflate if the sensing system detects a rollover. When a rollover is detected, side and curtain air bags will remain inflated longer to help provide pro- tection from ejection, especially when used in conjunction with the seat belts.

To help provide protection, the air bags must inflate rapidly. The speed of air bag inflation is a con- sequence of extremely short time in which to inflate the air bag between the occupant and the vehicle structures before the occu- pant impacts those structures. This speed of inflation reduces the risk of serious or life-threatening injuries and is thus a necessary part of air bag design.

If your SRS malfunctions, the air bag may not inflate properly dur- ing an accident increasing the risk of serious injury or death. If any of the following condi- tions occur, your SRS is mal- functioning: The light does not turn on for

approximately six seconds when the Engine Start/Stop button is in the ON position.

The light stays on after illumi- nating for approximately six seconds.

The light comes on while the vehicle is in motion.

The light blinks when the engine is running.

Have an authorized HYUNDAI dealer inspect the SRS as soon as possible if any of these con- ditions occur.

WARNING

2-65

Safety system of your vehicle

2

However, the rapid air bag inflation can also cause injuries which can include facial abrasions, bruises and broken bones because the inflation speed also causes the air bags to expand with a great deal of force.

There are even circumstances under which contact with the air bag can cause fatal injuries, espe- cially if the occupant is positioned excessively close to the air bag.

You can take steps to help reduce the risk of being injured by an inflat- ing air bag. The greatest risk is sitting too close to the air bag. An air bag needs about 10 inches (25 cm) of space to inflate. NHTSA recom- mends that drivers allow at least 10 inches (25 cm) between the center of the steering wheel and the chest.

When the SRSCM detects a suffi- ciently severe impact to the front of the vehicle, it will automatically deploy the front air bags.

To reduce the risk of serious injury or death from an inflating air bag, take the following pre- cautions: NEVER place a child restraint

in the front passenger seat. Always properly restrain chil- dren under age 13 in the rear seats of the vehicle.

Adjust the front passengers and driver’s seats as far to the rear as possible while allow- ing you to maintain full con- trol of the vehicle.

Hold the steering wheel with hands at the 9 o’clock and 3 o’clock positions.

Never place anything or any- one between the air bag and the seat occupant.

Do not allow the front passen- ger to place their feet or legs on the dashboard.

WARNING

OHM039102N

Driver’s front air bag (1)

2-66

Safety system of your vehicle

Upon deployment, tear seams mold- ed directly into the pad covers will separate under pressure from the expansion of the air bags. Further opening of the covers allows full inflation of the air bags. A fully inflated air bag, in combina- tion with a properly worn seat belt, slows the driver or the front passen- ger forward motion, reducing the risk of head and chest injury.

After complete inflation, the air bag immediately starts deflating, enabling the driver to maintain forward visibili- ty and the ability to steer or operate other controls.

OHM039103N

Driver’s front air bag (2)

To prevent objects from becom- ing dangerous projectiles when the passenger’s air bag inflates: Do not install or place any

objects (drink holder, CD holder, stickers, etc.) on the front passenger’s panel above the glove box where the pas- senger’s air bag is located.

Do not install a container of liquid air freshener near the instrument cluster or on the instrument panel surface.

WARNING

OHM039104N

Driver’s front air bag (3)

OLMB033057

Passenger’s front air bag

2-67

Safety system of your vehicle

2

What to Expect After an Air Bag Inflates After a frontal or side air bag inflates, it will deflate very quickly. Air bag inflation will not prevent the driver from seeing out of the windshield or being able to steer. Curtain air bags may remain partially inflated for some time after they deploy.

Noise and smoke from inflating air bag When the air bags inflate, they make a loud noise and may produce smoke and powder in the air inside of the vehicle. This is normal and is a result of the ignition of the air bag inflator. After the air bag inflates, you may feel substantial discomfort in breathing because of the contact of your chest with both the seat belt and the air bag, as well as from breathing the smoke and powder. The powder may aggravate asthma for some people. If you experience breathing problems after an air bag deploy- ment, seek medical attention imme- diately. Though the smoke and powder are nontoxic, they may cause irritation to the skin, eyes, nose, throat, etc. If this is the case, wash and rinse with cold water immediately and seek medical attention if the symptoms persist.

Always wash exposed skin areas thoroughly with cold water and mild soap.

Always have an authorized HYUNDAI dealer replace the air bag immediately after deployment. Air bags are designed to be used only once.

After an air bag inflates, take the following precautions: Open your windows and doors

as soon as possible after impact to reduce prolonged exposure to the smoke and powder released by the inflat- ing air bag.

Do not touch the air bag stor- age area’s internal compo- nents immediately after an air bag has inflated. The parts that come into contact with an inflating air bag may be very hot.

WARNING

2-68

Safety system of your vehicle

Occupant Classification System (OCS)

Your vehicle is equipped with an Occupant Classification System (OCS) in the front passenger’s seat.

Main components of the Occupant Classification System A detection device located within

the front passenger seat cushion. Electronic system to help deter-

mine whether the passenger air bag systems should be activated or deactivated.

An indicator light located on the instrument panel which illuminates the words OFF and symbol indi- cating the front passenger air bag system is deactivated.

The instrument panel air bag indi- cator light is interconnected with the OCS.

The OCS is designed to help detect the presence of a properly-seated front passenger and determine if the passenger’s front air bag should be enabled (may inflate) or not. The purpose is to help reduce the risk of injury or death from an inflat- ing air bag to certain front passenger seat occupants, such as children, by requiring the air bag to be automati- cally turned OFF.

For example, if a child restraint of the type specified in the regulations is on the seat, sensor can help detect it and cause the air bag to turn OFF. Front passenger seat adult occu- pants who are properly seated and wearing the seat belt properly, should not cause the passenger air bag to be automatically turned OFF. For small adults it may be turned OFF, however, if the occupant does not sit in the seat properly (for exam- ple, by not sitting upright, by sitting on the edge of the seat, or by other- wise being out of position), this could cause the sensor to turn the air bag OFF. You will find the «PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF» indicator on the center fascia panel. This system detects the conditions 1-4 in the following table and activates or deactivates the front passenger air bag based on these conditions.

OLX2039047N

2-69

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Always be sure that you and all vehi- cle occupants are seated properly and wearing the seat belt properly for the most effective protection by the air bag and the seat belt. The OCS may not function properly if the passenger takes actions which can affect the classification system. These include: Failing to sit in an upright position. Leaning against the door or center

console. Sitting towards the sides of the

front of the seat. Putting their legs on the dash-

board or resting them on other locations which reduce the pas- senger weight on the front seat.

Wearing the seat belt improperly. Reclining the seatback. Wearing a thick cloth like ski wear

or hip protection wear. Putting an additional thick cushion

on the seat. Putting electrical devices (e.g.

notebook, satellite radio) on the seat with inverter charging.

Condition and operation in the front passenger Occupant Classification System

Condition detected by the occupant classification system

Indicator/Warning light Devices

«PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF» indicator light

SRS warning light

Front passenger air bag

1. Adult *1 Off Off Activated

2. Infant *2 or child restraint system with 12 months old *3 *4

On Off Deactivated

3. Unoccupied On Off Deactivated

4. Malfunction in the system Off On Activated

*1 The system judges a person of adult size as an adult. When a smaller adult sits in the front passenger seat, the system may recognize him/her as a child depending on his/her physique and posture.

*2 Do not allow children to ride in the front passenger seat. When a larger child who has out- grown a child restraint system sits in the front passenger seat, the system may recognize him/her as an adult depending upon his/her physique or sitting position.

*3 Never install a child restraint system on the front passenger seat. *4 The PASSENGER AIR BAG «OFF» indicator may turn on or off when a child above 12 months

to 12 years old (with or without child restraint system) sits in the front passenger seat. This is a normal condition.

2-70

Safety system of your vehicle

Riding in an improper position or placing weight on the front passengers seat when it is unoccupied by a passenger adversely affects the OCS. To reduce the risk of serious injury or death:

WARNING

OLX2039104N

OLMB033100

OLMB033101

OLMB033103

OLMB033102

OLMB033104

NEVER put a heavy load in the front seat or seatback pocket.

NEVER place your feet on the front passenger seat- back.

NEVER sit with your hips shifted towards the front of the seat.

NEVER ride with the seat- back reclined when the vehicle is moving.

NEVER place your feet or legs on the dashboard.

NEVER lean on the door or center console or sit on one side of the front pas- senger seat.

2-71

Safety system of your vehicle

2

ODH035900K

ODH035901K

OTM038054

OTM038055

Do not sit on the passen- ger seat wearing heavily padded clothes such as ski wear and hip protector.

Do not use car seat accessories such as thick blankets and cushions which cover up the car seat surface.

Do not place electronic devices such as laptops, DVD player, or conductive materials such as water bottles on the passenger seat.

Do not use electronic devices such as laptops and satellite radios which use inverter chargers.

If large quantity of liquid has been spilled on the passenger seat, the air bag warning light may illuminate or malfunction. Therefore, make sure the seat has been completely dried before driving the vehicle.

Do not place sharp objects on the front passenger seat.These may damage the occupant detection sys- tem, if they puncture the seat cushion.

Do not place any items under the front passenger seat. When changing or replacing the seat or seat cover, use original items only. The OCS has been devel-

oped based on using original HYUNDAI car seats only. Altering or changing the authentic parts may result in system malfunction and increase risk of injury when in collision. Any of the above could inter- fere with the proper operation of the OCS sensor thereby increasing the risk of an injury in an accident.

2-72

Safety system of your vehicle

Proper seated position for OCS

If the «PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF» indicator is on when an adult is seat- ed in the front passenger seat, place the Engine Start/Stop button in the OFF position and ask the passenger to sit properly (sitting upright with the seat back in an upright position, cen- tered on the seat cushion with their seat belt on, legs comfortably extended and their feet on the floor). Restart the engine and have the per- son remain in that position. This will allow the system to detect the person and to enable the passenger air bag. If the «PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF» indicator is still on, ask the passen- ger to move to the rear seat.

The «PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF» indicator illuminates for approxi- mately 4 seconds after the Engine Start/Stop button is in the ON position or after the engine is started. If the front passenger seat is occupied, the OCS will then classify the front passenger after several more seconds.

Do Not Install a Child Restraint in the Front Passenger’s Seat

Even though your vehicle is equipped with the OCS, never install a child restraint in the front passenger’s seat. An inflating air bag can forcefully strike a child or child restraint result- ing in serious or fatal injury.

NOTICE

B990A01O

Never allow an adult passenger to ride in the front passenger seat when the «PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF» indicator is illuminat- ed. During a collision, the air bag will not inflate if the indicator is illuminated. Have your passen- ger reposition themself in the seat. If the «PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF» indicator remains illu- minated after the passenger repositions themself properly and the vehicle is restarted, have the passenger move to the rear seat because the air bag will not inflate.

WARNING

1JBH3051

2-73

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Why Didn’t My Air Bag Go Off in a Collision? Air bags are not designed to inflate in every collision. There are certain types of accidents in which the air bag would not be expected to provide additional protection. These include rear impacts, second or third colli- sions in multiple impact accidents, as well as low speed impacts. Damage to the vehicle indicates a collision energy absorption, and is not an indi- cator of whether or not an air bag should have inflated.

Air bag collision sensors

NEVER place a rear-facing or front-facing child restraint in the front passenger’s seat of the vehicle.

An inflating frontal air bag could forcefully strike a child resulting in serious injury or death.

Always properly restrain chil- dren in an appropriate child restraint in the rear seat of the vehicle.

WARNING

To reduce the risk of an air bag deploying unexpectedly and causing serious injury or death: Do not hit or allow any objects

to impact the locations where air bags or sensors are installed.

WARNING

Do not perform maintenance on or around the air bag sen- sors. If the location or angle of the sensors is altered, the air bags may deploy when they should not or may not deploy when they should.

Do not install bumper guards or replace the bumper with a non-genuine HYUNDAI parts. This may adversely affect the collision and air bag deploy- ment performance.

Place the ignition switch in the LOCK/OFF or ACC posi- tion when the vehicle is being towed to prevent inadvertent air bag deployment.

Have all air bag repairs conduct- ed by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

2-74

Safety system of your vehicle

1. SRS control module/Rollover sensor

2. Front impact sensor

3. Side pressure sensor

4. Side impact sensor

5. Side impact sensor

OLX2039052N/OLX2038053N/OLX2039054N/OLX2038055N/OLX2038056/OLX2038057

2-75

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Air bag inflation conditions

Front air bags

Front air bags and the driver’s knee air bag are designed to inflate in a frontal collision depending on the the severity of impact of the front colli- sion.

Side and curtain air bags

Side and curtain air bags are designed to inflate when an impact is detected by side collision sensors depending on the severity of impact resulting from a side impact collision.

Although the driver’s and front pas- senger’s air bags are designed to inflate only in frontal collisions, they also may inflate in other types of col- lisions if the front impact sensors detect a sufficient impact. Side and curtain air bags are designed to inflate only in side impact collisions or rollover situations, but they may inflate in other collisions if the side impact sensors detect a sufficient impact. If the vehicle chassis is impacted by bumps or objects on unimproved roads, the air bags may deploy. Drive carefully on unimproved roads or on surfaces not designed for vehicle traffic to prevent unintended air bag deployment.

OLX2038058

OLX2038060

OLX2038059L

2-76

Safety system of your vehicle

Air bag non-inflation conditions

In certain low-speed collisions the air bags may not deploy. The air bags are designed not to deploy in such cases because they may not provide benefits beyond the protection of the seat belts.

Front air bags are not designed to inflate in rear collisions, because occupants are moved backward by the force of the impact. In this case, inflated air bags would not provide any additional benefit.

Front air bags may not inflate in side impact collisions, because occupants move in the direction of the collision, and thus in side impacts, front air bag deployment would not provide addi- tional occupant protection. However, side and curtain air bags may inflate depending on the severi- ty of impact.

OLX2038061

OLX2038062 OLX2038063

2-77

Safety system of your vehicle

2

In an angled collision, the force of impact may direct the occupants in a direction where the air bags would not be able to provide any additional benefit, and thus the sensors may not deploy any air bags.

Just before impact, drivers often brake heavily. Such heavy braking lowers the front portion of the vehicle causing it to «ride» under a vehicle with a higher ground clearance. Air bags may not inflate in this «under- ride» situation because deceleration forces that are detected by sensors may be significantly reduced by such «underride» collisions.

Front air bags may not inflate in rollover accidents because air bag deployment could not provide protec- tion to the occupants. However, side and curtain air bags may inflate when the vehicle is rolled over by a side impact collision.

OTM038090 OLX2038064 OTL035068

2-78

Safety system of your vehicle

Air bags may not inflate if the vehicle collides with objects such as utility poles or trees, where the point of impact is concentrated and the colli- sion energy is absorbed by the vehi- cle structure.

SRS Care The SRS is virtually maintenance- free and there are no parts you can safely service by yourself. If the SRS air bag warning light does not illumi- nate when the ignition switch is in the ON position, or continuously remains on, have your vehicle immediately inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. Any work on the SRS system, such as removing, installing, repairing, or any work on the steering wheel, the front passenger’s panel, front seats and roof rails must be performed by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. Improper handling of the SRS system may result in serious personal injury.

To reduce the risk of serious injury or death, take the follow- ing precautions: Do not attempt to modify or

disconnect the SRS compo- nents or wiring, including the addition of any kind of badges to the pad covers or modifica- tions to the body structure.

Do not place objects over or near the air bag modules on the steering wheel, instrument panel, or the front passen- gers panel above the glove box.

Clean the air bag pad covers with a soft cloth moistened with plain water. Solvents or cleaners could adversely affect the air bag covers and proper deployment of the sys- tem.

Always have inflated air bags replaced by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

WARNING

OLX2038065

2-79

Safety system of your vehicle

2

Additional Safety Precautions Passengers should not move out of or change seats while the vehi- cle is moving. A passenger who is not wearing a seat belt during a crash or emergency stop can be thrown against the inside of the vehi- cle, against other occupants, or be ejected from the vehicle. Do not use any accessories on seat belts. Devices claiming to improve occupant comfort or reposi- tion the seat belt can reduce the pro- tection provided by the seat belt and increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.

Do not modify the front seats. Modification of the front seats could interfere with the operation of the supplemental restraint system sens- ing components or side air bags. Do not place items under the front seats. Placing items under the front seats could interfere with the opera- tion of the supplemental restraint system sensing components and wiring harnesses. Do not cause impact to the doors. Impact to the doors when the Engine Start/Stop button is in the ON posi- tion may cause the air bags to inflate. Modifications to accommodate disabilities. If you require modifica- tion to your vehicle to accommodate a disability, contact the HYUNDAI Customer Connect Center at 800- 633-5151.

Adding equipment to or modify- ing your air bag equipped vehicle If you modify your vehicle by chang- ing your vehicle’s frame, bumper sys- tem, front end or side sheet metal or ride height, this may affect the opera- tion of your vehicle’s air bag system.

Air Bag Warning Labels

Air bag warning labels, required by the U.S. National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA), are attached to alert the driver and pas- sengers of potential risks of the air bag system. Be sure to read all of the information about the air bags that are installed on your vehicle in this Owners Manual.

If components of the air bag system must be discarded, or if the vehicle must be scrapped, certain safety precautions must be observed. Consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for the necessary information. Failure to follow these precau- tions could increase the risk of personal injury.

OLX2038068L

Convenience Features

Accessing Your Vehicle …………………………………..3-4 Remote Key ……………………………………………………………..3-4 Smart Key ………………………………………………………………..3-8 Immobilizer System ………………………………………………..3-14

Door Locks……………………………………………………3-16 Operating Door Locks from Outside the Vehicle ..3-16 Operating Door Locks from Inside the Vehicle ……3-17 Automatic Door Lock and Unlock Features ………….3-20 Child-Protector Rear Door Locks …………………………3-21 Electronic Child Safety Lock System ……………………3-21

Safe Exit Assist (SEA)…………………………………..3-23 Safe Exit Assist settings…………………………………………3-24 Safe Exit Assist operation ……………………………………..3-25 Safe Exit Assist malfunction and limitations…………3-27 Rear Occupant Alert (ROA) System ……………………..3-29

Theft-alarm System ……………………………………..3-31 Driver position memory system ……………………3-32

Storing Positions into Memory …………………………….3-32 Recalling Positions from Memory………………………….3-33 Resetting the Driver’s Seat Memory System………..3-33 Easy Access Function …………………………………………….3-34

Steering wheel………………………………………………3-36 Electric Power Steering (EPS) ……………………………….3-36 Tilt Steering / Telescopic Steering ………………………..3-37 Horn…………………………………………………………………………3-37 Heated Steering Wheel…………………………………………..3-38

Mirrors………………………………………………………….3-39 Inside Rearview Mirror …………………………………………..3-39 Side View Mirrors …………………………………………………..3-52 Reverse Parking Aid Function………………………………..3-54

Windows ……………………………………………………….3-55 Power Windows………………………………………………………3-56

Sunroof…………………………………………………………3-59 Sunroof ………………………………………………………………….3-59 Dual wide sunroof…………………………………………………..3-59 Sunshade (Front)/Power sunshade (Rear)……………3-60 Tilt open/close (Front)……………………………………………3-61 Slide open/close (Front)…………………………………………3-61 Resetting the sunroof…………………………………………….3-63 Sunroof open warning……………………………………………3-65

Exterior Features………………………………………….3-66 Hood ………………………………………………………………………..3-66 Non-Powered Liftgate……………………………………………3-67 Power Liftgate ……………………………………………………….3-69 Smart Liftgate …………………………………………………………3-75 Fuel Filler Door……………………………………………………….3-79

3

Instrument Cluster ………………………………………..3-82 Instrument Cluster Control……………………………………..3-84 Gauges and Meters ………………………………………………..3-84 Transmission Shift Indicator…………………………………..3-89 Warning and Indicator Lights…………………………………3-89 LCD Display Messages………………………………………….3-103

LCD Display (Cluster type A and type B)…….3-109 LCD Display Control………………………………………………3-109 LCD Display Modes ……………………………………………..3-110

Trip Computer (Cluster type A and type B)…3-123 Trip modes …………………………………………………………….3-123

LCD Display (Cluster type C)……………………….3-127 LCD Display Control………………………………………………3-127 View Modes …………………………………………………………3-128

Option Menu (Cluster type C)……………………..3-132 Head Up Display (HUD)……………………………….3-143 Lighting……………………………………………………….3-145

Exterior Lights ………………………………………………………3-145 Interior Lights ……………………………………………………….3-149 Welcome System ………………………………………………….3-152

High Beam Assist (HBA) …………………………….3-154 High Beam Assist setting ……………………………………..3-154 High Beam Assist operation…………………………………3-155 High Beam Assist malfunction and limitations ……3-156

Wipers and washers …………………………………..3-158 Front Windshield Wipers …………………………………….3-158 Front Windshield Washers ………………………………….3-160 Rear Window Wiper and Washer…………………………3-161

Rear View Monitor (RVM)…………………………..3-162 Rear View Monitor settings …………………………………3-162 Rear View Monitor operation ………………………………3-163 Rear View Monitor malfunction and limitations …3-165

Reverse Parking Distance Warning (PDW) ….3-166 Reverse Parking Distance Warning settings ……….3-166 Reverse Parking Distance Warning operation…….3-166 Reverse Parking Distance Warning malfunction and precautions…………………………………………………….3-167

Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning (PDW) ………………………………………….3-170

Reverse Parking Distance Warning settings ……….3-170 Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning operation……………………………………………………………….3-171 Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning malfunction and precautions ……………………………….3-173

Surround View Monitor (SVM) …………………..3-176 Surround View Monitor settings………………………….3-176 Surround View Monitor operation……………………….3-178 Surround View Monitor malfunction and limitations………………………………………………………………3-180

3

Convenience Features

Blind-Spot View Monitor (BVM) …………………3-182 Blind-Spot View Monitor settings ……………………….3-182 Blind-Spot View Monitor operation…………………….3-183 Blind-Spot View Monitor malfunction…………………3-183

Manual climate control system……………………3-184 Heating and Air Conditioning……………………………….3-185 Rear climate control……………………………………………..3-189 System Operation …………………………………………………3-192 System Maintenance…………………………………………….3-194

Automatic climate control system……………….3-196 Automatic Temperature Control Mode………………..3-197 Manual Temperature Control Mode…………………….3-198 Rear climate control……………………………………………..3-204 System Operation …………………………………………………3-207 System Maintenance…………………………………………….3-209

Windshield defrosting and defogging …………3-211 Auto Defogging System (Additional Feature with Automatic Temperature Control System)…………….3-213 Rear Window Defroster ……………………………………….3-215

Climate control additional features……………..3-216 Cluster ionizer……………………………………………………….3-216 Automatic Ventilation……………………………………………3-216 Sunroof Inside Air Recirculation ………………………….3-216

Storage compartment………………………………….3-217 Center Console Storage ……………………………………….3-217 Glove Box………………………………………………………………3-217 Luggage Tray ………………………………………………………..3-218

Interior features………………………………………….3-219 Cup Holder …………………………………………………………….3-219 Conversation mirror………………………………………………3-221 Sunvisor…………………………………………………………………3-221 Power Outlet …………………………………………………………3-222 AC Inverter…………………………………………………………….3-223 USB Charger………………………………………………………….3-225 Wireless Cellular Phone Charging System…………..3-226 Clock………………………………………………………………………3-228 Coat Hook ……………………………………………………………..3-228 Floor Mat Anchor(s)……………………………………………..3-229 Luggage Net Holder ……………………………………………..3-230 Cargo Security Screen………………………………………….3-230 Side Curtain …………………………………………………………..3-232

Exterior features ………………………………………..3-234 Roof Side Rails ……………………………………………………..3-234

3

3-4

Convenience Features

Remote Key (if equipped)

Your HYUNDAI uses a remote key, which you can use to lock or unlock the driver and passenger doors or the rear liftgate.

1. Door Lock 2. Door Unlock 3. Liftgate Unlock (if equipped) 4. Panic

Locking your vehicle To lock your vehicle: 1. Make sure all doors, the engine,

hood and the liftgate are closed. 2. Press the Door Lock button (1) on

the remote key to lock all doors. 3. If the Door Lock button (1) is

pressed once more within four seconds, the horn will beep once and the hazard warning lights will blink.

4. Make sure the doors are locked by checking the position of the door lock button inside the vehicle.

ACCESSING YOUR VEHICLE

Do not leave the keys in your vehicle with unsupervised chil- dren. Unattended children could place the key in the igni- tion switch and may operate power windows or other con- trols, or even make the vehicle move, which could result in serious injury or death.

WARNING

OLX2049414N

Type A

Type B

OPD046001

3-5

Convenience Features

3

Unlocking your vehicle To unlock your vehicle : 1.Press the Door Unlock button (2)

on the remote key. 2.The driver’s door will unlock. The

hazard warning lights will blink two times.

Two Press Unlock Feature The priority for unlocking the driver door only, or unlocking all the doors with one press may be adjusted in the User Settings mode in the cluster LCD display. The Two Press Unlock feature, when enabled, will require the user to press the door unlock button once for driver door only and twice for unlock- ing all the doors. Select or Deselect the Two Press Unlock feature in the User Settings mode in the cluster LCD display. The option can be found under the follow- ing menu: User Settings Door Two Press Unlock

The Two Press Unlock feature can also be enabled or disabled by press- ing the door lock and unlock buttons simultaneously on the Key FOB: Press and hold both the Door Lock button and the Door Unlock button simultaneously until the hazard warning lights blink. This will enable or disable the Two Press Unlock feature. Repeat this procedure to enable/disable the mode again.

Information After unlocking the doors, the doors will automatically relock after 30 sec- onds unless a door is opened.

Liftgate unlocking (if equipped) To unlock the liftgate : 1.Press and hold the Liftgate Unlock

button (3) on the remote key for more than one second.

2.The hazard warning lights will blink two times and the liftgate will open.

3.Once the liftgate is opened and then closed, the liftgate will auto- matically re-lock after 30 seconds.

Information The word «HOLD» is written on the button to inform you that you must press and hold the button for more than one second.

Panic button Press and hold the Panic button (4) for more than one second. The horn sounds and hazard warning lights flash for about 30 seconds. To cancel the panic mode, press any button on the remote key.

i i

3-6

Convenience Features

Start-up For information, refer to the «Key Ignition Switch» section in chapter 5.

To prevent damaging the remote key: Keep the remote key away from

water or any liquid and fire. Internal circuits may malfunc- tion if the inside of the remote key gets damp (from liquids or moisture) or if it is heated. This can exclude the remote key from being covered under warranty.

Avoid dropping or throwing the remote key.

Protect the remote key from extreme temperatures.

Mechanical key

If the remote key does not operate normally, you can lock or unlock the driver’s door by using the mechanical key. To unfold the mechanical key, press the release button on the remote key. To return the key to its stored posi- tion, press the release button and fold the key back into the remote key.

Remote key precautions The remote key will not work if any of the following occur: The key is in the ignition switch. You exceed the operating distance

limit (about 90 feet [30 m]). The remote key battery is weak. Other vehicles or objects may be

blocking the signal. The weather is extremely cold. The remote key is close to a radio

transmitter such as a radio station or an airport which can interfere with normal operation of the remote key.

If the remote key does not work cor- rectly, open and close the door with the mechanical key. If you have a problem with the remote key contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. If the remote key is in close proximi- ty to your mobile phone, the signal could be blocked by your mobile phone’s normal operational signals. This is specifically relevant when the phone is active such as making and receiving calls, text messaging, and/or sending/receiving emails.

NOTICE

OLX2049413N

3-7

Convenience Features

3

When possible, avoid placing the remote key and your mobile phone in the same location such as a pants or jacket pocket in order to avoid inter- ference between the two devices.

Information This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules.

Operation is subject to the following three conditions:

1.This device may not cause harmful interference.

2.This device must accept any inter- ference received, including interfer- ence that may cause undesired oper- ation.

3.Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the device.

Keep the remote key away from electromagnetic materials that block electromagnetic waves to the key surface.

Battery replacement

If the remote key is not working prop- erly, try replacing the battery with a new one. Battery type: CR2032

To replace the battery: 1.Insert a slim tool into the slot and

gently pry open the cover. 2. Using a screw driver, remove the

battery cover. 2.Remove the old battery and insert

the new battery. Make sure the bat- tery position is correct.

3.Reinstall the battery cover and key cover in the reverse order of removal.

NOTICE

i

OPD046002

3-8

Convenience Features

If you suspect your remote key might have sustained some damage, or you feel your remote key is not work- ing correctly contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Information An inappropriately disposed battery can be harmful to the environment and human health. Dispose of the battery according to your local law(s) or regula- tions.

Smart Key (if equipped)

Your HYUNDAI uses a Smart Key, which you can use to lock or unlock the driver and passenger doors or the rear liftgate.

1.Door Lock 2.Door Unlock 3. Remote start 4. Liftgate Unlock (if equipped) 5. Panic

Locking your vehicle

To lock your vehicle using the door handle button or the Smart Key: 1.Make sure all doors, the hood and

the liftgate are closed. 2.Make sure you have the smart key

in your possession.

i

THIS PRODUCT CONTAINS A BUTTONBATTERY. If swallowed, a lithium button battery can cause severe or fatal injuries within 2 hours. Keep batteries out of reach of children. If you think batteries may have been swallowed or placed inside any part of the body, seek immediate medical attention.

WARNING

OLX2049003N

Type A

Type B

OLX2048001

OLX2048002

3-9

Convenience Features

3

3.Press either the button on the door handle or the Door Lock button (1) on the smart key. The chime will sound once and the hazard warn- ing lights will blink.

4.Make sure the doors are locked by checking the position of the door lock button inside the vehicle.

Information The door handle button will only operate when the smart key is within 28~40 inches (0.7~1 m) from the out- side door handle.

Note that you cannot lock your vehi- cle using the door handle button if any of the following occur: The Smart Key is in the vehicle. The Engine Start/Stop button is in

ACC or ON position. Any of the doors are open except

for the liftgate.

Unlocking your vehicle

To unlock your vehicle: 1.Make sure you have the smart key

in your possession. 2.Press either the button on the door

handle or the Door Unlock button (2) on the smart key. The driver’s door will unlock and the hazard warning lights will blink two times.

Two Press Unlock Feature The priority for unlocking the driver door only, or unlocking all the doors with one press may be adjusted in the User Settings mode in the cluster LCD display.

i

Do not leave the Smart Key in your vehicle with unsupervised children. Unattended children could press the Engine Start/ Stop button and may operate power windows or other con- trols, or even make the vehicle move, which could result in serious injury or death.

WARNING

OLX2048002

3-10

Convenience Features

The Two Press Unlock feature, when enabled, will require the user to press the door unlock button once for driver door only and twice for unlock- ing all the doors. Select or Deselect the Two Press Unlock feature in the User Settings mode in the cluster LCD display. The option can be found under the follow- ing menu: User Settings Door Two Press Unlock The Two Press Unlock feature can also be enabled or disabled by pressing the door lock and unlock buttons simultaneously on the Key FOB: Press and hold both the Door Lock button and the Door Unlock button simultaneously until the hazard warning lights blink. This will enable or disable the Two Press Unlock feature. Repeat this procedure to enable/disable the mode again.

Information The door handle buttons will only

operate when the smart key is with- in 28-40 inches (0.7~1m) from the outside door handle.

Either the driver or front passenger door can be opened with the door handle button when the smart key is within this range.

If you press the front passenger out- side door handle with the smart key in your possession, all the doors will unlock.

Remote start (if equipped) You can start the vehicle using the remote start button (4) of the smart key.

To start the vehicle remotely : — Lock the doors by pressing the

door lock button (1) within 32 ft (10 m) distance from the vehicle.

— Press the remote start button for over 2 seconds within 4 seconds after locking the doors. The engine will start.

Press the remote start button once to turn off the vehicle. Air conditioner/heater system main- tains the status before turning off the vehicle. If no further action for operating/driv- ing the vehicle is taken, the vehicle will be turned off 10 minutes after starting the vehicle remotely.

i

Laws in your country may restrict the use of remote start. You should check country reg- ulations before using this remote starting system.

It is only possible to start the vehicle remotely when shifted to P (Park).

If the hood or the liftgate is opened, you cannot start the vehicle remotely.

The Remote start function works the same as Blue Link remote start. For further cau- tion information, refer to the separately supplied «Blue Link (Infotainment system) manual».

CAUTION

3-11

Convenience Features

3

Opening the liftgate Non-power liftgate

To unlock and open the liftgate: 1.Make sure you have the smart key

in your possession. 2.Press either the liftgate handle

release switch on the vehicle for more than one second. The hazard warning lights will blink two times and the liftgate latch will unlock.

3.Once the liftgate is opened and then closed, the liftgate will auto- matically re-lock after 30 seconds.

Information The liftgate handle switch will only operate when the smart key is within 28 inches (0.7 m) from the liftgate handle.

Power liftgate

To unlock and open the liftgate: 1.Make sure you have the smart key

in your possession. 2.Press either the liftgate handle

release switch on the vehicle or press and hold the Liftgate Unlock button (4) on the smart key for more than one second. The hazard warning lights will blink two times and the liftgate latch will open.

3.Once the liftgate is opened and then closed, the liftgate will auto- matically re-lock after 30 seconds.

Information The liftgate handle switch will only operate when the smart key is within 28 inches (0.7 m) from the liftgate handle.

Panic button Press and hold the Panic button (5) for more than one second. The horn sounds and hazard warning lights blink for about 30 seconds. To cancel the panic mode, press any button on the Smart Key.

Start-up You can start the vehicle without inserting the key.

For information, refer to the «Engine Start/Stop Button» sec- tion in chapter 5.

Information Preventing the doors/liftgate from locking/unlocking

Activating the feature

With the engine off, press the lock button on the smart key and immedi- ately press the unlock button along with the lock button for more than 4 seconds. When the feature is activat- ed, the hazard warning lights will blink four times.

iii

3-12

Convenience Features

How the feature works

When the feature is activated, the doors or liftgate will not lock or unlock even though the outside door handle button or liftgate handle release switch is pressed with the smart key in your possession. Also, Welcome System (if equipped) and Smart Liftgate (if equipped) will not operate even though you approach the vehicle with the smart key.

Deactivating the feature

Press the door lock or unlock button on the smart key, the feature will deactivate.

To prevent damaging the smart key: Keep the smart key in a cool, dry

place to avoid damage or mal- function. Exposure to moisture or high temperature may cause the internal circuit of the smart key to malfunction which may not be covered under warranty.

Avoid dropping or throwing the smart key.

Protect the smart key from extreme temperatures.

Mechanical key If the Smart Key does not operate normally, you can lock or unlock the driver’s door by using the mechanical key.

To remove the mechanical key from the smart key FOB, slide the release lever in the direction of the arrow (1) and then pull the mechanical key (2) outward. To unlock the vehicle using the mechanical key, insert the mechani- cal key into the key hole in the driver door (Refer to page 3-15). To reinstall the mechanical key into the FOB, insert the key in the top of the key FOB and push inward until a click sound is heard.

Loss of a smart key A maximum of two Smart Keys can be registered to a single vehicle. If you happen to lose your smart key, you should immediately take the vehicle and remaining keys to your authorized HYUNDAI dealer or tow the vehicle, if necessary.

Smart key precautions The smart key may not work if any of the following occur: The smart key is close to a radio

transmitter such as a radio station or an airport which can interfere with normal operation of the trans- mitter.

The smart key is near a mobile two way radio system or a cellular phone.

Another vehicle’s smart key is being operated close to your vehicle.

NOTICE OPD046045

3-13

Convenience Features

3

If the smart key does not work cor- rectly, open and close the door with the mechanical key. If you have a problem with the smart key, contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. If the smart key is in close proximity to your mobile phone, the signal could be blocked by your mobile phone’s normal operational signals. This is specifically relevant when the phone is active such as making and receiving calls, text messaging, and/or sending/receiving emails. When possible, avoid keeping the remote key and your mobile phone in the same location such as a pants or jacket pocket in order to avoid inter- ference between the two devices.

Keep the smart key away from electromagnetic materials that blocks electromagnetic waves to the key surface.

Always have the smart key with you when leaving the vehicle. If the smart key is left near the vehi- cle, the vehicle battery may be dis- charged.

Information This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules.

Operation is subject to the following three conditions:

1.This device may not cause harmful interference.

2.This device must accept any inter- ference received, including interfer- ence that may cause undesired oper- ation.

3.Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the device.

Battery replacement

If the Smart Key is not working prop- erly, try replacing the battery with a new one. Battery Type: CR2032 To replace the battery: 1.Remove the mechanical key. 2.Use a slim tool to pry open the rear

cover of the smart key. 3.Remove the old battery and insert

the new battery. Make sure the bat- tery position is correct.

4.Reinstall the rear cover of the smart key.

i

NOTICE

NOTICE

OLX2049004N

3-14

If you suspect your smart key might have sustained some damage, or you feel your smart key is not work- ing correctly, contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Information An inappropriately disposed battery can be harmful to the environment and human health. Dispose of the battery according to your local law(s) or regulations.

Immobilizer System (if equipped) The immobilizer system protects your vehicle from theft. If an improp- erly coded key (or other device) is used, the engine’s fuel system is dis- abled. When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, the immobilizer sys- tem indicator should come on briefly, then go off. If the indicator starts to blink, the system does not recognize the coding of the key. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK/OFF position, then turn the ignition switch to the ON position again. In some circumstances, the vehicle may not recognize your remote key or smart key if another remote key or smart key device is nearby or a metal object such as a key chain is causing interference with the remote key or smart key. If this occurs, your vehicle may not start. Remove any metal objects or additional keys near the remote key or smart key before attempting to start the vehicle again.

If the system repeatedly does not recognize the coding of the key, it is recommended that you contact your HYUNDAI dealer. Do not attempt to alter this system or add other devices to it. Electrical problems could result that may make your vehicle inoperable.

i

Convenience Features

In order to prevent theft of your vehicle, do not leave spare keys anywhere in your vehicle. Your immobilizer password is a cus- tomer unique password and should be kept confidential.

WARNING

THIS PRODUCT CONTAINS A BUTTONBATTERY. If swallowed, a lithium button battery can cause severe or fatal injuries within 2 hours. Keep batteries out of reach of children. If you think batteries may have been swallowed or placed inside any part of the body, seek immediate medical attention.

WARNING

3-15

Convenience Features

3

The transponder in your key is an important part of the immobilizer system. It is designed to give years of trouble-free service, how- ever you should avoid exposure to moisture, static electricity and rough handling. Immobilizer sys- tem malfunction could occur.

Information This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules.

Operation is subject to the following three conditions:

1.This device may not cause harmful interference.

2.This device must accept any inter- ference received, including interfer- ence that may cause undesired oper- ation.

3.Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the users authority to operate the device.

i

NOTICE

3-16

Convenience Features

Operating Door Locks from Outside the Vehicle Mechanical key

[A] : Unlock, [B] : Lock

First, pull the outside door handle (1) and push the hook (2) located inside of outside door handle by using the mechanical key. And remove the cover (3) and lower the cover down- ward not to be damaged.

Be careful not to damage the cover while removing it or mis- place it after removing it.

After removing the cover, turn the key toward the front of the vehicle to unlock and toward the rear of the vehicle to lock. If you lock the driver’s door with a mechanical key, the driver’s door will lock. If you unlock the driver’s door with a mechanical key, you can open and close the driver’s door only. Once the doors are unlocked, they may be opened by pulling the door handle. When closing the door, push the door by hand. Make sure that doors are closed securely.

Remote key

To lock the doors, press the Door Lock button (1) on the remote key. Press the Door Unlock button (2) on the remote key, the driver’s door will unlock. If you press the Door Unlock button on the remote key again with- in four seconds, then all the doors will unlock. Once the doors are unlocked, they may be opened by pulling the door handle. When closing the door, push the door by hand. Make sure that doors are closed securely.

NOTICE

DOOR LOCKS

OLX2049415N

OLX2048005

OLX2049052L

3-17

Convenience Features

3

Smart key

Press the button on the driver’s out- side door handle while carrying the Smart Key with you or press the Door Unlock button on the Smart Key, the driver’s door will unlock.

If you press the button on the front passenger’s outside door, all doors will unlock. Once the doors are unlocked, they may be opened by pulling the door handle. When closing the door, push the door by hand. Make sure that doors are closed securely.

Information In cold and wet climates, door lock

and door mechanisms may not work properly due to freezing conditions.

If the door is locked/unlocked multi- ple times in rapid succession with either the vehicle key or door lock switch, the system may stop operat- ing temporarily in order to protect the circuit and prevent damage to system components.

Two press unlock setting can be changed in the User Settings mode on the cluster.

Operating Door Locks from Inside the Vehicle With the door lock button

To unlock a door, push the door lock button (1) to the «Unlock» posi- tion. The red mark (2) on the door lock button will be visible.

To lock a door, push the door lock button (1) to the «Lock» position. If the door is locked properly, the red mark (2) on the door lock button will not be visible.

To open a door, pull the door han- dle (3) outward.

i

OLX2049416N

Door Lock Door Unlock OLX2048006

OLX2048002

3-18

Convenience Features

If the inner door handle of either the driver door or passenger door is pulled when the door lock button is in the lock position, the button is unlocked and the door will open.

For Key Start Vehicles (with Remote Key) The front doors cannot be locked if the remote key is in the ignition switch and either of the front doors are open.

For Push Button Start Vehicles (with Smart Key) The doors cannot be locked if the smart key is inside the vehicle and any of the doors are open.

Information If a power door lock ever fails to func- tion while you are in the vehicle try one or more of the following tech- niques to exit:

Operate the door unlock feature repeatedly (both electronic and manual) while simultaneously pulling on the door handle.

Operate the other door locks and handles, front and rear.

Lower a front window and use the mechanical key to unlock the door from outside.

Information When the vehicles battery run out and you leave the vehicle, make sure all the doors are locked. You can lock the drivers door with a key and the rest of the doors with the lock button above the door inside handle.

With the central door lock switch

The driver side and front passenger side door armrest is equipped with a central door lock switch. The lock button is indicated by a ( ) symbol. The unlock button is indicated by a ( ) symbol. When the lock button (1) is pressed, all the vehicle doors will lock. When the unlock button (2) is pressed, all the vehicle doors will unlock.

i

i

Driver’s door Passenger’s door

OLX2049417N

3-19

Convenience Features

3

For Key Start Vehicles (with Remote Key) If the key is in the ignition switch and any door is opened, the doors will not lock even though the lock button (2) is pressed.

For Push Button Start Vehicles (with Smart Key) If the smart key is in the vehicle and any door is open, the doors will not lock even though the lock button (2) is pressed.

The doors should always be fully closed and locked while the vehicle is in motion. If the doors are unlocked, the risk of being thrown from the vehicle in a crash is increased.

Do not pull the inner door handle of the driver’s or pas- senger’s door while the vehi- cle is moving.

WARNING

Do not leave children or animals unattended in your vehicle. An enclosed vehicle can become extremely hot, causing death or serious injury to unattended children or animals who cannot escape the vehicle. Children might operate features of the vehicle that could injure them, or they could encounter other harm, possibly from someone gaining entry to the vehicle.

WARNING

Always secure your vehicle.

Leaving your vehicle unlocked increases the potential risk to you or others from someone hiding in your vehicle. To secure your vehicle, while depressing the brake, press the P (Park) button, engage the parking brake, and place the ignition switch in the LOCK/OFF position, close all windows, lock all doors, and always take the key with you.

WARNING

3-20

Convenience Features

Automatic Door Lock and Unlock Features Your vehicle is equipped with fea- tures that will automatically lock or unlock your vehicle based on set- tings you select in the cluster LCD display.

Auto LOCK — Enable on Speed When this feature is set in the cluster LCD display, all the doors will be locked automatically when the vehi- cle exceeds 9 mph (15 kph).

Auto LOCK — Enable on Shift When this feature is set in the cluster LCD display, all the doors will be locked automatically when the vehi- cle is shifted out of P (Park) while the engine is running.

Auto UNLOCK — On shift to P When this feature is set in the LCD cluster display, all the doors will be unlocked automatically when the vehicle is shifted back into P (Park).

Auto UNLOCK — On key out (if equipped with remote key) When this feature is set in the LCD cluster display, all the doors will be unlocked automatically when the ignition key is removed from the key ignition switch.

Auto UNLOCK — Vehicle Off (if equipped with smart key) When this feature is set in the LCD cluster display, all the doors will be unlocked automatically when the vehicle is off.

For more information on these features, refer to the LCD Display section later in this chapter.

Additional Unlock Safety Feature — Air Bag Deployment As an additional safety feature, all doors will be automatically unlocked when an impact causes the air bags to deploy.

Opening a door when something is approaching may cause dam- age or injury. Be careful when opening doors and watch for vehicles, motorcycles, bicycles or pedestrians approaching the vehicle in the path of the door.

CAUTION

If you stay in the vehicle for a long time while the weather is very hot or cold, there are risks of injuries or danger to life. Do not lock the vehicle from the outside when someone is in the vehicle.

WARNING

3-21

Convenience Features

3

Child-Protector Rear Door Locks (if equipped)

The child safety lock is provided to help prevent children seated in the rear from accidentally opening the rear doors.The rear door safety locks should be used whenever children are in the vehicle. The child safety lock is located on the edge of each rear door. When the child safety lock is in the lock posi- tion, the rear door will not open if the inner door handle is pulled. To lock the child safety lock, insert a small flat blade tool (like a screwdriv- er or similar) (1) into the slot and turn it to the lock position as shown.

To allow a rear door to be opened from inside the vehicle, unlock the child safety lock.

Electronic Child Safety Lock System (if equipped)

If you push the Electronic child safety lock switch and the indicator illumi- nates, rear passengers cannot open the rear door from inside the vehicle. To cancel the Electronic child safety lock system, push the Electronic child safety lock system switch one more time and then the indicator turns off. The Safe Exit Assist (SEA) system is operated when the Electronic child safety lock system is activated and the Safe Exit Assist (SEA) function is selected in the cluster. However, the Safe Exit Assist (SEA) system does not automatically activate the Electronic child safety lock system.

OLX2048008 OLX2049418N

If children accidently open the rear doors while the vehicle is in motion, they could fall out of the vehicle.The rear door safety locks should always be used whenever children are in the vehicle.

WARNING

3-22

Convenience Features

The Electronic child safety lock sys- tem can be operated for approxi- mately 10 minutes after the engine is turned off. If your vehicle is equipped with the Electronic child safety lock system, the Child-protector rear door locks which is manually operated is not provided. If Electronic child safety lock system is activated, rear passenger cannot open or close the rear window also. For more details, refer to Windows in this chapter. If the Electronic child safety

lock system is not operated when pushing the Electronic child safety lock switch, the message is displayed and the alarm will sound. If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

CAUTION

OTM048424L

3-23

Convenience Features

SAFE EXIT ASSIST (SEA) (IF EQUIPPED)

3

After the vehicle stops, when an approaching vehicle from the rear area is detected as soon as a pas- senger opens a door, Safe Exit Assist will warn the driver with a warning message and an audible warning to help prevent a collision.

In addition, when the electronic child safety lock button is in the LOCK position and an approaching vehicle from the rear area is detected, the electronic child safety lock button will not unlock even if the driver presses the button to prevent the rear doors from opening.

Detecting sensor

[1] : Rear corner radar

Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensors.

OTM070238 OLX2048009

OLX2051139L

Warning timing may vary depending on the speed of the approaching vehicle.

CAUTION For more details on the precau- tions of the rear corner radars, refer to Blind-Spot Collision Assist (BCA) section in chap- ter 5.

CAUTION

3-24

Safe Exit Assist settings Setting features

Safe Exit Assist

With the engine on, select Driver Assistance Blind-Spot Safety Safe Exit Assist from the Settings menu to turn on Safe Exit Assist and deselect to turn off the function.

Information If the engine is restarted, Safe Exit Assist will maintain the last setting.

Warning Timing

With the engine on, select Driver Assistance Warning Timing from the Settings menu to change the ini- tial warning activation time for Safe Exit Assist. When the vehicle is first delivered, Warning Timing is set to Normal. If you change the Warning Timing, the warning time of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

i

Convenience Features

OTM070038N

OTMA058089

The driver should always be aware of unexpected and sud- den situations from occurring. If Safe Exit Assist is deselected, Safe Exit Assist cannot assist you.

WARNING

3-25

Convenience Features

Warning volume

With the engine on, select ‘Driver Assistance Warning Volume’ from the Settings menu to change the Warning Volume to ‘High’, ‘Medium’, ‘Low’ or ‘Off’ for Safe Exit Assist. However, even if ‘Off’ is selected, the function’s Warning Volume will not turn off but the volume will sound as ‘Low’. If you change the Warning volume, the warning volume of other Driver assistance systems may change.

Safe Exit Assist operation Warning and control

Collision warning when exiting vehicle

When an approaching vehicle from the rear is detected at the moment a door is opened, the Watch for traffic warning message will appear on the cluster, and an audi- ble warning will sound.

Safe Exit Assist will warn the driver when your vehicle speed is below 2 mph (3 km/h), and the speed of the approaching vehicle from the rear is above 4 mph (6 km/h).

3

The setting of the Warning Timing and Warning Volume applies to all functions of the Safe Exit Assist. Even though Standard is selected for Warning Timing, if the vehicles approaches at high speed from the rear, the initial warning activation time may seem late. Select Late for Warning Timing when traffic is light and driving speed is slow.

CAUTION

OTM070101N

ONX4E070090

3-26

Safe Exit Assist linked with Electronic child safety lock

When Electric child safety lock is operating and an approaching vehicle from the rear area is detected, the rear doors cannot be unlocked even if the driver tries to unlock the rear doors using the electronic child safety lock button. The warning light on the outside rearview mirror will blink and the Check surroundings then try again warning message will appear on the cluster.

Safe Exit Assist will warn the driver when vehicle speed is below 2 mph (3 km/h) and the speed of the approaching vehicle from the rear is above 4 mph (6 km/h).

For more details on electric child safety lock button, refer to Electronic Child Safety Lock sec- tion in chapter 3.

Convenience Features

OTM070145L

Take the following precautions when using Safe Exit Assist: For your safety, change the

Settings after parking the vehicle at a safe location.

If any other systems warning message is displayed or audi- ble warning is generated, Safe Exit Assist warning message may not be displayed and audible warning may not be generated.

You may not hear the warning sound of Safe Exit Assist if the surrounding is noisy.

Safe Exit Assist does not operate in all situations or cannot prevent all collisions.

Safe Exit Assist may warn the driver late or may not warn the driver depending on the road and driving conditions. Always check vehicle sur- roundings.

WARNING

If the driver presses the elec- tronic child lock button again within 10 seconds after the warning message appears, Safe Exit Assist judges that the driv- er has unlocked the doors acknowledging the rear status. The electronic child safety lock will turn off (button indicator OFF) and the rear doors will unlock. Always check the sur- roundings before turning off the electronic child safety lock but- ton.

CAUTION

3-27

Convenience Features

Information After the engine is turned off, Safe Exit Assist operates approximately for 3 minutes, but turns off immediately if the doors are locked.

Safe Exit Assist malfunction and limitations Safe Exit Assist malfunction

When Safe Exit Assist is not working properly, the Check Blind-Spot Safety system warning message will appear on the cluster for several sec- onds, and the master ( ) warning light will illuminate on the cluster. If the master warning light illuminates, we recommend that the vehicle be inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

When the outside rearview mirror warning light is not working properly, the Check side view mirror warning light warning message will appear on the cluster for several seconds, and the master ( ) warning light will illuminate on the cluster. If the master warning light illuminates, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

i

3

The driver and passengers are responsible for accidents that occurs while exiting the vehicle. Always check the sur- roundings before you exit the vehicle.

Never deliberately operate Safe Exit Assist. Doing so may lead to serious injury or death.

Safe Exit Assist does not operate if there is a problem with Blind-Spot Safety sys- tem. The warning message of Blind-Spot Safety system will appear when: — Blind-Spot Safety system

sensor or the sensor sur- rounding is polluted or cov- ered

— Blind-Spot Safety system fails to warn passengers or falsely warn passengers

OTM070099N

OTM070100N

3-28

Safe Exit Assist disabled

When the rear bumper around the rear corner radar or sensor is cov- ered with foreign material, such as snow or rain, or installing a trailer or carrier, it can reduce the detecting performance and temporarily limit or disable Safe Exit Assist. If this occurs, the Blind-Spot Safety system disabled. Radar blocked warning message will appear on the cluster. Safe Exit Assist will operate normal- ly when such foreign material or trail- er, etc. is removed, and then the engine is restarted.

If Safe Exit Assist does not operate normally after it is removed, have the vehicle be inspected by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer.

Limitations of Safe Exit Assist Safe Exit Assist may not operate nor- mally, or it may operate unexpected- ly under the following circumstances: Getting out of the vehicle where

trees or grass are overgrown Getting out of the vehicle where

the road is wet The approaching vehicle is very

fast or very slow

Information For more details on the limitations of the rear corner radar, refer to Blind- Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist (BCA) section in chapter 5.

i

Convenience Features

OTM070098N

Even though the warning message does not appear on the cluster, Safe Exit Assist may not properly operate.

Safe Exit Assist may not prop- erly operate in an area (e.g. open terrain) where any sub- stance are not detected right after the engine is turned on, or when the detecting sensor is blocked with foreign materi- al right after the engine is turned on.

WARNING

Turn off Safe Exit Assist to install a trailer, carrier, etc., or remove the trailer, carrier, etc. to use Safe Exit Assist.

CAUTION

3-29

Convenience Features

Rear Occupant Alert (ROA) System (if equipped) The Rear Occupant Alert (ROA) sys- tem is provided to help prevent exit- ing the vehicle with the rear passen- ger left in the vehicle.

1st alert — When you open the front door

after opening and closing the rear door and turning off the engine, the «Check rear seats» warning message appears on the cluster.

You can activate or deactivate the Rear Occupant Alert (ROA) sys- tem from the User Settings mode in the cluster LCD display. The option can be found under the fol- lowing menu: User Settings Convenience Rear Occupant Alert

2nd alert (if equipped) — After the 1st alert the 2nd alert

operates when any movement is detected in the vehicle after the driver’s door is closed and all the doors are locked. The horn will activate for about 25 seconds. If the system continues to detect a movement the alert operates up to 8 times.

— Unlock the door with the remote key or smart key to stop the alert.

— The system detects movement in the vehicle for 24 hours after the door is locked.

— The 2nd alert is activated only after the prior activation of the 1st alert.

3

Safe Exit Assist may not oper- ate normally if interfered by strong electromagnetic waves.

Safe Exit Assist may not oper- ate for 3 seconds after the vehicle is started, or the rear corner radars are initialized.

WARNING

Make sure that all the win- dows are closed. If the win- dow is open, the alert may activate by the sensor detect- ing an unintended movement (e.g. wind or bugs).

CAUTION

3-30

Convenience Features

Even if your vehicle is equipped with the Rear Occupant Alert (ROA) system, always make sure you check the rear seat before you get off the vehicle. The alert may not operate if: — The movement does not

continue for a certain period of time or the movement is small.

— The rear passenger is cov- ered with an obstacle such as a blanket.

— Also, always be cautious of the passengers safety as the detection function and 2nd alert may not operate according to the surround- ing environment and certain conditions.

— If a child sits on a vehicle seat without a child restraint system.

WARNING

If you do not want to use the Rear Occupant Alert (ROA) system, press OK button on the steering wheel when the 1st alert is displayed on the cluster. Doing so will deacti- vate the 2nd alert once. (if equipped)

OLX2049120N

Cluster

OTMA048421

Steering wheel

If boxes or objects are stacked in the vehicle, the system may not detect the obstacle. Also, the warning may generate if the box or object falls off.

The sensor may not operate normally if the senor is obscured by foreign sub- stances.

The alert may activate if move- ment in the driver or passen- ger seat is detected.

The alert may activate with the doors locked due to car wash or surrounding vibration or noise.

Inside movement detection is stopped under remote start (if equipped) status.

CAUTION

3-31

Convenience Features

3

This system helps to protect your vehi- cle and valuables. The horn will sound and the hazard warning lights will blink continuously if any of the following occur: — A door is opened without using the

remote key or smart key. — The liftgate is opened without

using the remote key or smart key. — The engine hood is opened. The alarm continues for 30 seconds (repeats 2 times unless the system is disarmed), then the system resets. To turn off the alarm, unlock the doors with the remote key or smart key. The Theft Alarm System automati- cally sets 30 seconds after you lock the doors and the liftgate. For the system to activate, you must lock the doors and the liftgate from outside the vehicle with the remote key or smart key or by pressing the button on the outside of the door handle with the smart key in your posses- sion. The hazard warning lights will blink and the chime will sound once to indicate the system is armed.

Once the security system is set, opening any door, the liftgate, or the hood without using the remote key or smart key will cause the alarm to activate. The Theft Alarm System will not set if the hood, the liftgate, or any door is not fully closed. If the system will not set, check the hood, the liftgate, or the doors are fully closed. Do not attempt to alter this system or add other devices to it.

Information Do not lock the doors until all pas-

sengers have left the vehicle. If the remaining passenger leaves the vehicle when the system is armed, the alarm will be activated.

If the vehicle is not disarmed with the remote key or smart key, open the doors by using the mechanical key and place the ignition switch in the ON position (for remote key) or start the engine (for smart key) by direct- ly pressing the ignition switch with the smart key.

If the system is disarmed by unlock- ing the vehicle, but neither a door or the liftgate is opened within 30 sec- onds, the doors will relock and the system will rearm automatically.

i THEFT-ALARM SYSTEM

3-32

Convenience Features

The Driver Position Memory System is provided to store and recall the fol- lowing memory settings with a sim- ple button operation. — Driver’s seat position (Power seat) — Side view mirror position — Instrument panel illumination inten-

sity — Head Up Display (HUD) position

and brightness (if equipped)

Information If the battery is disconnected, the

memory settings will be erased.

If the Driver Position Memory System does not operate normally, have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Storing Positions into Memory 1. Shift to P (Park) position. 2. Adjust the driver’s seat position,

side view mirror position, instru- ment panel illumination intensity and head-up display height/bright- ness to positions comfortable for the driver.

3. Press the SET button. The system will beep once and notify you «Press button to save settings» on the cluster LCD display.

4. Press one of the memory buttons (1 or 2) within 4 seconds. The sys- tem will beep twice when the memory has been successfully stored.

5. «Driver 1 (or 2) settings saved» will appear on the cluster LCD display.

i

DRIVER POSITION MEMORY SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)

OLX2049012N

Never attempt to operate the driver position memory system while the vehicle is moving. This could result in loss of con- trol, and an accident causing death, serious injury, or property damage.

WARNING

To prevent the battery from being discharged, use the driv- er position memory system while engine is running and the vehicle is in the park position.

CAUTION

3-33

Convenience Features

3

Recalling Positions from Memory 1. Shift to P (Park) while the ignition

switch is in the ON position. 2. Press the desired memory button

(1 or 2). The system will beep once, and then the driver’s seat position, side view mirror position, instrument panel illumination intensity and head-up display height/brightness will automatical- ly adjust to the stored positions.

3. «Driver 1 (or 2) settings applied» will appear on the cluster LCD dis- play.

Information While recalling the «1» memory

position, pressing the SET or 1 but- ton temporarily stops the adjust- ment of the recalled memory posi- tion. Pressing the 2 button recalls the «2» memory position.

While recalling the «2» memory position, pressing the SET or 2 but- ton temporarily stops the adjust- ment of the recalled memory posi- tion. Pressing the 1 button recalls the «1» memory position.

While recalling the stored positions, pressing one of the control buttons for the driver’s seat, side view mir- ror, instrument panel illumination or head-up display will cause the movement of that component to stop and move in the direction that the control button is pressed.

Resetting the Driver’s Seat Memory System Take the following procedures to reset the driver’s seat memory system, when it does not operate properly.

To reset the driver’s seat memo- ry system 1. Place the ignition switch to the ON

position, shift to P (Park), and open the driver’s door.

2. Operate the control switch to set the driver’s seat and seatback to the foremost position.

3. Simultaneously press the SET button and push forward the seat movement switch over 2 seconds.

i

3-34

Convenience Features

While resetting the driver’s seat memory system 1. It starts with the notification sound. 2. The driver’s seat and seatback is

adjusted to the rearward position with the notification sound.

3. The driver’s seat and seatback is re-adjusted to the default position (central position) with the notifica- tion sound.

However, in the following cases, the resetting procedure and the notifica- tion sound may stop. — The memory button is pressed. — The control switch is operated. — The driving speed exceeds 2 mph

(3 km/h). — The driver’s door is closed.

Reattempt to do the resetting procedure again, when the resetting procedure incomplete- ly stops or the notification sound do not stop.

Make sure that there is no obsta- cle around the driver’s seat in advance of resetting the driver’s seat memory system.

Easy Access Function The system will move the driver’s seat automatically as follows: With remote key — It will move the driver’s seat rear-

ward and downward when the igni- tion key is removed.

— It will move the driver’s seat for- ward and upward when the ignition key is inserted.

With smart key — It will move the driver’s seat rear-

ward and downward when the Engine Start/Stop button is pressed to the OFF position.

— It will move the driver’s seat forward and upward when the Engine Start/Stop button is pressed to the ACC or START position.

NOTICE

If the reset is failed, initialize the system once again.

Initialize the system after cleaning the obstacles sur- rounding of seat.

After completing the initializa- tion, adjust the driver position memory system again.

CAUTION

3-35

Convenience Features

3

You can activate or deactivate the Easy Access Function from the User Settings mode in the cluster LCD dis- play. ‘Convenience Seat Slide Easy Access Off/Normal/Extended’. ‘Convenience Seat Height Easy Access’. «Seat (upward/downward) Easy

Access» function may not operate below the specific seat height for preventing injury of the passenger.

For more details, refer to «LCD Display» in this chapter.

Driver should be cautious when using this function to assure no injury to passenger or child in the back seat. In case of emer- gency the driver has to stop movement of front seat (when easy access feature is activat- ed) by pressing SET button or any of the driver seat control switches.

CAUTION

3-36

Convenience Features

STEERING WHEEL Electric Power Steering (EPS) The system assists you with steering the vehicle. If the vehicle is turned off or if the power steering system becomes inoperative, you may still steer the vehicle, but it will require increased steering effort. Should you notice any change in the effort required to steer during normal vehicle operation, have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

If the Electric Power Steering System does not operate nor- mally, the warning light ( ) will illuminate on the instrument cluster. You may steer the vehi- cle, but it will require increased steering efforts. Take your vehi- cle to an authorized HYUNDAI dealer and have the system checked as soon as possible.

When abnormality is detected in the electric power steering sys- tem, the steering assist function will stop. At this time, the warn- ing light turns on or blinks on the cluster. The steering wheel may become difficult to control or operate. Have your vehicle checked immediately, after mov- ing the vehicle to a safe zone.

Information The following symptoms may occur during normal vehicle operation:

The steering effort may be high immediately after placing the igni- tion switch in the ON position.

This happens as the system per- forms the EPS system diagnostics. When the diagnostics are complet- ed, the steering wheel effort will return to its normal condition.

When the battery voltage is low, you might have to put more sterring effrot. However, it is a temporary conditions so that it will return to normal condition after charging the battery.

A click noise may be heard from the EPS relay after the ignition switch is in the ON or LOCK/OFF position.

Motor noise may be heard when the vehicle is at a stop or at a low driv- ing speed.

When you operate the steering wheel in low temperatures, abnor- mal noise may occur. If the temper- ature rises, the noise will disappear. This is a normal condition.

When an error is detected from the EPS, the steering effort assist func- tion will not be activated.

Instrument cluster warning lights may be on or the steering effort may be high. If these symptoms occur, drive the vehicle to a safe area as soon as it is safe to do so. Have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possi- ble.

i

NOTICE

3-37

Convenience Features

3

Tilt Steering / Telescopic Steering When adjusting the steering wheel to a comfortable position, adjust the steering wheel so that it points toward your chest, not toward your face. Make sure you can see the instrument cluster warning lights and gauges. After adjusting, push the steering wheel both up and down to be certain it is locked in position. Always adjust the position of the steering wheel before driving.

While adjusting the steering wheel height, please do not push or pull it hard since the fixture can be damaged.

To adjust the steering wheel angle and height: 1. Pull down the lock-release lever (1). 2. Adjust the steering wheel to the

desired angle (2) and distance for- ward/back (3).

3. Pull up the lock-release lever to lock the steering wheel in place.

Information Sometimes the lock release lever may not engage completely. This may occur when the gears of the locking mecha- nism do not completely mesh. If this occurs, pull down on the lock-release lever, readjust the steering wheel again, and then pull back up on the release lever to lock the steering wheel in place.

Horn

To sound the horn, press the area indicated by the horn symbol on your steering wheel (see illustration). The horn will operate only when this area is pressed.

Do not strike the horn severely to operate it, or hit it with your fist. Do not press on the horn with a sharp-pointed object.

NOTICE

i NOTICE

OTM048408

OLX2048013

NEVER adjust the steering wheel while driving. This may cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.

WARNING

3-38

Convenience Features

Heated Steering Wheel (if equipped)

When the ignition switch is in the ON position or when the engine is run- ning, press the heated steering wheel button to warm the steering wheel. The indicator on the button will illuminate. To turn the heated steering wheel off, press the button again. The indicator on the button will turn off.

The heated steering wheel defaults to the OFF position whenever the ignition switch is in the ON position.

Information The heated steering wheel will turn off automatically approximately 30 min- utes after the heated steering wheel is turned on.

Do not install any cover or acces- sory on the steering wheel. The cover or accessory could cause damage to the heated steering wheel system.

NOTICE

i

OLX2048014

3-39

Convenience Features

3

MIRRORS Inside Rearview Mirror Before driving your vehicle, check to see that your inside rearview mirror is properly positioned. Adjust the rearview mirror so that the view through the rear window is properly centered.

When cleaning the mirror, use a paper towel or similar material dampened with glass cleaner. Do not spray glass cleaner directly on the mirror as this may cause the liquid cleaner to enter the mirror housing.

Day/night rearview mirror (if equipped)

[A]: Day, [B]: Night

Make this adjustment before you start driving and while the day/night lever is in the day position. Pull the day/night lever towards you to reduce glare from the headlights of the vehicles behind you during night driving. Remember that you lose some rearview clarity in the night position.

NOTICE

NEVER adjust the mirror while driving. This may cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.

WARNING

Make sure your line of sight is not obstructed. Do not place objects in the rear seat, cargo area, or behind the rear head- rests which could interfere with your vision through the rear window.

WARNING

To prevent serious injury during an accident or deployment of the air bag, do not modify the rearview mirror and do not install a wide mirror.

WARNING

OLX2048015L

3-40

Convenience Features

Electrochromatic Mirror (ECM) (if equipped) Some vehicles come equipped with an electrochromic mirror that helps control glare while driving at night or under low light driving conditions. When the engine is running, the glare is automatically controlled by the sensor mounted in the rearview mirror. The sensor detects the light level around the vehicle, and auto- matically adjusts to control the head- lamp glare from vehicles behind you. Whenever the shift button is placed in R (Reverse), the mirror will auto- matically go to the brightest setting in order to improve the drivers view behind the vehicle.

[A] : Indicator

When cleaning the mirror, use a paper towel or similar material dampened with glass cleaner. Do not spray glass cleaner directly on the mirror as that may cause the liquid cleaner to enter the mirror housing.

Electrochromatic Mirror (ECM) with homelink system (if equipped)

To operate the electric rearview mirror

Press the I button (1) to turn the automatic- dimming function on. The mirror indicator light will illuminate. Press the O button (2) to turn the automatic- dimming function off. The mirror indicator light will turn off.

NOTICE

OLX2048099L

OHD046025N

3-41

Convenience Features

HomeLink Wireless Control System

Your new mirror comes with an inte- grated HomeLink Universal Transceiver, which allows you to pro- gram the mirror to activate your garage door(s), estate gate, home lighting, etc. The mirror actually learns the codes from your various existing transmitters.

Retain the original transmitter for future programming procedures (i.e., new vehicle purchase). It is also sug- gested that upon the sale of the vehi- cle, the programmed HomeLink but- tons be erased for security purposes (follow step 1 in the «Programming» portion of this text).

Programming

Your vehicle may require the ignition switch to be turned to the ACC posi- tion for programming and/or operation of HomeLink. It is also recommended that a new battery be replaced in the hand-held transmitter of the device being programmed to HomeLink for quicker training and accurate trans- mission of the radio-frequency. Follow these steps to train your HomeLink mirror:

3

OHD046305N

Glare detection sensor Indicator light

Homelink buttons

When programming the HomeLink Wireless Control System, you may be operating a garage door or gate operator. Make sure that people and objects are out of the way of the moving door or gate to pre- vent potential harm or damage.

Do not use HomeLink with any garage door opener that lacks the safety stop and reverse feature as required by U.S. federal safety standards. (This includes any garage door opener model manufac- tured before April 1, 1982.) A garage door opener which cannot detect an object, sig- naling the door to stop and reverse, does not meet cur- rent U.S. federal safety stan- dards. Using a garage door opener without these features increases risk of serious injury or death. For more details, call 1-800-355-3515 or on the internet at www.home- link.com.

WARNING

3-42

1. When programming the buttons for the first time, press and hold the left and center buttons ( , ) simultaneously for approximately 20 seconds until the indicator light begins to flash. (This procedure erases the factory-set default codes. Do not perform this step to program additional hand-held transmitters.)

For non rolling code garage door openers, follow steps 2 — 3. For rolling code garage door openers, follow steps 2 — 6. For Canadian Programming, please follow the Canadian Programming section. For help with determining whether your garage is non-rolling code or rolling code, please refer to the garage door openers owner’s manual or contact HomeLink cus- tomer service at 1-800-355-3515.

2. Press and hold the button on the HomeLink system you wish to train and the button on the transmitter while the transmitter is approxi- mately 1 to 3 inches away from the mirror. Do not release the buttons until step 3 has been completed.

3. The HomeLink indicator light will flash, first slowly and then rapidly. When the indicator light flashes rapidly, both buttons may be released. (The rapid flashing light indicates successful programming of the new frequency signal.)

NOTICE

Convenience Features

OHD046307N

Flashing

1-3 inc

he s

TransmitterOHD046306N

Flashing

3-43

Convenience Features

Some gate operators and garage door openers may require you to replace step #3 with the «cycling» procedure noted in the «Canadian Programming» section of this doc- ument.

Rolling code programming To train a garage door opener (or other rolling code equipped devices) with the rolling code feature, follow these instructions after completing the «Programming» portion of this text. (A second person may make the following training procedures quicker & easier.) 4. Locate the «learn» or «smart» but-

ton on the device’s motor head unit. Exact location and color of the button may vary by product brand. If there is difficulty locating the «learn» or «smart» button, refer- ence the device’s owner’s manual or contact HomeLink at 1-800- 355-3515 or on the internet at www.homelink.com.

5. Press and release the «learn» or «smart» button on the devices motor head unit. You have 30 sec- onds to complete step number 6.

6. Return to the vehicle and firmly press and release the pro- grammed HomeLink button up to three times. The rolling code equipped device should now rec- ognize the HomeLink signal and activate when the HomeLink but- ton is pressed. The remaining two buttons may now be programmed if this has not previously been done. Refer to the «Programming» portion of this text.

Operating HomeLink To operate, simply press the pro- grammed HomeLink button. Activation will now occur for the trained product (garage door, securi- ty system, entry door lock, estate gate, or home or office lighting). For convenience, the hand-held trans- mitter of the device may also be used at any time. The HomeLink Wireless Controls System (once programmed) or the original hand-held transmitter may be used to activate the device (e.g. garage door, entry door lock, etc.). In the event that there are still programming difficulties, contact HomeLink at 1-800-355-3515 or on the internet at www.homelink.com.

NOTICE

3

3-44

Erasing programmed HomeLink but- tons To erase the three programmed but- tons (individual buttons cannot be erased): Press and hold the left and center

buttons simultaneously, until the indicator light begins to flash (approximately 20 seconds). Release both buttons. Do not hold for longer than 30 seconds.

HomeLink is now in the train (or learning) mode and can be pro- grammed at any time.

Gate operator & Canadian program- ming During programming, your handheld transmitter may automatically stop transmitting. Continue to press the Integrated HomeLink Wireless Control System button (note steps 2 through 3 in the Programming por- tion of this document) while you press and re-press («cycle») your handheld transmitter every two sec- onds until the frequency signal has been learned. The indicator light will flash slowly and then rapidly after several seconds upon successful training. FCC ID: NZLZTVHL3 IC: 4112A-ZTVHL3

Information This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules.

Operation is subject to the following three conditions:

1. This device may not cause harmful interference.

2. This device must accept any inter- ference received, including interfer- ence that may cause undesired operation.

3. The transceiver has been tested and complies with FCC and Industry Canada rules. Changes or modifica- tions not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the device.

i

Convenience Features

OHD046306N

Flashing

3-45

Convenience Features

Integrated HomeLink Wireless Control System

The HomeLink Wireless Control System provides a convenient way to replace up to three handheld radio- frequency (RF) transmitters used to activate compatible devices such as gate operators, garage door open- ers, entry door locks, security sys- tems, and home lighting.

Considering the Home Security when the vehicle is parked out- side the garage, the HomeLink will ONLY work when the ignition switch is in ACC position or ON position.

NOTICE

3

Before programming HomeLink to a garage door opener or gate operator, make sure that people and objects are out of the way of the device to prevent poten- tial harm or damage. When pro- gramming a garage door open- er, it is advised to park outside of the garage. Do not use HomeLink with any garage door opener that lacks safety stop and reverse features as required by U.S. federal safe- ty standards (this includes any garage door opener model man- ufactured before April 1, 1982). A garage door that cannot detect an object signaling the door to stop and reverse — does not meet current U.S. federal safety standards. For more information, contact HomeLink at www.homelink.com, or call HomeLink customer support at 1-800-355-3515.

(Continued)

(Continued) It is also recommended that a new battery be replaced in the hand-held transmitter of the device being trained to HomeLink for quicker training and accurate transmission of the radio frequency.

WARNING

3-46

1. Programming homelink

The following steps show how to pro- gram HomeLink. If you have any questions or are having difficulty pro- gramming your HomeLink buttons, refer o the HomeLink website or call the HomeLink customer support toll- free number. Do this, before going back to the dealer who sold you the car. Visit the HomeLink website at:

www.homelink.com. Then at the top of the page, choose your vehi- cle make. Then watch the You Tube video, and/or access additional website information.

If you choose to access the website via your cell phone, scan the QR code.

Or, call HomeLink customer sup- port at 1-800-355-3515 (Please have the vehicle make/model AND the opener device make/model readily available.)

1) Programming Preparation 1. When programming a garage door

opener, it is advised to park the vehicle outside of the garage.

2. It is recommended that a new bat- tery be placed in the hand-held transmitter of the device being programmed to HomeLink for quicker training and accurate transmission of the radio-frequen- cy signal.

3. Place the ignition switch to the ACC(Accessory) position for pro- gramming of HomeLink.

2) Programming a New HomeLink Button

1. Press and hold the HomeLink but- ton (1), (2) or (3), you would like to program (Fig. 2). The HomeLink indicator light (4) will flash slowly in red (if not, perform the steps of Erasing HomeLink Buttons sec- tion, and start over).

Convenience Features

OHD046025N

3-47

Convenience Features

2. Position the garage door opener remote 1 3 inches (2 8 cm) away from the HomeLink buttons (Fig. 3).

3. While the HomeLink indicator light (4) (Fig. 2) is flashing slowly in red, press and hold the hand-held remote button. Continue pressing the HomeLink button and the hand-held remote button until the HomeLink indicator light (4) light changes from slowly to rapidly.You may now release the buttons.

4. Wait until your garage door comes to a complete stop, regardless of position, before proceeding to the next steps.

5. Press the HomeLink button you are programming and observe the indicator light. If the indicator light rapidly flash-

es or solid red, your device should operate when the HomeLink button is pressed. At this point, if your device operates, programming is complete.

If the indicator light rapidly flash- es, firmly press, hold for two sec- onds and release the HomeLink button up to three times in a row slowly to complete the program- ming process. Do not press the HomeLink button rapidly. At this point if your device operates, pro- gramming is complete. If the device does not operate, contin- ue with step P6.

3

OHD046025N OHD046307N

Flashing

1- 3

inc he

s

3-48

6. At the garage door opener motor, (security gate motor, etc.) locate the Learn,,Smart, Set or Program button (Fig. 4). This can usually be found where the hang- ing antenna wire is attached to the motor-head unit (see the devices manual to identify this button). The name and color of the button may vary by manufacturer.

[A] : LEARN BUTTON

A ladder and/or second person may simplify the following steps.

7. Firmly press and release the Learn, Smart, Set or Program button. You now have up to 30 seconds in which to com- plete the next step.

8. Return to the vehicle and firmly press, hold for two seconds and release, the HomeLink button up to three times in a row slowly. Do not press the HomeLink button rapidly. As soon as you see the garage door start to move, stop pressing any buttons until a few seconds after the garage door has come to a complete stop, regard- less of position. At this point pro- gramming is complete and your device should operate when the HomeLink button is pressed and released.

NOTICE

Convenience Features

ODL3A040504

3-49

Convenience Features

2. Operating homelink

1) Operating HomeLink

1. Press the desired programmed HomeLink button (1, 2 or 3).

The HomeLink indicator (4) should flashing in red or solid red, and your programmed device should operate. If your device does not operate, the HomeLink programming was not successful, and youll need to reprogram the button.

3. Erasing homelink buttons

If you recently purchased your vehi- cle and are programming HomeLink for the first time, we recommend that you follow the instructions below to erase ALL HomeLink programming. For new vehicles, there should not be any programming associated with any of the buttons. But clear them all out anyway, if you are having any programming issues. If you pur- chased your vehicle used, then youll need to erase ALL HomeLink programming so the unit is clear to accept new programming for your devices.

If you have owned your vehicle for some time, and already have pro- grammed one or more of the buttons, there may be situations where you only want to erase and reprogram a single button. For example, you move to a new home, and need to erase and reprogram only button 1 for your personal garage door, and you want to KEEP the programming of buttons 2 and 3. The same would be true if you had to purchase a replacement garage door opener for your current home. Therefore, if you want to erase and reprogram a sin- gle button, while keeping the pro- gramming of one or more of the other buttons, follow the instructions for erasing and reprogramming a single button.

NOTICE

3

OHD046025N

OHD046025N

3-50

1) Erasing and Reprogramming a Single HomeLink Button:

1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink button you want to re- program. DO NOT release the but- ton.

2. The HomeLink indicator light (4) will illuminate solid red and contin- ue to press the button until the HomeLink indicator light (4) begins to flash slow in red, usually about 20 seconds.

3. While keep pressing the HomeLink button, proceed with the steps in the Programming a New HomeLink Button section.

If you do not complete the re-pro- gramming of a new device to the button, it will revert to the previ- ously stored programming

2) The following instructions will erase ALL HomeLink program- ming from ALL buttons:

1. Press and hold the buttons (1) and (3) simultaneously until the HomeLink indicator light (4) begins to flash slowly in red (Approximately 20 seconds but do not hold for longer than 30 sec- onds)

2. Release the buttons and now all three HomeLink buttons (1), (2) and (3) are cleared of any pro- gramming

Information HomeLink and the HomeLink House logo are registered trade- marks of Gentex Corporation.

The myQ logo is a registered trade- mark of The Chamberlain Group, Inc

i

NOTICE

Convenience Features

OHD046306N

Flashing

3-51

Convenience Features

FCC (USA) This device complies with FCC rules part 15. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful inter- ference, and (2) This device must accept any interference that may be received including interference that may cause undesired operation. WARNING: The transmitter has been tested and complies with FCC rules. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the users authority to operate the device. This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment. End Users must follow the specific oper- ating instructions for satisfying RF exposure compliance. This transmit- ter must be at least 20 cm from the user and must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.

3

OAEPH040857C

3-52

Side View Mirrors

Make sure to adjust the side view mirrors to your desired position before you begin driving. Your vehicle is equipped with both left-hand and right-hand side view mirrors. The mirrors can be adjusted remotely with the remote switch. The side view mirrors can be folded to help prevent damage when going through an automatic car wash or when passing through a narrow street. The right side view mirror is convex. Objects seen in the mirror are closer than they appear.

Use the inside rear view mirror or look back directly to determine the actual distance of other vehicles prior to changing lanes.

Do not scrape ice off the mirror face; this may damage the sur- face of the glass.

If the mirror is jammed with ice, do not adjust the mirror by force. Use an approved spray de-icer (not radiator antifreeze) spray, or a sponge or soft cloth with very warm water, or move the vehicle to a warm place and allow the ice to melt.

Do not clean the mirror with harsh abrasives, fuel or other petroleum based cleaning products.

NOTICE

NOTICE

Convenience Features

OLX2048016

Do not adjust or fold the side view mirrors while driving. This may cause loss of vehicle con- trol resulting in an accident.

WARNING

3-53

Convenience Features

3

Side view mirror adjustment

Adjusting the side view mirrors 1. Move the lever (1) either to the L

(left side) or R (right side) to select the side view mirror you would like to adjust.

2. Use the mirror adjustment control switch (2) to position the selected mirror up, down, left or right.

3. After adjustment, move the lever (1) to the middle to prevent inad- vertent adjustment.

The mirrors stop moving when they reach the maximum adjust- ing angles, but the motor contin- ues to operate while the switch is pressed. Do not press the switch longer than necessary, because this can damage the motor.

Do not attempt to adjust the side view mirrors by hand, because this can damage the motor.

Folding the side view mirrors

To fold the side view mirrors, grasp the housing of the mirror and then fold it inwards.

NOTICE

OLX2048016L

3-54

Convenience Features

Reverse Parking Aid Function (if equipped)

When you move the shift button to the R (Reverse) position, the side view mirror(s) will rotate downwards to aid with driving in reverse. The position of the side view mirror switch (1) determines whether or not the mirrors will move: Left/Right : When either the L (Left) or

R (Right) switch is select- ed, both side view mirrors will move.

Neutral : When neither switch is select- ed, the side view mirrors will not move.

The side view mirrors will automati- cally revert to their original positions if any of the following occur: The ignition switch is placed to

either the LOCK/OFF position or the ACC position.

The shift button is selected to any position except R (Reverse).

The remote control side view mir- ror switch is not selected.

OLX2049019N

3-55

Convenience Features

3

(1) Driver’s door power window switch

(2) Front passenger’s door power window switch

(3) Rear door (left) power window switch

(4) Rear door (right) power window switch

(5) Window opening and closing (6) Automatic power window (7) Power window lock switch

WINDOWS

OLX2049020N

3-56

Convenience Features

Power Windows The ignition switch must be in the ON position to be able to raise or lower the windows. Each door has a Power Window switch to control that doors window. The driver has a Power Window Lock switch which can block the operation of passenger windows. The power windows will operate for approximately 10 minutes after the ignition switch is placed in the ACC or LOCK/OFF position. However, if the front doors are opened, the Power Windows will not operate even within the 10 minute period.

Information In cold and wet climates, power win-

dows may not work properly due to freezing conditions.

While driving with the rear win- dows down or with the sunroof (if equipped) opened (or partially opened), your vehicle may demon- strate a wind buffeting or pulsation noise. This noise is normal and can be reduced or eliminated by taking the following actions. If the noise occurs with one or both of the rear windows down, partially lower both front windows approximately one inch. If you experience the noise with the sunroof open, slightly close the sunroof.

Window opening and closing

To open: Press the window switch down to the first detent position (5). Release the switch when you want the window to stop.

To close: Pull the window switch up to the first detent position (5). Release the win- dow switch when you want the win- dow to stop.

i

To avoid serious injury or death, do not extend your head, arms or body outside the windows while driving.

WARNING

OIK047016

3-57

Convenience Features

3

Auto up/down window (if equipped) Pressing or pulling up the power win- dow switch momentarily to the sec- ond detent position (6) completely lowers or lifts the window even when the switch is released. To stop the window at the desired position while the window is in operation, pull up or press down and release the switch.

To reset the power windows If the power windows do not operate normally, the automatic power win- dow system must be reset as follows: 1. Place the ignition switch to the ON

position. 2. Close the window and continue

pulling up on the power window switch for at least one second.

If the power windows do not operate properly after resetting, have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Automatic reverse (if equipped)

If a window senses any obstacle while it is closing automatically, it will stop and lower approximately 12 inches (30 cm) to allow the object to be cleared. If the window detects the resistance while the power window switch is pulled up continuously, the window will stop upward movement then lower approximately 1 inch (2.5 cm). If the power window switch is pulled up continuously again within 5 sec- onds after the window is lowered by the automatic window reverse fea- ture, the automatic window reverse will not operate.

The automatic reverse feature doesn’t activate while resetting the power window system. Make sure body parts or other objects are safely out of the way before closing the windows to avoid injuries or vehicle damage.

WARNING

OTM048021

3-58

Convenience Features

Information The automatic reverse feature is only active when the «Auto Up» feature is used by fully pulling up the switch to the second detent.

Do not install any accessories on the windows.The automatic reverse feature may not operate.

Power window lock switch

The driver can disable the power window switches on the rear passen- ger doors by pressing the power win- dow lock switch. When the power window lock switch is pressed: The rear passenger control will not

be able to operate the rear passen- ger power window

Note that the front passenger con- trol is still able to operate the front passenger window, and that the driver master control can still oper- ate all the power windows.

To prevent possible damage to the power window system, do not open or close two windows or more at the same time. This will also ensure the longevity of the fuse.

Never try to operate the main switch on the driver’s door and the individual door window switch in opposite directions at the same time. If this is done, the window will stop and cannot be opened or closed.

NOTICE

NOTICE

i

Do not allow children to play with the power windows. Keep the driver’s door power window lock switch in the LOCK posi- tion. Serious injury or death can result from unintentional win- dow operation by a child.

WARNING

Make sure body parts or other objects are safely out of the way before closing the windows to avoid injuries or vehicle damage. Objects less than 0.16 inch (4 mm) in diameter caught between the window glass and the upper window channel may not be detected by the automatic reverse window and the window will not stop and reverse direc- tion.

WARNING

OLX2049023N

3-59

Convenience Features

3

Sunroof (if equipped) If your vehicle is equipped with a sunroof, you can slide or tilt your sunroof with the sunroof switch locat- ed on the overhead console.

The sunroof can only be operated when the ignition switch is in the ON position. The sunroof can be operated for approximately 10 minutes after the ignition switch is in the ACC or LOCK position. However, if the front door is open, the sunroof cannot be operat- ed even within the 10 minute period.

Dual wide sunroof (if equipped) If your vehicle is equipped with a sunroof, you can slide or tilt your sunroof with the sunroof switch locat- ed on the overhead console.

The sunroof can only be operated when the Engine Start/Stop button is in the ON or START position. The sunroof can be operated for approximately 3 minutes after the Engine Start/Stop button is in the ACC or OFF position. However, if the front door is open, the sunroof can- not be operated even within the 3 minute period.

Do not operate the sunroof when the roof bars are installed on the vehicle or when there is luggage on the roof.

NOTICE

SUNROOF (IF EQUIPPED)

Never adjust the sunroof or sunshade while driving. This could result in loss of control and an accident that may cause injury, or property dam- age.

Do not leave the engine run- ning and the key in your vehi- cle with unsupervised children. Unattended children could operate the sunroof, which could result in serious injury.

Do not sit on the top of the vehicle. It may cause injury or vehicle damage.

WARNING

OLX2048025L

OLX2048025

3-60

Convenience Features

Sunshade (Front)/Power sun- shade (Rear) Use the power sunshade to block direct sunlight coming through the sunroof glass.

Front Open or close the sunshade by hand.

Information

The sunshade opens automatically when the sunroof glass is opened by pushing the sunroof switch (A) rear- ward, but the sunshade does not close automatically when the sunroof glass is closed. Also, only the sunshade can- not be closed when the sunroof glass is opened.

Rear Push the power sunshade open switch (B), the power sunshade auto- matically slides open. Push the power sunshade close switch (B), the power sunshade auto- matically closes.

i

OCN7050029

OLX2041420

OLX2041421

3-61

Convenience Features

3

Do not pull or push the power sun- shade by hand as such action may damage the power sunshade or cause it to malfunction.

Information Wrinkles formed on the power sun- shade are normal due to material characteristic.

Tilt open/close (Front)

Push the sunroof switch upward, the sunroof glass tilts open.

Push the sunroof switch forward, the sunroof glass automatically closes.

To stop the sunroof movement at any point, push the sunroof switch in any direction.

Slide open/close (Front)

Push the sunroof switch rearward, the sunshade and sunroof glass slide open. Push the sunroof switch forward, only the sunroof glass closes.

Push the sunroof switch forward or rearward to the first detent posi- tion, the sunroof glass moves until the switch is released.

Push the sunroof switch forward or rearward to the second detent position, the sunroof glass oper- ates automatically (auto slide fea- ture). To stop the sunroof movement at any point, push the sunroof switch in any direction.

i

NOTICE

OLX2048029OLX2048028

3-62

Convenience Features

Automatic reversal

If the power sunshade or sunroof glass senses any obstacle while it is closing automatically, it will reverse direction then stop at a certain posi- tion. The auto reverse function may not work if an object thin or soft is caught between the sliding power sunshade or sunroof glass and sunroof sash.

Do not continue to push the sunroof switch after the sunroof is fully opened, closed, or tilted. Damage to the sunroof motor could occur.

Continuous operations such as slide open/close, tilt open/close, etc. may cause the motor or sun- roof system to malfunction.

Regularly remove any accumu- lated dust on the sunroof rail.

Using the sunroof for a long time can make noise caused by dust in accumulated between the sunroof and vehicle body. Open the sunroof and remove dust regularly using a clean cloth.

Do not try to open the sunroof when the temperature is below freezing or when the sunroof is covered with snow or ice, other- wise the motor could be dam- aged. In cold and wet climates, the sunroof may not work prop- erly.

NOTICE

Make sure heads, hands, arms or any other body parts or objects are out of the way before operating the sunroof. Body parts or objects may get caught causing injuries or vehicle damage.

Never deliberately use your body parts to test the auto- matic reversal function. The power sunshade or sunroof glass may reverse direction, but there is a risk of injury.

WARNING

ODH043039

3-63

Convenience Features

3

Do not open or drive with the sunroof glass open immediately after rain or washing the vehicle. Water may wet the interior of the vehicle.

Do not extend any luggage out- side the sunroof while driving. Vehicle damage may occur if the vehicle suddenly stops.

Resetting the sunroof

In some circumstances resetting the sunroof operation may need to be performed. Some instances where resetting the sunroof may be required include:

OLX2048032

Front

Rear

OLX2048098

Do not extend your head, arms, body parts or objects outside the sunroof while driving. Injuries may occur if the vehicle suddenly stops.

WARNING

3-64

Convenience Features

When the 12-volt battery is either disconnected or discharged

When the sunroof fuse is replaced If the sunroof one-touch AUTO

OPEN/CLOSE operation is not functioning properly

Sunroof resetting procedure: 1. It is recommended to perform the

reset procedure with the vehicle engine running. Start the vehicle in P (Park).

2. Make sure the power sunshade or sunroof glass is in the fully closed position. If the power sunshade or sunroof glass is open, push the switch forward until the power sun- shade and sunroof glass is fully closed.

3. Release the switch when the power sunshade or sunroof glass is fully closed.

4. Push the switch forward until the power sunshade or sunroof glass moves slightly. Then release the switch.

5. Once again push and hold the sunroof switch forward until the power sunshade or sunroof glass slides open and close. Do not release the switch until the opera- tion is completed. If you release the switch during operation, start the procedure again from step 2.

Information If the sunroof is not reset when the vehicle battery is disconnected or dis- charged, or the sunroof fuse is blown, the sunroof may not operate normally.

i

3-65

Convenience Features

3

Sunroof open warning

If the driver turns off the engine when the sunroof is not fully closed, the warning chime will sound for several seconds and the sunroof open warn- ing will appear on the cluster LCD display. Close the sunroof securely when leaving your vehicle.

OLX2048108

Make sure the sunroof is closed fully when leaving your vehicle. If the sunroof is left open, rain or snow may wet the interior of the vehicle. Also, leaving the sunroof open when the vehicle is unattended may invite theft.

CAUTION

3-66

Convenience Features

Hood Opening the hood

1. Park the vehicle and set the park- ing brake.

2. Pull the release lever to unlatch the hood. The hood should pop open slightly.

3. Go to the front of the vehicle, raise the hood slightly, push up the sec- ondary latch (1) inside of the hood center and lift the hood (2). After it has been raised about halfway, it will raise completely by itself.

Closing the hood 1. Before closing the hood, check in

and around the engine compart- ment to ensure the following:

— Any tools or other loose objects are removed from the engine room area or hood opening area

— All glove, rags, or other com- bustible material is removed from the engine compartment

— All filler caps are tightly and cor- rectly installed

2. Lower the hood halfway (lifted approximately 12 inches (30 cm) from the closed position) and push down to securely lock in place. Then double check to be sure the hood is secure. If the hood can be raised slightly, it is not securely locked. Open it again and close it with more force.

EXTERIOR FEATURES

OLX2049033L

OLX2048034L

3-67

Convenience Features

3

Non-Powered Liftgate (if equipped) Opening the liftgate

Before attempting to open the lift- gate, make sure the vehicle is in P (Park). To open the liftgate, perform one the following: 1. Unlock all doors with the Door

Unlock button on your remote key or smart key. From outside press the liftgate handle switch and open the liftgate.

2. From outside press the liftgate handle switch and open the lift- gate.

Closing the liftgate

Lower the liftgate lid and press down until it locks. To be sure the liftgate lid is securely fastened, always check by trying to pull it up again without pressing the liftgate handle switch.

Information In cold and wet climates, door lock and door mechanisms may not work properly due to freezing conditions.

i

Before closing the hood, ensure all obstructions are removed from around the hood opening.

Always double check to be sure that the hood is firmly latched before driving away. Check there is no hood open warning light or message dis- played on the instrument clus- ter. Driving with the hood opened may cause a total loss of visibility, which might result in an accident.

Do not move the vehicle with the hood in the raised posi- tion, as vision is obstructed, which might result in an acci- dent, and the hood could fall or be damaged.

WARNING

OLX2048035

OLX2048036

3-68

Convenience Features

Make certain that you close the liftgate before driving your vehi- cle. Possible damage may occur to the liftgate struts and mounting hinges if the liftgate is not closed prior to driving.

Emergency liftgate safety release

Your vehicle is equipped with an emergency liftgate safety release lever located on the bottom of the lift- gate inside the vehicle. To unlock and open the liftgate man- ually from inside the luggage com- partment, perform the following steps: 1. Push the release lever to the right

by a key. 2. Push up the liftgate.

NOTICE

OLX2048037

The liftgate swings upward. Make sure no objects or people are near the rear of the vehicle when opening the liftgate.

WARNING

Do not hold on to or try to pull on the liftgate strut. Be aware that the deformation of the lift- gate strut may cause vehicle damage and risk of injury.

WARNING

OHYK047009

Always keep the liftgate com- pletely closed while the vehicle is in motion. If it is left open or ajar, poisonous exhaust gases containing carbon monoxide (CO) may enter the vehicle and serious illness or death may result.

WARNING

3-69

Convenience Features

3

Power Liftgate (if equipped) Power liftgate button

Power liftgate setting

When the ignition switch is in the ON position and the shift button is in P (Park), the power liftgate can be opened by using the console button on the dash. Before using the power liftgate, make sure the power liftgate option is selected in the User Setting modes in the cluster LCD display. ‘User Settings Door Power Liftgate’

Also, the speed of the power liftgate can be adjusted in the User Settings mode in the cluster LCD display. ‘User Settings Door Power Liftgate Speed Normal / Fast’ — If the power liftgate function turns

off or the liftgate is not fully closed, you cannot adjust the power lift- gate speed.

— Initial speed of power liftgate is set as «Fast».

For more details, refer to «LCD Display» in this chapter.

Information The power liftgate operates only when the automatic shift button is in P (Park).

i

Be aware of the location of the emergency liftgate safety release lever in your vehicle and know how to open the lift- gate using the safety release lever.

No one should be allowed to occupy the luggage compart- ment of the vehicle at any time. The luggage compartment is a very dangerous location in the event of a crash.

Use the release lever for emer- gencies only. Use extreme cau- tion, especially while the vehi- cle is in motion.

WARNING

OLX2049040L

Never leave children unattended in your vehicle. Children might operate the power liftgate. Doing so could result in injury to themselves or others, and could damage the vehicle.

WARNING

3-70

Convenience Features

Do not close or open the power liftgate manually. This may cause damage to the power liftgate. If it is necessary to close or open the power liftgate manually when the battery is discharged or discon- nected, do not apply excessive force.

Opening the liftgate The power liftgate will open automat- ically by doing one of the following:

Smart key liftgate unlock button

Press and hold the liftgate unlock button on the smart key.

Power liftgate handle switch

Press the liftgate outside handle switch while having the smart key with you.

NOTICE

Make sure there are no people or objects around the liftgate before operating the power lift- gate. Wait until the liftgate is opened fully and stopped before loading or unloading cargo or passengers from the vehicle.

WARNING

OLX2048038

OLX2048039

3-71

Convenience Features

3

Power liftgate button

Press the power liftgate button for approximately one second.

In order to suddenly stop the move- ment of the liftgate while it is operat- ing, quickly press the power liftgate button.

Closing the liftgate The power liftgate will close automat- ically by doing one of the following:

Smart key liftgate unlock button

Press and hold the liftgate unlock button on the smart key when the lift- gate is opened. The liftgate will close and lock automatically.

Power liftgate inner button

Press the power liftgate inner button for approximately 1 second. The lift- gate will close and lock automatically.

OLX2049040L

OLX2048038

OLX2048041

3-72

Convenience Features

The chime will sound if you drive with the liftgate opened. Stop your vehicle immediately at a safe place and check if your liftgate is opened.

WARNING

Power liftgate button

Press the power liftgate button for approximately one second. In order to suddenly stop the movement of the liftgate while it is operating, quickly press the power liftgate but- ton.

In order to suddenly stop the move- ment of the liftgate while it is operat- ing, quickly press the power liftgate button.

Power liftgate non-opening con- ditions The power liftgate does not open when the vehicle is in motion.

OLX2049040L

Operating the power liftgate more than 5 times continuously could cause damage to the oper- ating motor. In this case, the power liftgate system enters into thermal protection mode to pre- vent the motor from overheating. In thermal protection mode the power liftgate will not operate. If any of the power liftgate buttons are pressed to try to open the liftgate, the chime will sound 3 times but the liftgate will remain closed. Allow the power liftgate system to cool for about 1 minute before operating the system again.

CAUTION

3-73

Convenience Features

3

The power liftgate can be oper- ated when the engine is not run- ning. However, the power liftgate operation consumes a large amount of electic power. To prevent the battery from being discharged, do not oper- ate it excessively (e.g. more than 5 times repeatedly).

To prevent the battery from being discharged, do not leave the power liftgate in the open position for a long time.

Do not modify or repair any part of the power liftgate by yourself. This must be done by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer.

When jacking up the vehicle to change a tire or repair the vehi- cle, do not operate the power liftgate. This could cause the power liftgate to operate improperly.

In cold and wet climates, the power liftgate may not work properly due to freezing condi- tions.

Automatic reversal

During power opening and closing if the power liftgate is blocked by an object or part of the body, the power liftgate may be able to detect the resistance. If resistance is detected while open- ing or closing the power liftgate, the liftgate will stop and move in the opposite direction. However, in some instances the automatic reversal system may not detect the object if it is too soft or is very thin, or if the liftgate is almost fully closed near the latched position. Caution should be taken to prevent any objects from obstructing the lift- gate opeining.

If the automatic reversal feature operates more than 2 times while attempting to open or close the lift- gate, the power liftgate may stop at that position. If this occurs, carefully close the liftgate manually, and then try to operate the power liftgate auto- matically again.

NOTICE

OLX2048042 Never intentionally place any object or part of your body in the path of the power liftgate to make sure the automatic rever- sal operates.

WARNING

Do not put heavy objects on the power liftgate before you oper- ate the power liftgate feature. Additional weight may damage the operation of the system.

CAUTION

3-74

Convenience Features

How to reset the power liftgate If the battery has been discharged or disconnected, or if the power liftgate fuse has been replaced or removed, reset the power liftgate by performing the following procedure: 1. Press the P (Parking) button. 2. Press the power liftgate inner but-

ton and the power liftgate outer handle button simultaneously for more than 3 seconds. The chime will sound.

3. Close the liftgate manually. If the power liftgate does not work properly after the above procedure, have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

When operating the power liftgate, the gear shift button must be in the (P) park position in order to operate normally.

Power liftgate opening height user setting

Follow the instructions below to set the fully open height of the power lift- gate: 1. Position the liftgate manually to

the height you prefer. 2. Press the power liftgate inner but-

ton for more than 3 seconds. 3. Close the liftgate manually after

hearing the buzzer sound.

The liftgate will open to the manually adjusted height that was set.

NOTICE

Always keep the liftgate com- pletely closed while the vehicle is in motion. If it is left open or ajar, poisonous exhaust gases containing carbon monoxide (CO) may enter the vehicle and serious illness or death may result.

WARNING

Rear cargo area

Occupants should never ride in the rear cargo area where no restraints are available.To avoid injury in the event of an acci- dent or sudden stops, occu- pants should always be proper- ly restrained.

WARNING OLX2048041

3-75

Convenience Features

3

Emergency liftgate safety release

Your vehicle is equipped with an emergency liftgate safety release lever located on the bottom of the lift- gate inside the vehicle. To unlock and open the liftgate man- ually from inside the luggage com- partment, perform the following steps: 1. Push the release lever to the right

by using a key. 2. Push up the liftgate.

Smart Liftgate (if equipped)

On vehicles equipped with a smart key, the liftgate can be opened with hands-free activation using the Smart Liftgate system.

Be aware of the location of the emergency liftgate safety release lever in your vehicle and know how to open the lift- gate using the safety release lever.

No one should be allowed to occupy the luggage compart- ment of the vehicle at any time. The luggage compartment is a very dangerous location in the event of a crash.

Use the release lever for emer- gencies only. Use extreme cau- tion, especially while the vehi- cle is in motion.

WARNING

OLX2048037

OLX2048043

3-76

Convenience Features

How to use the Smart Liftgate The hands-free smart liftgate system can be opened automatically when the following conditions are met: The Smart Liftgate option is

enabled in the User Settings in the cluster LCD display

The Smart Liftgate is activated and ready 15 seconds after all the doors are closed and locked

The Smart Liftgate will open when the smart key is detected in the area behind the vehicle for 3 sec- onds

Information The Smart Liftgate will NOT operate when:

Any door is open, or all doors are closed but not locked

The smart key is detected within 15 seconds from when the doors were closed and locked

For vehicles equipped with illumi- nated exterior front door handles, if the smart key is detected within 15 seconds from when the doors were closed and locked or if the smart key is within 60 inches (1.5 m) from the front door handles

The smart key is in the vehicle.

1. Setting To activate the Smart Liftgate, go to User Settings mode and select Smart Liftgate in the cluster LCD dis- play.

For more details, refer to «LCD Display» in this chapter.

2. Detect and Alert The Smart Liftgate detecting area extends approximately 20-40 in (50- 100 cm) behind the vehicle. If you are positioned in the detecting area and are carrying the smart key, the hazard warning lights will blink and the chime will sound to alert you that the smart liftgate will open.

Information Do not approach the detecting area if you do not want the liftgate to open. If you have unintentionally entered the detecting area and the hazard warn- ing lights and chime starts to operate, move away from the area behind the vehicle with the smart key. The lift- gate will remain closed.

i

i

3-77

Convenience Features

3

3. Automatic opening After the hazard warning lights blink and the chime sounds 6 times, the power liftgate will open.

How to deactivate the Smart Liftgate function using the smart key

1. Door lock 2. Door unlock 3. Liftgate open 4. Panic 5. Remote start

If you press any button on the smart key during the Detect and Alert stage, the Smart Liftgate function will be deactivated. Make sure to be aware of how to deactivate the Smart Liftgate func- tion for emergency situations.

Make certain that you close the liftgate before driving your vehicle.

Make sure there are no people or objects around the liftgate before opening or closing the liftgate.

Make sure objects in the rear cargo area do not come out when opening the liftgate, especially if the vehicle is parked on a grade or incline.

If you keep your vehicle parked and locked on your driveway, you may want to temporarily deactivate the Smart Liftgate system. Otherwise, standing at the rear of the vehicle with the smart key may cause the lift- gate to open unintentionally.

WARNING

The key should be kept out of reach of children. Children may inadvertently open the Smart Liftgate while playing around the rear area of the vehicle.

OLX2048003

3-78

Convenience Features

Information If you press the door unlock button

(2), the Smart Liftgate function will be deactivated temporarily. But, if you do not open any door for 30 sec- onds, the Smart Liftgate function will be activated again.

If you press the liftgate open button (3) for more than 1 second, the lift- gate opens.

The Smart Liftgate function will still be activated if you press the door lock button (1) or liftgate open button (3) on the smart key as long as the Smart Liftgate is not already in the Detect and Alert stage.

In case you have deactivated the Smart Liftgate function by pressing the smart key button and opened a door, the Smart Liftgate function can be activated again by closing and locking all doors.

Detecting area

The Smart Liftgate detecting area extends approximately 20-40 inch- es (50-100 cm) behind the vehicle. If you are positioned in the detect- ing area and are carrying the smart key, the hazard warning lights will blink and the chime will sound for about 3 seconds to alert you that the smart liftgate will open.

The alert stops once the smart key is moved outside of the detecting area within the 3 second period.

Information The Smart Liftgate function may

not operate properly if any of the following instances occur:

— The smart key is close to a radio transmitter such as a radio station or an airport which can interfere with normal operation of the transmitter.

— The smart key is near a mobile two way radio system or a cellular phone.

— Another vehicle’s smart key is being operated close to your vehi- cle.

The Smart Liftgate detecting area may change when:

— The vehicle is parked on an incline or slope

— One side of the vehicle is raised or lowered relative to the opposite side

ii

OLX2049045N

3-79

Convenience Features

3

Fuel Filler Door Opening the fuel filler door

1. Turn the engine off. 2. Ensure the driver’s door is unlocked. 3. Push the fuel filler door near the 3

o’clock position.

4. Pull the fuel filler door (1) outward to access the fuel tank cap.

5. To remove the fuel tank cap (2), turn it counterclockwise. You may hear a hissing noise as the pres- sure inside the tank equalizes.

6. Place the cap on the fuel filler door.

Information If the fuel filler door does not open because ice has formed around it, tap lightly or push on the door to break the ice and release the door. Do not pry on the door. If necessary, spray around the door with an approved de- icer fluid (do not use radiator anti- freeze) or move the vehicle to a warm place and allow the ice to melt.

Closing the fuel filler door 1. To install the fuel tank cap, turn it

clockwise until it «clicks» one time. 2. Close the fuel filler door until it is

latched securely.

Information The fuel filler door will not close if the driver’s door is locked. If you lock the driver’s door while fueling, unlock it before closing the fuel filler door.

Information Tighten the cap until it clicks once,

otherwise the fuel cap open warning indicator light will illuminate.

There may be an intermittent noise near the refueling hole while the engine is idling if the fuel cap is not closed securely. This occurs normal- ly with the OBD system.

When refueling on unleveled ground, the fuel gauge may not point to the F position. It is not a malfunction. If you move your vehi- cle to a level ground, the fuel gauge will move to the full position.

i

i

i

OLX2048046

OLX2048047

3-80

Convenience Features

Do not get back into a vehicle once you have begun refuel- ing. You can generate a build- up of static electricity by touching, rubbing or sliding against any item or fabric capable of producing static electricity. Static electricity discharge can ignite fuel vapors causing a fire. If you must re-enter the vehicle, you should once again eliminate potentially dangerous static electricity discharge by touch- ing a metal part of the vehicle, away from the fuel filler neck, nozzle or other gasoline source, with your bare hand.

When using an approved portable fuel container, be sure to place the container on the ground prior to refueling. Static electricity discharge from the container can ignite fuel vapors causing a fire.

Once refueling has begun, contact between your bare hand and the vehicle should be maintained until the filling is complete.

Use only approved portable plastic fuel containers designed to carry and store gasoline.

When refueling, always move the shift button to the P (Park) position, set the parking brake, and place the ignition switch to the LOCK/OFF posi- tion. Sparks produced by electrical components related to the engine can ignite fuel vapors causing a fire.

Do not use matches or a lighter and do not smoke or leave a lit cigarette in your vehicle while at a gas station, especially during refueling.

Gasoline is highly flammable and explosive. Failure to follow these guidelines may result in SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH: Read and follow all warnings

posted at the gas station. Before refueling, note the

location of the Emergency Gasoline Shut-Off, if available, at the gas station.

Before touching the fuel noz- zle, you should eliminate the potential build-up of static electricity by touching a metal part of the vehicle, a safe dis- tance away from the fuel filler neck, nozzle, or other gas source, with your bare hand.

Do not use cellular phones while refueling. Electric cur- rent and/or electronic interfer- ence from cellular phones can potentially ignite fuel vapors and cause a fire.

WARNING

3-81

Convenience Features

3

Information Make sure to refuel your vehicle according to the «Fuel Requirements» suggested in the Introduction chapter.

Do not spill fuel on the exterior surfaces of the vehicle. Any type of fuel spilled on painted sur- faces may damage the paint.

If the fuel filler cap requires replacement, use only a genuine HYUNDAI cap or the equivalent specified for your vehicle. An incorrect fuel filler cap can result in a serious malfunction of the fuel system or emission control system.

NOTICE

i Do not over-fill or top-off your vehicle tank, which can cause gasoline spillage.

If a fire breaks out during refu- eling, leave the vicinity of the vehicle, and immediately con- tact the manager of the gas station and then contact the local fire department. Follow any safety instructions they provide.

If pressurized fuel sprays out, it can cover your clothes or skin and thus subject you to the risk of fire and burns. Always remove the fuel cap carefully and slowly. If the cap is venting fuel or if you hear a hissing sound, wait until the condition stops before com- pletely removing the cap.

Always check that the fuel cap is installed securely to pre- vent fuel spillage in the event of an accident.

3-82

Convenience Features

INSTRUMENT CLUSTER

1. Tachometer

2. Speedometer

3. Engine coolant temperature gauge

4. Fuel gauge

5. Warning and indicator lights

6. LCD display (including Trip computer)

OLX2049100N/OLX2049101N

Type A

Type B

The actual cluster in the vehicle may differ from the illustration. For more information, refer to the «Gauges and Meters» in this chapter.

3-83

Convenience Features

3 1. Tachometer

2. Speedometer

3. Engine coolant temperature gauge

4. Fuel gauge

5. Warning and indicator lights

6. LCD display (including Trip computer)

OLX2049126N

Type C

The actual cluster in the vehicle may differ from the illustration. For more information, refer to the «Gauges and Meters» in this chapter.

3-84

Convenience Features

Instrument Cluster Control Adjusting instrument cluster illumination

When the vehicle’s position lights or headlights are on, press the illumina- tion control button to adjust the brightness of the instrument panel illumination. When pressing the illumination con- trol button, the interior switch illumi- nation intensity is also adjusted.

The brightness of the instrument panel illumination is displayed.

If the brightness reaches the maxi- mum or minimum level, a chime will sound.

For information regarding the illu- mination setting on your audio dis- play, refer to the «Setup» section of your Audio or Navigation manual.

Gauges and Meters Speedometer

The speedometer indicates the speed of the vehicle and is calibrated in miles per hour (MPH) and/or kilo- meters per hour (km/h).

Never adjust the instrument cluster while driving. Doing so could lead to driver distraction which may cause an accident and lead to vehicle damage, serious injury, or death.

WARNING

OLX2049049N

OLX2049139N

OLX2048102L

Type A and B

Type C

3-85

Convenience Features

3

Tachometer

The tachometer indicates the approximate number of engine revo- lutions per minute (RPM).

Do not operate the engine within the tachometer’s RED ZONE. This may cause severe engine damage.

Engine coolant temperature gauge

This gauge indicates the tempera- ture of the engine coolant when the ignition switch is in the ON position.

NOTICE

OLX2049138N

OLX2048105

Type A and B

Type C

OLX2049127N

OLX2048106

Type A and B

Type C

3-86

Convenience Features

If the gauge pointer moves beyond the normal range area toward the «H» position, it indi- cates overheating that may dam- age the engine. Do not continue driving with an overheated engine. If your vehicle overheats, refer to «If the Engine Overheats» in chapter 6.

Fuel gauge

This gauge indicates the approxi- mate amount of fuel remaining in the fuel tank.

Information The fuel tank capacity is given in

chapter 8.

The fuel gauge is supplemented by a low fuel warning light, which will illuminate when the fuel tank is nearly empty.

On inclines or curves, the fuel gauge pointer may fluctuate or the low fuel warning light may come on earlier than usual due to the movement of fuel in the tank.

iNOTICE

Never remove the radiator cap or engine coolant reservoir cap when the engine is hot. The engine coolant is under pressure and could severely burn. Wait until the engine is cool before adding coolant to the reservoir.

WARNING

OLX2049128N

OLX2048107

Type A and B

Type C

3-87

Convenience Features

3

Avoid driving with an extremely low fuel level. Running out of fuel could cause the engine to misfire damaging the catalytic converter.

Outside temperature gauge

This gauge indicates the current out- side air temperature by 1 degrees F (1 degrees C). — Temperature range : -40F ~ 140F

(-40C ~ 60C)

Note that the temperature indicated on the LCD display may not change as quickly as the outside tempera- ture (there may be a slight delay before the temperature changes.)

You can change the temperature unit from F to C or C to F in the User Settings mode in the cluster: — Go to User Settings Mode Other

Temperature Unit. For vehicles equipped with Automatic Climate Control, you can also: — Press the AUTO button while press-

ing the OFF button on the climate control unit for 3 seconds

Both the temperature unit on the cluster LCD display and climate con- trol screen will change.

NOTICE

Running out of fuel can expose vehicle occupants to danger. You must stop and obtain addi- tional fuel as soon as possible after the warning light comes on or when the gauge indicator comes close to the «E (Empty)» level.

WARNING

OTMA048112/OLX2049109N

Type A Type B

OLX2049129N

Type C

3-88

Convenience Features

Odometer

The odometer indicates the total dis- tance that the vehicle has been driv- en and should be used to determine when periodic maintenance should be performed.

Range

The range is the estimated dis- tance the vehicle can be driven with the remaining fuel.

If the estimated distance is below 1 mi. (1 km), the trip computer will display «—-» as range.

Information If the vehicle is not on level ground

or the battery power has been inter- rupted, the range function may not operate correctly.

The range may differ from the actu- al driving distance as it is only an estimate of the available driving range for the vehicle and driving conditions.

The trip computer may not register additional fuel if less than 1.6 gallon (6 liters) of fuel are added to the vehicle.

The range may vary significantly based on driving conditions, driving habits, and condition of the vehicle.

i

OTMA048183/OLX2049111N

Type A Type B

OPDE046138R/OLX2049112N

Type A Type B

OLX2049131N

Type C

OLX2049130N/OLX2049132N

Type C — Initial mode — Switch mode

3-89

Convenience Features

3

Transmission Shift Indicator Automatic transmission shift indicator

This indicator displays the gear posi- tion of the shift button.

Shift indicator pop-up (if equipped)

The pop-up indicates the current gear position displayed in the cluster for about 2 seconds when shifting into other positions (P/R/N/D). The shift indicator pop-up function can be activated or deactivated from the User Settings mode in the cluster LCD display.

Warning and Indicator Lights

Information Make sure that all warning lights are OFF after starting the engine. If any light is still ON, this indicates a situa- tion that needs attention.

Seat Belt Warning Light

This warning light informs the driver that the seat belt is not fastened.

For more information, refer to «Seat Belts» in chapter 2.

i

OIG046112/OLX2048110

Type A Type B

OIK047141

OLX2049133N

Type C

OLX2049134N

Type B

Type A

3-90

Convenience Features

Air Bag Warning Light

This warning light illuminates:

When you set the ignition switch or the Engine Start/Stop button to the ON position. — The air bag warning light illumi-

nates for about 6 seconds and then turns off when all checks have been performed

The air bag warning light will remain illuminated if there is a mal- function with the Safety Restraint System (SRS) air bag operation. If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Parking Brake & Brake Fluid Warning Light

This warning light illuminates:

When you set the ignition switch or the Engine Start/Stop button to the ON position. — The parking brake light illumi-

nates for about 3 seconds and will then turn off once the parking brake is released.

Whenever the parking brake is applied.

Whenever the brake fluid level in the reservoir is low. — If the warning light illuminates

with the parking brake released, it indicates the brake fluid level in the reservoir is low.

If the brake fluid level in the reser- voir is low:

1. Drive carefully to the nearest safe location and stop your vehicle.

2. With the engine stopped, check the brake fluid level immediately and add fluid as required (For more details, refer to «Brake Fluid» in chapter 7). After adding brake fluid, check all brake components for fluid leaks. If a brake fluid leak is found, or if the warning light remains on, or if the brakes do not operate properly, do not drive the vehicle. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Dual-diagonal braking system

Your vehicle is equipped with dual- diagonal braking system.This means you still have braking on two wheels even if one of the dual systems should fail. With only one of the dual systems working, more than normal pedal travel and greater pedal pressure is required to stop the vehicle.

3-91

Convenience Features

3

Also, the vehicle will not stop in as short a distance with only a portion of the brake system working. If the brakes fail while you are driv- ing, shift to a lower gear for addition- al engine braking and stop the vehi- cle as soon as it is safe to do so.

Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light

This warning light illuminates:

When you set the ignition switch or the Engine Start/Stop button to the ON position. — The ABS warning light illuminates

for about 3 seconds and then turns off.

Whenever there is a malfunction with the ABS. Note that the hydraulic braking system will still be operational even if there is a malfunction with the ABS.

Electronic Brake Force Distribution (EBD) System Warning Light

These two warning lights illuminate at the same time while driving:

When the ABS and regular brake system may not work normally. If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Parking Brake & Brake Fluid Warning Light

Driving the vehicle with a warn- ing light ON is dangerous. If the Parking Brake & Brake Fluid Warning Light illuminates with the parking brake released, it indicates that the brake fluid level is low. If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

WARNING

3-92

Convenience Features

Information — Electronic Brake Force Distribution (EBD) System Warning Light

When the ABS Warning Light is on or both ABS and Parking Brake & Brake Fluid Warning Lights are on, the speedometer, odometer, or tripmeter may not work. Also, the EPS Warning Light may illuminate and the steering effort may increase or decrease.

If this occurs, have the vehicle inspect- ed by an authorized HYUNDAI deal- er as soon as possible.

Electric Power Steering (EPS) Warning Light

This warning light illuminates:

When the ignition is moved to ON, the warning light illuminates for about 3 seconds and turns off automatically if no problem.

When the warning light illuminates while driving, it indicates that there is a problem with the electric power steering system. In this case, have the vehicle inspected by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer.

i

Electronic Brake Force Distribution (EBD) System Warning Light

When both ABS and Parking Brake & Brake Fluid Warning Lights are on, the brake system will not work normally and you may experience an unexpected and dangerous situation during sudden braking. If this occurs, avoid high speed driving and abrupt braking. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.

WARNING

3-93

Convenience Features

3

Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL)

This indicator light illuminates:

When you set the ignition switch or the Engine Start/Stop button to the ON position. — The malfunction indicator light

illuminates for about 3 seconds and then goes off.

Whenever there is a malfunction with either the emission control system or the engine or the vehicle powertrain. If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Driving with the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) on may cause damage to the emission control system which could affect drivability and/or fuel economy.

If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) illuminates, potential catalyt- ic converter damage is possible which could result in loss of engine power. If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possi- ble.

Electronic Parking Brake (EPB) Warning Light

This warning light illuminates:

When you set the ignition switch or the Engine Start/Stop button to the ON position. — It illuminates for approximately 3

seconds and then goes off. When there is a malfunction with

the EPB. If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Information The Electronic Parking Brake (EPB) Warning Light may illuminate when the Electronic Stability control (ESC) Indicator Light comes on to indicate that the ESC is not working properly (This does not indicate malfunction of the EPB).

i

NOTICE

NOTICE

EPB

3-94

Convenience Features

Charging System Warning Light

When this warning light illuminates while the engine is running, the bat- tery is not being charged. Immediately turn OFF all electrical accessories. Try not to use electrically operated controls, such as the power windows. Keep the engine running. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.

Engine Oil Pressure Warning Light

This warning light illuminates:

When the engine oil pressure is low.

If the engine oil pressure is low:

1. Drive carefully to the nearest safe location and stop your vehicle.

2. Turn the engine off and check the engine oil level (For more details, refer to «Engine Oil» in chapter 7). If the level is low, add oil as required. If the warning light remains on after adding oil or if oil is not avail- able, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.

If the oil pressure lowers due to insufficient engine oil, etc., the engine oil pressure warning light turns on.

If this warning light turns on while driving, drive carefully to the side of the road and stop the vehicle, check the engine oil level, and add if insufficient.

If the engine oil isn’t insufficient, or if the warning light does not turn off even after adding, we recommend to inspect the vehi- cle by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.

Driving with the warning light on may cause engine failure.

* When oil pressure is restored to an optimal level, the oil pressure warning light will turn off. Even if the oil pressure returns to nor- mal, check the engine once again in a safe place.

NOTICE

3-95

Convenience Features

3

Low Fuel Level Warning Light

This warning light illuminates:

When the fuel tank is nearly empty. Add fuel as soon as possible.

Driving with the Low Fuel Level warning light on or with the fuel level below «E» can cause the engine to misfire and damage the catalytic converter.

Washer Fluid Warning Light

This warning light illuminates:

When the washer fluid level in the reservoir is nearly empty. If washer fluid warning light illumi- nates, refill the washer fluid reser- voir in the engine room when pos- sible.

Master Warning Light

This warning light illuminates:

When there is a malfunction in operation in any of the following systems: — LED headlamp malfunction

(if equipped) — Forward Collision-Avoidance

Assist system malfunction (if equipped)

— Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist radar blocked (if equipped)

— Blind-Spot Collision Warning system malfunction (if equipped)

— Blind-Spot Collision Warning radar blocked (if equipped)

— Smart Cruise Control with Stop & Go malfunction (if equipped)

— Smart Cruise Control with Stop & Go radar blocked (if equipped)

— Lamp malfunction — High Beam Assist malfunction

(if equipped) — Tire Pressure Monitoring System

(TPMS) malfunction To identify the details of the warn- ing, look at the LCD display.

NOTICE

3-96

Convenience Features

Low Tire Pressure Warning Light

This warning light illuminates:

When you set the ignition switch or the Engine Start/Stop button to the ON position. — It illuminates for approximately 3

seconds and then goes off. When one or more of your tires are

significantly underinflated. (The location of the underinflated tires are displayed on the LCD display.)

For more details, refer to «Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)» in chapter 6.

This warning light remains ON after blinking for approximately 60 seconds, or repeatedly blinks ON and OFF in 3 second intervals:

When there is a malfunction with the TPMS. If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possi- ble.

For more details, refer to «Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)» in chapter 6.

All Wheel Drive (AWD) Warning Light (if equipped)

This warning light illuminates:

When you set the ignition switch or the Engine Start/Stop button to the ON position. — The All Wheel Drive warning light

illuminates for about 3 seconds and then goes off.

Whenever there is a malfunction with the AWD system. If this occurs, have your vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.Safe Stopping

The TPMS cannot alert you to severe and sudden tire dam- age caused by external fac- tors.

If you notice any vehicle insta- bility, immediately take your foot off the accelerator pedal, apply the brakes gradually with light force, and slowly move to a safe position off the road.

WARNING

3-97

Convenience Features

3

Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist (FCA) System Warning Light

This warning light illuminates:

When you set the ignition switch or the Engine Start/Stop button to the ON position. — It illuminates for approximately 3

seconds and then goes off. When there is a malfunction with

the FCA. If this occurs, have the vehicle inspect- ed by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

For more details, refer to «Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) system» in chapter 5.

Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) System Indicator Light

This indicator light illuminates:

[Green] When the system operat- ing conditions are satisfied.

[White] The system operating con- ditions are not satisfied.

[Yellow] When there is a malfunc- tion with the lane keeping assist system. If this occurs, have your vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

For more details, refer to «Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system» in chapter 5.

LED Headlight Warning Light (if equipped)

This warning light illuminates:

When you set the ignition switch or the Engine Start/Stop button to the ON position.

When there is a malfunction with the LED headlight. If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

This warning light blinks:

When there is a malfunction with a LED headlight related part. If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Continuous driving with the LED Headlight Warning Light on or blinking can reduce LED headlight life.

NOTICE

3-98

Convenience Features

Icy Road Warning Light (if equipped)

This warning light is to warn the driver the road may be icy. When the temperature on the out- side temperature gauge is approxi- mately below 40F (4C), the Icy Road Warning Light and Outside Temperature Gauge blinks and then illuminates. Also, the warning chime sounds 1 time. You can activate or deactivate Icy Road Warning function from the User Settings mode in the cluster LCD dis- play.

Information If the icy road warning light appears while driving, you should drive more attentively and safely refraining from over-speeding, rapid acceleration, sud- den braking or sharp turning, etc.

AUTO STOP Indicator Light

This indicator light illuminates:

When the engine enters the Idle Stop mode of the ISG (Idle Stop and Go) system.

This indicator light blinks:

When the automatic starting occurs, the AUTO STOP indicator on the cluster will blink for 5 seconds.

For more details, refer to the «ISG (Idle Stop and Go) system» in chapter 5.

Information When the engine automatically starts by the ISG system, some warning lights (ABS, ESC, ESC OFF, EPS or Parking brake warning light) may turn on for a few seconds.

This happens because of low battery voltage. It does not mean the system has malfunctioned.

Electronic Stability Control (ESC) Indicator Light

This indicator light illuminates:

When you set the ignition switch or the Engine Start/Stop button to the ON position. — The Electronic Stability Control

indicator light illuminates for about 3 seconds and then goes off.

Whenever there is a malfunction with the ESC system. If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

This indicator light blinks:

While the ESC is operating.

For more details, refer to «Electronic Stability Control (ESC)» in chapter 5.

ii

3-99

Convenience Features

3

Electronic Stability Control (ESC) OFF Indicator Light

This indicator light illuminates:

When you set the ignition switch or the Engine Start/Stop button to the ON position. — It illuminates for approximately

3 seconds and then goes off. When you deactivate the ESC sys-

tem by pressing the ESC OFF but- ton.

For more details, refer to «Electronic Stability Control (ESC)» in chapter 5.

Immobilizer Indicator Light (without smart key)(if equipped)

This indicator light illuminates:

When the vehicle detects the immobilizer in the key with the igni- tion switch in the ON position. — At this time, you can start the

engine. — The indicator light goes off after

starting the engine. This indicator light blinks:

When there is a malfunction with the immobilizer system.

If this occurs, have the vehicle inspect- ed by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Immobilizer Indicator Light (with smart key (if equipped)

This indicator light illuminates for up to 30 seconds:

When the vehicle detects the smart key in the vehicle with the Engine Start/Stop button in the ACC or ON position. — Once the smart key is detected,

you can start the engine. — The indicator light goes off after

starting the engine.

This indicator light blinks for a few seconds:

When the smart key is not in the vehicle. — If the smart key is not detected,

you cannot start the engine.

3-100

Convenience Features

This indicator light illuminates for 2 seconds and goes off:

If the smart key is in the vehicle and the Engine Start/Stop button is ON, but the vehicle cannot detect the smart key. If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

This indicator light blinks:

When there is a malfunction with the immobilizer system. If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Turn Signal Indicator Light

This indicator light blinks:

When you operate the turn signal indicator stalk.

If any of the following occur, there may be a malfunction with the turn signal system. — The turn signal indicator light illumi-

nates but does not blink — The turn signal indicator light blinks

rapidly — The turn signal indicator light does

not illuminate at all If any of these conditions occur, have your vehicle inspected by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer.

High Beam Indicator Light

This indicator light illuminates:

When the headlights are on and in the high beam position

When the turn signal lever is pulled into the Flash-to-Pass position.

Light ON Indicator Light

This indicator light illuminates:

When the tail lights or headlights are on.

3-101

Convenience Features

3

High Beam Assist (HBA) indicator light (if equipped)

This indicator light illuminates :

When the high-beam is on with the light switch in the AUTO light posi- tion.

If your vehicle detects oncoming or preceding vehicles, the High Beam Assist (HBA) system will switch the high beam to low beam automati- cally.

For more details, refer to «High Beam Assist (HBA) system» in this chapter.

AUTO HOLD Indicator Light

This indicator light illuminates:

[White] When you activate the Auto Hold system by pressing the AUTO HOLD button.

[Green] When you stop the vehicle completely by depressing the brake pedal with the Auto Hold system activated.

[Yellow] When there is a malfunc- tion with the Auto Hold system. If this occurs, have your vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

For more details, refer to «Auto Hold» in chapter 5.

Cruise Indicator Light

This indicator light illuminates:

When the cruise control system is enabled.

For more details, refer to «Cruise Control System» in chapter 5.

SPORT Mode Indicator Light (if equipped)

This indicator light illuminates:

When you select «SPORT» mode as drive mode.

For more details, refer to «Drive Mode Integrated Control System» in chapter 5.

AUTO HOLD

3-102

Convenience Features

SMART Mode Indicator Light (if equipped)

This indicator light illuminates:

When you select »SMART» mode as drive mode.

For more details, refer to «Drive Mode Integrated Control System» in chapter 5.

All Wheel Drive LOCK Indicator Light (if equipped)

This indicator light illuminates:

When you set the ignition switch or the Engine Start/Stop button to the ON position. — The AWD LOCK indicator light

illuminates for about 3 seconds and then goes off.

When you select AWD Lock mode by pressing the AWD LOCK but- ton. — The AWD LOCK mode is to trans-

fer a portion of the drive torque to the rear wheels for increased traction on wet pavement, snow covered roads or when driving off road.

Downhill Brake Control (DBC) Indicator Light (if equipped)

This indicator light illuminates:

When you set the ignition switch or the Engine Start/Stop button to the ON position. — The Downhill Brake Control

Indicator Light illuminates for about 3 seconds and then goes off.

When you activate the system by pressing the DBC button.

This indicator light blinks:

When the DBC is operating.

This indicator light illuminates yel- low:

When there is a malfunction with the DBC system.

If this occurs, have your vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

For more details, refer to «Downhill Brake Control (DBC) System» in chapter 5.

AWD Lock Mode

Do not use the AWD lock mode on dry paved roads. Doing so can cause abnormal noise or vibration, and may damage the AWD system.

CAUTION

3-103

Convenience Features

3

LCD Display Messages Shift to P or N to start engine (for smart key system) This warning message is displayed if you try to start the engine with the shift button not in the P (Park) or N (Neutral) position.

Information You can start the engine with the shift button in the N (Neutral) position. But, for your safety, we recommend that you start the engine with the shift button in the P (Park) position.

Low key battery (for smart key system) This warning message is displayed if the battery of the smart key is dis- charged while changing the Engine Start/Stop button to the OFF position.

Press brake pedal to start engine (for smart key system) This warning message is displayed if the Engine Start/Stop button changes to the ACC position twice by pressing the button repeatedly without depressing the brake pedal. You can start the vehicle by depress- ing the brake pedal and then press- ing the Engine Start/Stop button.

Key not in vehicle (for smart key system) This warning message is displayed if the smart key is not in the vehicle when you press the Engine Start/ Stop button. When attempting to start the vehicle, always have the smart key with you.

Key not detected (for smart key system) This warning message is displayed if the smart key is not detected when you press the Engine Start/Stop button.

Press START button again (for smart key system) This message is displayed if you were unable to start the vehicle when the Engine Start/Stop button was pressed. If this occurs, attempt to start the engine by pressing the Engine Start/ Stop button again. If the warning message appears each time you press the Engine Start/Stop button, have your vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

i

3-104

Convenience Features

Press START button with key (for smart key system) This warning message is displayed if you press the Engine Start/Stop but- ton while the warning message «Key not detected» is displayed. At this time, the immobilizer indicator light blinks.

Check BRAKE SWITCH fuse (for smart key system) This warning message is displayed if the brake switch fuse is disconnected. You need to replace the fuse with a new one before starting the engine. If that is not possible, you can start the engine by pressing the Engine Start/Stop button for 10 seconds in the ACC position.

Battery discharging due to external electrical devices This message is displayed if the bat- tery voltage is weak due to any non- factory electrical accessories (ex. dashboard camera) while parking. Be careful that the battery is not dis- charged. If the warning message appears after removing the non-factory elec- trical accessories, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Door, Hood, Liftgate open indicator

This warning is displayed if any door or the hood or the liftgate is left open. The warning will indicate which door is open in the display.

Before driving the vehicle, you should confirm that the door/ hood/liftgate is fully closed. Also, check there is no door/ hood/liftgate open warning light or message displayed on the instrument cluster.

CAUTION

OLX2048113

3-105

Convenience Features

3

Sunroof open indicator (if equipped)

This warning is displayed if you turn off the engine when the sunroof is open. Close the sunroof securely before leaving your vehicle.

Window open indicator (if equipped)

This warning is displayed if you turn off the engine when any window is open.

Low Pressure

This warning message is displayed if the tire pressure is low. The corre- sponding tire on the vehicle will be illuminated.

For more details, refer to «Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)» in chapter 6.

OLX2048108

Type A and B

OLX2049140N

Type C

OLX2049141N

Type C

OLX2049135N

Type COLX2048114

OLX2048116L

Type A and B

Type A and B

3-106

Convenience Features

Lights Mode

This indicator displays which exterior light is selected using the lighting control. You can activate or deactivate Wiper/Lights Display function from the User Settings mode in the cluster LCD display.

Wiper

This indicator displays which wiper speed is selected using the wiper control. You can activate or deactivate Wiper/Lights Display function from the User Settings mode in the cluster LCD display.

Heated Steering Wheel turned off (if equipped) This message is displayed if you turn off the heated steering wheel.

For more details, refer to «Heated Steering Wheel» in this chapter.

Low washer fluid This warning message is displayed if the washer fluid level in the reser- voir is nearly empty. Have the washer fluid reservoir refilled.

Low fuel This warning message is displayed if the fuel tank is almost out of fuel. When this message is displayed, the low fuel level warning light in the cluster will come on. It is recommended to look for the nearest fueling station and refuel as soon as possible.

Add fuel as soon as possible.

Engine overheated This warning message is displayed when the engine coolant tempera- ture is above 248F (120C). This means that the engine is overheated and may be damaged.

If your vehicle is overheated, refer to «Overheating» in chapter 6.

Rear Front

OIK047146L/OTMA048119OIK047145L

3-107

Convenience Features

3

Check headlight (if equipped) This warning message is displayed if the headlights are not operating properly. A headlight bulb may need to be replaced.

Information Make sure to replace the burned out bulb with a new one of the same wattage rating.

Check turn signal (if equipped) This warning message is displayed if the turn signal lamps are not operat- ing properly. A lamp may need to be replaced.

Information Make sure to replace the burned out bulb with a new one of the same wattage rating.

Check High Beam Assist (HBA) system (if equipped) This warning message is displayed if there is a problem with the High Beam Assist (HBA) system. Have the vehi- cle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

For more details, refer to «High Beam Assist (HBA) system» in chapter 3.

Check headlight LED (if equipped) This warning message is displayed if there is a problem with the LED headlight. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Check Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist system (if equipped) This warning message is displayed if there is a problem with the Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) system. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

For more details, refer to «Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) system» in chapter 5.

Check Blind-Spot Collision Warning (BCW) system (if equipped) This warning message is displayed if there is a problem with the Blind- Spot Collision Warning system. Have the vehicle inspected by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer.

For more details, refer to «Blind- Spot Collision Warning (BCW)/ Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist (BCA)» or «Rear Cross- Traffic Collision Warning (RCCW)/ Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist (RCCA)» System in chapter 5.

i

i

3-108

Convenience Features

Check Smart Cruise Control System (if equipped) This warning message is displayed if there is a problem with the Smart Cruise Control system. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

For more details, refer to «Smart Cruise Control with Stop & Go» in chapter 5.

Check Driver Attention Warning (DAW) system (if equipped) This warning message is displayed if there is a problem with the Driver Attention Warning (DAW). Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

For more details, refer to «Driver Attention Warning (DAW)» in chap- ter 5.

Check Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system (if equipped) This warning message is displayed if there is a problem with the Check Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

For more details, refer to «Check Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) sys- tem» in chapter 5.

3-109

Convenience Features

3

LCD DISPLAY (CLUSTER TYPE A AND TYPE B) LCD Display Control

The LCD display modes can be changed by using the control but- tons.

(1) : MODE button for changing modes

(2) , : MOVE switch for changing items

(3) OK : SELECT/RESET button for setting or resetting the selected item

OTMA048414

3-110

Convenience Features

Modes Symbol Explanation

Trip Computer The Trip Computer mode displays driving information such as the tripmeter, fuel economy, etc. For details, refer to «Trip Computer» in this chapter.

Turn By Turn (TBT) (if equipped)

This mode displays the state of the navigation.

Assist

The Driver Assist mode displays the status of the following features: — Smart Cruise Control (SCC) system — Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system — Driver Attention Warning (DAW) system — Tire pressure — Traction force distribution status of front-wheels and rear-wheels For more information, refer to «Smart Cruise Control with Stop & Go)», «Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system», «Driver Attention Warning (DAW) system», «Traction force distribution status of front-wheels and rear-wheels» in chapter 5 and «Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)» in chapter 6.

User Settings The User Settings mode provides user options for a variety of settings including door lock/unlock features, convenience features, driver assistance settings, etc.

Master Warning The Master Warning mode displays warning messages related to the vehicle when one or more systems is not operating normally.

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

LCD Display Modes

3-111

Convenience Features

3

Trip computer mode

The trip computer mode displays information related to vehicle driving parameters including fuel economy, tripmeter information and vehicle speed.

For more details, refer to «Trip Computer» in this chapter.

Turn By Turn (TBT) mode

This mode displays the state of the navigation.

Assist mode

SCC/LKA/DAW

This mode displays the state of the Smart Cruise Control (SCC), Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) and Driver Attention Warning (DAW).

For more details, refer to each system information in chapter 5.

OIK047124N OIK047147N OLX2049119N

3-112

Convenience Features

Tire Pressure

This mode displays information relat- ed to Tire Pressure.

For more details, refer to «Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)» in chapter 6.

Driving force distribution (AWD)

This mode displays information relat- ed to AWD driving force.

For more details, refer to the «All Wheel Drive» in the chapter 5.

Master warning mode This warning light informs the driver the following situations. — LED headlamp malfunction

(if equipped) — Forward Collision-Avoidance

Assist system malfunction (if equipped)

— Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist radar blocked (if equipped)

— Blind-Spot Collision Warning system malfunction (if equipped)

— Blind-Spot Collision Warning radar blocked (if equipped)

— Smart Cruise Control with Stop & Go malfunction (if equipped)

— Smart Cruise Control with Stop & Go radar blocked (if equipped)

— Lamp malfunction — High Beam Assist malfunction

(if equipped) — Tire Pressure Monitoring System

(TPMS) malfunction

OLX2048120L OLX2048121

3-113

Convenience Features

3

The Master Warning Light illumi- nates if one or more of the above warning situations occur. At this time, the LCD Modes Icon will change from ( ) to ( ). If the warning situation is solved, the master warning light will be turned off and the LCD Modes Icon will be changed back to its previous icon ( ).

User settings mode

In this mode, you can change the settings of the instrument cluster, doors, lamps, etc. 1. Head-up display 2. Driver Assistance 3. Door 4. Lights 5. Sound 6. Convenience 7. Service interval 8. Other 9. Language 10. Reset The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

Shift to P to edit settings

This warning message appears if you try to adjust the User Settings while driving. For your safety, change the User Settings after parking the vehicle, applying the parking brake and shift- ing to P (Park).

Quick guide help

This mode provides quick guides for the systems in the User Settings mode. Select an item, press and hold the OK button.

For more details, about each sys- tem, refer to this Owner’s Manual.

OIK047148L

OOSEV048172L

3-114

Convenience Features

Items Explanation

Enable Head-Up Display To activate or deactivate the Head-up display function.

Display Height To adjust the height of the image displayed

Rotation To adjust the angle of the image displayed.

Brightness To adjust the brightness of the image displayed.

Content Selection

To select the content to be displayed.

— Turn by Turn

— Traffic Information

— Cruise control

— Lane keeping assist

— Blind-spot Collision Warning

Speed Size To select the speedometer size displayed. — Large/Medium/Small

Speed Color To select the speedometer color displayed. — White/Orange/Green

1. Head-Up Display

For more information, refer to «Head-Up Display» in this chapter.

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

3-115

Convenience Features

3

Items Explanation

SCC Reaction

Fast / Normal / Slow To adjust the sensitivity of the Smart Cruise Control system.

For more details, refer to »Smart Cruise Control with Stop & Go» in chapter 5.

Driving assist

Leading vehicle departure alert To activate or deactivate the Leading vehicle departure alert.

For more details, refer to the «Leading vehicle departure alert» in chapter 5.

Lane Following Assist To activate or deactivate the Lane Following Assist (LFA) system.

For more details, refer to the «Lane Following Assist (LFA) System» in chapter 5.

Highway Driving Assist To activate or deactivate the Highway Driving Assist (HDA) system.

For more details, refer to the «Highway Driving Assist (HDA) System» in chapter 5.

Warning Timing Normal / Later To select when to provide a warning for all driver assistance.

Warning Volume High / Medium / Low To adjust the warning sound volume of all driver assistance.

Driver Attention Warning To activate or deactivate the Driver Attention Warning (DAW).

For more information, refer to the «Driver Attention Warning (DAW)» in chapter 5.

2. Driver Assistance

3-116

Convenience Features

Items Explanation

Forward Safety

Active Assist: If selected, the system controls the vehicle and provides a warning when a colli- sion is detected.

Warning Only: If selected, the system provides a warning when a collision is detected. Off: Deactivates the system.

For more details, refer to the «Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist system» in chapter 5.

Lane Safety

To adjust the Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) function. — Lane Keeping Assist — Lane Departure Warning — Off

For more details, refer to the «Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system» in chapter 5.

Blind-Spot Safety

Blind-Spot View To activate or deactivate the Blind-Spot View.

For more details, refer to the «Blind-Spot View» in this chapter.

SEA(Safe Exit Assistance) To activate or deactivate the Safe Exit Assistance.

For more details, refer to the «Safe Exit Assistance» in chapter 5.

Active assist

Warning only

Off

For more details, refer to «Blind-spot Collision-Avoidance Assist (BCA)» in chapter 5.

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

2. Driver Assistance

3-117

Convenience Features

3

Items Explanation

Automatically Lock

Enable on speed: All doors will be automatically locked when the vehicle speed exceeds 9.3 mph (15 km/h).

Enable on shift: All doors will be automatically locked if the vehicle is shifted from the P (Park) position to the R (Reverse), N (Neutral), or D (Drive) position. (Only when the engine is run- ning)

Automatically Unlock

Disable : The auto door unlock operation will be canceled. On key out : All doors will be automatically unlocked when the ignition key is removed from the

key ignition switch (if equipped with remote key). Vehicle off : All doors will be automatically unlocked when the Engine Start/Stop button is set

to the OFF position. (if equipped with smart key) On shift to P : All doors will be automatically unlocked if the automatic transmission is shifted

to the P (Park) position. (Only when the engine is running)

3. Door

Items Explanation

Parking Safety

Rear Cross-Traffic Safety To activate or deactivate the Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning function.

For more details, refer to the «Rear Cross-traffic Collision Warning (RCCW) / Rear Cross- traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist (RCCA)» in chapter 5.

2. Driver Assistance

3-118

Convenience Features

Items Explanation

Two Press Unlock

Off: The two press unlock function will be deactivated. Therefore, all doors will unlock if the door unlock button is pressed.

On: Only the driver’s door will unlock if the door unlock button is pressed. When the door unlock button is pressed again within 4 seconds, the remaining doors will unlock.

Horn Feedback

To activate or deactivate the horn feedback. If the horn feedback is activated, after locking the door by pressing the lock button on the remote key, and pressing it again within 4 seconds, the horn feedback sound will operate once to indicate that all doors are locked (if equipped with remote key).

Power Liftgate To activate or deactivate the Power Liftgate system.

For more details, refer to «Power Liftgate» in this chapter.

Power Liftgate Speed Fast / Normal To select the speed of the power liftgate opening and closing

For more details, refer to «Power Liftgate» in this chapter.

Smart Liftgate To activate or deactivate the Smart Liftgate system.

For more details, refer to «Smart Liftgate» in this chapter.

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

3. Door

3-119

Convenience Features

3

Items Explanation

One Touch Turn Signal

Off: The one touch turn signal function will be deactivated. 3, 5, 7 Flashes: The turn signal indicator will blink 3, 5, or 7 times when the turn signal lever is

moved slightly.

For more details, refer to «Lighting» in this chapter.

Headlight Delay To activate or deactivate the headlight delay function.

For more details, refer to «Lighting» in this chapter.

4. Lights

6. Convenience

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

5. Sound

Items Explanation

Welcome Sound To activate or deactivate the welcome sound function.

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

Items Explanation

Seat Slide Easy Access

Off: The seat easy access function is deactivated. Normal/Extended: When you turn off the engine, the driver’s seat will automatically move rear-

ward short (Normal) or long (Extended) for you to enter or exit the vehicle more comfortably. For more details, refer to «Driver Position Memory System» in this chapter.

3-120

Convenience Features

Items Explanation

Seat Height Easy Access To activate or deactivate the Seat Height Easy Access.

For more details, refer to «Driver Position Memory System» in this chapter.

Rear Occupant Alert To activate or deactivate the Rear Occupant Alert

For more details, refer to «Rear Occupant Alert (ROA) system» in this chapter.

Welcome Light

On driver approach: The welcome light turns on automatically when the vehicle is approached with the smart key.

For more details, refer to »Welcome System» in this chapter.

Wireless Charging System To activate or deactivate the wireless charging system in the front seat.

For more details, refer to «Wireless Charging System» in this chapter.

Traffic Information To activate or deactivate traffic information display function. When activated, traffic information, such as speed limits, etc. are displayed in the cluster LCD display.

Wiper/Lights Display To activate or deactivate the Wiper/Light mode. When activated, the LCD display shows the selected Wiper/Light mode whenever you change the mode.

Auto Rear Wiper (in R) To activate or deactivate the rear wiper while the vehicle is in reverse with the front wiper ON.

Gear Position Pop-up To activate or deactivate the gear position pop-up. When activated, the gear position will be displayed in the cluster LCD display.

Icy Road Warning To activate or deactivate the Icy Road Warning function.

6. Convenience

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

3-121

Convenience Features

3

7. Service interval

Information To use the service interval menu, consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

If the service interval is activated and the time and distance is adjusted, messages are displayed in the following situations each time the vehicle is turned on. — Service in: Displayed to inform the driver the remaining mileage and days to service. — Service required: Displayed when the mileage and days to service has been reached or passed.

Information If any of the following conditions occur, the mileage and number of days to service may be incorrect.

— The battery cable is disconnected.

— The fuse switch is turned off.

— The battery is discharged.

i

i

Items Explanation

Service Interval To activate or deactivate the service interval function.

Adjust Interval If the service interval menu is activated, you may adjust the time and distance.

3-122

Convenience Features

Items Explanation

Fuel Economy Reset

Off: The average fuel economy will not reset automatically whenever refueling. After ignition: When the engine has been OFF for 4 hours or longer the average fuel economy

will reset automatically. After refueling: The average fuel economy will reset automatically after adding 1.6 gallons (6

liters) of fuel or more and after driving speed exceeds 1 mph (1 km/h).

For more details, refer to «Trip Computer» in this chapter.

Fuel Economy Unit US gallon / UK gallon To select the fuel economy unit.

Temperature Unit C / F To select the temperature unit.

Tire Pressure Unit psi / kPa / bar To select the tire pressure unit.

8. Other

Items Explanation

Language To select language.

9. Language

Items Explanation

Reset You can reset the menus in the User Settings mode. All menus in the User Settings mode are reset to factory settings, except language and service interval.

10. Reset

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

3-123

Convenience Features

3

The trip computer is a microcomput- er-controlled driver information sys- tem that displays information related to driving.

Information Some driving information stored in the trip computer (for example Average Vehicle Speed) resets if the battery is disconnected.

Trip modes

To change the trip mode, toggle the » , » switch on the steering wheel.

i

TRIP COMPUTER (CLUSTER TYPE A AND TYPE B)

OTMA048414 Tripmeter Fuel Economy Timer

Accumulated Info

Tripmeter Fuel Economy Timer

Drive Info

Average Fuel Economy Instant Fuel Economy

Fuel Economy

Digital Speedometer

Auto Stop (if equipped)

Smart Shift

3-124

Convenience Features

Average fuel economy/ Instant fuel economy

Average Fuel Economy (1)

The average fuel economy is calcu- lated by the total driving distance and fuel consumption since the last average fuel economy reset.

The average fuel economy can be reset both manually and automati- cally.

Manual reset To clear the average fuel economy manually, press the OK button on the steering wheel for more than 1 sec- ond when the average fuel economy is displayed.

Automatic reset To automatically reset the average fuel economy, select between «After Ignition» or «After Refueling» in the User Settings mode in the cluster LCD display. — After ignition: When the engine has

been OFF for 4 hours or longer the average fuel economy will reset automatically.

— After refueling: The average fuel economy will reset automatically after adding 1.6 gallons (6 liters) of fuel or more and after driving speed exceeds 1 mph (1 km/h).

Information The vehicle must be driven for a min- imum of 0.19 miles (300 meters) since the last ignition key cycle before the average fuel economy will be recalcu- lated.

Instant Fuel Economy (2)

The instantaneous fuel economy is displayed according to the bar graph in the LCD display while driving.

i

OIK047124N

3-125

Convenience Features

3

Accumulated Info display

This display shows the accumulated trip distance (1), the average fuel economy (2), and the total driving time (3). The information is accumulated start- ing from the last reset. To reset the details, press and hold the OK button when viewing the Accumulated driving info. The trip distance, the average fuel economy, and total driving time will reset simul- taneously.

The accumulated driving information will continue to be counted while the engine is still running (for example, when the vehicle is in traffic or stopped at a stop light).

Information The vehicle must be driven for a min- imum of 0.19 miles (300 meters) since the last ignition key cycle before the average fuel economy will be recalcu- lated.

Drive Info display

This display shows the trip distance (1), the average fuel economy (2), and the total driving time (3). The information is combined for each ignition cycle. However, when the engine has been OFF for 4 hours or longer the Drive Info screen will reset. To reset the details, press and hold the OK button when viewing the Drive Info. The trip distance, the average fuel economy, and total driving time will reset simultaneously.

i

OIK047174N OIK047176N

3-126

Convenience Features

The driving information will continue to be counted while the engine is still run- ning (for example, when the vehicle is in traffic or stopped at a stop light).

Information The vehicle must be driven for a mini- mum of 0.19 miles (300 meters) since the last ignition key cycle before the average fuel economy will be recalculated.

Digital speedometer

This digital speedometer display shows the speed of the vehicle.

Smart shift

This mode displays the currently selected drive mode.

For more details, refer to «Drive Mode Integrated Control System» in chapter 5.

i

OIK047151N OIK047179N

3-127

Convenience Features

3

LCD Display Control The LCD display modes can be changed by using the control but- tons.

(1) : MODE button for changing modes

(2) , : MOVE switch for changing items

(3) OK — Tab: SELECT/RESET button for

setting the selected item — Tab and hold: SELECT/RESET

button for retrieving assist informa- tion or resetting the selected item

LCD DISPLAY (CLUSTER TYPE C) (IF EQUIPPED)

OTMA048414

3-128

Convenience Features

Modes Explanation

Utility The Trip Computer mode displays driving information such as the trip distance, fuel economy and etc. For details, refer to «Trip Computer» In this chapter.

Driving Assist The Driving Assist mode displays the driving status.

Turn By Turn (TBT) (if equipped)

This mode displays the state of the navigation.

Parking Assist The Parking Assist mode displays the parking status.

Driving Info. Display for 4 seconds when the vehicle mode changes from IGN ON to OFF

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

View Modes

3-129

Convenience Features

3

Utility View Mode The utility view mode displays infor- mation related to vehicle driving parameters including fuel economy and trip distance information.

Utility Items

The utility items appear as well in trip computer mode, driving assist mode and turn by turn mode. The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

Fuel Economy Information The average fuel economy and instant fuel economy are displayed.

— Manual reset: Press and hold OK button to initialize set up

— Automatic reset: Automatically reset the average fuel economy when the set-up conditions are satisfied in User Settings menu.

Driving Information The trip distance for each ignition cycle, fuel economy (undisplayed item in fuel economy: driving speed), trip time are shown. Press and hold OK button to initialize set up. When the engine has been OFF for 4 hours or longer the average fuel economy will reset automatically.

Information after Refueling The vehicle information such as trip distance, fuel economy (undisplayed item in fuel economy: driving speed) and trip time is displayed after refuel- ing. Press and hold OK button to ini- tialize set up.

Accumulated Information The vehicle information such as trip distance, fuel economy (undisplayed item in fuel economy: driving speed) and trip time is displayed after manu- al initialization.

Digital Speed Display It shows current vehicle speed.

AUTO STOP The cumulative time is show when the engine is off. Press and hold OK button to initialize set up.

Driver Attention Warning Display the status of the Driver Attention Warning system. When the engine is off or the vehicle comes to a stop, the system is reset. Press and hold OK button to initialize set up.

Smart Shift

Tire Pressure

Digital RPM

3-130

Convenience Features

Driving Assist View Mode

SCC/LKA/HAD/FCA

This mode displays the state of the Smart Cruise Control (SCC) and Lane Keeping Assist (LKA). For more details, refer to system information in chapter 5.

TBT (Turn By Turn) Mode

It shows the information by inter- working with the navigation.

Parking Assist View Mode

It displays the information related to the parking assist system move- ment.

OLX2059118N OLX2059119N OLX2049145N

3-131

Convenience Features

3

Other Information Display

Driving information summary (1)

The current operation conditions of the Cruise Control mode, Smart Cruise Control and high speed driv- ing assist modes. It does not show such information while driving assist mode is working.

Driving information summary (2)

It shows the weather and fine dust concentration. (If equipped)

While interworking with the naviga- tion, it displays the distance to the destinations or stops, the time to destinations or stops and the esti- mated time of arrival.

Assist messages appear while set up.

OLX2059120N

OLX2059121N

3-132

Convenience Features

Displayed items of user’s setting may differ from the content in this owner’s manual since the contents vary with the vehicles technical specifications.

NOTICE

OPTION MENU (CLUSTER TYPE C)

While driving, please do not change the setting mode. It may distract your attention and cause the acci- dent.

WARNING

List Set-up messages

Service Interval Check the service message

Head-up Display To activate or deactivate head-up display Set up the height, rotation and brightness (if equipped)

Warning Timing Normal/Later To select when to provide a warning for all driver assistance

3-133

Convenience Features

3

User settings mode In this mode, you can change the settings of the instrument cluster, doors, lamps, etc. 1. Head-up display 2. Driver Assistance 3. Door 4. Lights 5. Sound 6. Convenience 7. Service interval 8. Other 9. Language 10. Reset The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

Shift to P to edit settings

This warning message appears if you try to adjust the User Settings while driving. For your safety, change the User Settings after parking the vehicle, applying the parking brake and shift- ing to P (Park).

Quick guide help

This mode provides quick guides for the systems in the User Settings mode. Select an item, press and hold the OK button.

For more details, about each sys- tem, refer to this Owner’s Manual.

3-134

Convenience Features

Items Explanation

Enable Head-Up Display To activate or deactivate the Head-up display function.

Display Height To adjust the height of the image displayed

Rotation To adjust the angle of the image displayed.

Brightness To adjust the brightness of the image displayed.

Content Selection

To select the content to be displayed.

— Turn by Turn

— Traffic Information

— Cruise control

— Lane keeping assist

— Blind-spot Collision Warning

Speed Size To select the speedometer size displayed. — Large/Medium/Small

Speed Color To select the speedometer color displayed. — White/Orange/Green

1. Head-Up Display

For more information, refer to «Head-Up Display» in this chapter.

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

3-135

Convenience Features

3

Items Explanation

SCC Reaction

Fast / Normal / Slow To adjust the sensitivity of the Smart Cruise Control system.

For more details, refer to »Smart Cruise Control with Stop & Go» in chapter 5.

Driving Assist

Leading vehicle departure alert To activate or deactivate the Leading vehicle departure alert.

For more details, refer to the «Leading vehicle departure alert» in chapter 5.

Lane Following Assist To activate or deactivate the Lane Following Assist (LFA) system.

For more details, refer to the «Lane Following Assist (LFA) System» in chapter 5.

Highway Driving Assist To activate or deactivate the Highway Driving Assist (HDA) system.

For more details, refer to the «Highway Driving Assist (HDA) System» in chapter 5.

Warning Timing Normal / Later To select when to provide a warning for all driver assistance.

Warning Volume High / Medium / Low To adjust the warning sound volume of all driver assistance.

Driver Attention Warning To activate or deactivate the Driver Attention Warning (DAW).

For more information, refer to the «Driver Attention Warning (DAW)» in chapter 5.

2. Driver Assistance

3-136

Convenience Features

Items Explanation

Forward Safety

Active Assist: If selected, the system controls the vehicle and provides a warning when a colli- sion is detected.

Warning Only: If selected, the system provides a warning when a collision is detected. Off: Deactivates the system.

For more details, refer to the «Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist system» in chapter 5.

Lane Safety

To adjust the Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) function. — Lane Keeping Assist — Lane Departure Warning — Off

For more details, refer to the «Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system» in chapter 5.

Blind-Spot Safety

Blind-Spot View To activate or deactivate the Blind-Spot View.

For more details, refer to the «Blind-Spot View» in this chapter.

SEA(Safe Exit Assistance) To activate or deactivate the Safe Exit Assistance.

For more details, refer to the «Safe Exit Assistance» in chapter 5.

Active assist

Warning only

Off

For more details, refer to «Blind-spot Collision-Avoidance Assist (BCA)» in chapter 5.

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

2. Driver Assistance

3-137

Convenience Features

3

Items Explanation

Automatically Lock

Enable on speed: All doors will be automatically locked when the vehicle speed exceeds 9.3 mph (15 km/h).

Enable on shift: All doors will be automatically locked if the vehicle is shifted from the P (Park) position to the R (Reverse), N (Neutral), or D (Drive) position. (Only when the engine is run- ning)

Automatically Unlock

Disable : The auto door unlock operation will be canceled. On key out : All doors will be automatically unlocked when the ignition key is removed from the

key ignition switch (if equipped with remote key). Vehicle off : All doors will be automatically unlocked when the Engine Start/Stop button is set

to the OFF position. (if equipped with smart key) On shift to P : All doors will be automatically unlocked if the automatic transmission is shifted

to the P (Park) position. (Only when the engine is running)

3. Door

Items Explanation

Parking Safety

Rear Cross-Traffic Safety To activate or deactivate the Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning function.

For more details, refer to the «Rear Cross-traffic Collision Warning (RCCW) / Rear Cross- traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist (RCCA)» in chapter 5.

2. Driver Assistance

3-138

Convenience Features

Items Explanation

Two Press Unlock

Off: The two press unlock function will be deactivated. Therefore, all doors will unlock if the door unlock button is pressed.

On: Only the driver’s door will unlock if the door unlock button is pressed. When the door unlock button is pressed again within 4 seconds, the remaining doors will unlock.

Horn Feedback

To activate or deactivate the horn feedback. If the horn feedback is activated, after locking the door by pressing the lock button on the remote key, and pressing it again within 4 seconds, the horn feedback sound will operate once to indicate that all doors are locked (if equipped with remote key).

Power Liftgate To activate or deactivate the Power Liftgate system.

For more details, refer to «Power Liftgate» in this chapter.

Power Liftgate Speed Fast / Normal To select the speed of the power liftgate opening and closing

For more details, refer to «Power Liftgate» in this chapter.

Smart Liftgate To activate or deactivate the Smart Liftgate system.

For more details, refer to «Smart Liftgate» in this chapter.

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

3. Door

3-139

Convenience Features

3

Items Explanation

One Touch Turn Signal

Off: The one touch turn signal function will be deactivated. 3, 5, 7 Flashes: The turn signal indicator will blink 3, 5, or 7 times when the turn signal lever is

moved slightly.

For more details, refer to «Lighting» in this chapter.

Headlight Delay To activate or deactivate the headlight delay function.

For more details, refer to «Lighting» in this chapter.

4. Lights

6. Convenience

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

5. Sound

Items Explanation

Welcome Sound To activate or deactivate the welcome sound function.

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

Items Explanation

Seat Slide Easy Access

Off: The seat easy access function is deactivated. Normal/Extended: When you turn off the engine, the driver’s seat will automatically move rear-

ward short (Normal) or long (Extended) for you to enter or exit the vehicle more comfortably. For more details, refer to «Driver Position Memory System» in this chapter.

3-140

Convenience Features

Items Explanation

Seat Height Easy Access To activate or deactivate the Seat Height Easy Access.

For more details, refer to «Driver Position Memory System» in this chapter.

Rear Occupant Alert To activate or deactivate the Rear Occupant Alert

For more details, refer to «Rear Occupant Alert (ROA) system» in this chapter.

Welcome Light

On driver approach: The welcome light turns on automatically when the vehicle is approached with the smart key.

For more details, refer to »Welcome System» in this chapter.

Wireless Charging System To activate or deactivate the wireless charging system in the front seat.

For more details, refer to «Wireless Charging System» in this chapter.

Traffic Information To activate or deactivate traffic information display function. When activated, traffic information, such as speed limits, etc. are displayed in the cluster LCD display.

Wiper/Lights Display To activate or deactivate the Wiper/Light mode. When activated, the LCD display shows the selected Wiper/Light mode whenever you change the mode.

Auto Rear Wiper (in R) To activate or deactivate the rear wiper while the vehicle is in reverse with the front wiper ON.

Gear Position Pop-up To activate or deactivate the gear position pop-up. When activated, the gear position will be displayed in the cluster LCD display.

Icy Road Warning To activate or deactivate the Icy Road Warning function.

6. Convenience

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

3-141

Convenience Features

3

7. Service interval

Information To use the service interval menu, consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

If the service interval is activated and the time and distance is adjusted, messages are displayed in the following situations each time the vehicle is turned on. — Service in: Displayed to inform the driver the remaining mileage and days to service. — Service required: Displayed when the mileage and days to service has been reached or passed.

Information If any of the following conditions occur, the mileage and number of days to service may be incorrect.

— The battery cable is disconnected.

— The fuse switch is turned off.

— The battery is discharged.

i

i

Items Explanation

Service Interval To activate or deactivate the service interval function.

Adjust Interval If the service interval menu is activated, you may adjust the time and distance.

3-142

Convenience Features

Items Explanation

Fuel Economy Reset

Off: The average fuel economy will not reset automatically whenever refueling. After ignition: When the engine has been OFF for 4 hours or longer the average fuel economy

will reset automatically. After refueling: The average fuel economy will reset automatically after adding 1.6 gallons (6

liters) of fuel or more and after driving speed exceeds 1 mph (1 km/h).

For more details, refer to «Trip Computer» in this chapter.

Fuel Economy Unit US gallon / UK gallon To select the fuel economy unit.

Temperature Unit C / F To select the temperature unit.

Tire Pressure Unit psi / kPa / bar To select the tire pressure unit.

8. Other

Items Explanation

Language To select language.

9. Language

Items Explanation

Reset You can reset the menus in the User Settings mode. All menus in the User Settings mode are reset to factory settings, except language and service interval.

10. Reset

The information provided may differ depending on which functions are applicable to your vehicle.

3-143

Convenience Features

3

The Head-Up Display is an optional feature that allows the driver to view information projected onto a trans- parent screen while still keeping your eyes safely on the road ahead while driving.

Precautions while using the head up display It may sometimes be difficult to read information on the head up display in the following situations. — The driver is improperly positioned

in the driver’s seat. — The driver wears polarizing-filter

sunglasses. — An object is located above the

head up display cover. — The vehicle is driven on a wet road. — Any improper lighting accessory is

installed inside the vehicle, or there is incoming light from outside of the vehicle.

— The driver wears glasses. — The driver wears contact lenses. When it is difficult to read the head up display information, adjust the head up display angle or the head up display brightness level in the User Settings mode. For more details, refer to «LCD Display» in this chapter.

When replacing the front wind- shield glass of the vehicle equipped with the head up dis- play, replace it with a windshield glass designed for the head up display operation. Otherwise, duplicated images may be dis- played on the windshield glass.

NOTICE

HEAD UP DISPLAY (HUD) (IF EQUIPPED)

OLX2049051N

Do not tint the front wind- shield glass or add other types of metallic coating. Otherwise, the head up dis- play image may be invisible.

Do not place any accessories on the crash pad or attach any objects on the windshield glass.

The Blind-spot Collision Warning (BCW) system warn- ings on the head up display are supplemental. Do not sole- ly depend on them to change lanes. Always take a look around before changing lanes.

WARNING

3-144

Convenience Features

Head-up display ON/OFF

To activate the head up display, select ‘Head-UP Display’ on the User Settings mode on the instrument cluster LCD display. If you do not select ‘Head-Up Display’, the head up display will be deactivated.

Head-up display information

1. Turn By Turn (TBT) navigation infor- mation (if equipped)

2. Speed limit signs (if equipped) 3. Speedometer 4. Cruise setting speed (if equipped) 5. Smart Cruise Control (SCC) infor-

mation (if equipped) 6. Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) sys-

tem information (if equipped) 7. Blind-spot Collision Warning (BCW)

system information (if equipped) 8. Warning lights (Low fuel, etc.) 9. Audio/Video information

Information If you select the Turn By Turn (TBT) navigation information as HUD con- tents, the Turn By Turn (TBT) naviga- tion information will not be displayed in the instrument cluster LCD display.

Head-up display setting On the LCD display, you can change the head up display settings as fol- lows. Enable Head-up display Display Height Rotation Brightness Content Selection Speed Size Speed Color

For more details, refer to «LCD Display» in this chapter.

i

OLX2049419NOIK047152N

3-145

Convenience Features

3

LIGHTING Exterior Lights Lighting control

To operate the lights, turn the knob at the end of the control lever to one of the following positions: 1. OFF position 2. AUTO headlamp position 3. Parking lamp position 4. Headlamp position

Daytime running light (DRL)

The Daytime Running Lights (DRL) can make it easier for others to see the front of your vehicle during the day, especially after dawn and before sunset.

The DRL system will turn the dedi- cated lamp OFF when : The headlamps are ON. The parking lamps are ON. The vehicle is turned off. The parking brake is engaged.

AUTO headlamp position

The parking lamp and headlamp will be turned ON or OFF automatically depending on the amount of daylight as measured by the ambient light sensor (1) on the center dash.

OOS047404N

OTMA048477

OLX2048065

3-146

Convenience Features

Even with the AUTO headlamp fea- ture in operation, it is recommended to manually turn ON the headlamps when driving at night or in a fog, driv- ing in the rain, or when you enter dark areas, such as tunnels and parking facilities.

Do not cover or spill anything on the sensor (1) located in front of the instrument panel.

Do not clean the sensor using a window cleaner, the cleanser may leave a light film which could interfere with sensor operation.

If your vehicle has window tint or other types of metallic coat- ing on the front windshield, the AUTO headlamp system may not work properly.

Parking lamp position ( )

The parking lamp, license plate lamp and instrument panel lamp are turned ON.

Headlamp position ( )

The headlamp, parking lamp, license plate lamp and instrument panel lamp are turned ON.

Information The ignition switch must be in the ON position to turn on the headlamp.

i

NOTICE

OOS047405N OOS047406N

3-147

Convenience Features

3

High beam operation

To turn on the high beam headlamp, push the lever away from you. The lever will return to its original position. The high beam indicator will light when the headlamp high beams are switched on. To turn off the high beam headlamp, pull the lever towards you. The low beams will turn on.

To flash the high beam headlamp, pull the lever towards you, then release the lever. The high beams will remain ON as long as you hold the lever towards you.

Turn signals and lane change signals

To signal a turn, push down on the lever for a left turn or up for a right turn in position (A). If an indicator stays on and does not flash or if it flashes abnormally, one of the turn signal bulbs may be burned out and will require replacement.

Do not use high beam when there are other vehicles approaching you. Using high beam could obstruct the other driver’s vision.

WARNING

OOS047407N

OOS047408N

OOS047410N

3-148

Convenience Features

One-touch turn signal function

To activate the One Touch Turn Signal function, push the turn signal lever up or down to position (B) and then release it. The lane change signals will blink 3, 5 or 7 times. You can activate or deactivate the One Touch Turn Signal function or choose the number of blinks (3, 5, or 7) from the User Settings mode in the LCD display.

For more details, refer to the «LCD Display» section in this chapter.

Battery saver function The purpose of this feature is to help prevent the battery from being dis- charged. The system automatically turns off the parking lamp when the driver turns the vehicle off and opens the driver-side door. With this feature, the parking lamps will turn off automatically if the driver parks on the side of road at night. However, the position lamps stay ON even when the driver-side door is opened if the headlamp switch is turned to the position lamp or AUTO (if equipped) position after the engine is turned off. If necessary, to keep the lamps on turn the position lamps OFF and ON again using the headlamp switch on the steering column after the engine is turned off.

Headlamp delay function If the key is removed from the ignition switch or placed in the ACC position or the LOCK/OFF position with the headlamps ON, the headlamps (and/or parking lamps) remain on for about 5 minutes. However, if the dri- ver’s door is opened and closed, the headlights are turned off after 15 seconds. Also, with the engine off if the driver’s door is opened and closed, the headlamps (and/or park- ing lamps) are turned off after 15 seconds. The headlamps (and/or parking lamps) can be turned off by pressing the lock button on the remote key or smart key twice or turning the head- lamp switch to the OFF or AUTO position. You can activate or deactivate the Headlamp Delay function from the User Settings mode in the LCD dis- play.

For more details, refer to the «LCD Display» section in this chapter.

3-149

Convenience Features

3

If the driver exits the vehicle through another door besides the driver door, the battery saver func- tion does not operate and the headlamp delay function does not turn OFF automatically. This may cause the battery to dis- charge. To avoid battery dis- charge, turn OFF the headlamps manually from the headlamp switch before exiting the vehicle.

Interior Lights

Do not use the interior lights for extended periods when the vehi- cle is turned off or the battery will discharge.

Interior lamp AUTO cut The interior lamps will automatically go off approximately 20 minutes after the engine is turned off and the doors are closed. If a door is opened, the lamp will go off 40 minutes after the engine is turned off. If the doors are locked by the remote key or smart key and the vehicle enters the armed stage of the theft alarm sys- tem, the lamps will go off five sec- onds later.

Front lamps

Front Room Lamp (1) ( ) :

Press the button to turn the front and rear room lamps on or off.

NOTICE

NOTICE

Do not use the interior lights when driving in the dark. The interior lights may obscure your view and cause an accident.

WARNING

OLX2048066

3-150

Convenience Features

Front Door Lamp (2) ( ) :

The front or rear room lamps come on when the front or rear doors are opened if the engine is running or not. When doors are unlocked by the remote key or smart key, the front and rear lamps come on for approximate- ly 30 seconds as long as any door is not opened. The front and rear room lamps go out gradually after approxi- mately 30 seconds when the door is closed. However, if the ignition switch is in the ON position or all doors are locked, the front and rear lamps will turn off. If a door is opened with the ignition switch in the ACC position or the OFF position, the front and rear lamps stay on for about 20 minutes.

Front Map Lamp (3) :

Press either or switches ( ) to turn the map lamp on or off. This light produces a spot beam for convenient use as a map lamp at night or as a personal lamp for the driver and the front passenger.

Rear lamp

Rear Room Lamp ( ):

Press either buttons to turn the room lamp on or off.

Luggage compartment lamp

ON ( ) : The luggage compartment lamp stays on at all times.

DOOR ( ) : The luggage compartment lamp comes on when the liftgate is opened.

OFF ( ) : The luggage compartment lamp is off.

OLX2048067 OLX2049070N

3-151

Convenience Features

3

Vanity mirror lamp (if equipped)

Opening the lid of the vanity mirror will automatically turn on the mirror light.

To prevent unnecessary charging system drain, close the vanity mir- ror cover after using the mirror.

Glove box lamp (if equipped)

The glove box lamp comes on when the glove box is opened. If the glove box is not closed, the lamp will turn off after 20 minutes.

To prevent unnecessary charging system drain, close the glove box securely after using the glove box.

Puddle lamp (if equipped)

Welcome light

When all doors (and liftgate) are closed and locked, the puddle lamp will come on for 15 seconds if the door is unlocked by the remote key or smart key or outside door handle button.

For more details, refer to «Welcome System» in this chapter.

NOTICE NOTICE

ODH043356 OLX2048068 OLX2048071

3-152

Convenience Features

Escort light

When the vehicle is turned OFF and the driver’s door is opened, the pud- dle lamp will come on for 30 sec- onds. If the driver’s door is closed within the 30 seconds, the puddle lamp will turn off after 15 seconds. If the driver’s door is closed and locked, the puddle lamp will turn off immediately. The Puddle Lamp Escort Light will turn on only the first time the driver’s door is opened after the engine is turned off.

Welcome System (if equipped) Welcome light

Puddle lamp (if equipped) and door handle lamp (if equipped)

When all the doors (and liftgate) are closed and locked, the puddle lamp and door handle lamp will come on for about 15 seconds if any of the below is performed. When the door unlock button is

pressed on the remote key or smart key.

When the button of the outside door handle is pressed with the smart key in possession.

If ‘Convenience Welcome Light On driver approach’ is selected in the User Settings mode in the cluster LCD display, the lamps will turn on when the vehicle is approached with the smart key in possession.

Headlamp and parking lamp

When the headlamp (lamp switch in the headlamp or AUTO position) is on and all doors (and liftgate) are locked and closed, the parking lamp and headlamp will come on for 15 seconds when the door unlock button is pressed on the remote key or smart key. At this time, if you press the door lock or unlock button, the parking lamp and headlamp will turn off immediately.

OLX2048064

3-153

Convenience Features

3

Interior lamp When the interior lamp switch is in the DOOR position and all doors (and liftgate) are closed and locked, the room lamp will come on for 30 sec- onds if any of the below is performed. When the door unlock button is

pressed on the remote key or smart key.

When the button of the outside door handle is pressed with the smart key in possession.

At this time, if you press the door lock or unlock button on the smart key the room lamp will turn off immediately.

3-154

Convenience Features

High Beam Assist will automatically adjust the headlamp range (switches between high beam and low beam) according to the brightness of other vehicles and road conditions.

Detecting sensor (Front view camera)

[1] : Front view camera

The front view camera is used as a detecting sensor to detect ambient light and brightness while driving. Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensor. For more details on the precautions of the front view camera, refer to Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) section in chapter 5.

High Beam Assist setting Setting features The driver can activate HBA by plac- ing the ignition switch to the ON posi- tion and by selecting: User Settings Lights HBA (High Beam Assist). If you disable this setting, HBA will not work. The setting of HBA will be main- tained, as selected, when the engine is re-started.

HIGH BEAM ASSIST (HBA) (IF EQUIPPED)

OPDE046057

OLX2051137L

3-155

Convenience Features

3

High Beam Assist operation Display and control After selecting High Beam Assist

in the Settings menu, High Beam Assist will operate by following the procedure below. — Place the headlamp switch in the

AUTO position and push the headlamp lever towards the instrument cluster. The High Beam Assist ( ) indicator light will illuminate on the cluster and High Beam Assist will be enabled.

— When High Beam Assist is enabled, high beam will turn on when vehicle speed is above 40 km/h (25 mph). When vehicle speed is below 25 km/h (15 mph), high beam will not turn on.

— The High Beam ( ) indicator light will illuminate on the cluster when high beam is on.

When High Beam Assist is operat- ing, if the headlamp lever or switch is used, High Beam Assist oper- ates as follow: — If the headlamp lever is pulled

towards you when the high beam is off, the high beam will turn on without High Beam Assist can- celed. When you let go of the headlamp lever, the lever will move to the middle and the high beam will turn off.

— If the headlamp lever is pulled towards you when the high beam is on by High Beam Assist, low beam will be on and the system will turn off.

— If the headlamp switch is placed from AUTO to another position (headlamp/position/off), High Beam Assist will turn off and the corresponding lamp will turn on.

When High Beam Assist is operat- ing, high beam switches to low beam if any of the following condi- tions occur: — When the headlamp of an

oncoming vehicle is detected. — When the tail lamp of a vehicle in

front is detected. — When the headlamp or tail lamp

of a motorcycle or a bicycle is detected.

— When the surrounding ambient light is bright enough that high beams are not required.

— When streetlights or other lights are detected.

3-156

Convenience Features

High Beam Assist malfunction and limitations Warning light and message

When High Beam Assist is not work- ing properly, the warning message will come on for a few second. After the message disappears, the master warning light ( ) will illuminate. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Limitations of High Beam Assist High Beam Assist may not work properly in the following situations: Light from a oncoming or front

vehicle is not detected because of lamp damage, or because it is hid- den from sight, etc.

Headlamp of a oncoming or front vehicle is covered with dust, snow or water.

A front vehicles headlamps are off but the fog lamps are on and etc.

There is a lamp that has a similar shape as a vehicles lamp.

Headlamps have been damaged or not repaired properly.

Headlamps are not aimed properly. Driving on a narrow curved road,

rough road, uphill or downhill. Vehicle in front is partially visible

on a crossroad or curved road. There is a traffic light, reflecting

sign, flashing sign or mirror ahead.

There is a temporary reflector or flash ahead (construction area).

The road conditions are bad such as being wet, iced or covered with snow.

A vehicle suddenly appears from a curve.

The vehicle is tilted from a flat tire or is being towed.

Light from a oncoming or front vehicle is not detected due to obstacles in the air such as exhaust fume, smoke, fog, snow, or water spay or blizzard on the road, or fogging in the lamp, etc.

Information For more details on the limitations of the Front View Camera, refer to Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) section in chapter 5.

i

OOS047127L

3-157

Convenience Features

3

At times, High Beam Assist may not work properly. High Beam Assist is for your con- venience only. It is the respon- sibility of the driver for safe driving practices and always check the road conditions for your safety.

When High Beam Assist does not operate normally, change the headlamp position manu- ally between high beam and low beam.

WARNING

3-158

Convenience Features

A : Wiper speed control MIST Single wipe OFF Off INT Intermittent wipe

AUTO* Auto control wipe LO Low wiper speed HI High wiper speed

B : Intermittent control wipe time adjustment

C : Wash with brief wipes (pull lever towards you)

D : Rear wiper/washer control HI High wiper speed LO Low wiper speed OFF Off

E : Wash with brief wipes (rear) (push lever away from you)

* : if equipped

Front Windshield Wipers Operates as follows when the igni- tion switch is in the ON position. MIST : For a single wiping cycle,

push the lever upward and release. The wipers will oper- ate continuously if the lever is held in this position.

OFF : Wiper is not in operation. INT : Wiper operates intermittently at

the same wiping intervals. To vary the speed setting, move the speed control lever. The top most setting will run the wipers most frequently (for more rain). The bottom setting will run the wipers the least frequently (for less rain).

AUTO : The rain sensor located on the upper end of the wind- shield glass senses the amount of rainfall and con- trols the wiping cycle for the proper interval. The more it rains, the faster the wiper operates. When the rain stops, the wiper stops.To vary the speed setting, turn the speed control knob (B).

WIPERS AND WASHERS

OPD047454L

OTLA045318

Front windshield wiper/washer

Rear window wiper/washer

3-159

Convenience Features

3

LO : The wiper runs at a lower speed. HI : The wiper runs at a higher speed.

Information If there is heavy accumulation of snow or ice on the windshield, defrost the windshield for about 10 minutes, or until the snow and/or ice is removed before using the windshield wipers to ensure proper operation.

If you do not remove the snow and/or ice before using the wiper and washer, it may damage the wiper and washer system.

AUTO (Automatic) control (if equipped) The rain sensor located on the upper end of the windshield glass senses the amount of rainfall and controls the wiping cycle for the proper inter- val. The wiper operation time will be automatically controlled depends on rainfall. When the rain stops, the wiper stops. To vary the sensitivity setting, turn the sensitivity control knob (1). If the wiper switch is set in AUTO mode when the ignition switch is in the ON position, the wiper will oper- ate once to perform a self-check of the system. Set the wiper to OFF position when the wiper is not in use.

i To avoid personal injury from the windshield wipers, when the engine is running and the wind- shield wiper switch is placed in the AUTO mode: Do not touch the upper end of

the windshield glass facing the rain sensor.

Do not wipe the upper end of the windshield glass with a damp or wet cloth.

Do not put pressure on the windshield glass.

WARNING

3-160

Convenience Features

When washing the vehicle, set the wiper switch in the OFF posi- tion to stop the auto wiper oper- ation. The wiper may operate and be damaged if the switch is set in the AUTO mode while washing the vehicle.

Do not remove the sensor cover located on the upper end of the passenger side windshield glass. Damage to system parts could occur and may not be cov- ered by your vehicle warranty.

Because of using a photo sen- sor, temporary malfunction could occur according to sud- den ambient light change made by stone and dust while driving.

Front Windshield Washers

In the OFF position, pull the lever gently toward you to spray washer fluid on the windshield and to run the wipers 1-3 cycles. The spray and wiper operation will continue until you release the lever. If the washer does not work, you may need to add washer fluid to the washer fluid reservoir.

NOTICE

When the outside temperature is below freezing, ALWAYS warm the windshield using the defroster to help prevent the washer fluid from freezing on the windshield and obscuring your vision which could result in an accident and serious injury or death.

WARNING

OTLE045164

3-161

Convenience Features

3

To prevent possible damage to the washer pump, do not oper- ate the washer when the fluid reservoir is empty.

To prevent possible damage to the wipers or windshield, do not operate the wipers when the windshield is dry.

To prevent damage to the wiper arms and other components, do not attempt to move the wipers manually.

To prevent possible damage to the wipers and washer system, use anti-freezing washer fluids in the winter season or cold weather.

Rear Window Wiper and Washer

The rear window wiper and washer switch is located at the end of the wiper and washer switch lever. Turn the switch to the desired position to operate the rear wiper and washer. HI High wiper speed LO Low wiper speed OFF Off

Push the lever away from you to spray rear washer fluid and to run the rear wipers 1~3 cycles. The spray and wiper operation will continue until you release the lever.

Auto rear wiper The rear wiper will operate while the vehicle is in reverse with the front wiper ON by selecting the function on the LCD display. Go to ‘User Settings Convenience Auto Rear Wiper (in R)’.

NOTICE

OTLE045166

OTLE045165

3-162

Convenience features

REAR VIEW MONITOR (RVM) (IF EQUIPPED)

Rear View Monitor will show the area behind the vehicle to assist you when parking or backing up.

Detecting sensor

[1] : Rear view camera

Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensor.

Rear View Monitor settings Camera settings

You can change Rear View Monitor Display Contents or Display Settings by touching the setup icon ( ) on the screen while Rear View Monitor is operating, or selecting Driver Assistance Parking Safety Camera Settings from the Settings menu while the engine is on. In the Display Contents, you can change settings for Rear View, and in the Display Settings, you can change the screens Brightness and Contrast.

OLX2041436L

OLX2048057L

OLX2041056L

OTM070210L

3-163

Convenience features

3

Rear View Monitor operation Operating button

Parking/View button

Press the Parking/View button (1) to turn on Rear View Monitor. Press the button again to turn off the function.

Rear view Operating conditions

Shift the gear to R (Reverse), the image will appear on the screen.

Press the Parking/View button (1) while the gear is in P (Park), the image will appear on the screen.

Off conditions

The rear view cannot be turned off when the gear is in R (Reverse).

Press the Parking/View button (1) again while the gear is in P (Park) with the rear view on the screen, the rear view will turn off.

Shift the gear from R (Reverse) to P (Park), the rear view will turn off.

Extended rear view function The rear view will maintain showing on the screen to help you when park- ing.

Operating conditions

Shift the gear from R (Reverse) to N (Neutral) or D (Drive), the rear view will appear on the screen.

Off conditions

When vehicle speed is above 6 mph (10 km/h), the rear view will turn off.

Shift the gear to P (Park), the rear view will turn off.

OLX2048058

3-164

Convenience features

Rear View while driving

The driver is able to check the rear view on the screen while driving, it is to assist with safe driving.

Operating conditions

Press the Parking/View button (1) while the gear is in D (Drive) or N (Neutral), the driving rear view will appear on the screen.

Off conditions

Press the Parking/View button (1) again, the driving rear view will turn off.

Press one of the infotainment sys- tem button (2), the driving rear view will turn off.

Shift the gear to P (Park), the driv- ing rear view will turn off.

When operating

If the gear is shifted to R (Reverse), while Driving rear view is displayed on the screen, the screen will change to rear view with parking guidance.

Rear top view When you touch the icon (1), the top view is displayed on the screen and shows the distance from the vehicle in the back of your vehicle while parking.

OLX2048059

OLX2041431L

3-165

Convenience features

3

Rear View Monitor malfunction and limitations Rear View Monitor malfunction When Rear View Monitor is not work- ing properly, or the screen flickers, or the camera image does not display normally, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Limitations of Rear View Monitor When the vehicle is stopped for a long time in winter or when the vehi- cle is parked in an indoor parking lot, the exhaust fumes may temporarily blur the image.

The rear view camera does not cover the complete area behind the vehicle. The driver should always check the rear area directly through the inside and outside rearview mirror before parking or back- ing up.

The image shown on the screen may differ from the actual distance of the object. Make sure to directly check the vehicle’s surroundings for safety.

Always keep the rear view camera lens clean. If the lens is covered with foreign mate- rial, it may adversely affect camera performance and Rear View Monitor may not operate normally. However, do not use chemical solvents such as strong detergents containing high alkaline or volatile organ- ic solvents (gasoline, acetone etc.). This may damage the camera lens.

WARNING

3-166

Convenience features

Reverse Parking Distance Warning will help warn the driver if an obsta- cle is detected within a certain dis- tance when the vehicle is moving in reverse at low speeds.

Detecting sensor

[B] : Rear ultrasonic Sensor

Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensors.

Reverse Parking Distance Warning settings Warning Volume

With the engine on, select ‘Driver Assistance Warning Volume’ from the Settings menu to change the Warning Volume to ‘High’, ‘Medium’, ‘Low’ or ‘Off’ for Reverse Parking Distance Warning. However, even if ‘Off’ is selected, Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist’s Warning Volume will not turn off but the volume will sound as ‘Low’. If you change the warning volume, the Warning Volume of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

Reverse Parking Distance Warning operation Operating button

Parking Distance Warning Off but- ton

Press the Parking Distance Warning Off ( ) button to turn off Reverse Parking Distance Warning. Press the button again to turn on the function.

When Reverse Parking Distance Warning is off (button indicator light on), if you shift the gear to R (Reverse), the function will auto- matically turn on.

REVERSE PARKING DISTANCE WARNING (PDW) (IF EQUIPPED)

OLX2048053L

OLX2048096ONX4E070090

3-167

Convenience features

3

Reverse Parking Distance Warning Reverse Parking Distance Warning

will operate when the gear is in R (Reverse).

Reverse Parking Distance Warning detects a person, animal or object in the rear when the vehicles rear- ward speed is below 6 mph (10 km/h).

The corresponding indicator will illuminate whenever each ultrason- ic sensor detects a person, animal or object in its sensing range. Also an audible warning will sound.

When more than two objects are detected at the same time, the closest one will be warned with an audible warning.

The shape of the indicator in the illustration may differ from the actu- al vehicle.

Reverse Parking Distance Warning malfunction and pre- cautions Reverse Parking Distance Warning malfunction After starting the engine, a beep will sound when the gear is shifted to R (Reverse) to indicate Reverse Parking Distance Warning is operat- ing normally. However, if one or more of the fol- lowing occurs, first check whether the ultrasonic sensor is damaged or blocked with foreign material. If it still does not work properly, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Distance from object

Warning indicator Warning

soundDriving rearward

24 48 in. (60 120 cm)

Buzzer beeps intermittently

12 24 in. (30 60 cm)

Beeps more frequently

within 12 in. (30 cm)

Beeps continuously

3-168

Convenience features

The audible warning does not sound.

The buzzer sounds intermittently. The Parking sensor error or block-

age warning message appears on the cluster.

Limitations of Reverse Parking Distance Warning Reverse Parking Distance Warning

may not operate normally when: — Moisture is frozen to the sensor — Sensor is covered with foreign

material, such as snow or water (Reverse Parking Distance Warning will operate normally when such foreign material are removed.)

— The weather is extremely hot or cold The sensor or sensor assembly is disassembled

— The surface of the sensor is pressed hard or an impact is applied with a hard object

— The surface of the sensor is scratched with a sharp object

— The sensors or its surrounding area is directly sprayed with high pressure washer

OTM070218L

Reverse Parking Distance Warning is a supplemental function. The operation of Reverse Parking Distance Warning can be affected by several factors (including environmental conditions). It is the responsibility of the driver to always check the rear view before and while parking.

Your new vehicle warranty does not cover any accidents or damage to the vehicle due to the malfunction of Reverse Parking Distance Warning.

Pay close attention when driv- ing near objects, pedestrians, and especially children. Some objects may not be detected by the ultrasonic sensors, due to the objects distance, size or material, all of which can limit the effectiveness of the sensor.

WARNING

3-169

Convenience features

3

Reverse Parking Distance Warning may malfunction when: — Heavy rain or water spray is pres-

ent — Water flows on the surface of the

sensor — Affected by another vehicles sen-

sors — The sensor is covered with snow — Driving on uneven road, gravel

roads or bushes — Objects that generates ultrasonic

waves are near the sensor — Installing the license plate differ-

ently from the original location — The vehicle bumper height or

ultrasonic sensor installation has been modified

— Attaching equipments or acces- sories around the ultrasonic sen- sors

The following objects may not be detected: — Sharp or slim objects, such as

ropes, chains or small poles. — Objects, which tend to absorb

sensor frequency, such as clothes, spongy material or snow.

— Objects smaller than 40 in. (100 cm) in length and narrower than 6 in. (14 cm) in diameter.

— Pedestrians, animals or objects that are very close to the ultra- sonic sensors

Parking Distance Warning Indicators may be displayed differ- ently from the actual detected loca- tion when the obstacle is located between the sensors.

Parking Distance Warning indica- tor may not occur sequentially depending on vehicle speed or obstacle shape.

If Reverse Parking Distance Warning needs repair, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

3-170

Convenience features

Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning will help warn the driver if an obstacle is detected within a cer- tain distance when the vehicle is moving forward or in reverse at low speeds.

Detecting sensor

[A] : Front ultrasonic sensor, [B] : Rear ultrasonic sensor

Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensors.

Reverse Parking Distance Warning settings Warning Volume

With the engine on, select ‘Driver Assistance Warning Volume’ from the Settings menu to change the Warning Volume to ‘High’, ‘Medium’, ‘Low’ or ‘Off’ for Reverse Parking Distance Warning. However, even if ‘Off’ is selected, Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist’s Warning Volume will not turn off but the volume will sound as ‘Low’. If you change the warning volume, the Warning Volume of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

FORWARD/REVERSE PARKING DISTANCE WARNING (PDW) (IF EQUIPPED)

OLX2048055

OLX2048053L

ONX4E070090

3-171

Convenience features

3

Parking Distance Warning Auto On To use Parking Distance Warning Auto On function, select Driver Assistance Parking Safety Parking Distance Warning Auto On from the cluster or infotainment sys- tem Settings menu.

Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning operation Operating button

Parking Safety button

Press the Parking Safety ( ) button to turn on Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning. Press the button again to turn off the function.

When Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning is off (button indicator light off), if you shift the gear to R (Reverse), Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning will automatically turn on.

When Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning turns on, the button indicator light will turn on. If vehicle speed is above 12 mph (20 km/h), Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning will turn off (but- ton indicator light off). If equipped with Reverse

Parking Collision-Avoidance Assist or Remote Smart Parking Assist, Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning will turn off (button indicator light off) when vehicle speed is above 18 mph (30 km/h).OLX2048096

3-172

Convenience features

Forward Parking Distance Warning Forward Parking Distance Warning

will operate when one of the condi- tion is satisfied. — The gear is shifted from R

(Reverse) to D (Drive) with Reverse Parking Distance Warning on

— The gear is in D (Drive) and the Parking Safety button indicator light is on

— Parking Distance Warning Auto On is selected from the Settings menu and the gear is in D (Drive)

Forward Parking Distance Warning detects a person, animal or object in front when the vehicles forward speed is below 6 mph (10 km/h).

Forward Parking Distance Warning does not operate when the vehi- cle’s forward speed is above 6 mph (10 km/h) even when the Parking Safety button indicator is on. Forward Parking Distance Warning will operate again when the vehi- cle’s forward speed decreases below 6 mph (10 km/h) while the Parking Safety button indicator is on.

When Parking Distance Warning Auto On is selected, the Parking Safety button indicator light stays on.

When Parking Distance Warning Auto On is deselected, and the vehicles forward speed is above 12 mph (20 km/h), the Parking Safety button indicator will turn off. Although you drive below 6 mph (10 km/h), Forward Parking Distance Warning will not turn on. If equipped with Reverse

Parking Collision-Avoidance Assist or Remote Smart Parking Assist, Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning will turn off when vehicle speed is above 18 mph (30 km/h).

The corresponding indicator will illuminate whenever each ultrason- ic sensor detects a person, animal or object in its sensing range. Also an audible warning will sound.

When more than two objects are detected at the same time, the closest one will be warned with an audible warning.

The shape of the indicator in the illustration may differ from the actu- al vehicle.

Distance from object

Warning indicator Warning

soundDriving rearward

24 48 in. (60 120 cm)

Buzzer beeps intermittently

12 24 in. (30 60 cm)

Beeps more frequently

within 12 in. (30 cm)

Beeps continuously

3-173

Convenience features

3

Reverse Parking Distance Warning Reverse Parking Distance Warning

will operate when the gear is in R (Reverse).

Reverse Parking Distance Warning detects a person, animal or object in the rear when the vehicles rear- ward speed is below 6 mph (10 km/h).

When the vehicles rearward speed is below 6 mph (10 km/h), both the front and rear ultrasonic sensors will detect objects. However, the front ultrasonic sensors can detect a person, animal or object when it is within 24 in. (60 cm) from the sensors.

The corresponding indicator will illuminate whenever each ultrason- ic sensor detects a person, animal or object in its sensing range. Also an audible warning will sound.

When more than two objects are detected at the same time, the closest one will be warned with an audible warning.

The shape of the indicator in the illustration may differ from the actu- al vehicle.

Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning malfunction and precautions Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning malfunction After starting the engine, a beep will sound when the gear is shifted to R (Reverse) to indicate the function is operating normally. However, if one or more of the fol- lowing occurs, first check whether the ultrasonic sensor is damaged or blocked with foreign material. If it still does not work properly, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Distance from object

Warning indicator Warning

soundDriving rearward

24 48 in. (60 120 cm)

Buzzer beeps intermittently

12 24 in. (30 60 cm)

Beeps more frequently

within 12 in. (30 cm)

Beeps continuously

3-174

Convenience features

The audible warning does not sound.

The buzzer sounds intermittently. The Parking sensor error or block-

age warning message appears on the cluster.

Limitations of Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning Forward/Reverse Parking Distance

Warning may not operate normally when: — Moisture is frozen to the sensor — Sensor is covered with foreign

material, such as snow or water (Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning will operate normally when such foreign material are removed.)

— The weather is extremely hot or cold

— The sensor or sensor assembly is disassembled

— The surface of the sensor is pressed hard or an impact is applied with a hard object

— The surface of the sensor is scratched with a sharp object

— The sensors or its surrounding area is directly sprayed with high pressure washer

Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning is a supple- mental function. The opera- tion of Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning can be affected by several factors (including environmental con- ditions). It is the responsibility of the driver to always check the front and rear views before and while parking.

Your new vehicle warranty does not cover any accidents or damage to the vehicle due to the malfunction of Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning.

Pay close attention when driv- ing near objects, pedestrians, and especially children. Some objects may not be detected by the ultrasonic sensors, due to the objects distance, size or material, all of which can limit the effectiveness of the sensor.

WARNING

OTM070172L

3-175

Convenience features

3

Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning may malfunction when: — Heavy rain or water spray is pres-

ent — Water flows on the surface of the

sensor — Affected by another vehicles sen-

sors — The sensor is covered with snow — Driving on uneven road, gravel

roads or bushes — Objects that generates ultrasonic

waves are near the sensor — Installing the license plate differ-

ently from the original location — The vehicle bumper height or

ultrasonic sensor installation has been modified

— Attaching equipments or acces- sories around the ultrasonic sen- sors

The following objects may not be detected: — Sharp or slim objects, such as

ropes, chains or small poles. — Objects, which tend to absorb

sensor frequency, such as clothes, spongy material or snow.

— Objects smaller than 40 in. (100 cm) in length and narrower than 6 in. (14 cm) in diameter.

— Pedestrians, animals or objects that are very close to the ultra- sonic sensors

Parking Distance Warning Indicators may be displayed differ- ently from the actual detected loca- tion when the obstacle is located between the sensors.

Parking Distance Warning indica- tor may not occur sequentially depending on vehicle speed or obstacle shape.

If Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning needs repair, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

3-176

Convenience features

Surround View Monitor will assist in parking by allowing the driver to see around the vehicle.

Detecting sensor

[1] : Surround-front view camera, [2],[3] : Surround-side view camera

(under the outside rearview mirror), [4] : Surround-rear view camera

Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensors.

Surround View Monitor set- tings Camera settings

You can change Surround View Monitor Display Contents or Display Settings by touching the setup icon ( ) on the screen while Surround View Monitor is operating, or selecting Driver Assistance Parking Safety Camera Settings from the Settings menu while the engine is on.

In the Display Contents, you can change settings for Top View Parking Guidance, Rear View Parking Guidance and Parking Distance Warning.

In the Display Settings, you can change the screens Brightness and Contrast.

SURROUND VIEW MONITOR (SVM) (IF EQUIPPED)

OLX2048060

OTM070213L

OLX2051135L

OLX2041432L

OLX2041431L

3-177

Convenience features

3

Top View Parking Guidance

When the Top View Parking Guidance is selected, parking guid- ance is displayed on the right side of the Surround View Monitor screen.

You may see the front top view or the rear top view when using Top View Parking Guidance.

Rear View Parking Guidance

When the Rear View Parking Guidance is selected, parking guidance is displayed in the rear view.

The horizontal guideline of the Rear View Parking Guidance shows the distance of 1.6 ft. (0.5 m), 3.3 ft. ( 1 m) and 7.6 ft. (2.3 m) from the vehicle.

Parking Distance Warning

When the Parking Distance Warning is selected, parking dis- tance warning is displayed on the right side of the Surround View Monitor screen.

The image will be displayed only when Parking Distance Warning is warning the driver.

OTM070215L

Front top view

Rear top view

OTM070214L

OTM070216L OTM070217L

3-178

Convenience features

Surround View Monitor opera- tion Operating button

Press the Parking/View button (1) to turn on Surround View Monitor. Press the button again to turn off the function.

Other view modes can be selected by touching the view icons (2) on the Surround View Monitor screen.

When one of the infotainment sys- tem button (3) is pressed without the gear in R (Reverse), Surround View Monitor will turn off.

Front view The front image is displayed on the screen when the gear is in N (Neutral) or D (Drive) to assist in parking. The front view has a top view/front view/side view.

Operating conditions

When the gear is shifted from R (Reverse) to N (Neutral) or D (Drive), the last set mode of front view function will be selected.

Front view function will operate when the following conditions are satisfied: — While the infotainment system

screen is being displayed, press the Parking/View button (1) briefly when the gear is in D (Drive) or N (Neutral) and vehicle speed is below 9 mph (15 km/h).

OLX2048060

OLX2048061L

3-179

Convenience features

3

Surround View Monitor Auto On function will operate when the fol- lowing conditions are satisfied: — With Driver Assistance

Parking Safety Surround View Monitor Auto On selected from the Settings menu, the front park- ing assist view screen is dis- played when Parking Distance Warning warns the driver while driving in D (Drive).

Off conditions

Press the Parking/View button (1) again, the image will turn off.

When vehicle speed is above 9 mph (15 km/h) with the gear in D (Drive), Surround View Monitor will turn off and the screen will change back to the previous infotainment system screen. Although you drive below 9 mph (15 km/h) again, Surround View Monitor will not turn on.

Press one of the infotainment sys- tem button (3), the screen will change to the infotainment system screen.

Shift the gear to P (Park), the image will turn off.

Rear view The rear image is displayed on the screen when the gear is in P (Park) to assist in parking. The rear view has a top view/rear view/side view.

Operating conditions

Shift the gear to R (Reverse), the image will appear on the screen.

Press the Parking/View button (1) while the gear is in P (Park), the image will appear on the screen.

Off conditions

The image cannot be turned off when the gear is in R (Reverse).

Shift the gear from R (Reverse) to P (Park), the image will turn off.

Press the Parking/View button (1) again while the gear is in P (Park) with the image on the screen.

3-180

Convenience features

Rear View while driving The driver is able to check the rear view on the screen while driving, it is to assist with safe driving.

Operating conditions

The engine is ON. Press the Parking/View button (1)

when vehicle speed is above 9 mph (15 km/h), Rear View while driving will appear on the screen.

The ( ) icon is touched on the Surround View Monitor screen when vehicle speed is below 9 mph (15 km/h), Rear View while driving will appear on the screen.

Off conditions

Press the Parking/View button (1) again, the screen will change back to the previous infotainment sys- tem screen.

Select other view modes from the Surround View Monitor screen when vehicle speed is below 9 mph (15 km/h), Rear View while driving will turn off.

Press one of the infotainment sys- tem button (3), the screen will change to the infotainment system screen.

Shift the gear to P (Park), Rear View while driving will turn off.

Surround View Monitor mal- function and limitations Surround View Monitor malfunc- tion When Surround View Monitor is not working properly, or the screen flick- ers, or the camera image does not display normally, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Limitations of Surround View Monitor When the vehicle is stopped for a

long time in winter or when the vehicle is parked in an indoor park- ing lot, the exhaust fumes may temporarily blur the image.

The screen may be displayed abnormally, and an icon will appear at the top left side of the screen under the following circumstances: — The tailgate is opened — The driver or front passenger

door is opened — The outside rearview mirror is

folded

3-181

Convenience features

3

Information When Rear View while Driving is on, it stays on while driving regardless of vehicle speed.

When Rear View while Driving is on while backing up, the screen changes to the rear view.

i

Always keep the camera lens clean. If the lens is covered with foreign material, it may adversely affect camera per- formance and Surround View Monitor may not operate nor- mally. However, do not use chemical solvents such as strong detergents containing high alkaline or volatile organ- ic solvents (gasoline, ace- tone, etc.). This may damage the camera lens.

ALWAYS look around your vehicle to make sure there are no objects or obstacles before moving the vehicle. What you see on the screen may differ from the actual vehicles location.

The image shown on the screen may differ from the actual distance of the object. Make sure to directly check the vehicle’s surroundings for safety.

Surround View Monitor is designed to be used on a flat surface. Therefore, if used on roads with different heights such as curbs and speed bumps, the image in the screen my not look correct.

WARNING

3-182

Convenience features

Blind-Spot View Monitor displays the rear blind spot area of the vehicle in the cluster when the turn signal is turned on to help safely change lanes.

Detecting sensor

[1], [2]: Surround-side view camera (camera located at bottom of the mirror)

Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensors.

Blind-Spot View Monitor set- tings Setting features Blind-Spot View

With the engine on, select Driver Assistance Blind-Spot Safety Blind- Spot View from the Settings menu to turn on Blind-Spot View Monitor and deselect to turn off the function.

BLIND-SPOT VIEW MONITOR (BVM) (IF EQUIPPED)

OLX2051136L

OLX2041433L/OLX2041434L

Left side Right side

3-183

Convenience features

3

Blind-Spot View Monitor oper- ation Operating switch

Turn signal lever

Blind-Spot View Monitor will turn on and off when the turn signal is turned on and off.

Blind-Spot View Monitor Operating conditions

When the left or right side turn signal turns on, the image in that direction is displayed on the instrument clus- ter.

Off conditions

When the turn signal turns off, the image on the instrument cluster will turn off.

When the hazard warning flasher is on, Blind-Spot View Monitor will turn off, regardless of the turn sig- nal status.

When other important warning is displayed on the instrument clus- ter, Blind-Spot View Monitor may turn off.

Blind-Spot View Monitor mal- function When Blind-Spot View Monitor is not working properly, or the cluster dis- play flickers, or the camera image does not display normally, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

OIG046417

The image shown on the clus- ter may differ from the actual distance of the object. Make sure to directly check the vehicle’s surroundings for safety.

Always keep the camera lens clean. If the lens is covered with foreign material, it may adversely affect camera per- formance and Blind- Spot View Monitor may not operate normally.

WARNING

3-184

Convenience Features

MANUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)

OLX2048325L

Front

1. Fan speed control knob

2. Temperature control knob

3. Air conditioning button

4. Mode selection button

5. Front windshield defroster button

6. Rear window defroster button

7. Air intake control button

8. Rear climate control button

3-185

Convenience Features

3

Heating and Air Conditioning 1. Start the engine. 2. Set the mode to the desired position.

To improve the effectiveness of heat- ing and cooling, select the mode according to the following: — Heating: — Cooling:

3. Set the temperature control to the desired position.

4. Set the air intake control to Fresh mode or Recirculation mode posi- tion.

5. Set the fan speed control to the desired speed.

6. If air conditioning is desired, turn the air conditioning system on.

When starting the vehicle in cold weather a more efficient way to heat the passenger compartment is to do the following. — Turn off or lower the blower, right

after starting the engine. — Engine temperature is still low and

the air flow from the heater is still cold.

— After a few minutes of engine warm up, turn on or set the fan to a higher level and adjust the temperature set- ting to hot.

Mode selection

The mode selection button controls the direction of the air flow through the ventilation system. Air can be directed to the floor, dashboard outlets, or windshield. Five symbols are used to represent Face, Bi-Level, Floor, Floor- Defrost and Defrost air position.

OLX2049410N

3-186

Convenience Features

Face-Level (B, D)

Air flow is directed toward the upper body and face. Additionally, each outlet can be controlled to direct the air discharged from the outlet.

Bi-Level (B, C, D, E)

Air flow is directed towards the face and the floor.

Floor-Level (A, C, D, E)

Most of the air flow is directed to the floor, with a small amount of the air being directed to the windshield and side window defrosters.

Floor & Defrost (A, C, D, E)

Most of the air flow is directed to the floor and the windshield with a small amount directed to the side window defrosters.

MAX A/C-Level (B, D)

The MAX A/C mode is used to cool the inside of the vehicle faster. Air flow is directed toward the upper body and face. In this mode, the A/C button and the Recirculation mode button will be automatically selected. Turn the fan speed mode to adjust. After the interior cabin has cooled sufficiently, move the temperature knob away from the MAX A/C setting and adjust the knob to the desired position. If you wish to continue using A/C ON, make sure the A/C button LED is illu- minated.

OLX2048326L

3-187

Convenience Features

3

Instrument panel vents

The instrument panel vent air flow can be directed up/down or left/right using the vent adjustment lever. The outlet vents can be opened or closed separately using the vent control lever. If you move the vent control lever to the left end, the outlet vents can be closed.

Temperature control (2) The temperature will increase by turning the knob to the right. The temperature will decrease by turning the knob to the left.

Air intake control The air intake control button is used to select either Fresh mode (outside air) or Recirculation mode (cabin air).

Recirculation mode

When Recirculation mode is selected, air from the passenger compartment will be recirculated through the system and heated or cooled according to the function selected.

Fresh mode

When Fresh mode is selected, air enters the vehicle from outside and is heated or cooled according to the function selected.

Information Operating the system primarily in Fresh mode is recommended. Use Recirculation mode temporarily only when needed.

Prolonged operation of the heater in Recirculation mode and without the A/C ON can cause fogging of the windshield.

In addition, prolonged use of the A/C ON in Recirculation mode may result in excessively dry, dehumidified air in the cabin and may promote formation of musty vent odor due to stagnant air.

i

OLX2049306L

3-188

Convenience Features

Fan speed control (1) Turn the knob to the right to increase the fan speed and airflow. Turn the knob to the left to decrease fan speed and airflow. Setting the fan speed control knob to the «0» position turns off the fan.

Operating the fan speed when the ignition switch is in the ON posi- tion could cause the battery to discharge. Operate the fan speed when the engine is running.

Air conditioning (3) Push the A/C button to turn the sys- tem on (indicator light will illuminate) and off.

Rear climate control button

If you press the rear climate control button, rear passengers can control the rear climate system.

NOTICE

Continued use of the climate control system operation in Recirculation mode for a pro- longed period of time may cause drowsiness to the occupants in the cabin. This may lead to loss of vehicle control which may lead to an accident.

Continued use of the climate control system operation in Recirculation mode with the A/C OFF may allow humidity to increase inside the cabin. This may cause condensation to accumulate on the wind- shield and obscure visibility.

Do not sleep in your vehicle or remain parked in your vehicle with the windows up and either the heater or the air conditioning ON for pro- longed periods of time. Doing so may increase the levels of carbon dioxide in the cabin which may lead to serious injury or death.

WARNING

OLX2048327L

3-189

Convenience Features

3

Rear climate control

OLX2048328L/OLX2048329L/OLX2049337N

1. OFF button

2. Mode selection button

3. Temperature control button

4. Fan speed control button

If you press the rear climate control button of the front climate control sys- tem, rear passengers can control the rear climate system by using the rear climate control system.

2nd row air conditioning control

Type A

Type B

Type C

3-190

Convenience Features

Fan speed control

1. Press the rear climate control but- ton of the front climate control sys- tem.

2. The fan speed can be set to the desired speed by pushing the fan speed control button. The higher the fan speed is, the more air is delivered. Pressing the OFF button turns off the fan.

Temperature control 1. Press the rear climate control but-

ton of the front climate control sys- tem.

2. To turn off the 3rd row air condi- tioning control system, press the 3rd row air conditioning ON/OFF button once more located on the front climate control panel or set the fan speed to the OFF position with the 3rd row fan speed switch (indicator light on the ON/OFF button is not illuminated).

OLX2048327L

OLX2048330L

OLX2048331L

3-191

Convenience Features

3

OFF mode

Push the OFF button to turn the rear climate control system off.

Mode selection

You can select the direction of the air flow through the ventilation system. You can adjust the front climate con- trol system for heating or cooling to passengers on 2nd row seats. The air flow is directed from the floor.

: Air flow is directed toward the upper body from the rear headliner.

: Air flow is directed toward the upper body and the floor.

: Air flow is directed toward the floor.

OLX2048332L OLX2048313

3-192

Convenience Features

Rear vents on the headliner The rear passengers can adjust the direction of air flow from the rear vents on the headliner. If you operate the rear climate con- trol with rear vents closed, a noise may sound. When operating the rear climate control, open two or more rear vents.

System Operation Cooling / Ventilation 1. Select the Face Level mode. 2. Set the air intake control to fresh

mode. 3. Set the temperature control to the

desired position. 4. Set the fan speed control to the

desired speed.

Heating 1. Select the Floor Level mode. 2. Set the air intake control to fresh

mode. 3. Set the temperature control to the

desired position. 4. Set the fan speed control to the

desired speed. 5. If desired, turn the air conditioning

ON with the temperature control knob set to heat in order to dehu- midify the air before it enters into the cabin.

If the windshield fogs up, select the Floor & Defrost mode or press the Front Defrost mode.

OLX2048314

No Diffusion lever (A)

Direction thumbwheel (B)

Description

1 Open

( ) Close The air is delivered widely toward the sur- roundings of rear passengers. However, the fan speed may be decreased.

2 Open

( ) Open The air is delivered widely toward the rear passengers and surrounding of rear pas- sengers.

3

Close

( ) Open The air is only delivered toward the rear passengers.

3-193

Convenience Features

3

Operation Tips

To keep dust or unpleasant fumes from entering the vehicle through the ventilation system, temporarily set the air intake control to recircu- lation mode. Return the control to fresh mode when the unpleasant air outside has diminished.This will help keep the driver alert and com- fortable.

To help prevent the inside of the windshield from fogging, set the air intake control to fresh mode and fan speed to the desired position, turn on the air conditioning system, and adjust the temperature control to the desired temperature.

Air conditioning Your HYUNDAI vehicle air condition- ing system is filled with R-134a refrigerant. 1. Start the engine. 2. Press the air conditioning button. 3. Select the Face Level mode.

4. Set the air intake control to Recirculation mode temporarily to allow the cabin to cool quickly. When the desired temperature in the cabin is reached, change the air intake control back to Fresh mode.

5. Adjust the fan speed control and temperature control to maintain maximum comfort.

When maximum cooling is desired, set the temperature control to the MAX A/C position, then set the fan speed control to the highest setting.

When using the air conditioning system, monitor the engine tem- perature gauge closely while driv- ing up hills or in heavy traffic when outside temperatures are high. Air conditioning system operation when climbing a steep grade or in high outside ambient tempera- tures can cause engine overheat- ing. Continue to use the fan, but turn the air conditioning system off if the engine temperature gauge indicates engine overheating.

Air conditioning system operation tips

If the vehicle has been parked in direct sunlight during hot weather, open the windows for a short time to let the hot air inside the vehicle escape.

After sufficient cooling has been achieved, switch back from recircu- lation mode to fresh mode.

To help reduce moisture inside of the windows on rainy or humid days, decrease the humidity inside the vehicle by operating the air con- ditioning system with the windows and sunroof closed.

Use the air conditioning system every month only for a few minutes to ensure maximum system per- formance.

If you operate air conditioner exces- sively, the difference between the temperature of the outside air and that of the windshield could cause the outer surface of the windshield to fog up, causing loss of visibility. In this case, set the mode selection knob or button to the position and fan speed control to the lower speed.

NOTICE

3-194

Convenience Features

System Maintenance Cabin air filter

[A] : Outside air, [B] : Recirculated air [C] : Climate control air filter, [D] : Blower [E] : Evaporator core, [F] : Heater core

The cabin air filter is installed behind the glove box. It filters the dust or other pollutants that enter the vehicle through the heating and air condi- tioning system.

Have the cabin air filter replaced by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer according to the maintenance sched- ule. If the vehicle is being driven in severe conditions such as dusty or rough roads and/or if transporting pets or occupants smoke inside the vehicle, then more frequent cabin air filter inspections and changes are required. If the air flow rate suddenly decreas- es, the system should be checked at an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Checking the amount of air con- ditioner refrigerant and com- pressor lubricant When the amount of refrigerant is low, the performance of the air con- ditioning is reduced. Overfilling also reduces the performance of the air conditioning system. Therefore, if abnormal operation is found, have the system inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

It is important that the correct type and amount of oil and refrig- erant is used. Otherwise, damage to the compressor and abnormal system operation may occur. To prevent damage, the air condition- ing system in your vehicle should only be serviced by trained and certified technicians.

The refrigerant system should only be serviced by trained and certified technicians to insure proper and safe operation.

The refrigerant system should be serviced in a well-ventilated place.

The air conditioning evaporator (cooling coil) shall never be repaired or replaced with one removed from a used or sal- vaged vehicle and new replace- ment MAC evaporators shall be certified (and labeled) as meet- ing SAE Standard J2842.

NOTICE

NOTICE

OIK047401L

3-195

Convenience Features

3

Air Conditioning refrigerant label

You can find out which air condition- ing refrigerant is applied to your vehi- cle on the label located in front of engine compartment.

Each symbol and specification on the air conditioning refrigerant label is represented as below: 1. Classification of refrigerant 2. Amount of refrigerant 3. Classification of compressor lubri-

cant 4. Caution 5. Flammable refrigerant 6. To require registered technician to

service air conditioning system

Vehicles equipped with R-1234yf Since the refrigerant is operated at very high pressure, the air conditioning system should only be serv-

iced by trained and certified technicians. It is important that the correct type and amount of oil and refrigerant are used. All refrigerants should be reclaimed with proper equip- ment. Venting refrigerants directly to the atmosphere is harmful to individuals and environment. Failure to heed these warnings can lead to serious injuries.

WARNING

OHYK059001

Example

OLX2088007

3-196

Convenience Features

AUTOMATIC CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM

OLX2048300L

Front

1. Drivers temperature control knob

2. Passengers temperature control knob

3. AUTO (automatic control) button

4. SYNC button

5. OFF button

6. Front windshield defroster button

7. Air conditioning button

8. Fan speed control button

9. Mode selection button

10. Rear climate control button

11. Rear window defroster button

12. Air intake control button

13. Climate control information screen

3-197

Convenience Features

3

Automatic Temperature Control Mode The Automatic Climate Control System is controlled by setting the desired temperature. For your convenience and to improve the efficiency of the climate control, use the AUTO button and set the temperature to 72F (22C).

1. Press the AUTO button (3). The modes, fan speeds, air intake and air-conditioning will be controlled automatically by the temperature set- ting you select.

2. To select a different set point, turn the temperature control knob to the desired temperature. If the temperature is set to the lowest setting (Lo), the air conditioning system will operate continuously. After the interior has cooled suffi- ciently, adjust the knob to a higher temperature set point whenever possible.

To turn the automatic operation off, select any button of the following: — Mode selection button — Front windshield defroster button

(Press the button one more time to deselect the front windshield defroster function. The ‘AUTO’ sign will illuminate on the information display once again.)

— Fan speed control button The selected function will be con- trolled manually while other functions operate automatically.

OLX2048301

Driver side Passenger side

3-198

Convenience Features

Never place anything near the ambient light/solar sensor to ensure better control of the heat- ing and cooling system.

Manual Temperature Control Mode The heating and cooling system can be controlled manually by pushing buttons other than the AUTO button. In this case, the system works sequentially according to the order of buttons selected. When pressing any button except the AUTO button while using automatic operation, the functions not selected will be controlled automatically. 1. Start the engine. 2. Set the mode to the desired posi-

tion. To improve the effectiveness of heating and cooling, select the mode according to the following: — Heating: — Cooling:

3. Set the temperature control to the desired position.

4. Set the air intake control to Fresh mode.

5. Set the fan speed control to the desired speed.

6. If air conditioning is desired, turn the air conditioning system on.

7. Press the AUTO button to convert to full automatic control of the system.

When starting the vehicle in cold weather using manual temperature control, operate the system in the fol- lowing method to improve heating. — Turn off or lower the blower, right

after starting the engine. — Allow the engine to warm up during

this time since the air flow from the heater is still cold.

— After a few minutes of engine warm up, turn on or set the fan to a high- er level and adjust the temperature setting to hot.

NOTICE

OLX2048072

3-199

Convenience Features

3

Mode selection (9) The air flow outlet direction is cycled as follows:

Face-Level (B, D)

Air flow is directed toward the upper body and face. Additionally, each outlet can be controlled to direct the air discharged from the outlet.

Bi-Level (B, C, D, E)

Air flow is directed towards the face and the floor.

OLX2048304

The mode selection button controls the direction of the air flow through the ventilation system.

3-200

Convenience Features

Floor & Defrost (A, C, D, E)

Most of the air flow is directed to the floor and the windshield with a small amount directed to the side window defrosters.

Floor-Level (A, C, D, E)

Most of the air flow is directed to the floor, with a small amount of the air being directed to the windshield and side window defrosters.

Defrost-Level (6) (A, D)

Most of the air flow is directed to the windshield with a small amount of air directed to the side window defrosters.

Instrument panel vents

The instrument panel vent air flow can be directed up/down or left/right using the vent adjustment lever. The outlet vents can be opened or closed separately using the vent control lever. If you move the vent control lever to the left end, the outlet vents can be closed.

Temperature control

Turn the knob to the right to increase the temperature. Turn the knob to the left to decrease temperature. The temperature will increase or decrease by 1F/0.5C for each incre- mental location. When set to the low- est temperature setting, the air condi- tioning will operate continuously.

OLX2049306L OLX2048301

Driver side Passenger side

3-201

Convenience Features

3

Adjusting the driver and passenger side temperature equally

Press the «SYNC» button to oper- ate the driver and passenger side temperature equally. The passenger side temperature will be set to the same temperature as the driver side temperature.

Turn the driver side temperature control knob. The driver and pas- senger side temperature will be adjusted equally.

Adjusting the driver and passenger side temperature individually

Press the «SYNC» button again to operate the driver and passenger side temperature individually. The button indicator will turn off.

Temperature conversion

If the battery has been discharged or disconnected, the temperature mode display will reset to Fahrenheit. To change the temperature unit from F to C or C to F: — On the instrument cluster, go to

User Settings Other Temperature Unit.

— Press the AUTO button while press- ing the OFF button on the climate control unit for 3 seconds.

The temperature unit on both the cluster LCD display and climate con- trol screen will change.

Air intake control (12) The air intake control button is used to select either Fresh mode (outside air) or Recirculation mode (cabin air).

Recirculation mode

When Recirculation mode is selected, air from the passenger compartment will be recirculated through the system and heated or cooled according to the function selected.

Fresh mode

When Fresh mode is selected, air enters the vehicle from outside and is heated or cooled according to the function selected.

OLX2048307

3-202

Convenience Features

Information Operating the system primarily in Fresh mode is recommended. Use Recirculation mode temporarily only when needed.

Prolonged operation of the heater in Recirculation mode and without the A/C ON can cause fogging of the wind- shield.

In addition, prolonged use of the A/C ON in Recirculation mode may result in excessively dry, dehumidified air in the cabin and may promote formation of musty vent odor due to stagnant air.

Fan speed control (8) The fan speed can be set as desired by pushing the fan speed control but- ton. More air is delivered with higher fan speeds. Pressing the OFF button turns off the fan.

Information For better sound quality, fan speed may automatically slow down for a couple of minutes when you activate voice recognition or hands free.

Operating the fan when the igni- tion switch is in the ON position could cause the battery to dis- charge. Operate the fan when the engine is running.

NOTICE

i

i

Continued use of the climate control system operation in Recirculation mode for a pro- longed period of time may cause drowsiness to the occupants in the cabin. This may lead to loss of vehicle control which may lead to an accident.

Continued use of the climate control system operation in Recirculation mode with the A/C OFF may allow humidity to increase inside the cabin. This may cause condensation to accumulate on the wind- shield and obscure visibility.

Do not sleep in your vehicle or remain parked in your vehicle with the windows up and either the heater or the air conditioning ON for pro- longed periods of time. Doing so may increase the levels of carbon dioxide in the cabin which may lead to serious injury or death.

WARNING

3-203

Convenience Features

3

Air conditioning (7) Push the A/C button to manually turn the system on (indicator light will illu- minate) and off.

OFF mode (5) Push the OFF button to turn the cli- mate control system off. You can still operate the mode and air intake but- tons as long as the ignition switch is in the ON position.

Rear climate control button

If you press the rear climate control button, rear passengers can control the rear climate system.

OLX2048311

3-204

Convenience Features

Rear climate control

1. AUTO button

2. Temperature control button

3. Mode selection button

4. Fan speed control button

5. OFF button

6. Climate control information screen

2nd row air conditioning control

If you press the rear climate control button of the front climate control system, rear passengers can control the rear climate system by using the rear climate control system.

When you want to use the rear climate control (heating and air conditioning)

1. Press the air conditioning button of the front climate control. 2. Adjust the rear climate control (temperature, air direction and fan speed). 3. Check that «Lock Control» is not selected in the infotainment system. If «Lock Control» is selected, the rear

climate control is not adjusted in the rear climate control panel.

OLX2048318

3-205

Convenience Features

3

Fan speed control

1. Press the rear climate control but- ton of the front climate control sys- tem.

2. The fan speed can be set to the desired speed by pushing the fan speed control button. The higher the fan speed is, the more air is delivered. Pressing the OFF but- ton turns off the fan.

Temperature control 1. Press the rear climate control but-

ton of the front climate control sys- tem.

2. The temperature of delivered air can be set to the desired temper- ature by pushing the temperature control button. Pressing the OFF button turns off the fan.

OLX2048311

OLX2048323

OLX2048324

3-206

Convenience Features

AUTO mode

The rear automatic climate control system is controlled by setting the desired temperature. 1. Press the AUTO button. The

modes, fan speeds, air intake and air-conditioning will be controlled automatically by the temperature setting you select.

2. Press the temperature control but- ton to the desired temperature.

OFF mode Push the OFF button (5) to turn the rear climate control system off.

Mode selection

You can select the direction of the air flow through the ventilation system. You can adjust the front climate con- trol system for heating or cooling to passengers on 2nd row seats. The air flow is directed from the floor.

: Air flow is directed toward the upper body from the rear headliner.

: Air flow is directed toward the upper body and the floor.

: Air flow is directed toward the floor.

OLX2048313

OLX2048319

OLX2048334L

3-207

Convenience Features

3

Rear vents on the headliner The rear passengers can adjust the direction of air flow from the rear vents on the headliner. If you operate the rear climate con- trol with rear vents closed, a noise may sound. When operating the rear climate control, open two or more rear vents.

System Operation Cooling / Ventilation 1. Select the Face Level mode. 2. Set the air intake control to fresh

mode. 3. Set the temperature control to the

desired position. 4. Set the fan speed control to the

desired speed.

Heating 1. Select the Floor Level mode. 2. Set the air intake control to fresh

mode. 3. Set the temperature control to the

desired position. 4. Set the fan speed control to the

desired speed. 5. If desired, turn the air conditioning

ON with the temperature control knob set to heat in order to dehu- midify the air before it enters into the cabin.

If the windshield fogs up, select the Floor & Defrost mode or press the Front Defrost mode.

OLX2048314

No Diffusion lever (A)

Direction thumbwheel (B)

Description

1 Open

( ) Close The air is delivered widely toward the sur- roundings of rear passengers. However, the fan speed may be decreased.

2 Open

( ) Open The air is delivered widely toward the rear passengers and surrounding of rear pas- sengers.

3

Close

( ) Open The air is only delivered toward the rear passengers.

3-208

Convenience Features

Operation Tips

To keep dust or unpleasant fumes from entering the car through the ventilation system, temporarily set the air intake control to the recircu- lation mode. Return the control to the to fresh mode when the unpleasant air outside has dimin- ished. This will help keep the driver alert and comfortable.

To help prevent the inside of the windshield from fogging, set the air intake control to fresh mode and the fan speed to the desired posi- tion, turn on the air conditioning system, and adjust the temperature control to the desired temperature.

Air conditioning Your HYUNDAI vehicle air condition- ing system is filled with R-134a refrigerant. 1. Start the engine. 2. Press the air conditioning button. 3. Select the Face Level mode.

4. Set the air intake control to Recirculation mode temporarily to allow the cabin to cool quickly. When the desired temperature in the cabin is reached, change the air intake control back to Fresh mode.

5. Adjust the fan speed control and temperature control to maintain maximum comfort.

When maximum cooling is desired, set the temperature control to the MAX A/C position, then set the fan speed control to the highest setting.

When using the air conditioning system, monitor the engine tem- perature gauge closely while driv- ing up hills or in heavy traffic when outside temperatures. Air conditioning system operation when climbing a steep grade or in high outside ambient tempera- tures can cause engine overheat- ing. Continue to use the fan, but turn the air conditioning system off if the engine temperature gauge indicates engine overheat- ing.

Air conditioning system operation tips

If the vehicle has been parked in direct sunlight during hot weather, open the windows for a short time to let the hot air inside the vehicle escape.

After sufficient cooling has been achieved, switch back from recircu- lation mode to fresh mode.

To help reduce moisture inside of the windows on rainy or humid days, decrease the humidity inside the vehicle by operating the air conditioning system with the win- dows and sunroof closed.

Use the air conditioning system every month only for a few minutes to ensure maximum system per- formance.

If you operate air conditioner excessively, the difference between the temperature of the outside air and that of the windshield could cause the outer surface of the windshield to fog up, causing loss of visibility. In this case, set the mode selection knob or button to the position and fan speed control to the lower speed.

NOTICE

3-209

Convenience Features

3

System Maintenance Cabin air filter

[A] : Outside air, [B] : Recirculated air [C] : Climate control air filter, [D] : Blower [E] : Evaporator core, [F] : Heater core

The cabin air filter is installed behind the glove box. It filters the dust or other pollutants that enter the vehicle through the heating and air condi- tioning system.

Have the cabin air filter replaced by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer according to the maintenance sched- ule. If the vehicle is being driven in severe conditions such as dusty or rough roads and/or if transporting pets or occupants smoke inside the vehicle, then more frequent cabin air filter inspections and changes are required. If the air flow rate suddenly decreas- es, the system should be checked at an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Checking the amount of air con- ditioner refrigerant and com- pressor lubricant When the amount of refrigerant is low, the performance of the air con- ditioning is reduced. Overfilling also reduces the performance of the air conditioning system. Therefore, if abnormal operation is found, have the system inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

It is important that the correct type and amount of oil and refrig- erant is used. Otherwise, damage to the compressor and abnormal system operation may occur. To prevent damage, the air condition- ing system in your vehicle should only be serviced by trained and certified technicians.

The refrigerant system should only be serviced by trained and certified technicians to insure proper and safe operation.

The refrigerant system should be serviced in a well-ventilated place.

The air conditioning evaporator (cooling coil) shall never be repaired or replaced with one removed from a used or sal- vaged vehicle and new replace- ment MAC evaporators shall be certified (and labeled) as meet- ing SAE Standard J2842.

NOTICE

NOTICE

OIK047401L

3-210

Convenience Features

Air Conditioning refrigerant label

You can find out which air condition- ing refrigerant is applied to your vehi- cle on the label located in front of engine compartment.

Each symbol and specification on the air conditioning refrigerant label is represented as below: 1. Classification of refrigerant 2. Amount of refrigerant 3. Classification of compressor lubri-

cant 4. Caution 5. Flammable refrigerant 6. To require registered technician to

service air conditioning system

Vehicles equipped with R-1234yf Since the refrigerant is operated at very high pressure, the air conditioning system should only be serv-

iced by trained and certified technicians. It is important that the correct type and amount of oil and refrigerant are used. All refrigerants should be reclaimed with proper equip- ment. Venting refrigerants directly to the atmosphere is harmful to individuals and environment. Failure to heed these warnings can lead to serious injuries.

WARNING

OHYK059001

Example

OLX2088007

3-211

Convenience Features

3

For maximum defrost perform- ance, set the temperature control knob to the highest temperature setting (rotated all the way to the right) and the fan speed control to the highest setting.

If warm air to the floor is desired while defrosting or defogging, set the mode to the floor-defrost position.

Before driving, clear all snow and ice from the windshield, rear win- dow, side view mirrors, and all side windows.

Clear all snow and ice from the hood and air inlet in the cowl grill to improve heater and defroster effi- ciency and to reduce the probability of fogging up the inside of the wind- shield.

If the engine temperature is still cold after starting, then a brief engine warm up period may be required for the vented air flow to become warm or hot.

Manual Climate Control System

To defog inside windshield

1. Select any fan speed except «0» position.

2. Select the desired temperature. 3. Select the or position. 4. Fresh mode will be selected auto-

matically. Additionally, the air condi- tioning will automatically operate if the mode is selected to the position.

Check to make sure the A/C is ON. If the A/C ON LED is not illuminated, press the A/C button once to turn the air conditioner ON.

NOTICE

WINDSHIELD DEFROSTING AND DEFOGGING

Windshield heating

Do not use the or posi- tion during cooling operation in extremely humid weather. The difference between the temper- ature of the outside air and that of the windshield could cause the outer surface of the wind- shield to fog up, causing loss of visibility could cause an acci- dent resulting in serious injury or death. In this case, set the mode selection knob or button to the position and fan speed control knob or button to a lower speed.

WARNING

OLX2048335L

3-212

Convenience Features

3

Check to make sure the air intake control is in Fresh mode. If the air intake control LED is illuminated, press the button once to enable Fresh mode (LED OFF).

To defrost outside windshield

1. Set the fan speed to the highest setting (knob rotated all the way to the right).

2. Set the temperature control to the highest temperature setting.

3. Select the position. 4. Fresh mode (Recirculation OFF)

and A/C ON will automatically be selected.

Automatic Temperature Control System (if equipped)

To defog inside windshield

1. Select the desired fan speed. 2. Select the desired temperature. 3. Press the defroster button ( ). 4. Fresh mode will be selected auto-

matically. Check to make sure the air intake control is in Fresh mode. If the air intake control LED is illuminated, press the button once to enable Fresh mode (LED OFF). If the position is selected, the fan speed is automatically increased.

To defrost outside windshield

1. Set the fan speed to the highest position.

2. Set the temperature to the extreme hot (HI) position.

3. Press the defroster button ( ). 4. The outside (fresh) air position will

be selected automatically. If the position is selected, lower fan speed is adjusted to a higher fan speed.

OLX2048336L

OLX2048320

OLX2048321

3-213

Convenience Features

3

Defogging logic To reduce the probability of fogging up the inside of the windshield, the air intake or air conditioning are con- trolled automatically according to certain conditions such as or positions. To cancel or reset the defogging logic, do the following.

Manual climate control system

1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.

2. Press the defroster button ( ). 3. Press the air intake control button

at least 5 times within 3 seconds. The LED indicator on the air intake button will blink 3 times to indicate that the defogging logic has been disabled. Repeat the steps again to re-enable the defogging logic.

If the battery has been discharged or disconnected, it resets to the defog logic status.

Automatic climate control system

1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.

2. Press the defroster button ( ). 3. While pressing the air conditioning

button (A/C), press the air intake control button at least 5 times within 3 seconds.

The Automatic Climate Control infor- mation screen will blink 3 times to indicate that the defogging logic has been disabled. Repeat the steps again to re-enable the defogging logic.

If the battery has been discharged or disconnected, it resets to the defog logic status.

Auto Defogging System (Additional Feature with Automatic Temperature Control System) (if equipped)

Auto defogging helps reduce the pos- sibility of fogging up the inside of the windshield by automatically sensing the moisture on inside the windshield. The auto defogging system operates when the heater or air conditioning is on.

Information The auto defogging system may not operate normally, when the outside temperature is below 14 F (-10 C).

i

OLX2049322N

3-214

Convenience Features

When the Auto Defogging System operates, the indi- cator will illuminate.

If a high amount of humidity is detected in the vehicle, the Auto Defogging System will be enabled. The following steps will be performed automatically: Step 1) The A/C button will turn ON. Step 2) The air intake control will

change to Fresh mode. Step 3) The mode will be changed to

defrost to direct airflow to the windshield.

Step 4) The fan speed will be set to MAX.

If the air conditioning is off or recircu- lated air position is manually select- ed while Auto Defogging System is ON, the Auto Defogging System Indicator will blink 3 times to signal that the manual operation has been canceled.

To cancel or reset the Auto Defogging System

Press the front windshield defroster button for 3 seconds when the igni- tion switch is in the ON position. When the Auto Defogging System is canceled, the ADS OFF symbol will blink 3 times and ADS OFF will be displayed on the climate control information screen. When the Auto Defogging System is reset, the ADS OFF symbol will blink 6 times without a signal.

Information When the air conditioning is turned

on by Auto defogging system, if you try to turn off the air conditioning, the indicator will blink 3 times and the air conditioning will not be turned off.

To maintain the effectiveness and efficiency of the Auto Defogging System, do not select Recirculation mode while the system is operating.

When the Auto Defogging System is operating, the fan speed adjustment button, the temperature adjustment knob, and the air intake control but- ton are all disabled.

Do not remove the sensor cover located on the upper end of the windshield glass. Damage to system parts could occur and may not be covered by your vehicle warranty.

NOTICE

i

3-215

Convenience Features

3

Rear Window Defroster

To prevent damage to the rear window defroster conducting ele- ments bonded to the inside sur- face of the rear window, never use sharp instruments or window cleaners containing abrasives to clean the window.

If you want to defrost and defog the front windshield, refer to the «Windshield Defrosting and Defogging» section in this chapter.

The defroster heats the window to remove frost, fog and thin ice from the interior and exterior of the rear win- dow, while the engine is running.

To activate the rear window defroster, press the rear window defroster button located in the center control panel. The indicator on the rear window defroster button illumi- nates when the defroster is ON.

To turn off the defroster, press the rear window defroster button again.

Information If there is heavy accumulation of

snow on the rear window, brush it off before operating the rear defroster.

The rear window defroster automat- ically turns off after approximately 20 minutes or when the ignition switch is in the LOCK/OFF posi- tion.

Side view mirror defroster If your vehicle is equipped with the side view mirror defrosters, they will operate at the same time you turn on the rear window defroster.

i

NOTICE

3-216

Convenience Features

Cluster ionizer (if equipped) When the ignition switch is in the ON position, the clean air function turns on automatically. Also, the clean air function turns off automatically, when the ignition switch is in the OFF position.

Automatic Ventilation (if equipped) When the ignition switch is in the ON position or when the engine is run- ning and temperature is below 59F (15C) with the recirculation mode selected more than three to five min- utes, the air intake position will auto- matically change to fresh mode.

To cancel or reset the Automatic Ventilation

When the air conditioning system is on, select Face Level mode and press the recirculation mode button five times within three seconds while pressing A/C button. When the Automatic Ventilation fea- ture is enabled, the recirculation but- ton LED indicator will blink 6 times. When the Automatic Ventilation fea- ture is disabled, the recirculation but- ton LED indicator will blink 3 times.

Sunroof Inside Air Recirculation (if equipped) When the sunroof is opened, outside (fresh) air will be automatically selected. At this time, if you press the air intake control button, recirculated air position will be selected but will change back to outside (fresh) air after 3 minutes. When the sunroof is closed, the air intake position will return to the original position that was selected.

CLIMATE CONTROL ADDITIONAL FEATURES

3-217

Convenience Features

3

STORAGE COMPARTMENT

To avoid possible theft, do not leave valuables in the storage compartments.

Center Console Storage

To open : Grab and hold the latch (1) on the arm rest then lift the lid.

Glove Box

To open: Pull the lever (1).

NOTICE

Never store cigarette lighters, propane cylinders, or other flammable/explosive materials in the vehicle. These items may catch fire and/or explode if the vehicle is exposed to hot tem- peratures for extended periods.

WARNING

ALWAYS keep the storage com- partment covers closed secure- ly while driving. Items inside your vehicle are moving as fast as the vehicle. If you have to stop or turn quickly, or if there is a crash, the items may fly out of the compartment and may cause an injury if they strike the driver or a passenger.

WARNING

ALWAYS close the glove box door after use. An open glove box door can cause serious injury to the pas- senger in an accident, even if the passenger is wearing a seat belt.

WARNING

OLX2049073L OLX2048075L

3-218

Convenience Features

Luggage Tray (if equipped)

You can place a first aid kit, a reflec- tor triangle (front tray), tools, etc. in the box for easy access. Grasp the handle on the top of the

cover and lift it.

OLX2048076

3-219

Convenience Features

3

Cup Holder Front

Cups or small beverages cups may be placed in the cup holders.

Push the button and the cover opens. Push the buttons and the cup supporter protrudes from the front console. Push in the cup supporter securely after use.

Rear (2nd row, 3rd row)

Cups or small beverages cups may be placed in the cup holders.

INTERIOR FEATURES

OLX2048077

OLX2048078

Do not place thin objects (coin, card etc.) on the cover. These may fall into the inside when the cover is operated.

CAUTION

OLX2048079

Rear (2nd row)

OLX2048080

Rear (3rd row)

3-220

Convenience Features

Rear (2nd row, 8 passengers vehicle)

Pull the armrest down to use the cup holders.

Keep your drinks sealed while driving to prevent spilling your drink. If liquid spills, it may get into the vehicle’s electrical/elec- tronic system and damage elec- trical/electronic parts.

When cleaning spilled liquids do not use hot air to blow out or dry the cup holder. This may dam- age the interior.

NOTICE

Keep cans or bottles out of direct sun light and do not put them in a hot vehicle. It may explode.

WARNING

Do not place uncovered or unsecured cups, bottles, cans, etc., in the cup holder containing hot liquid while the vehicle is in motion. Injuries may result in the event of a sudden stop or collision.

Only use soft cups in the cup holders. Hard objects can injure you in an accident.

Avoid abrupt starting and braking when the cup holder is in use to prevent spilling your drink. If hot liquid spills, you could be burned. Such a burn to the driver could cause loss of vehicle control result- ing in an accident.

WARNING

OLX2048097

3-221

Convenience Features

3

Conversation mirror

You can see widely the rear view through the conversation mirror. To open: Press the cover and the holder will slowly open. To close: Push back into position.

Sunvisor

To use the sunvisor, pull it down- ward. To use the sunvisor to block the sun from the side window, pull it down- ward, release it from the bracket (1) and swing it to the side towards the window (2). To use the vanity mirror, pull down the sunvisor and slide the mirror cover (3). Adjust the sunvisor forward or back- ward (4) as needed. Use the ticket holder (5) to hold tickets.

Close the vanity mirror cover secure- ly and return the sunvisor to its origi- nal position after use.

Do not put several tickets in the ticket holder at one time. This could cause damage to the ticket holder.

NOTICE

For your safety, do not block your view when using the sunvi- sor.

WARNING

ODH047359OLX2048074L

3-222

Convenience Features

Power Outlet

The power outlet is designed to pro- vide power for mobile telephones or other devices designed to operate with vehicle electrical systems. The devices should draw less than 180 W with the engine running.

To prevent damage to the Power Outlets : Use the power outlet only when

the engine is running and remove the accessory plug after use. Using the accessory plug for prolonged periods of time with the engine off could cause the battery to discharge.

Only use 12V electric acces- sories which are less than 180 W in electric capacity.

Adjust the air-conditioner or heater to the lowest operating level when using the power outlet.

Close the cover when not in use.

NOTICE OLX2049411L

Avoid electrical shocks. Do not place your fingers or foreign objects (pin, etc.) into a power outlet or touch the power outlet with a wet hand.

WARNING

OLX2048081

Front

OLX2048082

Rear (2nd row)

OLX2049083N

Center console storage

Rear (3rd row, left side)

3-223

Convenience Features

3

Some electronic devices can cause electronic interference when plugged into a vehicle’s power outlet.These devices may cause excessive audio static and malfunctions in other elec- tronic systems or devices used in your vehicle.

Push the plug in as far as it will go. If good contact is not made, the plug may overheat and the fuse may open.

Plug in battery equipped electri- cal/electronic devices with reverse current protection. The current from the battery may flow into the vehicle’s electri- cal/electronic system and cause system malfunction.

AC Inverter (if equipped)

The AC inverter supplies 115V/150W electric power to operate electric accessories or equipments.

Information Rated voltage : AC 115V

Maximum electric power : 150W

In order to avoid an electrical sys- tem failure, electric shock, etc., be sure to read owner’s manual before use.

Be sure to close the cover except the time of use.

i OLX2049088N OUMA046410

3-224

Convenience Features

To prevent the battery from being discharged, do not use the AC inverter while the engine is not running.

When not using the AC inverter, make sure to close the AC invert- er cover.

After using an electric accessory or equipment, pull the plug out. Leaving the accessory or equip- ment plugged in for a long time may cause battery discharge.

Do not use an electric accessory or equipment the power con- sumption of which is greater than 150W (115V).

Some electric accessories or equipments can cause electron- ic interference. It may cause excessive audio noise and mal- functions in other electric sys- tems or devices in the vehicle.

Do not use broken electric accessories or equipments, which may damage the AC inverter and electrical systems of the vehicle.

Do not use two or more electric accessories or equipments at the same time. It may cause damage to the electrical sys- tems of the vehicle.

When the input voltage is lower, outlet LED will blink and the AC inverter will turn off automatical- ly. If the input voltage goes up to normal, the AC inverter will turn on again.

NOTICE

To reduce a risk of serious or fatal injuries: Do not use a heated electric

device such as a coffeepot, toaster, heater, iron, etc.

Do not insert foreign objects into the outlet and do not touch the outlet as you may get shocked.

Do not let children touch the AC inverter.

WARNING

3-225

Convenience Features

3

USB Charger (if equipped)

The battery charging state may be monitored on the electrical device. Disconnect the USB cable from the USB port after use.

OLX2048084

Front

OLX2049085N

Rear (2nd row)

The USB charger is designed to recharge batteries of small size electrical devices using a USB cable. The electrical devices can be recharged when the ignition switch is ON. Insert the USB charger into the USB port, and re-charge a smart phone or a tablet PC.

OLX2048086L

Rear (3rd row, left side)

Center console storage

OLX2048087L

Rear (3rd row, right side)

OLX2049412L

3-226

Convenience Features

A smart phone or a tablet PC may get warmer during the re-charging process. It does not indicate any malfunction with the charging sys- tem.

A smart phone or a tablet PC, which adopts a different re-charg- ing method, may not be properly re-charged. In this case, use an exclusive charger of your device.

The charging terminal is only to recharge a device. Do not use the charging terminal either to turn ON an audio or to play media.

Wireless Cellular Phone Charging System (if equipped)

[A]: Indicator light, [B]: Charging pad

On certain models, the vehicle comes equipped with a wireless cel- lular phone charger. The system is available when all doors are closed, and when the igni- tion switch is ON.

To charge a cellular phone The wireless cellular phone charging system charges only the Qi-enabled cellular phones ( ). Read the label on the cellular phone accessory cover or visit your cellular phone manufacturer’s website to check whether your cellular phone supports the Qi technology. The wireless charging process starts when you put a Qi-enabled cellular phone on the wireless charging unit.

1. Remove other items, including the smart key, from the wireless charg- ing unit. If not, the wireless charg- ing process may be interrupted. Place the cellular phone on the center of the charging pad ( ).

2. The indicator light is orange when the cellular phone is charging. The indicator light turns green when phone charging is complete.

3. You can turn ON or OFF the wire- less charging function in the user settings mode on the instrument cluster. For further information, refer to the «LCD Display Modes» in this chapter.

OLX2048089L

3-227

Convenience Features

3

If your cellular phone is not charging: — Slightly change the position of the

cellular phone on the charging pad.

— Make sure the indicator light is orange.

The indicator light will blink orange for 10 seconds if there is a malfunction in the wireless charging system. In this case, temporarily stop the charging process, and re-attempt to charge your cellular phone again. The system warns you with a mes- sage on the LCD display if the cellular phone is still on the wireless charging unit after the engine is turned OFF and the front door is opened.

Information For some manufacturers’ cellular phones, the system may not warn you even though the cellular phone is left on the wireless charging unit. This is due to the particular characteristic of the cellular phone and not a malfunc- tion of the wireless charging.

The wireless cellular phone charging system may not sup- port certain cellular phones, which are not verified for the Qi specification ( ).

When placing your cellular phone on the charging mat, position the phone in the middle of the mat for optimal charging performance. If your cell phone is off to the side, the charging rate may be less and in some cases the cell phone may experi- ence higher heat conduction.

In some cases, the wireless charging may stop temporarily when the Remote Key or Smart Key is used, either when starting the vehicle or locking/unlocking the doors, etc.

When charging certain cellular phones, the charging indicator may not change to green when the cell phone is fully charged.

The wireless charging process may temporarily stop, when tem- perature abnormally increases inside the wireless cellular phone charging system. Stop the charg- ing cellular phone and wait until temperature falls to a certain level.

The wireless charging process may temporarily stop when there is any metallic item, such as a coin, between the wireless cellular phone charging system and the cellular phone.

When charging some cellular phones with a self-protection fea- ture, the wireless charging speed may decrease and the wireless charging may stop.

If the cellular phone has a thick cover, the wireless charging may not be possible.

If the cell phone is not completely contacting the charging pad, wire- less charging may not operate properly.

Some magnetic items like credit cards, phone cards or rail tickets may be damaged if left with the cellular phone during the charging process.

NOTICE

i

3-228

Convenience Features

When any cellular phone without a wireless charging function or a metallic object is placed on the charging pad, a small noise may sound. This small sound is due to the vehicle discerning compatibil- ity of the object placed on the charging pad. It does not affect your vehicle or the cellular phone in any way.

Information If the ignition switch is in the OFF position, the charging also stops.

Information This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules.

Operation is subject to the following two conditions:

1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and

2. This device must accept any inter- ference received, including interfer- ence that may cause undesired operation.

Clock

You can set the time through info- tainment system.

Coat Hook

These hangers are not designed to hold large or heavy items.

i

i OTM048095

Do not attempt to adjust the clock while driving. Doing so may result in distracted driving which may lead to an accident involving personal injury or death.

WARNING

3-229

Convenience Features

3

Floor Mat Anchor(s) ALWAYS use the Floor Mat Anchors to attach the floor mats to the vehi- cle. The anchors on the front floor carpet keep the floor mats from slid- ing forward.

Do not hang other objects such as hangers or hard objects except clothes. Also, do not put heavy, sharp or breakable objects in the clothes pockets. In an accident or when the cur- tain air bag is inflated, it may cause vehicle damage or per- sonal injury.

WARNING

OTM048096

Do not overlay additional mats or liners over the floor mats. If using All Weather mats, remove the carpeted floor mats before installing them. Only use floor mats designed to connect to the anchors.

WARNING

The following must be observed when installing ANY floor mat to the vehicle. Ensure that the floor mats are

securely attached to the vehi- cle’s floor mat anchor(s) before driving the vehicle.

Do not use ANY floor mat that cannot be firmly attached to the vehicle’s floor mat anchors.

Do not stack floor mats on top of one another (e.g. all-weath- er rubber mat on top of a car- peted floor mat). Only a single floor mat should be installed in each position.

IMPORTANT — Your vehicle was manufactured with drivers side floor mat anchors that are designed to securely hold the floor mat in place. To avoid any interference with pedal opera- tion, HYUNDAI recommends that the HYUNDAI floor mat designed for use in your vehicle be installed.

WARNING

3-230

Convenience Features

Luggage Net Holder (if equipped) To keep items from shifting in the lug- gage compartment, you can use the 4 holders located in the luggage board to attach the luggage net. Make sure the luggage net is secure- ly attached to the holders in the lug- gage board.

Cargo Security Screen (if equipped)

Use the cargo security screen to cover items stored in the cargo area.

To use the cargo security screen

1. Pull the cargo security screen towards the rear of the vehicle by the handle (1).

2. Insert the guide pin (2) into the guide (3).

Information Pull out the cargo security screen with the handle in the center to prevent the guide pin from falling out of the guide.

i

OLX2048403L

OLX2048402LAvoid eye injury. DO NOT over- stretch the luggage net. ALWAYS keep your face and body out of the luggage net’s recoil path. DO NOT use the luggage net when the strap has visible signs of wear or damage. Use the luggage net to keep only light items from shifting in the luggage compartment.

WARNING

3

3-231

Convenience Features

3

When the cargo security screen is not in use:

1. Pull the cargo security screen backward and up to release it from the guides.

2. The cargo security screen will automatically slide back in.

Information The cargo security screen may not automatically slide back in if the cargo security screen is not fully pulled out. Pull the cargo screen out all the way and then slowly allow the screen to retract back into the mecha- nism.

To remove the cargo security screen 1. Push one side of the cargo screen

inward to compress the spring mechanism and release the screen from the vehicle.

2. While the mechanism is com- pressed, pull out the cargo securi- ty screen.

3. Open the luggage tray and keep the cargo security screen in the tray.

To remove the cargo security screen from the luggage tray

1. Pull up the screen board.

2. Push in the guide pin.

i

OTLE055152

OTLE055153

3-232

Convenience Features

3. While pushing the guide pin, pull out the cargo security screen.

Since the cargo security screen may be damaged or malformed, do not put luggage on it when it is used.

Side Curtain (if equipped)

To use the side curtain: 1. Lift the curtain by the curtain knob

(1). 2. Hang the curtain on both sides of

the hook.

NOTICE

Do not place objects on the cargo security screen. Such objects may be thrown about inside the vehicle and possi- bly injure vehicle occupants during an accident or when braking.

Never allow anyone to ride in the luggage compartment. It is designed for luggage only.

Maintain the balance of the vehicle and locate the weight as forward as possible.

WARNING

OLX2048090

OTLE055154

3-233

Convenience Features

3

Always hang both sides of the curtain on the hook. This could cause damage to the side curtain if only one side of the curtain is hooked.

Do not let any foreign material get in between the vehicle and side curtain. The side curtain may not be lifted up.

Do not hang other objects except the side curtain.

When using the side curtain and turning it back into place, pulling the curtain or applying force may cause damage to the side curtain. When lower- ing the curtain, be sure to place the curtain knob down- ward in that state and slowly return it to the position.

CAUTION

3-234

Convenience Features

Roof Side Rails (if equipped)

If your vehicle comes equipped with roof side rails, then roof rack cross- bars can be installed on top of your vehicle. The roof rack crossbars are an accessory and are available at your local HYUNDAI dealer.

If the vehicle is equipped with a sunroof, be sure not to position cargo onto the roof rack in such a way that it could interfere with sunroof operation.

When carrying cargo on the roof rack, take the necessary precau- tions to make sure the cargo does not damage the roof of the vehicle.

When carrying large objects on the roof rack, make sure they do not exceed the overall roof length or width.

NOTICE

NOTICE

EXTERIOR FEATURES

The following specification is the maximum weight that can be loaded onto the roof rack. Distribute the load as evenly as possible onto the roof rack and secure the load firmly. Loading cargo or luggage in excess of the specified weight limit on the roof rack may damage your vehicle.

The vehicle center of gravity will be higher when items are loaded onto the roof rack. Avoid sudden starts, braking, sharp turns, abrupt maneuvers or high speeds that may result in loss of vehicle control or rollover resulting in an accident.

Always drive slowly and turn corners carefully when carry- ing items on the roof rack. Severe wind updrafts, caused by passing vehicles or natural causes, can cause sudden upward pressure on items loaded on the roof rack. This is especially true when carry- ing large, flat items such as wood panels or mattresses. This could cause the items to fall off the roof rack and cause damage to your vehicle or others around you.

To prevent damage or loss of cargo while driving, check fre- quently before or while driving to make sure the items on the roof rack are securely fastened.

WARNING

ROOF 220 lbs. (100kg) RACK EVENLY DISTRIBUTED

OLX2048091

Multimedia System

Infotainment System……………………………………….4-2 USB Port ……………………………………………………………………4-2 Antenna …………………………………………………………………….4-2 Steering Wheel Audio Controls………………………………..4-3 Bluetooth Wireless Technology …………………………….4-4 Audio (Display Audio) / Video / Navigation System (AVN)………………………………………….4-4

4

4-2

Multimedia System

If you install an aftermarket HID head lamp, your vehicle’s audio and electronic devices may not function properly.

Prevent chemicals such as per- fume, cosmetic oil, sun cream, hand cleaner, and air freshener from contacting the interior parts because they may cause damage or discoloration.

USB port

You can use a USB port to plug in a USB device.

Information When using a portable audio device connected to the power outlet, noise may occur during playback. If this happens, use the portable audio device’s power source.

Antenna Pole antenna (if equipped)

Your vehicle uses a roof antenna to receive AM or/and FM broadcast sig- nals. This antenna pole is removable. To remove the roof antenna pole, turn it counterclockwise. To install the roof antenna pole, turn it clockwise.

Before entering a place with a low height clearance or a car wash, remove the antenna pole by rotat- ing it counterclockwise. If not, the antenna may be damaged.

NOTICE

i

NOTICE

INFOTAINMENT SYSTEM

OLX2048404L

OLX2048093L

When reinstalling your roof anten- na, it is important that it is fully tightened and adjusted to the upright position to ensure proper reception.

When cargo is loaded on the roof rack, do not place the cargo near the antenna pole to ensure proper reception.

Shark fin antenna (if equipped)

The shark fin antenna will receive the AM, FM broadcast signals and trans- mit data.

Steering Wheel Audio Control

Do not operate multiple audio remote control buttons simultane- ously.

VOLUME (VOL + / — ) (1) Press the VOLUME (+) switch up

to increase volume. Press the VOLUME (-) switch down

to decrease volume.

SEEK/PRESET ( / ) (2) If the SEEK/PRESET switch is pressed up or down and held for 0.8 second or more, it will function in the following modes:

RADIO mode

It will function as the AUTO SEEK select button. It will SEEK until you release the button.

MEDIA mode

It will function as the FF/RW button.

If the SEEK/PRESET switch is pressed up or down, it will function in the following modes:

RADIO mode

It will function as the PRESET STA- TION UP/DOWN button.

MEDIA mode

It will function as the TRACK UP/ DOWN button.

NOTICE

4-3

M ultim

edia System

4

OLX2048092

OTM048402

4-4

Multimedia System

MODE (3) Press the MODE button to select Radio and Media.

MUTE ( ) (4) Press the MUTE button to mute the

sound. Press the MUTE button again to

activate the sound.

Information Detailed information for audio control buttons are described in the separately supplied manual with the vehicle.

Bluetooth Wireless Technology

(1) Call / Answer button (2) Call end button (3) Microphone

Detailed information for the Bluetooth hands-free is described in a separate- ly supplied manual with the vehicle.

Audio (Display Audio) / Video / Navigation System (if equipped) Detailed information for the Audio/Video/Navigation system is described in a separately supplied manual with the vehicle.

i OTM048404

OLX2049094L

Driving your vehicle

5

Before driving…………………………………………………5-5 Before Entering the Vehicle …………………………………….5-5 Before Starting …………………………………………………………5-5

Ignition switch ………………………………………………..5-7 Key Ignition Switch …………………………………………………..5-7 Engine Start/Stop Button ………………………………………5-10

Automatic transmission…………………………………5-15 Automatic transmission operation ………………………..5-15 Parking…………………………………………………………………….5-18 LCD display message………………………………………………5-19 Good driving practices …………………………………………..5-20 Paddle Shifter (Manual Shift Mode) ……………………..5-22

Braking system ……………………………………………5-23 Power Brakes………………………………………………………….5-23 Disc Brakes Wear Indicator ……………………………………5-24 Electronic Parking Brake (EPB)……………………………..5-24 Auto Hold ………………………………………………………………..5-29 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) ………………………………5-33 Electronic Stability Control (ESC)…………………………..5-35 Vehicle Stability Management (VSM)…………………….5-38 Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC) ………………………………5-39 Downhill Brake Control (DBC) ……………………………….5-39 Trailer Stability Assist (TSA)…………………………………..5-42 Good Braking Practices …………………………………………5-42

All Wheel Drive (AWD) ………………………………….5-43 AWD Operation ……………………………………………………….5-44 LCD display message………………………………………………5-47 Emergency Precautions………………………………………….5-48

ISG (Idle Stop and Go) system………………………5-50 To Activate the ISG System ……………………………………5-50 To Deactivate the ISG System ………………………………5-53 ISG System Malfunction…………………………………………5-53 Calibrating the Battery Sensor………………………………5-54

Drive Mode Integrated Control System (2WD)……………………………………………….5-55

Drive Mode ……………………………………………………………..5-55 Drive mode integrated control system (AWD) ..5-59

Drive Mode ……………………………………………………………..5-59 Forward collision-avoidance assist (FCA) (Sensor Fusion)…………………………………………….5-63

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist settings ………..5-64 Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist operation ……5-66 Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist malfunction and limitations…………………………………………………………5-70

Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) …………………………..5-78 Lane Keeping Assist settings ………………………………..5-78 Lane Keeping Assist operation ………………………………5-80 Lane Keeping Assist malfunction and limitations …5-82

5

Blind-spot Collison Warning (BCW) ………………5-85 Blind-Spot Collision Warning settings settings …….5-86 Blind-Spot Collision Warning operation ……………….5-89 Blind-Spot Collision Warning malfunction and limitations ………………………………………………………………..5-90

Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist (BCA)..5-96 Blind-Spot Collision Warning settings …………………..5-98 Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist operation……………………………………………………………….5-101 Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist malfunction and limitations ………………………………….5-105

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning (RCCW) ………………………………………..5-111

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning settings ……5-112 Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning operation…5-113 Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning malfunction and limitations ………………………………….5-115

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist (RCCA) …………………………………………….5-119

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist …..5-120 Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist operation……………………………………………………………….5-121 Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist malfunction and limitations ………………………………….5-125

Lane Following Assist (LFA)………………………..5-131 Lane Following Assist settings …………………………….5-131 Lane Following Assist operation………………………….5-132 Lane Following Assist malfunction and limitations………………………………………………………………5-134

Driver Attention Warning (DAW)…………………5-136 Driver Attention Warning settings ……………………..5-137 Driver Attention Warning operation ……………………5-138 Driver Attention Warning malfunction and limitations………………………………………………………………5-140

Highway Driving Assist (HDA) …………………….5-143 Highway Driving Assist Settings ………………………….5-144 Highway Driving Assist Operation ……………………….5-145 Highway Driving Assist Malfunction and Limitations……………………………………………………………..5-148

Smart Cruise Control (SCC) …………………………5-151 Smart Cruise Control settings………………………………5-152 Smart Cruise Control operation……………………………5-156 Smart Cruise Control display and control……………5-157 Smart Cruise Control malfunction and limitations………………………………………………………………5-163

Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control (NSCC) ……………………………………………5-170

Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control Settings………………………………………………………………….5-170 Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control Operation ………………………………………………………………5-171 Limitations of Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control ………………………………………………………………….5-174

Special driving conditions……………………………5-178 Hazardous Driving Conditions………………………………5-178 Rocking the Vehicle………………………………………………5-178 Smooth Cornering…………………………………………………5-179 Driving at Night …………………………………………………….5-179 Driving in the Rain ………………………………………………..5-179 Driving in Flooded Areas………………………………………5-180 Highway Driving ……………………………………………………5-180 Reducing the Risk of a Rollover …………………………5-181

Winter driving……………………………………………..5-182 Snow or Icy Conditions…………………………………………5-182 Winter Precautions……………………………………………….5-184

Trailer towing ……………………………………………..5-186 If you decide to pull a trailer……………………………….5-186 Trailer towing equipment ……………………………………..5-188 Driving with a trailer …………………………………………….5-189 Maintenance when trailer towing ………………………5-192

Vehicle load limit…………………………………………5-194 Tire Loading Information Label ……………………………5-195

Declaration of confirmity ……………………………5-200 Front radar …………………………………………………………..5-200 Rear corner radar ……………………………………………….5-200

5

5-4

Driving your vehicle

Carbon monoxide (CO) gas is toxic. Breathing CO can cause unconsciousness and death. Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide which cannot be seen or smelled.

Do not inhale engine exhaust. If at any time you smell engine exhaust inside the vehicle, open the windows immediately. Exposure to CO can cause unconsciousness and death by asphyxiation.

Be sure the exhaust system does not leak. The exhaust system should be checked whenever the vehicle is raised to change the oil or for any other purpose. If you hear a change in the sound of the exhaust or if you drive over something that strikes the underneath side of the vehicle, have the exhaust system checked as soon as possible by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Do not run the engine in an enclosed area. Letting the engine idle in your garage, even with the garage door open, is a hazardous practice. Run the engine only long enough to start the engine and to move the vehicle out of the garage.

Avoid idling the engine for prolonged periods with people inside the vehicle. If it is necessary to idle the engine for a prolonged period with people inside the vehicle, be sure to do so only in an open area with the air intake set at «Fresh» and fan control set to high so fresh air is drawn into the interior.

Keep the air intakes clear. To assure proper operation of the ventilation system, keep the ventilation air intakes located in front of the windshield clear of snow, ice, leaves, or other obstructions.

If you must drive with the liftgate open: Close all windows. Open instrument panel air vents. Set the air intake control at «Fresh», the air flow control at «Floor» or «Face», and the fan control set to high.

WARNING

5-5

Driving your vehicle

5

Before Entering the Vehicle Be sure all windows, outside mir-

ror(s), and outside lights are clean and unobstructed.

Remove frost, snow, or ice. Visually check the tires for uneven

wear and damage. Check under the vehicle for any

sign of leaks. Be sure there are no obstacles

behind you if you intend to back up.

Before Starting Make sure the hood, the liftgate,

and the doors are securely closed and locked.

Adjust the position of the seat and steering wheel.

Adjust the inside and outside rearview mirrors.

Verify all the lights work. Fasten your seatbelt. Check that all

passengers have fastened their seatbelts.

Check the gauges and indicators in the instrument panel and the mes- sages on the instrument display when the ignition switch is in the ON position.

Check that any items you are car- rying are stored properly or fas- tened down securely.

CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65 WARNING

Engine exhaust and a wide vari- ety of automobile components including components found in the interior furnishings in a vehicle, contain or emit harmful chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects and reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and cer- tain products of components contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. For more information go to https://www.p65warnings.ca.go v/passenger-vehicle

WARNING

BEFORE DRIVING

5-6

Driving your vehicle

NEVER drink or take drugs and drive. Drinking or taking drugs and driv- ing is dangerous and may result in an accident and SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH. Drunk driving is the number one contributor to the highway death toll each year. Even a small amount of alcohol will affect your reflexes, percep- tions and judgment. Just one drink can reduce your ability to respond to changing conditions and emergencies and your reac- tion time gets worse with each additional drink. Driving while under the influ- ence of drugs is as dangerous or more dangerous than driving under the influence of alcohol.

WARNING You are much more likely to have a serious accident if you drink or take drugs and drive. If you are drinking or taking drugs, don’t drive. Do not ride with a driver who has been drinking or taking drugs. Choose a designated driv- er or call a taxi.

To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH, take the fol- lowing precautions: ALWAYS wear your seat belt.

All passengers must be prop- erly belted whenever the vehi- cle is moving. For more infor- mation, refer to «Seat Belts» in chapter 2.

Always drive defensively. Assume other drivers or pedes- trians may be careless and make mistakes.

Stay focused on the task of driving. Driver distraction can cause accidents.

Leave plenty of space between you and the vehicle in front of you.

WARNING

5-7

Driving your vehicle

5

Key Ignition Switch

Whenever the front door is opened, the ignition switch will illuminate, pro- vided the ignition switch is not in the ON position. The light will go off immediately when the ignition switch is turned on or go off after about 30 seconds when the door is closed. (if equipped)

IGNITION SWITCH

To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH, take the fol- lowing precautions: NEVER allow children or any

person who is unfamiliar with the vehicle to touch the igni- tion switch or related parts. Unexpected and sudden vehi- cle movement can occur.

NEVER reach through the steering wheel for the ignition switch, or any other control, while the vehicle is in motion. The presence of your hand or arm in this area may cause a loss of vehicle control result- ing in an accident.

WARNING NEVER turn the ignition switch to the LOCK or ACC position while the vehicle is in motion except in an emergency. This will result in the engine turning off and loss of power assist for the steering and brake systems. This may lead to loss of direc- tional control and braking func- tion, which could cause an acci- dent. Before leaving the driver’s seat, always make sure the gear is in P (Park) position, apply the park- ing brake, and turn ignition switch to the LOCK position. Unexpected vehicle movement may occur if these precautions are not followed.

WARNING

OAE056172

LOCK

ACC ON START

5-8

Driving your vehicle

Key ignition switch positions

Switch Position Action Notice

LOCK

To turn the ignition switch to the LOCK position, put the key in at the ACC position and turn the key towards the LOCK position.

The ignition key can be removed in the LOCK position.

The shift lever must be in the P (Park) position.

ACC Some of the electrical accessories are usable.

ON

This is the normal key position when the engine has started.

All features and accessories are usable.

The warning lights can be checked when you turn the ignition switch from ACC to ON.

Do not leave the ignition switch in the ON position when the engine is not running in order to prevent the battery from discharging.

START To start the engine, turn the ignition switch to the START position. The switch returns to the ON position when you let go of the key.

The engine will crank until you release the key.

5-9

Driving your vehicle

5

Starting the engine 1. Make sure the parking brake is applied.

2. Make sure the gear is in P (Park). 3. Depress the brake pedal. 4. Turn the ignition switch to the

START position. Hold the key (maximum of 10 seconds) until the engine starts and release it.

Information It is best to maintain a moderate

engine speed until the vehicle engine comes up to normal operating tem- perature. Avoid harsh or abrupt acceleration or deceleration while the engine is still cold.

Whether the engine is cold or warm, always start the vehicle with your foot on the brake pedal. Do not depress the accelerator while start- ing the vehicle. Do not rev the engine while warming it up.

To prevent damage to the vehicle: Do not hold the ignition key in

the START position for more than 10 seconds. Wait 5 to 10 seconds before trying again.

Do not push or tow your vehicle to start the engine.

Turning off the engine 1. Stop the vehicle and depress the

brake pedal fully. 2. Shift the gear to P (Park). 3. Turn the ignition switch to the off

position and apply the parking brake.

NOTICE

i

Always wear appropriate shoes when operating your vehicle. Unsuitable shoes, such as high heels, ski boots, sandals, flip- flops, etc., may interfere with your ability to use the brake and accelerator pedals.

WARNING

5-10

Driving your vehicle

Engine Start/Stop Button

Whenever the front door is opened, the Engine Start/Stop button will illu- minate and will go off 30 seconds after the door is closed.

NEVER press the Engine Start/ Stop button while the vehicle is in motion except in an emer- gency. This will result in the engine turning off and loss of power assist for the steering and brake systems.

WARNING

To turn the engine off in an emergency: Press and hold the Engine Start/Stop button for more than two seconds OR rapidly press and release the Engine Start/ Stop button three times (within three seconds). If the vehicle is still moving, you can restart the engine without depressing the brake pedal by pressing the Engine Start/Stop button with the gear in the N (Neutral) position.

This may lead to loss of direc- tional control and braking function, which could cause an accident.

Before leaving the driver’s seat, always make sure the gear is in the P (Park) posi- tion, set the parking brake, press the Engine Start/ Stop button to the OFF position, and take the Smart Key with you. Unexpected vehicle movement may occur if these precautions are not followed.

NEVER reach through the steering wheel for the Engine Start/Stop button or any other control while the vehicle is in motion. The presence of your hand or arm in this area may cause a loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.

WARNING

To reduce risk of serious injury or death, NEVER allow children or any person who is unfamiliar with the vehicle to touch the Engine Start/Stop button or related parts. Unexpected and sudden vehicle movement can occur.

WARNING

OLX2058074

5-11

Driving your vehicle

5

Engine Start/Stop button positions

Button Position Action Notice

OFF

To turn off the engine, press the Engine Start/Stop button with the gear in P (Park). When you press the Engine Start/Stop but- ton without the gear in P (Park), the Engine Start/Stop button does not turn to the OFF position, but turns to the ACC position.

ACC

Press the Engine Start/Stop button when the button is in the OFF position without depress- ing the brake pedal. Some of the electrical accessories are usable.

If you leave the Engine Start/Stop button in the ACC position with the gear in P (Park) for more than one hour, the battery power will turn off automatically to prevent the battery from dis- charging.

5-12

Driving your vehicle

Button Position Action Notice

ON

Press the Engine Start/Stop button while it is in the ACC position without depressing the brake pedal. The warning lights can be checked before the engine is started.

Do not leave the Engine Start/Stop button in the ON position when the engine is not run- ning to prevent the battery from discharging.

START

To start the engine, depress the brake pedal and press the Engine Start/Stop button with the gear in the P (Park) or in the N (Neutral) position. For your safety, start the engine with the gear in the P (Park) position.

If you press the Engine Start/Stop button with- out depressing the brake pedal, the engine does not start and the Engine Start/Stop but- ton changes as follows: OFF ACC ON OFF However, the engine may start if you depress the brake pedal within 0.5 second after press- ing the Engine Start/Stop button from the OFF position.

5-13

Driving your vehicle

5

Starting the engine Information The engine will start by pressing the

Engine Start/Stop button, only when the smart key is in the vehicle.

Even if the smart key is in the vehi- cle, if it is far away from the driver, the engine may not start.

When the Engine Start/Stop button is in the ACC or ON position, if any door is open, the system checks for the smart key. If the smart key is not in the vehicle, the « » indicator will blink and the warning «Key not in vehicle» will come on and if all doors are closed, the chime will also sound for about 5 seconds. Keep the smart key in the vehicle when using the ACC position or if the vehicle engine is ON.

1. Always carry the smart key with you.

2. Make sure the parking brake is applied.

3. Make sure the gear is in P (Park). 4. Depress the brake pedal. 5. Press the Engine Start/Stop but-

ton.

Information Do not wait for the engine to warm

up while the vehicle remains station- ary. Start driving at moderate engine speeds. (Aggressive accelerat- ing and decelerating should be avoided.)

Always start the vehicle with your foot on the brake pedal. Do not depress the accelerator while start- ing the vehicle. Do not rev the engine while warming it up.

i

i

Always wear appropriate shoes when operating your vehicle. Unsuitable shoes, such as high heels, ski boots, sandals, flip-flops, etc., may interfere with your ability to use the brake and accelerator pedals.

Do not start the vehicle with the accelerator pedal depressed. The vehicle can move and lead to an accident.

Wait until the engine RPM is normal. The vehicle may sud- denly move if the brake pedal is released when the RPM is high.

WARNING

5-14

Driving your vehicle

To prevent damage to the vehicle: If the engine stalls while you are

in motion, do not attempt to shift the gear to the P (Park) position. If traffic and road conditions permit, you may put the gear in the N (Neutral) position while the vehicle is still moving and press the Engine Start/Stop button in an attempt to restart the engine.

Do not push or tow your vehicle to start the engine.

To prevent damage to the vehicle: When the stop lamp switch fuse is blown, you can’t start the engine normally. Replace the fuse with a new one. If you are not able to replace the fuse, you can start the engine by pressing and holding the Engine Start/Stop button for 10 seconds with the Engine Start/ Stop button in the ACC position. Do not press the Engine Start/Stop button for more than 10 seconds except when the stop lamp switch fuse is blown. For your safety always depress the brake pedal before starting the engine.

Information If the smart key battery is weak or the smart key does not work correctly, you can start the engine by pressing the Engine Start/Stop button with the smart key in the direction of the pic- ture above.

Turning off the engine 1. Stop the vehicle and depress the

brake pedal fully. 2. Shift the gear to P (Park). 3. Press the Engine Start/Stop but-

ton to the off position and apply the parking brake.

i

NOTICENOTICE

OLX2058001

5-15

Driving your vehicle

5

Automatic transmission opera- tion The automatic transmission has eight forward speeds and one reverse speed. The individual speeds are selected automatically in the D (Drive) posi- tion.

AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION

OLX2058003

The automatic transmission shift button or interior parts might get hot when a vehicle is parked outside during hot weather. Always be careful when the vehicle is hot.

WARNING

Driving your vehicle

Transmission ranges The indicator in the instrument cluster displays the gear position when the ignition switch is in the ON position.

P (Park)

Always come to a complete stop before shifting into P (Park). To shift from P (Park), you must depress firmly on the brake pedal and make sure your foot is off the accelerator pedal. The gear must be in P (Park) before turning the engine off.

R (Reverse)

Use this position to drive the vehicle backward.

Always come to a complete stop before shifting into or out of R (Reverse); you may damage the transmission if you shift into R (Reverse) while the vehicle is in motion.

When the vehicle is stopped in R (Reverse) position, if you open the driver’s door with the seat belt unfas- tened, the gear is shifted to P (Park) position automatically. However when the vehicle moves in R (Reverse) position, if you open the driver’s door with the seat belt unfas- tened, the gear may be not shifted to P (Park) position automatically for protecting the automatic transmis- sion.

NOTICE

To reduce the risk of serious injury or death: ALWAYS check the surround-

ing areas near your vehicle for people, especially children, before shifting a vehicle into D (Drive) or R (Reverse).

Before leaving the drivers seat, always make sure the gear is in the P (Park) posi- tion, then set the parking brake, and place the ignition switch in the LOCK/OFF posi- tion. Unexpected and sudden vehicle movement can occur if these precautions are not followed.

Do not use the engine brake (shifting from a high gear to lower gear) rapidly on slip- pery roads. The vehicle may slip causing an accident.

WARNING

Shifting into P (Park) while the vehicle is in motion may cause you to lose control of the vehicle.

After the vehicle has stopped, always make sure the gear is in P (Park), apply the parking brake, and turn the engine off.

Do not use the P (Park) posi- tion in place of the parking brake.

WARNING

5-16

5-17

Driving your vehicle

5

N (Neutral)

The wheels and transmission are not engaged. Use N (Neutral) if you need to restart a stalled engine, or if it is necessary to stop with the engine ON. Shift into P (Park) if you need to leave your vehicle for any reason. Always depress the brake pedal when you are shifting from N (Neutral) to another gear.

D (Drive)

This is the normal driving position. The transmission will automatically shift through a 8-gear sequence, pro- viding the best fuel economy and power. To start the vehicle forward, push the D (Drive) button by depressing the brake pedal with the engine ON. Then depress the accelerator pedal smoothly. For extra power when passing anoth- er vehicle or driving uphill, depress the accelerator fully. The transmis- sion will automatically downshift to the next lower gear (or gears, as appropriate). When the vehicle is stopped in D (Drive) position, if you open the dri- ver’s door with the seat belt unfas- tened, the gear is shifted to P (Park) position automatically. However when the vehicle moves in D (Drive) position, if you open the dri- ver’s door with the seat belt unfas- tened, the gear may not shift to P (Park) position automatically to pro- tect the automatic transmission.

Shift-lock system For your safety, the automatic trans- mission has a shift-lock system which prevents shifting the gear from P (Park) or N (Neutral) to R (Reverse) or D (Drive) unless the brake pedal is depressed. To shift the gear from P (Park) or N (Neutral) to R (Reverse) or D (Drive): 1. Depress and hold the brake pedal. 2. Start the engine or place the igni-

tion switch in the ON position. 3. Depress the brake pedal and push

the R (Reverse) or D (Drive) but- ton.Do not shift into gear unless

your foot is firmly on the brake pedal. Shifting into gear when the engine is running at high speed can cause the vehicle to move very rapidly. You could lose control of the vehicle and hit people or objects.

WARNING

5-18

Driving your vehicle

When the battery is discharged: You cannot shift the gear when the battery is discharged. In emergencies, do the following to move the shift button to N (Neutral) on a level ground. 1. Connect the battery cables from

another vehicle or from a another battery to the jump-starting termi- nals inside the engine compart- ment. For more information refer to «Jump Starting» in chapter 6.

2. Release the parking brake with the Engine Start/Stop button in the ON position.

3. Shift the gear to the N(Neutral) position. Refer to the «Stay in Neutral when vehicle is Off» in this chapter.

Parking Always come to a complete stop and continue to depress the brake pedal. Press the P button, apply the parking brake, and place the ignition switch in the LOCK/OFF position. Take the Key with you when exiting the vehi- cle. The gear is shifted to P (Park)

position automatically for safety under the following conditions. — When the driver unfastens the

seat belt and opens the drivers door.

— When the engine is turned off with the gear shifted to R (Reverse), D (Drive) or N (Neutral).

When you stay in the vehicle with the engine running, be careful not to depress the accel- erator pedal for a long period of time. The engine or exhaust system may overheat and start a fire. The exhaust gas and the exhaust system are very hot. Keep away from the exhaust system components. Do not stop or park over flam- mable materials, such as dry grass, paper or leaves. They may ignite and cause a fire.

WARNING

5-19

Driving your vehicle

5

LCD display message Shifting conditions not met The warning message appears on the LCD display, when engine RPM is too high, or when driving speed is too fast to shift the gear. We recommend you decrease the engine speed or slow down before shifting the gear.

Press brake pedal to change gear The warning message appears on the LCD display, when the brake pedal is not depressed while shifting the gear. We recommend you to depress the brake pedal and then shift the gear.

Shift to P after stopping The warning message appears on the LCD display, when the gear is shifted to P (Park) while the vehicle is moving. Stop the vehicle before shifting to P (Park).

PARK engaged The warning message appears on the LCD display, when the gear is shifted to P (Park) while the vehicle is moving. Stop the vehicle before shifting to P (Park).

Press and hold OK button to stay in Neutral when vehicle is Off The warning message appears on the LCD display, when pushing the N(Neutral) button. If you want to stay N(Neutral) after turning off the engine, press and hold the OK but- ton on the steering wheel more than 1 second.

Vehicle will stay in (N). Change gear to cancel The warning message appears on the LCD display, when pushing the «OK» button on the steering wheel after the message («Press and hold OK button to stay in Neutral when vehicle is Off») appears on the clus- ter LCD display. The gear stays in N(Neutral) position after turning off the engine.

NEUTRAL engaged The message appears on the LCD display, when the N (Neutral) posi- tion is engaged.

Gear already selected The message appears on the LCD display, when pushing the current shift button again.

5-20

Driving your vehicle

Shift button held down The warning message appears on the LCD display, when the shift but- ton is pressed continuously or the shift button does not properly oper- ate. Clean the surroundings of gear shift button. If this message appears again, we recommend you to have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Shifter system malfunction The warning message appears on the LCD display, when the transmis- sion or the shift button does not prop- erly operate in the P (Park) position. In this case, we recommend you to immediately have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Check shift controls The warning message appears on the LCD display, when there is a mal- function with transmission shift but- ton. In this case, we recommend you to immediately have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Good driving practices Never shift the gear from P (Park)

or N (Neutral) to any other position with the accelerator pedal depressed.

Never shift the gear into P (Park) when the vehicle is in motion. Be sure the vehicle is completely stopped before you attempt to shift into R (Reverse) or D (Drive).

Do not shift the gear to N (Neutral) when driving. Doing so may result in an accident because of a loss of engine braking and the transmis- sion could be damaged.

Driving uphill or downhill, always shift to D (Drive) when driving for- ward or to R (Reverse) when driv- ing backwards, and check the gear position indicated on the cluster before driving. If you drive in the opposite direction of the selected gear, the engine will turn off and a serious accident might be occurred due to the degraded brake per- formance.

5-21

Driving your vehicle

5

Do not drive with your foot resting on the brake pedal. Even light, but consistent pedal pressure can result in the brakes overheating, brake wear and possibly even brake failure.

When driving in sports mode, slow down before shifting to a lower gear. Otherwise, the lower gear may not be engaged if the engine RPMs are outside of the allowable range.

Always apply the parking brake when leaving the vehicle. Do not depend on placing the transmis- sion in P (Park) to keep the vehicle from moving.

Exercise extreme caution when driving on a slippery surface. Be especially careful when braking, accelerating or shifting gears. On a slippery surface, an abrupt change in vehicle speed can cause the drive wheels to lose traction and may cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident

Optimum vehicle performance and economy is obtained by smoothly depressing and releasing the accelerator.

In the event your vehicle leaves the roadway, do not steer sharply. Instead, slow down before pulling back into the travel lanes.

HYUNDAI recommends you follow all posted speed limits.

To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH: ALWAYS wear your seatbelt.

In a collision, an unbelted occupant is significantly more likely to be seriously injured or killed than a properly belt- ed occupant.

Avoid high speeds when cor- nering or turning.

Do not make quick steering wheel movements, such as sharp lane changes or fast, sharp turns.

The risk of rollover is greatly increased if you lose control of your vehicle at highway speeds.

Loss of control often occurs if two or more wheels drop off the roadway and the driver over steers to reenter the roadway.

WARNING

5-22

Driving your vehicle

Paddle Shifter (Manual Shift Mode)

The paddle shifter is available when the gear is in the D (Drive) position.

Pull the [+] or [-] paddle shifter once to shift up or down one gear and the system changes from automatic shift mode to manual shift mode. To change back to the automatic shift mode from manual shift mode, do one of the following: Gently depress the accelerator

pedal for more than 5 seconds. Drive the vehicle under 6 mph (10

km/h). Pull and hold the right side paddle

shifter.

Information If the [+] and [-] paddle shifters are pulled at the same time, gear shift may not occur.

i

OLX2058002

5-23

Driving your vehicle

5

Power Brakes Your vehicle has power-assisted brakes that adjust automatically through normal usage. If the engine is not running or is turned off while driving, the power assist for the brakes will not work. You can still stop your vehicle by applying greater force to the brake pedal than typical. The stopping dis- tance, however, will be longer than with power brakes. When the engine is not running, the reserve brake power is partially depleted each time the brake pedal is applied. Do not pump the brake pedal when the power assist has been interrupted.

BRAKING SYSTEM

Take the following precautions: Do not drive with your foot

resting on the brake pedal. This will create abnormal high brake temperatures, exces- sive brake lining and pad wear, and increased stopping distances.

When descending down a long or steep hill, use the pad- dle shifter and manually downshift to a lower gear in order to control your speed without using the brake pedal excessively. Applying the brakes continuously will cause the brakes to overheat and could result in a tempo- rary loss of braking perform- ance.

Wet brakes may impair the vehicle’s ability to safely slow down; the vehicle may also pull to one side when the brakes are applied. Applying the brakes lightly will indicate whether they have been affected in this way. Always test your brakes in this fash- ion after driving through deep water. To dry the brakes, light- ly tap the brake pedal to heat up the brakes while maintain- ing a safe forward speed until brake performance returns to normal. Avoid driving at high speeds until the brakes func- tion correctly.

WARNING

5-24

Driving your vehicle

Disc Brakes Wear Indicator When your brake pads are worn and new pads are required, you will hear a high pitched warning sound from your front or rear brakes. You may hear this sound come and go or it may occur whenever you depress the brake pedal. Note that some driving conditions or climates may cause a brake squeal when you first apply (or lightly apply) the brakes. This is normal and does not indicate a problem with your brakes.

To avoid costly brake repairs, do not continue to drive with worn brake pads.

Information Always replace brake pads as com- plete front or rear axle sets.

Electronic Parking Brake (EPB) Applying the parking brake

To apply the EPB (Electronic Parking Brake):

1. Depress the brake pedal. 2. Pull up the EPB switch. Make sure the Parking Brake Warning Light comes on.i

NOTICE

To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH, do not oper- ate the EPB while the vehicle is moving except in an emergency situation. It could damage the brake system and lead to an accident.

WARNING

OLX2058082

5-25

Driving your vehicle

5

Releasing the parking brake

To release the EPB (Electronic Parking Brake):

Place the ignition switch in the ON position.

Depress and hold the brake pedal. Press the EPB switch. Make sure the Parking Brake Warning Light goes off.

To release EPB (Electronic Parking Brake) automatically:

1. Ensure seat belts are fastened and the doors, hood and liftgate are closed.

2. With the engine running, depress the brake pedal and shift out of P (Park) to R (Reverse) or D (Drive).

3. Depress the accelerator pedal. Make sure the parking brake warning light goes off.

Information For your safety, you can engage the

EPB even though the ignition switch is in the OFF position, but you can- not release it.

For your safety, depress the brake pedal and release the parking brake manually with the EPB switch when you drive downhill or when backing up the vehicle.

If the parking brake warning light is still on even though the EPB has been released, have the system checked by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer.

Do not drive your vehicle with the EPB applied. It may cause excessive brake pad and brake rotor wear.

EPB (Electronic Parking Brake) may be automatically applied when:

Requested by other systems The driver turns the engine off

while Auto Hold is operating.

NOTICE

i

OLX2059083L

5-26

Driving your vehicle

Warning messages

To release EPB, fasten seatbelt, close door, hood and liftgate

If you try to drive with the EPB applied, a warning will sound and a message will appear.

If the driver’s seat belt is unfas- tened and the engine hood or lift- gate is opened, a warning will sound and a message will appear.

If there is a problem with the vehi- cle, a warning may sound and a message may appear.

If the situation occurs, depress the brake pedal and release EPB by pressing the EPB switch.

Do not apply the accelerator pedal while the parking brake is engaged. If you depress the accelerator pedal with the EPB engaged, a warning will sound and a message will appear. Damage to the parking brake may occur.

Driving with the parking brake on can overheat the braking sys- tem and cause premature wear or damage to brake parts. Make sure the EPB is released and the Parking Brake Warning Light is off before driving.

NOTICE

Whenever leaving the vehicle or parking, always come to a complete stop and continue to depress the brake pedal. Shift the gear into the P (Park) position, press the EPB switch, and set the ignition switch to the OFF position. Take the Key with you when exiting the vehicle. Vehicles not fully engaged in P (Park) with the parking brake set are at risk for mov- ing inadvertently and causing injury to yourself or others.

NEVER allow anyone who is unfamiliar with the vehicle to touch the EPB switch. If the EPB is released unintentional- ly, serious injury may occur.

Only release the EPB when you are seated inside the vehicle with your foot firmly on the brake pedal.

WARNING

OTMA058132

5-27

Driving your vehicle

5

Information A clicking sound may be heard

while operating or releasing the EPB. These conditions are normal and indicate that the EPB is func- tioning properly.

When leaving your keys with a parking attendant or assistant, make sure to inform him/her how to operate the EPB.

AUTO HOLD turning Off! Press brake pedal

When the conversion from Auto Hold to EPB is not working properly a warning will sound and a message will appear.

Parking brake automatically engaged

If the EPB is applied while Auto Hold is activated, a warning will sound and a message will appear.

i

OIK057079N OIK057077N

5-28

Driving your vehicle

EPB malfunction indicator

This warning light illuminates if the ignition switch is set to the ON posi- tion and goes off in approximately 3 seconds if the system is operating normally. If the EPB malfunction indicator remains on, comes on while driving, or does not come on when the igni- tion switch is changed to the ON position, this indicates that the EPB may have malfunctioned. If this occurs, have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

The EPB malfunction indicator may illuminate when the ESC indicator comes on to indicate that the ESC is not working properly, but it does not indicate a malfunction of the EPB.

If the EPB warning light is still on, have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

If the parking brake warning light does not illuminate or blinks even though the EPB switch was pulled up, the EPB may not be applied.

If the parking brake warning light blinks when the EPB warn- ing light is on, press the switch, and then pull it up. Repeat this one more time. If the EPB warn- ing does not go off, have the system checked by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer.

Parking brake warning light Check the Parking Brake Warning Light by placing the ignition switch to the ON posi- tion (do not start the engine).

This light will be illuminated when the parking brake is applied with the igni- tion switch in the START or ON posi- tion. Before driving, be sure the parking brake is released and the Brake Warning Light is OFF. If the Parking Brake Warning Light remains on after the parking brake is released while engine is running, there may be a malfunction in the brake system. Immediate attention is necessary. If at all possible, cease driving the vehicle immediately. If that is not pos- sible, use extreme caution while operating the vehicle and only con- tinue to drive the vehicle until you can reach a safe location.

NOTICE

OLX2058075

5-29

Driving your vehicle

5

Emergency braking If there is a problem with the brake pedal while driving, emergency brak- ing is possible by pulling up and holding the EPB switch. Braking is possible only while you are holding the EPB switch. However, braking distance will be longer than normal.

Information During emergency braking, the park- ing brake warning light will illumi- nate to indicate that the system is operating.

If you continuously notice a noise or burning smell when the EPB is used for emergency braking, have system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

When the EPB (Electronic Parking Brake) does not release

If the EPB does not release normal- ly, we recommend that you contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer by loading the vehicle on a flatbed tow truck and have the system checked.

Auto Hold The Auto Hold maintains the vehicle in a standstill even though the brake pedal is not depressed after the driv- er brings the vehicle to a complete stop by depressing the brake pedal.

To apply :

1. With the driver’s door and engine hood closed, depress the brake pedal and then press the [AUTO HOLD] switch. The white AUTO HOLD indicator will come on and the system will be in the standby position.

NOTICE

i

Do not operate the parking brake while the vehicle is mov- ing except in an emergency sit- uation. It could damage the brake system and lead to a severe accident.

WARNING

OLX2058013

5-30

Driving your vehicle

2. When you stop the vehicle com- pletely by depressing the brake pedal, the Auto Hold maintains the brake pressure to hold the vehicle stationary. The indicator changes from white to green.

3. The vehicle will remain stationary even if you release the brake pedal.

4. If EPB is applied, Auto Hold will be released.

To release : If you press the accelerator pedal with the gear in D (Drive) or Manual shift mode, the Auto Hold will be released automatically and the vehi- cle will start to move. The AUTO HOLD indicator changes from green to white.

To cancel :

1.Depress the brake pedal. 2.Press the [AUTO HOLD] switch. The AUTO HOLD indicator will turn off.

When the AUTO HOLD is auto- matically released by depress- ing the accelerator pedal, always take a look around your vehicle. Slowly depress the accelerator pedal for a smooth start.

WARNING OLX2059014L

To prevent, unexpected and sud- den vehicle movement, ALWAYS press your foot on the brake pedal to cancel the Auto Hold before you: Drive downhill. Drive the vehicle in R (Reverse). Park the vehicle.

WARNING

OLX2058015

5-31

Driving your vehicle

5

Information The Auto Hold does not operate

when:

— The driver’s door is opened

— The engine hood is opened

— The gear is in P (Park) or R (Reverse)

— The EPB is applied

For your safety, the Auto Hold auto- matically switches to EPB when:

— The driver’s door is opened with the gear in D (Drive) or N (Neutral)

— The engine hood is opened with the gear in D (Drive) or N (Neutral)

— The vehicle stops for more than 10 minutes

— The vehicle stands on a steep slope

— The vehicle moves several times

In these cases, the parking brake warning light comes on, the AUTO HOLD indicator changes from green to white, and a warning sound and a message will appear to inform you that EPB has been automatical- ly engaged. Before driving off again, press foot brake pedal, check the surrounding area near your vehicle and release parking brake manually with the EPB switch.

While operating Auto Hold, you may hear mechanical noise. However, it is normal operating noise.

If the AUTO HOLD indicator changes to yellow, the Auto Hold is not working properly. Contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

If there is a malfunction with the driver’s door or engine hood open detection system, the Auto Hold may not work properly. Contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

NOTICE

NOTICE

i

Depress the accelerator pedal slowly when you start the vehicle.

For your safety, cancel the Auto Hold when you drive downhill, back up the vehicle or park the vehicle.

WARNING

5-32

Driving your vehicle

Warning messages

Parking brake automatically engaged

When the EPB is applied from Auto Hold, a warning will sound and a message will appear.

AUTO HOLD turning Off! Press brake pedal

When the conversion from Auto Hold to EPB is not working properly a warning will sound and a message will appear. When this message is displayed, the Auto Hold and EPB may not operate. For your safety, depress the brake pedal.

Press brake pedal to deactivate AUTO HOLD

If you did not apply the brake pedal when you release the Auto Hold by pressing the [AUTO HOLD] switch, a warning will sound and a message will appear.

OIK057077N/OIK057075N

Type A Type B

OIK057079N OIK057080L

5-33

Driving your vehicle

5

AUTO HOLD conditions not met. Close door and hood.

When you press the [AUTO HOLD] switch, if the driver’s door and engine hood are not closed, a warning will sound and a message will appear on the cluster LCD display. Press the [AUTO HOLD] switch after closing the driver’s door and hood.

Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)

ABS is an electronic braking system that helps prevent a braking skid. ABS allows the driver to steer and brake at the same time.

An Anti-Lock Braking System (ABS) or an Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system will not prevent accidents due to improper or dangerous driving maneuvers. Even though vehi- cle control is improved during emergency braking, always maintain a safe distance between you and objects ahead of you. Vehicle speeds should always be reduced during extreme road conditions. The braking distance for cars equipped with ABS or ESC may be longer than for those without these systems in the following road conditions. Drive your vehicle at reduced speeds during the following conditions: Rough, gravel or snow-cov-

ered roads. On roads where the road sur-

face is pitted or has different surface height.

WARNING

OTM058159L

Tire chains are installed on your vehicle.

The safety features of an ABS or ESC equipped vehicle should not be tested by high speed driving or cornering. This could endanger the safety of yourself or others.

5-34

Driving your vehicle

Using ABS To obtain the maximum benefit from your ABS in an emergency situation, do not attempt to modulate your brake pressure and do not try to pump your brakes. Depress your brake pedal as hard as possible. When you apply your brakes under conditions which may lock the wheels, you may hear sounds from the brakes, or feel a corresponding sensation in the brake pedal. This is normal and it means your ABS is active. ABS does not reduce the time or dis- tance it takes to stop the vehicle. Always maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in front of you. ABS will not prevent a skid that results from sudden changes in direction, such as trying to take a corner too fast or making a sudden lane change. Always drive at a safe speed for the road and weather con- ditions.

ABS cannot prevent a loss of stabili- ty. Always steer moderately when braking hard. Severe or sharp steer- ing wheel movement can still cause your vehicle to veer into oncoming traffic or off the road.

On loose or uneven road surfaces, operation of the anti-lock brake sys- tem may result in a longer stopping distance than for vehicles equipped with a conventional brake system. The ABS warning light ( ) will stay on for several seconds after the igni- tion switch is in the ON position. During that time, the ABS will go through self-diagnosis and the light will go off if everything is normal. If the light stays on, you may have a problem with your ABS. Contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible

If the ABS warning light ( ) is on and stays on, you may have a problem with the ABS. Your power brakes will work normal- ly. To reduce the risk of serious injury or death, contact your HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.

WARNING

5-35

Driving your vehicle

5

When you drive on a road having poor traction, such as an icy road, and apply your brakes continu- ously, the ABS will be active con- tinuously and the ABS warning light ( ) may illuminate. Pull your car over to a safe place and turn the engine off. Restart the engine. If the ABS warning light is off, then your ABS system is normal. Otherwise, you may have a prob- lem with your ABS system. Contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.

Information When you jump start your vehicle because of a drained battery, the ABS warning light ( ) may turn on at the same time. This happens because of the low battery voltage. It does not mean your ABS is malfunctioning. Have the battery recharged before driving the vehicle.

Electronic Stability Control (ESC)

The Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system helps to stabilize the vehicle during cornering maneuvers. ESC checks where you are steering and where the vehicle is actually going. ESC applies braking pressure to any one of the vehicle’s brakes and intervenes in the engine man- agement system to assist the driver with keeping the vehicle on the intended path. It is not a substitute for safe driving practices. Always adjust your speed and driving to the road conditions.

ESC operation ESC ON condition

When the ignition switch is in the ON position, the ESC and the ESC OFF indicator lights illuminate for approxi- mately three seconds. After both lights go off, the ESC is enabled.

i

NOTICE

OLX2059016L

Never drive too fast for the road conditions or too quickly when cornering. The ESC system will not prevent accidents. Excessive speed in turns, abrupt maneuvers, and hydroplaning on wet surfaces can result in severe accidents.

WARNING

5-36

Driving your vehicle

When operating

When the ESC is in opera- tion, the ESC indicator light blinks:

When you apply your brakes under conditions which may lock the wheels, you may hear sounds from the brakes, or feel a corresponding sensation in the brake pedal. This is normal and it means your ESC is active.

When the ESC activates, the engine may not respond to the accelerator as it does under rou- tine conditions.

If Smart Cruise Control was in use when the ESC activates, Smart Cruise Control automatically disen- gages. Smart Cruise Control can be reengaged when the road con- ditions allow. See «Smart Cruise Control(SCC)» later in this chapter. (if equipped)

When moving out of the mud or driving on a slippery road, the engine RPM (revolutions per minute) may not increase even if you press the accelerator pedal deeply. This is to maintain the sta- bility and traction of the vehicle and does not indicate a problem.

ESC OFF condition

To cancel ESC operation :

State 1 Press the ESC OFF button briefly. The ESC OFF indicator light and message «Traction Control disabled» will illuminate. In this state, the trac- tion control function of ESC (engine management) is disabled, but the brake control function of ESC (brak- ing management) still operates.

State 2 Press and hold the ESC OFF button continuously for more than 3 sec- onds. The ESC OFF indicator light and message «Traction and Stability Control disabled» illuminates and a warning chime sounds. In this state, both the traction control function of ESC (engine management) and the brake control function of ESC (brak- ing management) are disabled. If the ignition switch is placed to the LOCK/OFF position when ESC is off, ESC remains off. Upon restarting the engine, the ESC will automatically turn on again.

Indicator lights

When the ignition switch is placed to the ON position, the ESC indicator light illuminates, then goes off if the ESC system is operating normally. The ESC indicator light blinks when- ever the ESC is operating. If ESC indicator light stays on, your vehicle may have a malfunction with the ESC system. When this warning light illuminates have your vehicle checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible. The ESC OFF indicator light comes on when the ESC is turned off.

ESC indicator light (blinks)

ESC OFF indicator light (comes on)

5-37

Driving your vehicle

5Driving with wheels and tires with different sizes may cause the ESC system to malfunction. Before replacing tires, make sure all four tires and wheels are the same size. Never drive the vehicle with different sized wheels and tires installed.

ESC OFF usage When Driving

The ESC OFF mode should only be used briefly to help free the vehicle if stuck in snow or mud by temporarily stopping operation of the ESC to maintain wheel torque. To turn ESC off while driving, press the ESC OFF button while driving on a flat road surface.

To prevent damage to the trans- mission: Do not allow wheel(s) of one

axle to spin excessively while the ESC, ABS, and parking brake warning lights are displayed. The repairs would not be cov- ered by the vehicle warranty. Reduce engine power and do not spin the wheel(s) excessive- ly while these lights are dis- played.

When operating the vehicle on a dynamometer, make sure the ESC is turned off (ESC OFF light illuminated).

Information Turning the ESC off does not affect ABS or standard brake system operation.

i

NOTICE NOTICE

When the ESC is blinking, this indicates the ESC is active: Drive slowly and NEVER attempt to accelerate. NEVER turn the ESC off while the ESC indicator light is blinking or you may lose control of the vehicle resulting in an accident.

WARNING

5-38

Driving your vehicle

Vehicle Stability Management (VSM) The Vehicle Stability Management (VSM) is a function of the Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system. It helps ensure the vehicle stays stable when accelerating or braking sud- denly on wet, slippery and rough roads where traction over the four tires can suddenly become uneven. VSM operation

VSM ON condition

The VSM operates when: The Electronic Stability Control

(ESC) is on. Vehicle speed is approximately

above 13 mph (22 km/h) on curve roads.

Vehicle speed is approximately above 6 mph (10 km/h) when the vehicle is braking on a two surface road.

The two surface road is made of surfaces which have different fric- tion forces.

When operating

When you apply your brakes under conditions which may activate the ESC, you may hear sounds from the brakes, or feel a corresponding sen- sation in the brake pedal. This is nor- mal and it means your VSM is active.

Information The VSM does not operate when:

Driving on a banked road such as gradient or incline.

Driving rearward.

ESC OFF indicator light is on.

EPS (Electric Power Steering) warn- ing light ( ) is on or blinks.

i

Never drive too fast for the road conditions.The VSM sys- tem will not prevent acci- dents. Excessive speed in bad weather, slippery and uneven roads can result in severe accidents.

Take the following precautions when using the Vehicle Stability Management (VSM): ALWAYS check the speed and

the distance to the vehicle ahead. The VSM is not a sub- stitute for safe driving prac- tices.

WARNING

5-39

Driving your vehicle

5

Driving with wheels and tires with dif- ferent sizes may cause the ESC sys- tem to malfunction. Before replacing tires, make sure all four tires and wheels are the same size. Never drive the vehicle with different sized tires and wheels installed.

Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC) The Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC) helps prevent the vehicle from rolling backwards when starting a vehicle from a stop on a hill. The system operates the brakes automatically for approximately 2 seconds and releas- es the brake after 2 seconds or when the accelerator pedal is depressed.

The HAC does not operate when the vehicle is shifted to P (Park) or N (Neutral)

The HAC activates even though the ESC (Electronic Stability Control) is off but does not acti- vate when the ESC has malfunc- tioned.

Downhill Brake Control (DBC) (if equipped)

The Downhill Brake Control (DBC) feature assists the driver to descend down a steep hill without having to depress the brake pedal. The system automatically applies the brakes to maintain the vehicle speed below a certain speed and allows the driver to concentrate on steering the vehicle down hill. The DBC defaults to the off position whenever the ignition switch is placed to the ON position. Press the button to activate the system and press the button again to deactivate.

NOTICE

Always be ready to depress the accelerator pedal when starting off on an incline. The HAC acti- vates only for approximately 2 seconds.

WARNING OLX2058017

If ESC indicator light ( ) or EPS warning light ( ) stays on or blinks, your vehicle may have a malfunction with the VSM sys- tem.When the warning light illu- minates, have your vehicle checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.

WARNING

5-40

Driving your vehicle

DBC operation

Standby Press the DBC button when the vehicle speed is under 37 mph (60 km/h). The DBC system will turn on and enter the standby mode.

The system does not turn on if the vehicle speed is over 37 mph (60 km/h).

In the standby mode, the DBC will activate under the following conditions: The hill is steep enough. The accelerator pedal is not depressed. The vehicle speed is within 2~25 mph (4~40 km/h) range (within 1.5~5 mph (2.5~8 km/h) when

reversing). Within the activation speed range 2~25 mph (4~40 km/h), the driver can control the vehicle speed by depressing the brake/accelerator pedal.

The DBC will turn off under the following conditions: The DBC button is pressed again. The vehicle speed is over 37 mph (60 km/h).

The yellow warning light illuminates when the system may have malfunctioned or may not work properly during the activation. In this case, the DBC system is deactivated. Have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.

The DBC will be deactivated but maintain the standby mode under the following conditions: The hill is not steep enough. The vehicle speed is between 25~37 mph (40~60 km/h).

Activated

Deactivated

System malfunction

Mode Indicator light Description

Green light blinks

— Green light

turns off

Green light turns on (maintains standby mode)

Yellow light turns on

Green light turns on

5-41

Driving your vehicle

5

Downhill Brake Control disabled. Control vehicle speed

When the DBC system is not work- ing properly this warning message will appear on the LCD display and you will hear a warning sound. If this occurs, control the vehicle speed by depressing the brake pedal.

Information Noise or vibration may occur from

the brakes when the DBC is activat- ed.

The rear stop light comes on when DBC is activated.

The DBC may not deactivate on steep inclines even though the brake or accelerator pedal is depressed.

The DBC system may not always maintain the vehicle speed at a certain speed.

The DBC does not operate when: — The gear is in P (Park). — The ESC is activated.

NOTICE

i

Always turn off the DBC on nor- mal roads. The DBC might acti- vate inadvertently from the stand- by mode when driving through speed bumps or making sharp curves.

WARNING

OTMA048167

5-42

Driving your vehicle

Trailer Stability Assist (TSA) Trailer Stability Assist system helps stabilize the vehicle and trailer when the trailer sways or oscillates. There are various reasons making the vehi- cle sway and oscillate.

Factors of swaying are such as: — High speed — Strong crosswinds — Improper overloading — Sudden controlling of steering

wheel — Uneven road

Trailer Stability Assist system contin- uously analyzes the vehicle and trail- er instability. When the Trailer Stability Assist system detects some sway, the brakes are applied auto- matically to stabilize the vehicle on the front wheel. However, if it is not enough to stabilize, the brakes are applied on all wheels automatically and engine power is properly reduced. When the vehicle is stable from swaying, trailer stability assist system does not operate.

Good Braking Practices

Wet brakes can be dangerous! The brakes may get wet if the vehicle is driven through standing water or if it is washed. Your vehicle will not stop as quickly if the brakes are wet. Wet brakes may cause the vehicle to pull to one side.

To dry the brakes, apply the brakes lightly until the braking action returns to normal, taking care to keep the vehicle under control at all times. If the braking action does not return to normal, stop as soon as it is safe to do so and call an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for assistance. DO NOT drive with your foot resting on the brake pedal. Even light, but constant pedal pressure can result in the brakes overheating, brake wear, and possibly even brake failure. If a tire goes flat while you are driv- ing, apply the brakes gently and keep the vehicle pointed straight ahead while you slow down. When you are moving slowly enough for it to be safe to do so, pull off the road and stop in a safe location. Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal when the vehicle is stopped to prevent the vehicle from rolling for- ward.

Whenever leaving the vehicle or parking, always come to a com- plete stop and continue to depress the brake pedal. Shift the gear to P (Park), then apply the parking brake, and place the ignition switch in the LOCK/OFF position. Vehicles parked with the park- ing brake not applied or not fully engaged may roll inadver- tently and may cause injury to the driver and others. ALWAYS apply the parking brake before exiting the vehicle.

WARNING

5-43

Driving your vehicle

5

The All Wheel Drive (AWD) system delivers engine torque to both the front and rear wheels for extra trac- tion. AWD is useful when maximum traction is required on slippery, muddy, wet, or snow-covered roads. Occasional off-road use such as established unpaved roads and trails are OK. It is always important that the driver carefully reduces the speed to a level that does not exceed the safe operating speed for those conditions.

Do not drive in water if the level is higher than the bottom of the vehicle.

Check your brake condition once you are out of mud or water. Depress the brake pedal several times as you move slow- ly until you feel normal braking return.

Shorten your scheduled mainte- nance interval if you drive in off- road conditions such as sand, mud or water (see «Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions» in chapter 7).

Always wash your vehicle thor- oughly after off road use, espe- cially the bottom of the vehicle.

Be sure to equip the vehicle with four tires of the same size and type.

Make sure that a full time AWD vehicle is towed by a flat bed tow truck.

NOTICE

ALL WHEEL DRIVE (AWD) (IF EQUIPPED)

To reduce the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH: Do not drive in conditions that

exceed the vehicles intended design such as challenging off-road conditions.

Avoid high speeds when cor- nering or turning.

Do not make quick steering wheel movements, such as sharp lane changes or fast, sharp turns.

The risk of a rollover is great- ly increased if you lose con- trol of your vehicle at highway speeds.

Loss of control often occurs if two or more wheels drop off the roadway and the driver over steers to reenter the roadway.

In the event your vehicle leaves the roadway, do not steer sharply. Instead, slow down before pulling back into the travel lanes.

WARNING

5-44

Driving your vehicle

Transfer mode Selection mode Description

AWD AUTO (Normal driving)

In the AWD AUTO mode, under normal operating conditions, the vehicle operates similar to conventional 2WD vehicles. If the system determines there is a need for four wheel drive, the engine’s driving power is distributed to all four wheels automatically.

Use this mode when driving on normal roads.

If you select the «Driving force distribution» in the cluster, Driving force distribution (AWD) state is displayed.

SNOW In this mode, the vehicle can start stably by properly distributing the driving force of the vehicle on slippery roads such as snowy roads. And you can drive safely by suppressing wheel slip.

AWD LOCK

The main goal of AWD Lock mode is toallow a driver to maximize the vehicle’s traction under extreme driving conditions such as unpaved off-road, sandy roads, and muddy roads.

AWD Lock mode is in operation only when a vehicle travels at 25 mph (40 km/h) or less. When travelling at 25 mph (40 km/h) or faster, the mode will switch to AWD Auto. When travelling at 20 mph (30 km/h) or less, the mode will switch back to AWD Lock.

Press the AWD Lock mode switch again to switch back to AWD Auto.

AWD Operation All Wheel Drive (AWD) mode selection

When the AWD LOCK mode is deactivated, a shock may be felt as the drive power is delivered entirely to the front wheels. This shock is not a mechanical failure.

5-45

Driving your vehicle

5

For safe AWD operation Before driving

Make sure all passengers are wearing seat belts.

Sit upright and closer to the steer- ing wheel than usual. Adjust the steering wheel to a position com- fortable for you to drive.

Driving on snow-covered or icy roads

Start off slowly by applying the accelerator pedal gently.

Use snow tires or tire chains. Keep sufficient distance between

your vehicle and the vehicle in front of you.

Apply engine braking during decel- eration by using the paddle shifter and manually selecting a lower gear.

Avoid speeding, rapid acceleration, sudden brake applications, and sharp turns to prevent skids.

Driving in sand or mud

Maintain slow and constant speed. Use tire chains driving in mud if

necessary. Keep sufficient distance between

your vehicle and the vehicle in front of you.

Reduce vehicle speed and always check the road condition.

Avoid speeding, rapid acceleration, sudden brake applications, and sharp turns to prevent getting stuck.

When the vehicle is stuck in snow, sand or mud, place a non- slip material under the drive wheels to provide traction OR Slowly spin the wheels in for- ward and reverse directions which causes a rocking motion that may free the vehicle. However, avoid running the engine continuously at high RPM, doing so may damage the AWD system.

CAUTION

5-46

Driving your vehicle

Driving up or down hills

Driving uphill — Before starting off, check if it is

possible to drive uphill. — Drive as straight as possible.

Driving downhill — Do not change gear while driving

downhill. Select gear before driv- ing downhill.

— Drive slowly using engine braking while driving downhill.

— Drive straight as possible.

Driving through water

Try to avoid driving in deep stand- ing water. It may stall your engine and clog your exhaust system.

If you need to drive in water, stop your vehicle, set the vehicle in AWD LOCK mode and drive under 5 mph (8 km/h).

Do not change gear while driving in water.

Exercise extreme caution when driving up or down steep hills. The vehicle may flip over depending on the grade, the ter- rain, and the trail conditions.

WARNING

Do not drive across the contour of steep hills. A slight change in the wheel angle can destabilize the vehicle, or a stable vehicle may lose stability if the vehicle stops its forward motion. Your vehicle may roll over and lead to a serious injury or death.

WARNING

Always drive slowly in water. If you drive too fast, water may get into the engine compart- ment and wet the ignition sys- tem causing your vehicle to suddenly stop.

CAUTION

OLMB053018

OLMB053017

5-47

Driving your vehicle

5

Additional driving conditions

Become familiar with the off-road conditions before driving.

Always pay attention when driving off-road and avoid dangerous areas.

Drive slowly when driving in heavy wind.

Reduce vehicle speed when cor- nering. The center of gravity of AWD vehicles is higher than con- ventional 2WD vehicles, making them more likely to roll over when you rapidly turn corners.

Always hold the steering wheel firmly when you are driving off- road.

LCD display message Transmission hot! Park with engine On

Under certain conditions, such as repeated stop-and-go launches on steep grades, sudden take off or acceleration, or other harsh driving conditions (mud or sand road), the transmission temperatures will increase excessively. Finally the transmission could be overheated.

Do not grab the inside of the steering wheel when you are driving off-road. You may hurt your arm by a sudden steering maneuver or from steering wheel rebound due to an impact with objects on the ground.You could lose control of the steering wheel which may lead to serious injury or death.

WARNING

OJS058137L/OJS058138L

5-48

Driving your vehicle

If the vehicle continues to be driven and the automatic transmission temperatures reach the maximum temperature limit, the «Transmission hot! Park with engine On» warning will be displayed. When this occurs the automatic transmission is dis- abled until the automatic transmis- sion cools to normal temperatures.

The warning will display a time to wait for the transmission to cool.

If this occurs, pull over to a safe location, stop the vehicle with the engine running, apply the brakes and shift the vehicle to P (Park), and allow the transmission to cool.

When the message «Transmission cooled down. Resume driving» appears you can continue to drive your vehicle.

When possible, drive the vehicle smoothly.

Emergency Precautions Tires Do not use a tire and wheel package with a different size and type from the one originally installed on your vehicle. It can affect the safety and performance of your vehicle, which could lead to steering failure or rollover causing serious injury. When replacing the tires, be sure to equip all four tires with the tire and wheel of the same size, type, tread, brand and load-carrying capacity. If you equip your vehicle with any tire/wheel combination not recom- mended by HYUNDAI for off-road driving, you should not use these tires for highway driving.

Towing AWD vehicles must be towed with a wheel lift and dollies or flatbed equip- ment with all the wheels off the ground. For more details, refer to «Towing» in chapter 6.

Dynamometer testing A full-time AWD vehicle must be test- ed on a special four wheel chassis dynamometer.

Never start or run the engine while a full-time AWD vehicle is raised on a jack.The vehicle can slip or roll off of a jack causing serious injury or death to you or those nearby.

WARNING

5-49

Driving your vehicle

5

A full-time AWD vehicle should not be tested on a 2WD roll tester. If a 2WD roll tester must be used, per- form the following procedure: 1.Check the tire pressures recom-

mended for your vehicle. 2.Place the front wheels on the roll

tester for a speedometer test as shown in the illustration.

3.Release the parking brake. 4.Place the rear wheels on the tem-

porary free roller as shown in the illustration.

Never engage the parking brake while performing the test.

When the vehicle is lifted up, do not operate the front and rear wheel separately. All four wheels should be operated.

CAUTION

Keep away from the front of the vehicle while the vehicle is in gear on the dynamometer. The vehicle can jump forward and cause serious injury or death.

WARNING

OLX2058010Roll Tester (Speedometer)

Temporary Free Roller

5-50

Driving your vehicle

The Idle Stop and Go (ISG) system automatically and temporarily shuts down the engine when the vehicle is stopped and idling to improve fuel efficiency and reduce exhaust gas emissions. (i.e. red stop light, stop sign, and traffic jam). The engine is automatically started upon satisfying the starting condi- tions. The ISG system is always active, when the engine is running.

Information When the engine is automatically started by the ISG system, some warn- ing lights (i.e. ABS, ESC, ESC OFF, EPS, and parking brake warning light) may illuminate for a few sec- onds due to the low battery voltage. However, it does not indicate a mal- function with the ISG system.

To Activate the ISG System Prerequisite for activation The ISG system operates in the fol- lowing situations. The driver’s seatbelt is fastened The driver’s door and hood are

closed The brake vacuum pressure is

adequate The battery sensor is activated and

the battery is sufficiently charged Outside temperature is not too low

or too high The vehicle is driven over a con-

stant speed and stops The climate control system satis-

fies the conditions The vehicle is sufficiently warmed

up The incline is gradual The steering wheel is turned less

than 180 degrees and then the vehicle stops

Information The ISG system is not activated, when the prerequisites to activate the ISG sys- tem are unsatisfied. In this case, the ISG

OFF button indicator illuminates, and the auto stop indicator ( ) illuminates in yellow on the instru- ment cluster.

When the above indicator remains illuminated on the instrument clus- ter, we recommend that you have the IGS system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

i

i

ISG (IDLE STOP AND GO) SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)

5-51

Driving your vehicle

5

Auto stop To stop the engine in idle stop mode

1. Decrease the vehicle speed to 0 mph.

2. Depress the brake pedal with the shift lever in D (Drive) or N (Neutral).

The auto stop indicator ( ) illumi- nates in green on the instrument cluster, when the engine stops.

Information The driving speed must reach at least 3 mph (5 km/h) after an idle stop to stop the engine in idle stop mode again.

In auto stop mode, when the driver opens the hood, the ISG system will be deactivated.

When the system is deactivated:

The ISG OFF button indicator illumi- nates.

If the message «Auto Stop is Off. Start vehicle manually», appears on the LCD display with a beep sound, restart the vehicle manually by depressing the brake pedal with the vehicle shifted to P (Park) or N (Neutral). For your safety, restart the vehicle in the P (Park) position.

i OLX2058018

OIK057173N

5-52

Driving your vehicle

Auto start To restart the engine in the auto stop mode

Release the brake pedal. — When Auto Hold is activated, if you

release the brake pedal, the engine will be in the auto stop state. However, if you depress the accelerator pedal, the engine will start again.

The auto stop indicator ( ) goes OFF on the instrument cluster, when the engine is restarted.

The engine is automatically restart- ed in the following situations.

The brake vacuum pressure is low The engine has stopped for about

5 minutes The air conditioning is ON with the

fan speed set to the highest posi- tion

The front defroster is ON The battery is weak The cooling and heating perform-

ance of the climate control system is unsatisfactory

The vehicle is shifted to P (Park) when Auto Hold is activated

The door is opened or the seatbelt is unfastened when Auto Hold is activated

The EPB switch is pressed when Auto Hold is activated

The auto stop indicator ( ) blinks in green for 5 seconds on the instru- ment cluster.

The auto start is temporarily deac- tivated in the following situations.

When the gear is shifted from N (Neutral) to R (Reverse), D (Drive) or Manual shift mode without the brake pedal depressed. A message «Press brake pedal for Auto Start» will appear on the LCD display. To acti- vate auto start, depress the brake pedal.

OIK057086N

5-53

Driving your vehicle

5

To Deactivate the ISG System Press the ISG OFF button to deac-

tivate the ISG system. Then, the ISG OFF button indicator illumi- nates.

Press the ISG OFF button again to reactivate the ISG system. Then, the ISG OFF button indicator turns OFF.

ISG System Malfunction The ISG system may not operate:

When there is a malfunction with the ISG sensors or the ISG system.

The followings occur, when there is a malfunction with the ISG system:

The auto stop indicator ( ) will blink in yellow on the instrument cluster.

The light on the ISG OFF button will illuminate.

Information When you cannot turn OFF the ISG

OFF button indicator by pressing the ISG OFF button, or when the mal- function with the ISG system per- sists, contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

You can turn off the ISG OFF but- ton indicator by driving over 50 mph (80 km/h) for up to 2 hours with the fan speed below the 2nd position. If the ISG OFF button indicator remains ON, contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

i

When the engine is in auto stop mode, the engine may restart. Before leaving the vehicle or checking the engine compart- ment, stop the engine placing the ignition switch to the LOCK/OFF position or remove the ignition key.

WARNING

5-54

Driving your vehicle

Calibrating the Battery Sensor If the AGM battery is reconnected or replaced, ISG system will not oper- ate immediately. If you want to use the system, the battery sensor needs to be calibrated following the below procedure.

1. Turn off the engine. 2. Disconnect all electronic devices

that were additionally installed after the vehicle was delivered, such as navigation, dashcam, etc.

3. After 4 hours with the engine off, turn the engine on and off 3 to 4 times.

Information The ISG system may not operate in the following situations.

— There is a malfunction with the ISG system.

— The battery is weak.

— The brake vacuum pressure is low.

If this occurs, have the ISG system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Use only a genuine HYUNDAI ISG battery for replacement. If not, the ISG system may not operate normally.

Do not recharge the ISG battery with a general battery charger. It may damage or explode the ISG battery.

Do not remove the battery cap. The battery electrolyte, which is harmful to the human body, may leak out.

NOTICEi

OLX2058019

Battery sensor

5-55

Driving your vehicle

5

The drive mode may be selected according to the driver’s preference or road condition.

Drive Mode The mode changes whenever the DRIVE MODE selection knob is rotated. SMART mode :

SMART mode automatically adjusts the driving mode (ECO COMFORT SPORT) in accor- dance with the driver’s driving habits.

SPORT mode : SPORT mode provides sporty but firm riding.

ECO mode : ECO mode helps improve fuel effi- ciency for eco-friendly driving.

COMFORT mode : COMFORT mode provides smooth driving and comfortable riding.

SMART mode SMART mode selects the proper driving mode among ECO, COMFORT, and SPORT by judging

the driver’s driving habits (i.e. Economical or Aggressive) from the brake pedal depression or the steer- ing wheel operation. Rotate the DRIVE MODE selection

knob to activate SMART mode. When SMART mode is activated, the indicator illuminates on the instrument cluster.

The vehicle starts in SMART mode, when the engine was turned OFF in SMART mode.

SMART mode automatically con- trols gear shifting patterns, engine torque, in accordance with the dri- ver’s driving habits.

DRIVE MODE INTEGRATED CONTROL SYSTEM (2WD)

OLX2058092

SMART

5-56

Driving your vehicle

Information When you mildly drive the vehicle

in SMART mode, the driving mode changes to ECO mode to improve fuel efficiency. However, the actual fuel efficiency may differ in accor- dance with your driving situations (i.e. upward/downward slope, vehi- cle deceleration/acceleration).

When you dynamically drive the vehicle in SMART mode by abrupt- ly decelerating or sharply turning the driving mode changes to SPORT mode. However, it may adversely affect fuel economy.

Various driving situations, which you may encounter in SMART mode

The driving mode automatically changes to ECO mode after a cer- tain period of time, when you gen- tly depress the accelerator pedal (Your driving is categorized to be economical.).

The driving mode automatically changes from SMART ECO mode to SMART COMFORT mode after a certain period of time, when you sharply or repetitively depress the accelerator pedal.

The driving mode automatically changes to SMART COMFORT mode with the same driving pat- terns, when the vehicle starts to drive on an upward slope of a cer- tain angle. The driving mode auto- matically returns to SMART ECO mode, when the vehicle enters a leveled road.

The driving mode automatically changes to SMART SPORT, when you abruptly accelerate the vehicle or repetitively operate the steering wheel (Your driving is categorized to be aggressive.). In this mode, your vehicle drives in a lower gear for abrupt accelerating/decelerat- ing and increases the engine brake performance.

You may still sense the engine braking performance, even when you release the accelerator pedal in SMART SPORT mode. It is because your vehicle remains in lower gear over a certain period of time for next acceleration. Thus, it is a normal driving situation, not indicating any malfunction.

The driving mode automatically changes to SMART SPORT mode only in harsh driving situations. In most of the normal driving situa- tions, the driving mode sets to be either in SMART ECO mode or in SMART COMFORT mode.

i

5-57

Driving your vehicle

5

Limitation of SMART mode

The SMART mode may be limited in following situations. (The OFF indica- tor illuminates in those situations.) The driver uses the paddle shifter

(manual shift mode) : It deactivates SMART mode. The vehicle drives, as the driver manu- ally changes gear with the paddle shifter.

Smart Cruise Control is activated : Smart Cruise Control may deacti- vate the SMART mode when the vehicle is controlled by the set speed of Smart Cruise Control. (SMART mode is not deactivated just by activating Smart Cruise Control.)

The transmission oil temperature is either extremely low or extremely high : The SMART mode can be active in most of the normal driving situa- tions. However, an extremely high/ low transmission oil temperature may temporarily deactivate the SMART mode, because the trans- mission condition is out of normal operation condition.

SPORT SPORT mode manages the driving dynamics by automatically adjusting the steering effort, and

the engine and transmission control logic for enhanced driver perform- ance. When SPORT mode is selected by

rotating the DRIVE MODE selec- tion knob, the SPORT indicator will illuminate.

Whenever the engine is restarted, the drive mode will revert back to COMFORT mode. If SPORT mode is desired, re-select SPORT mode.

When SPORT mode is activated: — The engine RPM will tend to

remain a little higher for a brief time even after releasing the accelerator. This is typical when the SPORT mode is activated.

— Upshifts are delayed when accel- erating

Information In SPORT mode, the fuel efficiency may decrease.

ECO mode When the drive mode is set to ECO mode, the engine and transmission control logic are changed to maximize fuel efficien- cy.

When ECO mode is selected by rotating the DRIVE MODE selec- tion knob, the ECO indicator will illuminate.

The vehicle starts in ECO mode, when the engine was turned OFF in ECO mode.

Information Fuel efficiency depends on the driver’s driving habit and road condition.

i

i

SPORT ECO

5-58

Driving your vehicle

When ECO mode is activated:

The acceleration response may be slightly reduced if the accelerator pedal is depressed moderately.

The air conditioner performance may be limited.

The shift pattern of the automatic transmission may change.

The engine noise may be louder at some automatic transmission shifts as down-shift requires press- ing down more on the accelerator.

The above situations are normal conditions when ECO mode is acti- vated to help improve fuel efficiency.

Limitation of ECO mode operation:

If the following conditions occur while ECO mode is operating, the system operation is limited even though there is no change in the ECO indi- cator.

When the coolant temperature is low: The system will be limited until engine performance becomes nor- mal.

When driving up a hill: The system will be limited to gain power when driving uphill because engine torque is restricted.

When driving the vehicle in manual shift mode using the paddle shifter. The system will be limited accord- ing to the shift location.

5-59

Driving your vehicle

5

The drive mode may be selected according to the driver’s preference or road condition.

Drive Mode The mode changes whenever the DRIVE MODE selection knob is rotated.

SMART mode : SMART mode automatically adjusts the driving mode (ECO COMFORT SPORT) in accor- dance with the driver’s driving habits.

DRIVE MODE INTEGRATED CONTROL SYSTEM (AWD)

OLX2059021N

OLX2059025N/OLX2059024N

OLX2059023N/OLX2059022N

Type A

OLX2059112N/OLX2059111N

OLX2059110N/OLX2059124N

Type B

5-60

Driving your vehicle

SPORT mode : SPORT mode provides sporty but firm riding.

ECO mode : ECO mode helps improve fuel effi- ciency for eco-friendly driving.

COMFORT mode : COMFORT mode provides smooth driving and comfortable riding.

SMART mode SMART mode selects the proper driving mode among ECO, COMFORT, and SPORT by judging

the driver’s driving habits (i.e. Economical or Aggressive) from the brake pedal depression or the steer- ing wheel operation. Rotate the DRIVE/TERRAIN mode

selection knob to activate SMART mode. When SMART mode is acti- vated, the indicator illuminates on the instrument cluster.

The vehicle starts in SMART mode, when the engine was turned OFF in SMART mode.

SMART mode automatically con- trols gear shifting patterns, engine torque, in accordance with the dri- ver’s driving habits.

SMART mode automatically con- trols the vehicle driving, such as gear shifting patterns, engine torque, riding quality (if equipped with the electronic suspension sys- tem), and power distribution (if equipped with the All-Wheel Drive (AWD) system), in accordance with the driver’s driving habits.

Information When you mildly drive the vehicle

in SMART mode, the driving mode changes to ECO mode to improve fuel efficiency. However, the actual fuel efficiency may differ in accor- dance with your driving situations (i.e. upward/downward slope, vehi- cle deceleration/acceleration).

When you dynamically drive the vehicle in SMART mode by abrupt- ly decelerating or sharply turning the driving mode changes to SPORT mode. However, it may adversely affect fuel economy.

Various driving situations, which you may encounter in SMART mode

The driving mode automatically changes to ECO mode after a cer- tain period of time, when you gen- tly depress the accelerator pedal (Your driving is categorized to be economical.).

The driving mode automatically changes from SMART ECO mode to SMART COMFORT mode after a certain period of time, when you sharply or repetitively depress the accelerator pedal.

The driving mode automatically changes to SMART COMFORT mode with the same driving pat- terns, when the vehicle starts to drive on an upward slope of a cer- tain angle. The driving mode auto- matically returns to SMART ECO mode, when the vehicle enters a leveled road.

iSMART

5-61

Driving your vehicle

5

The driving mode automatically changes to SMART SPORT, when you abruptly accelerate the vehicle or repetitively operate the steering wheel (Your driving is categorized to be aggressive.). In this mode, your vehicle drives in a lower gear for abrupt accelerating/decelerat- ing and increases the engine brake performance.

You may still sense the engine braking performance, even when you release the accelerator pedal in SMART SPORT mode. It is because your vehicle remains in lower gear over a certain period of time for next acceleration. Thus, it is a normal driving situation, not indicating any malfunction.

The driving mode automatically changes to SMART SPORT mode only in harsh driving situations. In most of the normal driving situa- tions, the driving mode sets to be either in SMART ECO mode or in SMART COMFORT mode.

Limitation of SMART mode

The SMART mode may be limited in following situations. (The OFF indica- tor illuminates in those situations.) The driver uses the paddle shifter

(manual shift mode) : It deactivates SMART mode. The vehicle drives, as the driver manu- ally changes gear with the paddle shifter.

Smart Cruise Control is activated : Smart Cruise Control may deacti- vate the SMART mode when the vehicle is controlled by the set speed of Smart Cruise Control. (SMART mode is not deactivated just by activating Smart Cruise Control.)

The transmission oil temperature is either extremely low or extremely high : The SMART mode can be active in most of the normal driving situa- tions. However, an extremely high/ low transmission oil temperature may temporarily deactivate the SMART mode, because the trans- mission condition is out of normal operation condition.

SPORT SPORT mode manages the driving dynamics by automatically adjusting the steering effort, and

the engine and transmission control logic for enhanced driver perform- ance. When SPORT mode is selected by

rotating the DRIVE/TERRAIN mode selection knob, the SPORT indicator will illuminate.

Whenever the engine is restarted, the drive mode will revert back to COMFORT mode. If SPORT mode is desired, re-select SPORT mode.

When SPORT mode is activated: — The engine RPM will tend to

remain a little higher for a brief time even after releasing the accelerator. This is typical when the SPORT mode is activated.

— Upshifts are delayed when accel- erating

Information In SPORT mode, the fuel efficiency may decrease.

i

SPORT

5-62

Driving your vehicle

ECO mode When the drive mode is set to ECO mode, the engine and transmission control logic are changed to maximize fuel efficien- cy.

When ECO mode is selected by rotating the DRIVE mode selection knob, the ECO indicator will illumi- nate.

The vehicle starts in ECO mode, when the engine was turned OFF in ECO mode.

Information Fuel efficiency depends on the driver’s driving habit and road condition.

When ECO mode is activated:

The acceleration response may be slightly reduced if the accelerator pedal is depressed moderately.

The air conditioner performance may be limited.

The shift pattern of the automatic transmission may change.

The engine noise may be louder at some automatic transmission shifts as down-shift requires press- ing down more on the accelerator.

The above situations are normal conditions when ECO mode is acti- vated to help improve fuel efficiency.

Limitation of ECO mode operation:

If the following conditions occur while ECO mode is operating, the system operation is limited even though there is no change in the ECO indi- cator.

When the coolant temperature is low: The system will be limited until engine performance becomes nor- mal.

When driving up a hill: The system will be limited to gain power when driving uphill because engine torque is restricted.

When driving the vehicle in manual shift mode using the paddle shifter. The system will be limited accord- ing to the shift location.

i

ECO

5-63

Driving your vehicle

5

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist is designed to help detect and moni- tor the vehicle ahead or help detect a pedestrian or cyclist in the roadway and warn the driver that a collision is imminent with a warning message and an audible warning, and if nec- essary, apply emergency braking.

Junction Turning function (if equipped)

Junction Turning function will help avoid a collision with an oncoming vehicle in an adjacent lane when turning right at a crossroad with the turn signal on by applying emer- gency braking.

Detecting sensor

[1] : Front view camera, [2] : Front radar

Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensors.

FORWARD COLLISION-AVOIDANCE ASSIST (FCA) (SENSOR FUSION) (IF EQUIPPED)

OJX1071255N

OJK071221N

OLX2051137L

OLX2051138L

5-64

Driving your vehicle

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist settings Setting features

Forward Safety

With the engine on, select or dese- lect ‘Driver Assistance Forward Safety’ from the Settings menu to set whether or not to use each function. — If ‘Active Assist’ is selected, the

function will warn the driver with a warning message and an audible warning depending on the collision risk levels. Braking assist will be applied depending on the collision risk.

Do not apply licence plate frame or objects, such as a bumper sticker, film or a bumper guard, near the front radar cover.

Always keep the front radar and cover clean and free of dirt and debris. Use only a soft cloth to wash the vehicle. Do not spray pres- surized water directly on the sensor or sensor cover.

If unnecessary force has been applied to the radar or around the radar, Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist may not properly operate even though a warning message does not appear on the instrument cluster. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Use only genuine parts to repair or replace a damaged front radar cover. Do not apply paint to the front radar cover.

OTM070090N

Take the following precautions to maintain optimal perform- ance of the detecting sensor: Never disassemble the detect-

ing sensor or sensor assem- bly, or apply any impact on it.

If the detecting sensors have been replaced or repaired, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI deal- er.

Never install any accessories or stickers on the front wind- screen, or tint the front wind- screen.

Use extreme caution to keep the front view camera dry.

Never place any reflective objects (for example, white paper, mirror) over the instru- ment panel. Any light reflec- tion may prevent the system from functioning properly.

CAUTION

5-65

Driving your vehicle

5

— If ‘Warning Only’ is selected, the function will warn the driver with a warning message and an audible warning depending on the collision risk levels. Braking will not be assisted.

— If ‘Off’ is selected, the function will turn off. The warning light will illuminate on the cluster.

The driver can monitor Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist ON/OFF status from the Settings menu. If the

warning light remains ON when the function is ON, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Information Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist will turn off when ESC is turned off by pressing and holding the ESC OFF button. The warning light will illuminate on the instrument cluster.

Warning Timing

With the engine on, select ‘Driver Assistance Warning Timing’ from the Settings menu to change the ini- tial warning activation time for Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist. When the vehicle is first delivered, Warning Timing is set to ‘Normal’. If you change the Warning Timing, the warning time of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

i

When the engine is restarted, Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist will always turn on. However, if ‘Off’ is selected after the engine is restarted, the driv- er should always be aware of the surroundings and drive safely.

WARNING

If ‘Warning Only’ is selected, braking is not assisted.

CAUTION

OTMA058089

5-66

Driving your vehicle

Warning Volume

With the engine on, select ‘Driver Assistance Warning Volume’ from the Settings menu to change the Warning Volume to ‘High’, ‘Medium’, ‘Low’ or ‘Off’ for Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist. However, even if ‘Off’ is selected, Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist’s Warning Volume will not turn off but the volume will sound as ‘Low’. If you change the warning volume, the Warning Volume of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

Information If the engine is restarted, Warning Timing and Warning Volume will maintain the previous setting.

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist operation Warning and control The basic function for Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist is to help warn and control the vehicle depend- ing on the collision level: ‘Collision Warning’, ‘Emergency Braking’ and ‘Stopping vehicle and ending brake control’.

i

ONX4E070090

The setting of the Warning Timing and Warning Volume applies to all functions of Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist.

Even though ‘Normal’ is selected for Warning Timing, if the front vehicle suddenly stops, the initial warning acti- vation time may seem late.

Select ‘Late’ for Warning Timing when traffic is light and when driving speed is slow.

CAUTION

5-67

Driving your vehicle

5

Collision Warning To warn the driver of a collision, the ‘Collision Warning’ warning message will appear on the instrument cluster and an audible warning will sound. If a vehicle is detected in front, the function will operate when your vehi- cle speed is between approximately 6 — 100 mph (10 — 160 km/h). If a pedestrian or cyclist is detected in front, the function will operate when your vehicle speed is between approximately 6 — 53 mph (10 — 85 km/h). If ‘Active Assist’ is selected, braking may be assisted.

Emergency Braking To warn the driver that emergency braking will be assisted, the ‘Emergency Braking’ warning mes- sage will appear on the instrument cluster and an audible warning will sound. If a vehicle is detected in front, the system will operate when your vehi- cle speed is between approximately 6 — 50 mph (10 — 80 km/h). If a pedestrian or cyclist is detected in front, the function will operate when your vehicle speed is between approximately 6 — 40 mph (10 — 65 km/h).

In emergency braking situation, braking is assisted with strong brak- ing power by the system to help pre- vent collision with the vehicle ahead.

OLX2051145AU OLX2058027L

5-68

Driving your vehicle

Stopping vehicle and ending brake control When the vehicle is stopped due to

emergency braking, the ‘Drive carefully’ warning message will appear on the instrument cluster. For your safety, the driver should press the brake pedal immediately and check the surroundings.

Brake control will end after the vehicle is stopped by emergency braking for approximately 2 sec- onds.

OLX2051144L

Take the following precautions when using Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist: For your safety, change the

Settings after parking the vehicle at a safe location.

With ‘Active Assist’ or ‘Warning Only’ selected, when ESC is turned off by pressing and holding the ESC OFF but- ton, Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist will turn off automatically. In this case, Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist cannot be set from the Settings menu and the warning light will illuminate on the instrument cluster which is normal. If ESC is turned on by pressing the ESC OFF button, Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist will maintain the last setting.

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist does not operate in all situations or cannot avoid all collisions.

The driver should hold the responsibility to control the vehicle. Do not solely depend on Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist. Rather, maintain a safe braking dis- tance, and if necessary, press the brake pedal to reduce driving speed or to stop the vehicle.

Never deliberately operate Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist on people, animals, objects, etc. It may cause seri- ous injury or death.

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist may not operate if the driver presses the brake pedal to avoid collision.

WARNING

5-69

Driving your vehicle

5

Information In a situation where a collision is imminent, braking may be assisted by Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist when braking is insufficient by the driver.

i

Depending on the road and driving conditions, Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist may warn the driver late or may not warn the driver.

During Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist operation, the vehicle may stop sudden- ly injuring passengers and shifting loose objects. Ensure all occupants have their seat belt on and keep loose objects secured.

If any other system’s warning message is displayed or audi- ble warning is generated, Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist warning message may not be displayed and audible warning may not be generat- ed.

You may not hear the warning sound of Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist if the sur- roundings are noisy.

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist may turn off or may not operate properly or may oper- ate unnecessarily depending on the road conditions and the surroundings.

Even if there is a problem with Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist, the vehicle’s basic braking performance will operate normally.

During emergency braking, braking control by Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist will automatically cancel when the driver excessively presses the accelerator pedal or sharply steers the vehicle.

WARNING

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist operating speed range may reduce due to the condi- tions of the vehicle, pedestri- an or cyclist in front or sur- roundings. Depending on the speed, the function may only warn the driver, or the func- tion may not operate.

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist will operate under cer- tain conditions by judging the risk level based on the condi- tion of the oncoming vehicle, driving direction, speed and surroundings.

CAUTION

5-70

Driving your vehicle

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist malfunction and limita- tions Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist malfunction

When Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist is not working properly, the ‘Check Forward Safety system(s)’ warning message will appear, and the and warning lights will illuminate on the cluster. have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist disabled

When the front windscreen where the front view camera is located, front radar cover or sensor is cov- ered with foreign material, such as snow or rain, it can reduce the detecting performance and tem- porarily limit or disable Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist. If this occurs the ‘Forward Safety system(s) disabled. Radar blocked’ warning message, and the and

warning lights will illumi- nate on the instrument cluster.

The function will operate normally when when such snow, rain or for- eign material is removed. If the function does not operate nor- mally after obstruction (snow, rain, or foreign material) is removed, have the vehicle inspected by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer.

OTM070094L

OTM070095N

Even though the warning message or warning light does not appear on the instru- ment cluster, Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist may not properly operate.

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist may not properly oper- ate in an area (for example, open terrain), where sub- stances are not detected after turning ON the engine.

WARNING

5-71

Driving your vehicle

5

Limitations of the Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist may not operate normally, or the function may operate unexpectedly under the following circumstances: The detecting sensor or the sur-

roundings are contaminated or damaged

The temperature around the front view camera is high or low

The camera lens is contaminated due to tinted, filmed or coated windscreen, damaged glass, or stuck of foreign material (sticker, bug, etc.) on the glass

Moisture is not removed or frozen on the windscreen

Washer fluid is continuously sprayed, or the wiper is on

Driving in heavy rain or snow, or thick fog

The field of view of the front view camera is obstructed by sun glare

Street light or light from an oncom- ing vehicle is reflected on the wet road surface, such as a puddle on the road

An object is placed on the instru- ment panel

Your vehicle is being towed The surroundings are very bright The surroundings are very dark,

such as in a tunnel, etc. The brightness changes suddenly,

for example when entering or exit- ing a tunnel

The brightness outside is low, and the headlamps are not on or are not bright

Driving through steam, smoke or shadow

Only part of the vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist is detected

The vehicle in front is a bus, heavy truck, truck with a unusually shaped luggage, trailer, etc.

The vehicle in front has no tail lights, tail lights are located unusu- ally, etc.

The brightness outside is low, and the tail lamps are not on or are not bright

The rear of the front vehicle is small or the vehicle does not look normal, such as when the vehicle is tilted, overturned, or the side of the vehicle is visible, etc.

The front vehicle’s ground clear- ance is low or high

A vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist suddenly cuts in front

The bumper around the front radar is impacted, damaged or the front radar is out of position

The temperature around the front radar is high or low

Driving through a tunnel or iron bridge

Driving in large areas where there are few vehicles or structures (for example, desert, meadow, suburb, etc.)

5-72

Driving your vehicle

Driving near areas containing metal substances, such as a con- struction zone, railroad, etc.

A material is near that reflects very well on the front radar, such as a guardrail, nearby vehicle, etc.

The cyclist in front is on a bicycle made of material that does not reflect on the front radar

The vehicle in front is detected late The vehicle in front is suddenly

blocked by a obstacle The vehicle in front suddenly

changes lane or suddenly reduces speed

The vehicle in front is bent out of shape

The front vehicle’s speed is fast or slow

The vehicle in front steers in the opposite direction of your vehicle to avoid a collision

With a vehicle in front, your vehicle changes lane at low speed

The vehicle in front is covered with snow

You are departing or returning to the lane

Unstable driving You are on a roundabout and the

vehicle in front is not detected You are continuously driving in a

circle The vehicle in front has an unusu-

al shape The vehicle in front is driving uphill

or downhill The pedestrian or cyclist is not fully

detected, for example, if the pedes- trian is leaning over or is not fully walking upright

The pedestrian or cyclist is wear- ing clothing or equipment that makes it difficult to detect as a pedestrian or cyclist

The illustration above shows the image the front view camera will detect as a vehicle, pedestrian and cyclist. The pedestrian or cyclist in front is

moving very quickly The pedestrian or cyclist in front is

short or is posing a low posture The pedestrian or cyclist in front

has impaired mobility The pedestrian or cyclist in front is

moving intersected with the driving direction

There is a group of pedestrians, cyclists or a large crowd in front

OADAS044N

5-73

Driving your vehicle

5

The pedestrian or cyclist is wear- ing clothing that easily blends into the background, making it difficult to detect

The pedestrian or cyclist is difficult to distinguish from the similar shaped structure in the surround- ings

You are driving by a pedestrian, cyclist, traffic sign, structure, etc., near the intersection

Driving in a parking lot Driving through a tollgate, con-

struction area, unpaved road, par- tial paved road, uneven road, speed bumps, etc.

Driving on an incline road, curved road, etc.

Driving on a roadside with trees or streetlights

The adverse road conditions cause excessive vehicle vibrations while driving

Your vehicle height is low or high due to heavy loads, abnormal tyre pressure, etc.

Driving on a narrow road where trees or grass are overgrown

There is interference from electro- magnetic waves, such as driving in an area with strong radio waves or electrical noise

Driving on a curved road

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist may not detect other vehicles, pedestrians or cyclists in front of you on curved roads adversely affect- ing the performance of the sensors.

WARNING

OADAS016R/OADAS018R

OADAS014R

5-74

Driving your vehicle

This may result in no warning or braking assist when neces- sary. When driving on a bend, you must maintain a safe braking distance, and if necessary, steer the vehicle and press the brake pedal to reduce your driving speed in order to maintain a safe distance.

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist may detect a vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist in the next lane or outside the lane when driving on a curved road. If this occurs, the func- tion may unnecessarily warn the driver and control the brake. Always check the traf- fic conditions around the vehicle.

OADAS017R/OADAS019R

OADAS015R

Driving on a sloped road

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist may not detect other vehicles, pedestrians or cyclists in front of you while driving uphill or downhill adversely affecting the per- formance of the sensors.

OADAS010R/OADAS011R

OADAS012R

5-75

Driving your vehicle

5

This may result in unneces- sary warning or braking assist, or no warning or brak- ing assist when necessary. Also, vehicle speed may rap- idly decrease when a vehicle, pedestrian or cyclist ahead is suddenly detected. Always have your eyes on the road while driving uphill or downhill and if necessary, steer your vehicle and press the brake pedal to reduce your driving speed in order to maintain a safe distance.

Changing lanes

[A] : Your vehicle, [B] : Lane changing vehicle

When a vehicle moves into your lane from an adjacent lane, it cannot be detected by the sensor until it is in the sensor’s detection range.

OADAS030R

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist may not immediately detect the vehicle when the vehicle changes lanes abrupt- ly. In this case, you must maintain a safe braking dis- tance, and if necessary, steer your vehicle and press the brake pedal to reduce your driving speed in order to maintain a safe distance.

Driving your vehicle

5-76

[A] :Your vehicle, [B] : Lane changing vehicle, [C] : Same lane vehicle

When a vehicle in front of you merges out of the lane, Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist may not immediately detect the vehicle that is now in front of you.

OADAS031R

In this case, you must main- tain a safe braking distance, and if necessary, steer your vehicle and press the brake pedal to reduce your driving speed in order to maintain a safe distance.

Detecting vehicle

If the vehicle in front of you has cargo that extends rear- ward from the cab, or when the vehicle in front of you has higher ground clearance, additional special attention is required. Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist may not be able to detect the cargo extending from the vehicle. In these instances, you must maintain a safe braking dis- tance from the rearmost object, and if necessary, steer your vehicle and press the brake pedal to reduce your driving speed in order to maintain distance.

OLX2051077N

5-77

Driving your vehicle

Information This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules.

Operation is subject to the following three conditions:

1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and

2. This device must accept any inter- ference received, including interfer- ence that may cause undesired operation.

3. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the device.

Information Radio frequency radiation exposure information:

This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment.

This equipment should be installed and operated with minimum distance of 8 in. (20 cm) between the radiator (antenna) and your body.

This transmitter must not be co-locat- ed or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.

ii

5

When you are towing a trailer or another vehicle, we recom- mend that Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist is turned off for safety reasons.

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist may operate if objects that are similar in shape or characteristics to vehicles, pedestrians and cyclists are detected.

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist does not operate for bicycles, motorcycles, or smaller wheeled objects, such as luggage bags, shopping carts, or strollers.

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist may not operate nor- mally if interfered by strong electromagnetic waves.

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist may not operate for 15 seconds after the vehicle is started, or the front view cam- era is initialized.

WARNING

5-78

Driving your vehicle

Lane Keeping Assist is designed to help detect lane markings (or road edges) while driving over a certain speed. Lane Keeping Assist will warn the driver if the vehicle leaves the lane without using the turn signal, or will automatically assist the drivers steering to help prevent the vehicle from departing the lane.

Detecting sensor

[1] : Front view camera

The front view camera is used as a detecting sensor to detect lane markings (or road edges). Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensor.

Lane Keeping Assist settings Setting features

Lane Safety

With the engine on, select or dese- lect Driver Assistance Lane Safety from the Settings menu to set whether or not to use each function.

LANE KEEPING ASSIST (LKA) (IF EQUIPPED)

OLX2051137L

For more details on the precau- tions of the front view camera, refer to Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist (FCA) sec- tion in this chapter.

CAUTION

OTM070184N

5-79

Driving your vehicle

5

— If Assist is selected, Lane Keeping Assist will automatically assist the drivers steering when lane depar- ture is detected to help prevent the vehicle from moving out of its lane.

— If ‘Warning Only’ is selected, Lane Keeping Assist will warn the driver with an audible warning and steer- ing wheel vibration when lane departure is detected. The driver must steer the vehicle.

— If Off is selected, Lane Keeping Assist will turn off. The indica- tor light will turn off on the cluster.

Turning Lane Keeping Assist On/Off

With the engine on, press and hold the Lane Safety button located on the instrument panel to turn on Lane Keeping Assist. The white indi- cator light will illuminate on the clus- ter. Press and hold the button again to turn off the function. If the engine is restarted, Lane Keeping Assist will maintain the last setting.

Information When the Lane Driving Assist button is pressed shortly, Lane Following Assist will turn on and off.

Warning Volume

With the engine on, select ‘Driver Assistance Warning Volume’ from the Settings menu to change the Warning Volume to ‘High’, ‘Medium’, ‘Low’ or ‘Off’ for Highway Driving Assist. However, even if ‘Off’ is selected, Lane Keeping Assist’s Warning Volume will not turn off but the vol- ume will sound as ‘Low’. If you change the warning volume, the Warning Volume of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

i

If ‘Warning Only’ is selected, steering is not assisted.

Lane Keeping Assist does not control the steering wheel when the vehicle is driven in the middle of the lane.

The driver should always be aware of the surroundings and steer the vehicle if Off is selected.

WARNING

OLX2059057L ONX4E070090

5-80

Driving your vehicle

Lane Keeping Assist operation Warning and control Lane Keeping Assist will warn and control the vehicle with Lane Departure Warning and Lane Keeping Assist.

Lane Departure Warning

To warn the driver that the vehicle is departing from the projected lane in front, the green indica- tor light will blink on the cluster, the lane line will blink on the cluster depending on which direction the vehicle is veering, and an audible warning will sound. Also, the steer- ing wheel will vibrate.

Lane Keeping Assist will operate when your vehicle speed is between approximately 40 112 mph (64 180 km/h).

Lane Keeping Assist

To warn the driver that the vehicle is departing from the projected lane in front, the green indica- tor light will blink on the cluster, and the steering wheel will make adjustments to keep vehicle inside the lane.

Lane Keeping Assist will operate when your vehicle speed is between approximately 40 112 mph (64 180 km/h).

OLX2051061N/OLX2051060N

Left Right

5-81

Driving your vehicle

5

Hands-off warning

If the driver takes their hands off the steering wheel for several seconds, the Place hands on the steering wheel warning message will appear on the cluster, and an audible warn- ing will sound in stages.

Information You may change settings from the

instrument cluster (User Settings) or infotainment system (Vehicle Settings), whichever option that is provided with your vehicle. For more details, see «User Settings» section in chapter 4, or «Vehicle Settings» section in supplied Infotainment Manual.

When lane markings (or road edges) are detected, the lane lines on the cluster will change from grey to white and the green indicator light will illuminate.

i

OLX2058062L

The steering wheel may not be assisted if the steering wheel is held very tight or the steering wheel is steered over a certain degree.

Lane Keeping Assist does not operate at all times. It is the responsibility of the driver to safely steer the vehicle and to maintain the vehicle in its lane.

The handsoff warning mes- sage may appear late depend- ing on road conditions. Always have your hands on the steering wheel while driv- ing.

If the steering wheel is held very lightly, the handsoff warning message may appear because Lane Keeping Assist may not recognize that the driver has their hands on the steering wheel.

If you attach objects to the steering wheel, the hands-off warning may not work proper- ly.

WARNING

5-82

Driving your vehicle

Even though the steering is assisted by Lane Keeping Assist, the driver may control the steering wheel.

The steering wheel may feel heavier or lighter when the steering wheel is assisted by Lane Keeping Assist than when it is not.

Lane Keeping Assist malfunc- tion and limitations Lane Keeping Assist malfunc- tion

When Lane Keeping Assist is not working properly, the Check Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) system warn- ing message will appear and the yel- low indicator light will illuminate on the cluster. If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Limitations of Lane Keeping Assist Lane Keeping Assist may not oper- ate normally or may operate unex- pectedly under the following circum- stances: The lane is contaminated or diffi-

cult to distinguish because, — The lane markings (or road edge)

is covered with rain, snow, dirt, oil, etc.

— The color of the lane marking (or road edge) is not distinguishable from the road

— There are markings (or road edges) on the road near the lane or the markings (or road edges) on the road looks similar to the lane markings (or road edge)

— The lane marking (or road edge) is indistinct or damaged

— The shadow is on the lane mark- ing (or road edge) by a median strip, trees, guardrail, noise barri- ers, etc.

OTM070035L

OLX2058058L/OLX2058059L

Lane undetected Lane detected

5-83

Driving your vehicle

5

The lane number increases or decreases, or the lane markings (or road edges) are crossing

There are more than two lane markings (or road edges) on the road

The lane markings (or road edges) are complicated or a structure sub- stitutes for the lines, such as a con- struction area

There are road markings, such as zigzag lanes, crosswalk markings and road signs

The lane suddenly disappears, such as at the intersection

The lane (or road width) is very wide or narrow

There is a road edge without a lane There is a boundary structure in

the roadway, such as a tollgate, sidewalk, curb, etc.

The distance to the front vehicle is extremely short or the vehicle in front is covering the lane marking (or road edge)

Information For more details on the limitations of the front view camera, refer to Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) section in this chapter.

i

Take the following precautions when using Lane Keeping Assist: The driver should hold the

responsibility to safely drive and control the vehicle. Do not solely rely on Lane Keeping Assist and drive dan- gerously.

The operation of Lane Keeping Assist can be can- celled or not work properly depending on road conditions and surroundings. Always be cautious while driving.

Refer to Limitations of Lane Keeping Assist if the lane is not detected properly.

WARNING

When you are towing a trailer or another vehicle, we recom- mend that Lane Keeping Assist is turned off due to safety reasons.

If the vehicle is driven at high speed, the steering wheel will not be controlled. The driver must always follow the speed limit when using Lane Keeping Assist.

If any other systems warning message is displayed or audi- ble warning is generated, Lane Keeping Assist warning message may not be dis- played and audible warning may not be generated.

You may not hear the warning sound of Lane Keeping Assist if the surrounding is noisy.

If you attach objects to the steering wheel, steering may not be assisted properly.

5-84

Driving your vehicle

Information This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules.

Operation is subject to the following three conditions:

1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and

2. This device must accept any inter- ference received, including interfer- ence that may cause undesired operation.

3. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the device.

Information Radio frequency radiation exposure information:

This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment.

This equipment should be installed and operated with minimum distance of 8 in. (20 cm) between the radiator (antenna) and your body.

This transmitter must not be co-locat- ed or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter

ii Lane Keeping Assist may not operate for 15 seconds after the vehicle is started, or the front view camera is initial- ized.

Lane Keeping Assist will not operate when: — The turn signal or hazard

warning flasher is turned on. — The vehicle is not driven in

the center of the lane when Lane Keeping Assist is turned on or right after changing a lane.

— ESC (Electronic Stability Control) or VSM (Vehicle Stability Management) is activated.

— The vehicle is driven on a sharp curve.

— Vehicle speed is below 34 mph (55 km/h) or above 112 mph (180 km/h).

— The vehicle makes sharp lane changes.

— The vehicle brakes suddenly.

5-85

Driving your vehicle

5

BLIND-SPOT COLLISON WARNING (BCW) (IF EQUIPPED) Blind-Spot Collision Warning is designed to help detect and monitor approaching vehicles in the drivers blind spot area and warn the driver of a possible collision with a warning message and audible warning.

Blind-Spot Collision Warning helps detect and inform the driver that a vehicle is in the blind spot.

Blind-Spot Collision Warning helps detect and inform the driver that a vehicle is approaching at high speed from the blind spot area.

Detecting sensor

[1] : Rear corner radar

Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensor.OJX1079256

OJX1079026

OLX2051139L

The detecting range may vary depending on the speed of your vehicle. However, even if there is a vehicle in the blind spot, the function may not warn you when you pass by at high speed.

CAUTION

Warning timing may vary depending on the speed of the vehicle approaching at high speed.

CAUTION

5-86

Driving your vehicle

Blind-Spot Collision Warning settings settings Setting features

Blind-Spot Safety

With the engine on, select or dese- lect Driver assistance Blind-spot safety from the Settings menu to set whether or not to use each function. — If Warning Only is selected, the

function will warn the driver with a warning message, an audible warning and steering wheel vibra- tion depending on the collision risk levels.

— If Off is selected, the function will turn off.

OTM070202N

Take the following precautions to maintain optimal perform- ance of the detecting sensor: Never disassemble the rear

corner radar or radar assem- bly, or apply any impact on it.

If the rear corner radars have been replaced or repaired, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI deal- er.

If there is impact on the rear corner radar or near the radar, even though the warning mes- sage does not appear on the cluster, Blind-Spot Safety sys- tem may not operate properly. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI deal- er.

Use only genuine parts to repair the rear bumper where the rear corner radar is locat- ed.

Do not apply license plate frame or objects, such as a bumper sticker, film or a bumper guard near the rear corner radar.

The function may not work properly if the bumper has been replaced, or the sur- roundings of the rear corner radar has been damaged or paint has been applied.

If a trailer, carrier, etc. is installed, it may adversely affect the performance of the rear corner radar or the func- tion may not operate.

CAUTION

For more details on the precau- tions of the front view camera, refer to Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist (FCA) sec- tion in chapter 5.

CAUTION

5-87

Driving your vehicle

5

If you press Blind-Spot Safety but- ton while ‘Warning only’ is selected the indicator on the button extin- guishes and the system deacti- vates.

If you press Blind-Spot Safety but- ton while the system is cancelled the indicator on the button illumi- nates and the function activates. In this case, the function returns to the state before the engine turned off. When the function is initially turned on and when the engine is turned off then on again while the function is in activation, the warning light will illuminate for 3 seconds on the outside rearview mirror.

When the engine is restarted with the function off, the Blind-Spot Safety System is Off message will appear on the cluster. If you change the setting from Off to Warning Only, the warning light on the outside rearview mirror will blink for three seconds. In addition, if the engine is turned on, when Blind-Spot Collision Warning is set to Warning Only, the warning light on the outside rearview mirror will blink for three seconds.

Information If the engine is restarted, Blind-Spot Safety system will maintain the last setting.

i OLX2059032L OTM070097N

If Warning only is selected, braking is not assisted.

If Off is selected, the driver should always be aware of the surroundings and drive safe- ly.

WARNING

5-88

Driving your vehicle

Warning Timing

With the engine on, select Driver assistance Warning timing from the Settings menu to change the ini- tial warning activation time for Blind- Spot Safety system. When the vehicle is first delivered, Warning Timing is set to Normal. If you change the Warning Timing, the warning time of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

Warning Volume

With the engine on, select ‘Driver Assistance Warning Volume’ from the Settings menu to change the Warning Volume to ‘High’, ‘Medium’, ‘Low’ or ‘Off’ for Blind Spot Collision Warning. However, even if ‘Off’ is selected, Blind-Spot Collision Warning’s Warning Volume will not turn off but the volume will sound as ‘Low’. If you change the warning volume, the Warning Volume of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

OTMA058089

The setting of the Warning Timing and Warning Volume applies to all functions of the Blind-Spot Safety system.

Even though Normal is selected for Warning Timing, if the vehicles approaches at high speed, the initial warning activation time may seem late.

Select Later for Warning Timing when traffic is light and when driving speed is slow.

CAUTION

ONX4E070090

5-89

Driving your vehicle

5

Blind-Spot Collision Warning operation Warning and control

Vehicle detection

To warn the driver a vehicle is detected, the warning light on the outside rearview mirror and head- up display (if equipped) will illumi- nate.

Blind-Spot Collision Warning will operate when your vehicle speed is above 20 mph (30 km/h) and the speed of the vehicle in the blind spot area is above 7 mph (10 km/h).

Collision warning

Collision warning will operate when the turn signal is turned on in the direction of the detected vehicle.

To warn the driver of a collision, the warning light on the outside rearview mirror and head-up dis- play (if equipped) will blink. At the same time, an audible warning will sound.

When the turn signal is turned off or you move away from the lane, the collision warning will be can- celed and the function will return to vehicle detection state.

Information If the driver’s seat is on the left side, the collision warning may occur when you turn left. Maintain a proper dis- tance with the vehicles in the left lane. If the driver’s seat is on the right side, the collision warning may occur when you turn right. Maintain a proper dis- tance with the vehicles in the right lane.

i

ORG3070025

The detecting range of the rear corner radar is deter- mined by the standard road width, therefore, on a narrow road, the function may detect other vehicles in the next next lane and warn you. In con- trast, on a wide road, the func- tion may not be able to detect a vehicle driving in the next lane and may not warn you.

When the hazard warning light is on, the collision warn- ing by the turn signal will not operate.

WARNING

5-90

Driving your vehicle

Blind-Spot Collision Warning malfunction and limitations Blind-Spot Collision Warning malfunction

When Blind-Spot Collision Warning is not working properly, the Check Blind-Spot Safety system warning message will appear on the cluster, and the Blind-Spot Collision Warning turn off automatically, or the function will be limited. We recommend that Blind-Spot Collision Warning be inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

OTM070099N

Take the following precautions when using Blind-Spot Safety system: For your safety, change the

Settings after parking the vehicle at a safe location.

If any other systems warning message is displayed or audi- ble warning is generated, Blind-Spot Safety systems warning message may not be displayed and audible warn- ing may not be generated.

You may not hear the warning sound of Blind-Spot Safety system if the surrounding is noisy.

Blind-Spot Safety system may warn the driver late or may not warn the driver depending on the road and driving condi- tions.

Driver should maintain con- trol of the vehicle at all times. Do not depend on Blind-Spot Safety system. Maintain a safe braking distance, and if nec- essary, depress the brake pedal to reduce driving speed or to stop the vehicle.

WARNING

5-91

Driving your vehicle

5

When the outside rearview mirror warning light is not working properly, the Check side view mirror warning light warning message will appear on the cluster. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Blind-Spot Collision Warning disabled

When the rear bumper around the rear corner radar or sensor is cov- ered with foreign material, such as snow or rain, or installing a trailer or carrier, it can reduce the detecting performance and temporarily limit or disable Blind-Spot Safety system. If this occurs, the Blind-Spot Safety system disabled. Radar blocked warning message will appear on the cluster. Blind-Spot Collision Warning will operate normally when such foreign material or trailer, etc. is removed, and then the engine is restarted.

If the function does not operate nor- mally after it is removed, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

OTM070098N

OTM070100N

Even though the warning message does not appear on the cluster, Blind-Spot Safety system may not properly operate.

Blind-Spot Safety system may not properly operate in an area (e.g. open terrain), where any substance are not detect- ed right after the engine is turned on, or when the detect- ing sensor is blocked with for- eign material right after the engine is turned on.

WARNING

Turn off Blind-Spot Safety sys- tem to install a trailer, carrier, etc., or remove the trailer, carri- er, etc. to use Blind-Spot Safety system.

CAUTION

5-92

Driving your vehicle

Limitations of Blind-Spot Collision Warning Blind-Spot Collision Warning may not operate normally, or the function may operate unexpectedly under the fol- lowing circumstances: There is inclement weather, such

as heavy snow, heavy rain, etc. The rear corner radar is covered

with snow, rain, dirt, etc. The temperature around the rear

corner radar is high or low Driving on a highway (or motor-

way) ramp The road pavement (or the periph-

eral ground) abnormally contains metallic components (i.e. possibly due to subway construction)

There is a fixed object near the vehicle, such as sound barriers, guardrails, central dividers, entry barriers, street lamps, signs, tun- nels, walls, etc. (including double structures)

Driving in large areas where there are few vehicles or structures (i.e. desert, meadow, suburb, etc.)

Driving through a narrow road where trees or grass are over- grown

Driving on a wet road surface, such as a puddle on the road

The other vehicle drives very close behind your vehicle, or the other vehicle passes by your vehicle in close proximity

The speed of the other vehicle is very fast that it passes by your vehicle in a short time

Your vehicle passes by the other vehicle

Your vehicle changes lane Your vehicle has started at the

same time as the vehicle next to you and has accelerated

The vehicle in the next lane moves two lanes away from you, or when the vehicle two lanes away moves to the next lane from you

A trailer or carrier is installed around the rear corner radar

The bumper around the rear cor- ner radar is covered with objects, such as a bumper sticker, bumper guard, bike rack, etc.

The bumper around the rear cor- ner radar is impacted, damaged or the radar is out of position

Your vehicle height is low or high due to heavy loads, abnormal tire pressure, etc.

5-93

Driving your vehicle

5

Blind-Spot Collision Warning may not operate normally, or the function may operate unexpectedly when the fol- lowing objects are detected: A motorcycle or bicycle is detected A vehicle such as a flat trailer is

detected A big vehicle such as a bus or truck

is detected A moving obstacle such as a

pedestrian, animal, shopping cart or a baby stroller is detected

A vehicle with low height such as a sports car is detected

For more details on the limita- tions of the front view camera, refer to Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist (FCA) and Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) section in chapter 5.

CAUTION

Driving on a curved road

Blind-Spot Collision Warning may not operate properly when driving on a curved road. The function may not detect the vehicle in the next lane. Always pay attention to road and driving conditions while driving.

Blind-Spot Collision Warning may not operate properly when driving on the curved road. The function may recog- nize the vehicle in the same lane. Always pay attention to road and driving conditions while driving.

WARNING

OJX1079057

OJX1079058

5-94

Driving your vehicle

Driving where the road is merging/dividing

Blind-Spot Collision Warning may not operate properly when driving where the road merges or divides. The func- tion may not detect the vehi- cle in the next lane. Always pay attention to road and driving conditions while driving.

Driving on an inclined road

Blind-Spot Collision Warning may not operate properly when driving on a slope. The function may not detect the vehicle in the next lane or may incorrectly detect the ground or structure. Always pay attention to road and driving conditions while driving.

Driving where the heights of the lanes are different

Blind-Spot Collision Warning may not operate properly when driving where the heights of the lanes are differ- ent. The function may not detect the vehicle on a road with different lane heights (underpass joining section, grade separated intersec- tions, etc.). Always pay attention to road and driving conditions while driving.

OJX1079059

OLX2058040

OLX2058039

5-95

Driving your vehicle

5

Information This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules.

Operation is subject to the following three conditions:

1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and

2. This device must accept any inter- ference received, including interfer- ence that may cause undesired operation.

3. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the device.

Information Radio frequency radiation exposure information:

This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment.

This equipment should be installed and operated with minimum distance of 8 in. (20 cm) between the radiator (antenna) and your body.

This transmitter must not be co-locat- ed or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.

ii

When you are towing a trailer or another vehicle, make sure that you turn off Blind-Spot Collision Warning.

Blind-Spot Collision Warning may not operate normally if interfered by strong electro- magnetic waves.

Blind-Spot Collision Warning may not operate for 15 sec- onds after the vehicle is start- ed, or the rear corner radars are initialized.

WARNING

5-96

Driving your vehicle

Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist is designed to help detect and monitor approaching vehicles in the drivers blind spot area and warn the driver of a possible collision with a warning message and audible warn- ing. In addition, if there is a risk of colli- sion when changing lanes or driving forward out of a parking space, the function will help avoid collision by applying the brake. Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance

Assist helps detect and inform the driver that a vehicle is in the blind spot.

Blind-Spot Collision Assist helps detect and inform the driver that a vehicle is approaching at high speed from the blind spot area.

BLIND-SPOT COLLISION-AVOIDANCE ASSIST (BCA) (IF EQUIPPED)

OJX1079256 OJX1079026

The detecting range may vary depending on the speed of your vehicle. However, even if there is a vehicle in the blind spot, the function may not warn you when you pass by at high speeds.

CAUTION

Warning timing may vary depending on the speed of the vehicle approaching at high speed.

CAUTION

5-97

Driving your vehicle

5

When changing lanes by detecting the lane ahead, if the function judges that there is a collision risk with an approaching vehicle in the blind spot, the function will help avoid collision by applying the brake.

When you are driving forward out of a parking space, if the function judges that there is a collision risk with an approaching vehicle in the blind spot, the function will help avoid collision by applying the brake.

Detecting sensor

[1] : Front view camera, [2] : Rear corner radar

Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensors.

OJX1079027 OJX1079028

OLX2051137L

OLX2051140L

5-98

Driving your vehicle

Blind-Spot Collision Warning settings Setting features

Blind-Spot Safety

With the engine on, select or dese- lect Driver assistance Blind-spot safety from the Settings menu to set whether or not to use each function.

OTM070096N

Take the following precautions to maintain optimal perform- ance of the detecting sensor: Never disassemble the rear

corner radar or radar assem- bly, or apply any impact on it.

If there is impact on the rear corner radar or near the radar, even though the warning mes- sage does not appear on the cluster, Blind-Spot Safety sys- tem may not operate properly. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI deal- er.

If the rear corner radars have been replaced or repaired, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI deal- er.

Use only genuine parts to repair the rear bumper where the rear corner radar is locat- ed.

Do not apply license plate frame or objects, such as a bumper sticker, film or a bumper guard near the rear corner radar.

The function may not work properly if the bumper has been replaced, or the sur- roundings of the rear corner radar has been damaged or paint has been applied.

If a trailer, carrier, etc. is installed, it may adversely affect the performance of the rear corner radar or the func- tion may not operate.

CAUTION

For more details on the precau- tions of the front view camera, refer to Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist (FCA) sec- tion in chapter 5.

CAUTION

5-99

Driving your vehicle

5

— If Active Assist is selected, the function will warn the driver with a warning message, an audible warning, steering wheel vibration and braking assist will be applied depending on the collision risk lev- els.

— If Warning Only is selected, the function will warn the driver with a warning message, an audible warning and steering wheel vibra- tion depending on the collision risk levels. Braking will not be assisted.

— If Off is selected, the function will turn off.

If you press the Blind-Spot Safety button while ‘Active assist’ or ‘Warning only’ is selected the indi- cator on the button will turn off and the system will deactivate.

If you press the Blind-Spot Safety button while the system is cancelled the indicator on the button illumi- nates and the function activates. In this case, the function returns to the state before the engine was turned off. When Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist is initially turned on and when the engine is turned off then on again while the function is in activation, the warning light will illuminate for 3 seconds on the outside rearview mirror.

When the engine is restarted with the function off, the Blind-Spot Safety System is Off message will appear on the cluster. If you change the setting from Off to Active Assist or Warning Only, the warning light on the outside rearview mirror will blink for three seconds. In addition, if the engine is turned on, when the function is set to Active Assist or Warning Only, the warning light on the outside rearview mirror will blink for three seconds.

OLX2059032L OTM070097N

5-100

Driving your vehicle

Information If the engine is restarted, Blind-Spot Safety system will maintain the last setting.

Warning Timing

With the engine on, select Driver assistance Warning timing from the Settings menu to change the ini- tial warning activation time for Blind- Spot Safety system. When the vehicle is first delivered, Warning Timing is set to Normal. If you change the Warning Timing, the warning time of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

Warning Volume

With the engine on, select ‘Driver Assistance Warning Volume’ from the Settings menu to change the Warning Volume to ‘High’, ‘Medium’, ‘Low’ or ‘Off’ for Blind Spot Collision Avoidance Assist. However, even if ‘Off’ is selected, Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist’s Warning Volume will not turn off but the volume will sound as ‘Low’. If you change the warning volume, the Warning Volume of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

i OTMA058089

If Warning Only is selected, braking is not assisted.

If Off is selected, the driver should always be aware of the surroundings and drive safe- ly.

WARNING

ONX4E070090

5-101

Driving your vehicle

5

Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist operation Warning and control

Vehicle detection

To warn the driver a vehicle is detected, the warning light on the outside rearview mirror and head- up display (if equipped) will illumi- nate.

Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist will operate when your vehi- cle speed is above 12 mph (20 km/h) and the speed of the vehicle in the blind spot area is above 7 mph (10 km/h).

Collision Warning

Collision warning will operate when the turn signal is turned on in the direction of the detected vehicle.

If Warning Only is selected from the Settings menu, the collision warning will operate when your vehicle approaches the lane the blind spot vehicle is detected.

To warn the driver of a collision, the warning light on the outside rearview mirror and head-up dis- play (if equipped) will blink. At the same time, an audible warning will sound and the steering wheel will vibrate.

When the turn signal is turned off or you move away from the lane, the collision warning will be can- celed and the function will return to vehicle detection state.

The setting of the Warning Timing and Warning Volume applies to all functions of the Blind-Spot Safety system.

Even though Normal is selected for Warning Timing, if the vehicles approaches at high speed, the initial warning activation time may seem late.

Select Later for Warning Timing when traffic is light and when driving speed is slow.

CAUTION

ORG3070025

5-102

Driving your vehicle

Information If the driver’s seat is on the left side, the collision warning may occur when you turn left. Maintain a proper dis- tance with the vehicles in the left lane. If the driver’s seat is on the right side, the collision warning may occur when you turn right. Maintain a proper dis- tance with the vehicles in the right lane.

Collision-Avoidance Assist (while driving)

To warn the driver of a collision, the warning light on the outside rearview mirror will blink and a warning message will appear on the cluster. At the same time, an audible warning will sound, warn- ing light on the head-up display (if equipped) will blink and the steer- ing wheel will vibrate.

Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist will operate when your vehi- cle speed is between 40 120 mph (60 200 km/h) and both lane markings of the driving lane are detected.

Emergency braking will be assist- ed to help prevent collision with the vehicle in the blind spot area.

i

OLX2051141L

The detecting range of the rear corner radar is deter- mined by a standard road width, therefore, on a narrow road, Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist may detect other vehicles in the next next lane and warn you. In con- trast, on a wide road, the func- tion may not be able to detect a vehicle driving in the next lane and may not warn you.

When the hazard warning flasher is on, the collision warning by the turn signal will not operate.

WARNING

Collision-Avoidance Assist will be canceled under the fol- lowing circumstances: — Your vehicle enters the next

lane by a certain distance — Your vehicle is away from

the collision risk — The steering wheel is

sharply steered — The brake pedal is

depressed — Forward Collision-

Avoidance Assist is operat- ing

After Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist operation or changing lane, you must drive to the center of the lane. The function will not operate if the vehicle is not driven in the center of the lane.

WARNING

5-103

Driving your vehicle

5

Collision-Avoidance Assist (while departing)

To warn the driver of a collision, the warning light on the outside rearview mirror will blink and a warning message will appear on the cluster. At the same time, an audible warning will sound, warn- ing light on the head-up display (if equipped) will blink and the steer- ing wheel will vibrate.

Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist will operate when your vehi- cle speed is below 2 mph (3 km/h) and the speed of the vehicle in the blind spot area is above 3 mph (5 km/h).

Emergency braking will be assist- ed to help prevent collision with the vehicle in the blind spot area.

Stopping vehicle and ending brake control

When the vehicle is stopped due to emergency braking, the Emergency Braking complete warning message will appear on the cluster. For your safety, the driver should depress the brake pedal immedi- ately and check the surroundings.

Brake control will end after the vehicle is stopped by emergency braking for approximately 2 sec- onds.

OLX2051149L OTM070059L

Take the following precautions when using Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist: For your safety, change the

Settings after parking the vehicle at a safe location.

If any other systems warning message is displayed or audi- ble warning is generated, Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assists warning message may not be dis- played and audible warning may not be generated.

You may not hear the warning sound of Blind-Spot Safety system if the surrounding is noisy.

Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist may not operate if the driver applies the brake pedal to avoid colli- sion.

WARNING

5-104

Driving your vehicle

When Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist is operat- ing, braking control by the function will automatically cancel when the driver exces- sively depresses the accelera- tor pedal or sharply steers the vehicle.

During Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist operation, the vehicle may stop sudden- ly injuring passengers and shifting loose objects. Always have the seat belt on and keep loose objects secured.

Even if there is a problem with Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist, the vehi- cles basic braking perform- ance will operate normally.

Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist does not operate in all situations or cannot avoid all collisions.

Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist may warn the driver late or may not warn the driver depending on the road and driving conditions.

Driver should maintain con- trol of the vehicle at all times. Do not depend on Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist. Maintain a safe braking dis- tance, and if necessary, depress the brake pedal to reduce driving speed or to stop the vehicle.

Never operate Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist on people, animal, objects, etc. It may cause serious injury or death.

The brake control may not oper- ate properly depending on the status of ESC (Electronic Stability Control). There will only be a warning when: The ESC (Electronic Stability

Control) warning light is on ESC (Electronic Stability

Control) is engaged in a differ- ent function

WARNING

5-105

Driving your vehicle

5

Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist malfunction and limitations Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist malfunction

When Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist is not working properly, the Check Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist warning message will appear on the cluster, and the function will turn off automat- ically or the function will be limited. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

When the outside rearview mirror warning light is not working properly, the Check side view mirror warning light warning message will appear on the cluster. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist disabled

When the rear bumper around the rear corner radar or sensor is cov- ered with foreign material, such as snow or rain, or installing a trailer or carrier, it can reduce the detecting performance and temporarily limit or disable Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist. If this occurs, the Blind-Spot Safety system disabled. Radar blocked warning message will appear on the cluster.

OTM070099N

OTM070098N

OTM070100N

5-106

Driving your vehicle

Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist will operate normally when such foreign material or trailer, etc. is removed, and then the engine is restarted. If Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist does not operate normally after it is removed, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Limitations of Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist may not operate normally, or the function may operate unexpect- edly under the following circum- stances: There is inclement weather, such

as heavy snow, heavy rain, etc. The rear corner radar is covered

with snow, rain, dirt, etc. The temperature around the rear

corner radar is high or low Driving on a highway (or motor-

way) ramp The road pavement (or the periph-

eral ground) abnormally contains metallic components (i.e. possibly due to subway construction)

There is a fixed object near the vehicle, such as sound barriers, guardrails, central dividers, entry barriers, street lamps, signs, tun- nels, walls, etc. (including double structures)

Driving in large areas where there are few vehicles or structures (i.e. desert, meadow, suburb, etc.)

Even though the warning message does not appear on the cluster, Blind-Spot Safety system may not properly operate.

Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist may not properly operate in an area (e.g. open terrain) where any substance are not detected right after the engine is turned on, or when the detecting sen- sor is blocked with foreign material right after the engine is turned on.

WARNING

Turn off Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist to install a trailer, carrier, etc., or remove the trailer, carrier, etc. to use Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist.

CAUTION

5-107

Driving your vehicle

5

Driving through a narrow road where trees or grass are over- grown

Driving on a wet road surface, such as a puddle on the road

The other vehicle drives very close behind your vehicle, or the other vehicle passes by your vehicle in close proximity

The speed of the other vehicle is very fast that it passes by your vehicle in a short time

Your vehicle passes by the other vehicle

Your vehicle changes lane Your vehicle has started at the

same time as the vehicle next to you and has accelerated

The vehicle in the next lane moves two lanes away from you, or when the vehicle two lanes away moves to the next lane from you

A trailer or carrier is installed around the rear corner radar

The bumper around the rear cor- ner radar is covered with objects, such as a bumper sticker, bumper guard, bike rack, etc.

The bumper around the rear cor- ner radar is impacted, damaged or the radar is out of position

Your vehicle height is low or high due to heavy loads, abnormal tire pressure, etc.

Blind-Spot Safety system may not operate normally, or the function may operate unexpectedly when the fol- lowing objects are detected: A motorcycle or bicycle is detected A vehicle such as a flat trailer is

detected A big vehicle such as a bus or truck

is detected A moving obstacle such as a

pedestrian, animal, shopping cart or a baby stroller is detected

A vehicle with low height such as a sports car is detected

Braking control may not work, dri- vers attention is required in the fol- lowing circumstances: The vehicle severely vibrates while

driving over a bumpy road, uneven road or concrete patch

Driving on a slippery surface due to snow, water puddle, ice, etc.

The tire pressure is low or a tire is damaged

The brake is reworked The vehicle makes abrupt lane

changes

5-108

Driving your vehicle

For more details on the limita- tions of the front view camera, refer to Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist (FCA) and Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) section in chapter 5.

CAUTION

Driving on a curved road

Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist may not operate properly when driving on a curved road.The function may not detect the vehicle in the next lane. Always pay attention to road and driving conditions while driving.

Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist may not operate properly when driving on a curved road.The function may recognize a vehicle in the same lane. Always pay attention to road and driving conditions while driving.

WARNING

OJX1079057

OJX1079058

5-109

Driving your vehicle

5

Driving where the road is merging/dividing

Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist may not operate properly when driving where the road merges or divides. The function may not detect the vehicle in the next lane. Always pay attention to road and driving conditions while driving.

Driving on an inclined road

Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist may not operate properly when driving on a slope. The function may not detect the vehicle in the next lane or may incorrectly detect the ground or struc- ture. Always pay attention to road and driving conditions while driving.

Driving where the heights of the lanes are different

Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist may not operate properly when driving where the heights of the lanes are different.The function may not detect the vehicle on a road with different lane heights (underpass joining section, grade separated intersections, etc.). Always pay attention to road and driving conditions while driving.

OJX1079059

OLX2058040

OLX2058039

5-110

Driving your vehicle

Information This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules.

Operation is subject to the following three conditions:

1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and

2. This device must accept any inter- ference received, including interfer- ence that may cause undesired operation.

3. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the device.

Information Radio frequency radiation exposure information:

This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment.

This equipment should be installed and operated with minimum distance of 8 in. (20 cm) between the radiator (antenna) and your body.

This transmitter must not be co-locat- ed or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.

ii

When you are towing a trailer or another vehicle, make sure that you turn off Blind-Spot Safety system.

Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist may not operate normally if interfered by strong electromagnetic waves.

Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist may not operate for 15 seconds after the vehicle is started, or the front view camera or rear cor- ner radars are initialized.

WARNING

5-111

Driving your vehicle

5

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning is designed to help detect vehicles approaching from the left and right side while your vehicle is reversing, and warn the driver that a collision is imminent with a warning message and an audible warning.

[A] : Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning

operating range

Information In the following text, Rear Cross- Traffic Collision Warning will be referred as Rear Cross-Traffic Safety system.

Detecting sensor

[1] : Rear corner radar

Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensor.

i

REAR CROSS-TRAFFIC COLLISION WARNING (RCCW) (IF EQUIPPED)

OJX1070108L

OLX2051139L

The time of warning may vary depending on vehicle speed of the approaching vehicle.

CAUTION

For more details on the precau- tions of the rear corner radar, refer to Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Warning (BCW) sec- tion in chapter 5.

CAUTION

5-112

Driving your vehicle

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning settings Setting features

Rear Cross-Traffic Safety

With the engine on, select Driver Assistance Parking Safety Rear Cross-Traffic Safety from the Settings menu to turn on Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning and deselect to turn off the function.

Warning Timing

With the engine on, select Driver Assistance Warning Timing from the Settings menu to change the ini- tial warning activation time for Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning. When the vehicle is first delivered, Warning Timing is set to Normal. If you change the Warning Timing, the warning time of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

OTM070194N

OLX2071064N

When the engine is restarted, Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning will always turn on. However, if Off is selected after the engine is restarted, the driv- er should always be aware of the surroundings and drive safely.

WARNING

5-113

Driving your vehicle

5

Warning Volume

With the engine on, select ‘Driver Assistance Warning Volume’ from the Settings menu to change the Warning Volume to ‘High’, ‘Medium’, ‘Low’ or ‘Off’ for Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning. However, even if ‘Off’ is selected, Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist’s Warning Volume will not turn off but the volume will sound as ‘Low’. If you change the warning volume, the Warning Volume of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

Information If the engine is restarted, Warning Timing and Warning Volume will maintain the last setting.

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning operation Warning Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning will warn the driver when a collision is imminent.

i ORG3070025/OTM070168

OLX2058044L

The setting of the Warning Timing and Warning Volume applies to all functions of the Rear Cross-Traffic Safety.

Even though Normal is selected for Warning Timing, if the vehicles from the left and right side approaches at high speed, the initial warning acti- vation time may seem late.

Select Later for Warning Timing when traffic is light and when driving speed is slow.

CAUTION

ONX4E070090

5-114

Driving your vehicle

Collision Warning

To warn the driver of an approach- ing vehicle from the rear left/right side of your vehicle, the outside rearview mirror will blink and a warning will appear on the cluster. At the same time, an audible warn- ing will sound and the steering wheel will vibrate. If the Rear View Monitor is operating, a warning will also appear on the infotainment system screen.

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning will operate when all the following conditions are satisfied: — The gear is shifted to R (Reverse) — Vehicle speed is below 5 mph (8

km/h) — The approaching vehicle is within

approximately 82 ft. (25 m) from the left and right side of your vehi- cle

— The speed of the vehicle approaching from the left and right is above 3 mph (5 km/h)

Information If the operating conditions are satis- fied, there will be a warning whenever the vehicle approaches from the left or right side even though your vehicle speed is 0 mph (0 km/h).

i

Take the following precautions when using Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning: For your safety, change the

Settings after parking the vehicle at a safe location.

If any other systems warning message is displayed or audi- ble warning is generated, Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warnings warning message may not be displayed and audible warning may not be generated.

You may not hear the warning sound of Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning if the sur- rounding is noisy.

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning may warn the driver late or may not warn the driv- er depending on the road and driving conditions.

The driver should hold the responsibility to control the vehicle. Do not solely depend on Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning. Rather, maintain a safe braking dis- tance, and if necessary, depress the brake pedal to reduce driving speed or to stop the vehicle.

WARNING

5-115

Driving your vehicle

5

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning malfunction and limi- tations Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning malfunction

When Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning is not working properly, the Check Rear Cross-Traffic Safety system warning message will appear on the cluster, and the func- tion will turn off automatically, or the function will be limited. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

When the outside rearview mirror warning light is not working properly, the Check side view mirror warning light (or Check outside mirror warn- ing icon) warning message will appear on the cluster. Have the vehi- cle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning disabled

When the rear bumper around the rear corner radar or sensor is cov- ered with foreign material, such as snow or rain, or installing a trailer or carrier, it can reduce the detecting performance and temporarily limit or disable Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning. If this occurs, the Rear Cross-Traffic Safety system disabled. Radar blocked warning message will appear on the cluster.

OTM070125N

OTM070100N

OTM070124N

5-116

Driving your vehicle

The function will operate normally when such foreign material or trailer, etc. is removed. If the function does not operate nor- mally after it is removed, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Limitations of Rear Cross- Traffic Collision Warning Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning may not operate normally, or the function may operate unexpectedly under the following circumstances: Departing from where trees or

grass are overgrown Departing from where roads are

wet Speed of the approaching vehicle

is fast or slow

Turn off Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning to install a trailer, carrier, etc., or remove the trailer, carrier, etc. to use Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning.

CAUTION

For more details on the limita- tions of the rear corner radar, refer to Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Warning (BCW) sec- tion in chapter 5.

CAUTION

Even though the warning message does not appear on the cluster, Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning may not operate properly.

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning may not operate properly in an area (for exam- ple: open terrain), where any substance are not detected after turning ON the engine.

WARNING

Driving near a vehicle or structure

[A] : Structure

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning may be limited when driving near a vehicle or structure, and may not detect the vehicle approaching from the left or right. If this occurs, the function may not warn the driver when necessary. Always check your surround- ings while backing up.

WARNING

OJX1079111

5-117

Driving your vehicle

5

When the vehicle is in a com- plex parking environment

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning may detect vehicles which are parking or pulling out near your vehicle (for example: a vehicle leaving beside your vehicle, a vehicle parking or pulling out in the rear area, a vehicle approach- ing your vehicle making a turn, etc.). If this occurs, the function may unnecessarily warn the driver. Always check your surround- ings while backing up.

OJX1079112

When the vehicle is parked diagonally

[A] : Vehicle

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning may be limited when backing up diagonally, and may not detect the vehicle approaching from the left or right. If this occurs, the func- tion may not warn the driver when necessary. Always check your surround- ings while backing up.

OJX1079113

When the vehicle is on or near an inclined road

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning may be limited when the vehicle is on a uphill or downhill slope, or near it, and may not detect the vehicle approaching from the left or right. If this occurs, the func- tion may not warn the driver when necessary. Always check your surround- ings while backing up.

OLX2058048

5-118

Driving your vehicle

Pulling into the parking space where there is a structure

[A] : Structure, [B] :Wall

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning may detect vehicles passing by in front of you when parking backwards into a parking space with a wall or structure in the rear or side area. If this occurs, the func- tion may unnecessarily warn the driver. Always check your surround- ings while backing up.

OJX1079115

When the vehicle is parked rearward

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning may detect vehicles passing by behind you when parking backwards into a parking space. If this occurs, the function may unnecessar- ily warn the driver. Always check your surround- ings while backing up.

OJX1079116

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning may not operate nor- mally if interfered by strong electromagnetic waves.

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning may not operate for 3 seconds after the vehicle is started, or the rear corner radars are initialized.

WARNING

5-119

Driving your vehicle

5

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist is designed to help detect vehicles approaching from the left and right side while your vehicle is reversing, and warn the driver that a collision is imminent with a warning message and an audible warning. Also, braking is assisted to help pre- vent collision.

[A] : Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning operating

range,

[B] : Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist

operating range

Detecting sensor

[1] : Rear corner radar

Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensors.

REAR CROSS-TRAFFIC COLLISION-AVOIDANCE ASSIST (RCCA) (IF EQUIPPED)

OJX1070108R

OLX2051139L

The time of warning may vary depending on vehicle speed of the approaching vehicle.

CAUTION

For more details on the precau- tions of the rear corner radar, refer to Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist (BCA) sec- tion in chapter 5.

CAUTION

5-120

Driving your vehicle

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist Setting features

Rear Cross-Traffic Safety

With the engine on, select Driver Assistance Parking Safety Rear Cross-Traffic Safety from the Settings menu to turn on Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist and deselect to turn off the function.

Information Settings for Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist include Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning and Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist.

Warning Timing

With the engine on, select Driver Assistance Warning Timing from the Settings menu to change the ini- tial warning activation time for Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist. When the vehicle is first delivered, Warning Timing is set to Normal. If you change the Warning Timing, the warning time of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

i OTM070194N

When the engine is restarted, Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist will always turn on. However, if Off is selected after the engine is restarted, the driver should always be aware of the sur- roundings and drive safely.

WARNING

OTMA058089

5-121

Driving your vehicle

5

Warning Volume

With the engine on, select ‘Driver Assistance Warning Volume’ from the Settings menu to change the Warning Volume to ‘High’, ‘Medium’, ‘Low’ or ‘Off’ for Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist. However, even if ‘Off’ is selected, Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist’s Warning Volume will not turn off but the volume will sound as ‘Low’. If you change the warning volume, the Warning Volume of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

Information If the engine is restarted, Warning Timing and Warning Volume will maintain the last setting.

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist operation Warning and control Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist will warn and con- trol the vehicle depending on colli- sion level: Collision Warning, Emergency Braking and Stopping vehicle and ending brake control.

i

The setting of the Warning Timing and Warning Volume applies to all functions of the Rear Collision-Avoidance Assist.

Even though Normal is selected for Warning Timing, if the vehicles from the left and right side approaches at high speed, the initial warning acti- vation time may seem late.

Select Later for Warning Timing when traffic is light and when driving speed is slow.

CAUTION

ONX4E070090

5-122

Driving your vehicle

Collision Warning

To warn the driver of an approach- ing vehicle from the rear left/right side of your vehicle, the warning light on the outside rearview mirror will blink and a warning will appear on the cluster.

At the same time, an audible warn- ing will sound and the steering wheel will vibrate. If the Rear View Monitor is operating, a warning will also appear on the infotainment system screen.

The function will operate when all the following conditions are satis- fied: — The gear is shifted to R (Reverse) — Vehicle speed is below 5 mph (8

km/h) — The approaching vehicle is within

approximately 82 ft. (25 m) from the left and right side of your vehi- cle

— The speed of the vehicle approaching from the left and right is above 3 mph (5 km/h)

Information If the operating conditions are satis- fied, there will be a warning whenever the vehicle approaches from the left or right side even though your vehicle speed is 0 mph (0 km/h).

Emergency Braking

To warn the driver of an approach- ing vehicle from the rear left/right side of your vehicle, the warning light on the outside rearview mirror will blink and a warning message will appear on the cluster.

i OLX2058044L

OPDEN060039/OTM070168

OLX2058044L

OPDEN060039/OTM070122N

5-123

Driving your vehicle

5

At the same time, an audible warn- ing will sound and the steering wheel will vibrate. If the Rear View Monitor is operating, a warning will also appear on the infotainment system screen.

The function will operate when all the following conditions are satis- fied: — The gear is shifted to R (Reverse) — Vehicle speed is below 5 mph (8

km/h) — The approaching vehicle is within

approximately 5 ft. (1.5 m) from the left and right side of your vehi- cle

— The speed of the vehicle approaching from the left and right is above 3 mph (5 km/h)

Emergency braking will be assist- ed to help prevent collision with approaching vehicles from the left and right.

Stopping vehicle and ending brake control

When the vehicle is stopped due to emergency braking, the Drive carefully warning message will appear on the cluster.

For your safety, the driver should depress the brake pedal immedi- ately and check the surroundings.

Brake control will end after the vehicle is stopped by emergency braking for approximately 2 sec- onds.

During emergency braking, brak- ing control by the function will auto- matically cancel when the driver excessively depresses the brake pedal.

Brake control will end when: The approaching vehicle is

out of the detecting range The approaching vehicle

passes behind your vehicle The approaching vehicle does

not drive toward your vehicle The approaching vehicle

speed slows down The driver depresses the

brake pedal with sufficient power

WARNING

OTM070169L

5-124

Driving your vehicle

Take the following precautions when using Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist: For your safety, change the

Settings after parking the vehicle at a safe location.

If any other systems warning message is displayed or audi- ble warning is generated, Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assists warning message may not be dis- played and audible warning may not be generated.

You may not hear the warning sound of Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist if the surrounding is noisy.

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist may not operate if the driver applies the brake pedal to avoid colli- sion.

During Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist operation, the vehicle may stop suddenly injuring pas- sengers and shifting loose objects. Always have the seat belt on and keep loose objects secured.

Even if there is a problem with Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist, the vehi- cles basic braking perform- ance will operate normally.

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist does not operate in all situations or cannot avoid all collisions.

During emergency braking, braking control by the system will automatically cancel when the driver excessively depresses the accelerator pedal.

The driver should hold the responsibility to control the vehicle. Do not solely depend on Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist. Rather, maintain a safe brak- ing distance, and if necessary, depress the brake pedal to reduce driving speed or to stop the vehicle.

Never deliberately operate Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist on people, animal, objects, etc. It may cause serious injury or death.

WARNING

5-125

Driving your vehicle

5

Information If the function assists you with brak-

ing, the driver needs to pay atten- tion as the brake assist will end within 2 seconds. The driver must immediately depress the brake pedal and check vehicle surround- ings.

Brake control will end when the driver depresses the brake pedal with sufficient power.

After shifting the gear to R (Reverse), braking control will operate once for left and right vehi- cle approach.

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist malfunction and limitations Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist malfunction

When Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist is not working properly, the Check Rear Cross- Traffic Safety system warning mes- sage will appear on the cluster, and the function will turn off automatical- ly or the system will be limited. Have the vehicle inspected by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer.

i

The brake control may not oper- ate properly depending on the status of ESC (Electronic Stability Control). There will only be a warning when: The ESC (Electronic Stability

Control) warning light is on ESC (Electronic Stability

Control) is engaged in a differ- ent function

CAUTION

OTM070125N

5-126

Driving your vehicle

When the outside rearview mirror warning light is not working properly, the Check side view mirror warning light warning message will appear on the cluster. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist disabled

When the rear bumper around the rear-side radar or sensor is covered with foreign material, such as snow or rain, or installing a trailer or carri- er, it can reduce the detecting per- formance and temporarily limit or dis- able Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist. If this occurs, the Rear Cross-Traffic Safety system disabled. Radar blocked warning message will appear on the cluster. The system will operate normally when such foreign material or trailer, etc. is removed.

If the function does not operate nor- mally after it is removed, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Even though the warning message does not appear on the cluster, Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist may not operate properly.

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist may not operate properly in an area (for example: open terrain), where any substance are not detected after turning ON the engine.

WARNING

Turn off Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist to install a trailer, carrier, etc., or remove the trailer, carrier, etc. to use Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist.

CAUTION

OTM070100N

OTM070124N

5-127

Driving your vehicle

5

Limitations of Rear Cross- Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist may not operate normally, or the function may operate unexpectedly under the following cir- cumstances: Departing from where trees or

grass are overgrown Departing from where roads are

wet Speed of the approaching vehicle

is fast or slow

Braking control may not work, dri- vers attention is required in the fol- lowing circumstances: The vehicle severely vibrates while

driving over a bumpy road, uneven road or concrete patch

Driving on a slippery surface due to snow, water puddle, ice, etc.

The tire pressure is low or a tire is damaged

The brake is reworked Remote Smart Parking Assist is

operating (if equipped)

For more details on the limita- tions of the rear corner radar, refer to Blind-Spot Collision- Avoidance Assist (BCA) sec- tion in chapter 5.

CAUTION

Driving near a vehicle or structure

[A] : Structure

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist may be lim- ited when driving near a vehi- cle or structure, and may not detect the vehicle approach- ing from the left or right. If this occurs, the function may not warn the driver or control the brakes when necessary. Always check your surround- ings while backing up.

WARNING

OJX1079111

5-128

Driving your vehicle

When the vehicle is in a com- plex parking environment

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist may detect vehicles which are parking or pulling out near your vehicle (for example: a vehicle leaving beside your vehicle, a vehicle parking or pulling out in the rear area, a vehicle approach- ing your vehicle making a turn, etc.). If this occurs, the function may unnecessarily warn the driver and control the brake. Always check your surround- ings while backing up.

OJX1079112

When the vehicle is parked diagonally

[A] : Vehicle

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist may be lim- ited when backing up diago- nally, and may not detect the vehicle approaching from the left or right. If this occurs, the system may not warn the driv- er or control the brakes when necessary. Always check your surround- ings while backing up.

OJX1079113

When the vehicle is on or near an inclined road

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist may be lim- ited when the vehicle is on a uphill or downhill slope, or near it, and may not detect the vehicle approaching from the left or right. If this occurs, the function may not warn the driver or control the brakes when necessary. Always check your surround- ings while backing up.

OLX2058048

5-129

Driving your vehicle

5

When you are towing a trailer or another vehicle, we recom- mend that Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist is turned off due to safety rea- sons.

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist may not operate normally if interfered by strong electromagnetic waves.

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist may not operate for 15 seconds after the vehicle is started, or the rear corner radars are initial- ized.

WARNING Pulling into the parking space where there is a structure

[A] : Structure, [B] :Wall

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist may detect vehicles passing by in front of you when parking backwards into a parking space with a wall or structure in the rear or side area. If this occurs, the function may unnecessarily warn the driver and control the brake. Always check your surround- ings while backing up.

OJX1079115

When the vehicle is parked rearward

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision- Avoidance Assist may detect vehicles passing by behind you when parking backwards into a parking space. If this occurs, the function may unnecessarily warn the driver and control the brake. Always check your surround- ings while backing up.

OJX1079116

5-130

Driving your vehicle

Information This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules.

Operation is subject to the following three conditions:

1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and

2. This device must accept any inter- ference received, including interfer- ence that may cause undesired operation.

3. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the device.

Information Radio frequency radiation exposure information:

This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment.

This equipment should be installed and operated with minimum distance of 8 in. (20 cm) between the radiator (antenna) and your body.

This transmitter must not be co-locat- ed or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.

ii

5-131

Driving your vehicle

5

Lane Following Assist is designed to help detect lane markings and/or vehicles on the road, and assists the drivers steering to help keep the vehicle between lanes.

Detecting sensor

[1]: Front view camera

The front view camera is used as a detecting sensor to detect lane markings and front vehicles. Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensor.

Lane Following Assist settings Setting features The driver can turn on Lane Following Assist with the vehicle on and by selecting ‘User settings Driver assistance Driving Assist Lane Following Assist’ in the clus- ter LCD display. Lane Following Assist deactivates, when the driver deselects the function setting from the User Settings mode in the cluster LCD display. The set-up of Lane Following Assist will be maintained, as selected, when the vehicle is restarted.

LANE FOLLOWING ASSIST (LFA) (IF EQUIPPED)

OLX2051137L

For more details on the precau- tions of the front view camera, refer to Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist (FCA) sec- tion in this chapter.

CAUTION

5-132

Driving your vehicle

Warning Volume

With the engine on, select Driver Assistance Warning Volume from the Settings menu to change the Warning Volume to High, Medium, Low for Lane Following Assist. If you change the Warning Volume, the warning volume of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

Lane Following Assist opera- tion Warning and control

Lane Following Assist

If the vehicle ahead and/or both lane markings are detected and your vehicle speed is below 112 mph (180 km/h), the green indicator light will illuminate on the cluster, and Lane Following Assist will help the vehicle stay in lane by assisting the steering wheel.

When the steering wheel is not assisted, the white indicator light will blink and change to grey.

CAUTION

OTM070141N

OLX2051148N

5-133

Driving your vehicle

5

Hands-off warning

If the driver takes their hands off the steering wheel for several seconds, the Place hands on the steering wheel warning message will appear and an audible warning will sound in stages. First stage : Warning message Second stage : Warning message

(red steering wheel) and audible warning

If the driver still does not have their hands on the steering wheel after the hands-off warning, the Driving con- venience systems cancelled warning message will appear and Lane Following Assist will be automatically canceled.

OLX2058062L OLX2059126L

The steering wheel may not be assisted if the steering wheel is held very tight or the steering wheel is steered over a certain degree.

Lane Following Assist does not operate at all times. It is the responsibility of the driver to safely steer the vehicle and to maintain the vehicle in its lane.

The handsoff warning mes- sage may appear late depend- ing on road conditions. Always have your hands on the steering wheel while driv- ing.

If the steering wheel is held very lightly the handsoff warning message may appear because Lane Following Assist may not recognize that the driver has their hands on the steering wheel.

WARNING

5-134

Driving your vehicle

Information You may change settings from the

instrument cluster (User Settings) or infotainment system (Vehicle Settings), whichever option that is provided with your vehicle. For more details, see «User Settings» section in chapter 4, or «Vehicle Settings» section in supplied Infotainment Manual.

When both lane markings are detected, the lane lines on the clus- ter will change from grey to white.

If lane markings are not detected, steering wheel control by Lane Following Assist can be limited depending on whether a vehicle is in front or the driving conditions of the vehicle.

Even though the steering is assist- ed by Lane Following Assist, the driver may control the steering wheel.

The steering wheel may feel heav- ier or lighter when the steering wheel is assisted by Lane Following Assist than when it is not.

Lane Following Assist mal- function and limitations Lane Following Assist malfunc- tion

When Lane Following Assist is not working properly, the Check Lane Following Assist (LFA) system sys- tem) warning message will appear for several seconds, and the master ( ) warning light will illuminate on the cluster. If the master warning light illuminates, have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

i

If you attach objects to the steering wheel, the hands-off warning may not work proper- ly.

OLX2051058N/OLX2051059N

Lane undetected Lane detected

OTM070118N

5-135

Driving your vehicle

5

Limitations of Lane Following Assist For more details on Lane Following Assist limitations, refer to Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) section in this chapter.

For more details on Lane Following Assist precautions, refer to Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) section in this chapter.

WARNING

5-136

Driving your vehicle

Basic function Driver Attention Warning will help determine the driver’s attention level by analyzing driving pattern, driving time, etc. while vehicle is being driv- en. Driver Attention Warning will rec- ommend a break when the drivers attention level falls below a certain level.

Leading vehicle departure alert function Leading Vehicle Departure Alert function will inform the driver when the front vehicle departs from a stop.

Detecting sensor

[1]: Front view camera

The front view camera is used as a detecting sensor to detect driving patterns and front vehicle departure while vehicle is being driven. Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensor.

DRIVER ATTENTION WARNING (DAW)

OLX2051137L

Always keep the front view camera in good condition to maintain optimal performance of Driver Attention Warning.

For more details on the pre- cautions of the front view camera, refer to Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) section in this chapter.

CAUTION

5-137

Driving your vehicle

5

Driver Attention Warning set- tings Setting features To turn ON the Driver Attention

Warning (DAW) system, turn on the engine, and then select «User Settings Driver Assistance Driver Attention Warning» on the LCD display. If you deselect «User Settings Driver Assistance Driver Attention Warning» on LCD display, Driver Attention Warning turns off.

The set-up of the Driver Attention Warning will be maintained, as selected, when theengine is re- started.

Leading Vehicle Departure Alert

With the engine ON, the Leading Vehicle Departure Alert system turn- son and gets ready to be activated- when the ‘User Settings Driver Assistance Driving Convenience Leading vehicle departure alert’ isselected on the cluster. The func- tion stops operation when the setting is deactivated. However, if the engine isturned off then on again, the func- tion maintains the previous state. Warning Timing

With the engine on, select Driver Assistance Warning Timing from the Settings menu to change the ini- tial warning activation time for Driver Attention Warning. When the vehicle is first delivered, Warning Timing is set to Normal. If you change the Warning Timing, the warning time of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

Information If the engine is restarted, Driver Attention Warning will maintain the last setting.

i

OTMA058089

5-138

Driving your vehicle

Driver Attention Warning oper- ation Basic function Display and warning

The basic function of Driver Attention Warning is to inform the driver the Attention Level and to warn the driv- er Consider taking a break.

Attention level

The driver can monitor his/her driv- ing conditions on the cluster. — When the Inattentive Driving

Warning is deselected from the Settings menu, System Off is displayed.

— Driver Attention Warning will operate when vehicle speed is between 0 — 112 mph (0 — 180 km/h).

— When vehicle speed is not within the operating speed, the mes- sage Standby (or ‘Disabled’) will be displayed.

The drivers attention level is dis- played on the scale of 1 to 5. The lower the level is, the more inatten- tive the driver is.

The level decreases when the driv- er does not take a break for a cer- tain period of time.

OIK057129L/OTM058162L

Standby/Disabled System off

OIK057130L/OLX2071065N

Inattentive driving Attentive driving

5-139

Driving your vehicle

5

Taking a break

The Consider taking a break mes- sage will appear on the cluster and an audible warning will sound to suggest that the driver take a break, when the drivers attention level is below 1.

Driver Attention Warning will not suggest a break when the total driving time is shorter than 10 min- utes or 10 minutes has not passed after the last break was suggested.

Information You may change settings from the

instrument cluster (User Settings) or infotainment system (Vehicle Settings), whichever option that is provided with your vehicle. For more details, see «User Settings» section in chapter 4, or «Vehicle Settings» section in supplied Infotainment Manual.

Driver Attention Warning will reset the last break time to 00:00 in the following situations:

— The engine is turned off

— The driver unfastens the seat belt and opens the drivers door

— The vehicle is stopped for more than 10 minutes

When the driver resets Driver Attention Warning, the last break time is set to 00:00 and the drivers attention level is set to High.

i

OTM070105L

For your safety, change the Settings after parking the vehi- cle at a safe location.

WARNING

Driver Attention Warning may suggest a break depending on the drivers driving pattern or habits, even if the driver does- nt feel fatigue.

Driver Attention Warning is a supplemental function and may not be able to determine whether the driver is inatten- tive.

The driver who feels fatigued should take a break at a safe location, even though there is no break suggestion by Driver Attention Warning.

CAUTION

5-140

Driving your vehicle

Leading vehicle departure alert function

When the front vehicle departs from a stop, Leading Vehicle Departure Alert will inform the driver by display- ing the Leading vehicle is driving away message on the cluster and an audible warning will sound.

Driver Attention Warning mal- function and limitations Driver Attention Warning mal- function

When Driver Attention Warning is not working properly, the Check Driver Attention Warning (DAW) system warning message will appear on the cluster. If this occurs, have the vehi- cle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

If any other systems warning message is displayed or audi- ble warning is generated, Leading Vehicle Departure Alert’s warning message may not be displayed and audible warning may not be generat- ed.

The driver should hold the responsibility to safely drive and control the vehicle.

WARNING

Leading Vehicle Departure Alert is a supplemental func- tion and may not alert the driver whenever the front vehicle departs from a stop.

Always check the front of the vehicle and road conditions before departure.

CAUTION

OTM070042N

OTM070107L

5-141

Driving your vehicle

5

Limitations of Driver Attention Warning Driver Attention Warning may not work properly in the following situa- tions: The vehicle is driven violently The vehicle intentionally crosses

over lanes frequently The vehicle is controlled by Driver

Assistance system, such as Lane Keeping Assist

Leading vehicle departure alert function

When the vehicle cuts in

[A] : Your vehicle, [B] : Front vehicle

If a vehicle cuts in front of your vehi- cle, Leading Departure Alert may not operate properly.

When the vehicle ahead sharply steers

[A] : Your vehicle, [B] : Front vehicle

If the vehicle in front makes a sharp turn, such as to turn left or right or make a U- turn, etc., Leading Vehicle Departure Alert may not operate properly.

OADAS021R

OADAS022R

OADAS034R

5-142

Driving your vehicle

When the vehicle ahead abruptly departures

If the vehicle in front abruptly depar- tures, Leading Vehicle Departure Alert may not operate properly.

When in a parking lot

If a vehicle parked in front drives away from you, Leading Vehicle Departure Alert may alert you that the parked vehicle is driving away.

When driving at a tollgate or inter- section, etc.

If you pass a tollgate or intersection with lots of vehicles or you drive where lanes are merged or divided frequently, Leading Vehicle Departure Alert may not operate properly.

Information For more details on the precautions of the front view camera, refer to Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) section in this chapter.

i

OADAS024R

OADAS027

OADAS026R

5-143

Driving your vehicle

Highway Driving Assist is designed to help detect vehicles and lanes ahead, and help maintain distance from the vehicle ahead, maintain the set speed, and help center the vehi- cle in the lane while driving on the highway.

Information The Highway Driving Assist is avail-

able only on controlled access road of certain highways.

Controlled access road indicates roads with limited entrances and exits that allow uninterrupted high speed traffic flow. Only pas- senger cars and motorcycles are allowed on controlled access roads.

Additional highways may be expanded by future navigation updates.

Detecting sensor

[1] : Front view camera, [2] : Front radar

Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensors.

i

HIGHWAY DRIVING ASSIST (HDA) (IF EQUIPPED)

5

OADAS035

OLX2051137L

OLX2051138L

5-144

Highway Driving Assist Settings Setting features

Highway Driving Assist

With the engine on, select or dese- lect Driver Assistance Driving Convenience from the Settings menu to set whether or not to use the following function(s). — If Highway Driving Assist is select-

ed, it helps maintain distance from the vehicle ahead, maintain the set speed, and helps center the vehicle in the lane.

Information If there is a problem with the func-

tion(s), the settings cannot be changed. We recommend that the vehicle be inspected by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer.

If the engine is restarted, the func- tion(s) will maintain the last setting.

i

Driving your vehicle

For more details on the precau- tions of the detecting sensors, refer to Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist (FCA) sec- tion in chapter 5.

CAUTION

OLX2071066N

5-145

Driving your vehicle

Warning Volume

With the engine on, select Driver Assistance Warning Volume from the Settings menu to change the Warning Volume to High, Medium or Low for Highway Driving Assist. If you change the Warning Volume, the Warning Volume of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

Highway Driving Assist Operation Highway Driving Assist display and control

You can see the status of the Highway Driving Assist operation in the Driving Assist mode on the clus- ter. Refer to LCD Display Modes section in chapter 3. Highway Driving Assist will be dis- played as below depending on the status of the function.

(1) Highway Driving Assist indicator, whether there is a vehicle ahead and the selected distance level are displayed.

Highway Driving Assist indicator — Green : Operating state — Grey : Standby state

5

OTM070141N OTMA070009/OTMA070010

Operating state Standby state

5-146

(2) Set speed is displayed. (3) Lane Following Assist indicator

displayed. (4) Whether there is a vehicle ahead

and the selected vehicle distance are displayed.

(5) Whether the lane is detected or not is displayed.

For more details on the display refer to Smart Cruise Control (SCC) and Lane Following Assist (LFA) sections in chapter 5.

Highway Driving Assist operating Highway Driving Assist will operate when entering or driving on the main road of highways (or motorways), and satisfying all the following condi- tions: — Lane Following Assist is operating — Smart Cruise Control is operating

Information While driving on the highway (or

motorway), if Smart Cruise Control starts operating, Highway Driving Assist will operate.

When entering the main roads of highways (or motorways), Highway Driving Assist will not turn on if the Lane Following Assist is turned off even when Smart Cruise Control is operating.

Restarting after stopping

When Highway Driving Assist is operating, your vehicle will stop if the vehicle ahead of you stops. Also, if the vehicle ahead of you starts mov- ing within 30 seconds after the stop, your vehicle will start as well. In addi- tion, after the vehicle has stopped and 30 seconds have passed, the Use switch or pedal to accelerate message will appear on the cluster. Depress the accelerator pedal or push the + switch, — switch or switch to start driving.

i

Driving your vehicle

OTM070114L

5-147

Driving your vehicle

Hands-off warning

If the driver takes their hands off the steering wheel for several seconds, the Place hands on the steering wheel warning message will appear and an audible warning will sound in stages. First stage : Warning message Second stage : Warning message

(red steering wheel) and audible warning

If the driver still does not have their hands on the steering wheel after the hands-off warning, the Highway Driving Assist (HDA) canceled warn- ing message will appear and Highway Driving Assist and Lane Change Assist will be automatically canceled.

Highway Set Speed Auto Change Highway Driving Assist enters the automatic speed setting mode when: 1. The operating conditions are satis-

fied indicator will illumi- nate green

2. The set speed and the highway speed limit matches

If the system changes to the auto- matic speed mode, the symbol

will turn green and a chime will sound. When the highway speed limit changes, the set speed automatical- ly changes to the changed speed limit.

Highway Driving Assist standby When Smart Cruise Control is tem- porarily canceled while Highway Driving Assist is operating, Highway Driving Assist will be in the standby state. At this time, Lane Following Assist will operate normally.

5

OLX2058062L

OTM070195N

5-148

Highway Driving Assist Malfunction and Limitations Highway Driving Assist mal- function

When Highway Driving Assist or Highway Lane Change function is not working properly, the Check Highway Driving Assist (HDA) sys- tem warning message will appear, and the warning light will illumi- nate on the cluster. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Driving your vehicle

OTM070120N

The driver is responsible for controlling the vehicle for safe driving.

Always have your hands on the steering wheel while driv- ing.

Highway Driving Assist is a supplemental function that assists the driver in driving the vehicle and is not a com- plete autonomous driving system. Always check road conditions, and if necessary, take appropriate actions to drive safely.

Always have your eyes on the road, and it is the responsibil- ity of the driver to avoid vio- lating traffic laws. The vehicle manufacturer is not responsi- ble for any traffic violation or accidents caused by the driv- er.

Highway Driving Assist may not be able to recognize all traffic situations. Highway Driving Assist may not detect possible collisions due to lim- itations of the function. Always be aware of the limita- tions of the function. Obstacles such as vehicles, motorcycles, bicycles, pedes- trians, or unspecified objects or structures such as guardrails, tollgate, etc. that may collide with the vehicle may not be detected.

Highway Driving Assist will turn off automatically under the following situations: — Driving on roads that

Highway Driving Assist does not operate, such as a rest area, intersection, junction, etc.

— The navigation does not operate properly such as when the navigation is being updated or restarted

WARNING

5-149

Driving your vehicle

Limitations of Highway Driving Assist Highway Driving Assist may not operate normally, or may not operate under the following circumstances: The map information and the actu-

al road is different because the navigation is not updated

The map information and the actu- al road is different because of real- time GPS data or map information error

The infotainment system is over- loaded by simultaneously perform- ing functions such as route search, video playback, voice recognition, etc.

GPS signals are blocked in areas such as a tunnel

The driver goes off course or the route to the destination is changed or canceled by resetting the navi- gation

The vehicle enters a service sta- tion or rest area

Android Auto or Car Play is operat- ing

5

Highway Driving Assist may inadvertently operate or turn off depending on road condi- tions (navigation information) and surroundings.

Lane Following Assist func- tion may be temporarily dis- abled when the front view camera cannot detect lanes properly or the hands-off warning is on.

You may not hear the warning sound of Highway Driving Assist if the surrounding is noisy.

If the vehicle is driven at high speed above a certain speed at a curve, your vehicle may drive to one side or may depart from the driving lane.

When you are towing a trailer or another vehicle, we recom- mend that Highway Driving Assist is turned off due to safety reasons.

The handsoff warning mes- sage may appear early or late depending on how the steer- ing wheel is held or road con- ditions. Always have your hands on the steering wheel while driving.

For your safety, please read the owner’s manual before using the Highway Driving Assist.

Highway Driving Assist will not operate when the engine is started, or when the detect- ing sensors or navigation is being initialized.

5-150

The navigation cannot detect the current vehicle position (ex: elevat- ed roads including overpass adja- cent to general roads or nearby roads exist in a parallel way)

Information For more details on the limitations of the front view camera, front radar, front corner radar and rear corner radar, refer to Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist (FCA) section in chapter 5.

Information This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules.

Operation is subject to the following three conditions:

1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and

2. This device must accept any inter- ference received, including interfer- ence that may cause undesired operation.

3. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the device.

Information Radio frequency radiation exposure information:

This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment.

This equipment should be installed and operated with minimum distance of 8 in. (20 cm) between the radiator (antenna) and your body.

This transmitter must not be co-locat- ed or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.

ii

i

Driving your vehicle

5-151

Driving your vehicle

5

SMART CRUISE CONTROL (SCC) (IF EQUIPPED) Smart Cruise Control is designed to detect the vehicle ahead and help maintain the desired speed and min- imum distance between the vehicle ahead.

Overtaking Acceleration Assist While Smart Cruise Control is oper- ating, if the function judges that the driver is determined to overtake the vehicle in front, acceleration will be assisted.

[1]: Front view camera, [2]: Front radar

The front view camera and front radar are used as a detecting sensor to detect front vehicles. Refer to the picture above for the detailed location of the detecting sensor.

OLX2051137L

OLX2051138L

Always keep the front view cam- era and front radar in good con- dition to maintain optimal per- formance of Smart Cruise Control. For more details on the precau- tions of the front view camera and front radar, refer to Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist (FCA) section in this chapter.

CAUTION

5-152

Driving your vehicle

Smart Cruise Control settings Setting features

To turn on Smart Cruise Control

Push the CRUISE/ button on the steering wheel to turn Smart Cruise Control on.The cruise indi- cator will illuminate.

Accelerate to the desired speed. The Smart Cruise Control set speed can be set as follows: — 5 100 mph (10 — 160 km/h) :

when there is no vehicle in front — 0 100 mph (0 — 160 km/h) :

when there is a vehicle in front

Push the SET- switch down. The Set Speed and Vehicle Distance on the LCD display will illuminate.

Release the accelerator pedal. The desired speed will automatically be maintained.

If there is a vehicle in front of you, the speed may decrease to maintain the distance to the vehicle ahead. On a steep grade, the vehicle may slow down or speed up slightly while going uphill or downhill.

Information Vehicle speed may decrease on an upward slope and increase on a down- ward slope.

When you are setting the cruise con- trol speed, with a vehicle in front and your vehicle speed is between 0 — 20 mph (0 — 30 km/h ), the speed will set to 20 mph (30 km/h).

i

OTM058037

OTM058038

5-153

Driving your vehicle

5

To set vehicle distance Each time the button is pressed, the headway changes as follows:

Information If you drive at 56 mph (90 km/h),

the distance is maintained as fol- lows:

Distance 4 —

approximately 172 ft. (53 m)

Distance 3 —

approximately 130 ft. (40 m)

Distance 2 —

approximately 106 ft. (30 m)

Distance 1 —

approximately 82 ft. (25 m)

The distance is set to the last set dis- tance when the engine is restarted, or when Smart Cruise Control was temporarily canceled.

To increase set speed

Push the RES+ switch up, and release it immediately. The set speed will increase by 1 mph (1 km/h) each time you push the RES+ switch up in this manner.

Push the RES+ switch up, and hold it. Your vehicle set speedwill increase by 5 mph (10 km/h). Release the RES+ switch at the speed you want.

You can set the speed to 100 mph (160 km/h).

i

OTM058039OTM058041

Distance 4 Distance 3 Distance 2

Distance 1

5-154

Driving your vehicle

To decrease set speed

Push the SET- switch down, and release it immediately. The set speed will decrease by 1 mph (1 km/h) each time you push the SET- switch down in this manner.

Push the SET- switch down, and hold it. Your vehicle set speed will decrease by 5 mph (10 km/h). Release the SET- switch at the speed you want.

You can set the speed to 0 20 mph (0 — 30 km/h).

To temporarily cancel Smart Cruise Control

Depressing the brake pedal. Pushing the CANCEL the SET-

switch down button located on the steering wheel.

OTM058038 OTM058040

Check the driving condition before using the Res+ switch. Driving speed may sharply increase when you push up and hold the Res+ switch.

WARNING

5-155

Driving your vehicle

5

To resume Smart Cruise Control set speed

If any method other than the Driving Assist button was used to cancel the function and the function is still acti- vated, the cruising speed will auto- matically resume when push the RES+ switch up or the SET — switch down. If you push the RES+ switch up, the speed will resume to the recently set speed. However, if vehi- cle speed drops below 0 20 mph (0 — 30 km/h), it will resume when there is a vehicle in front of your vehicle.

Information Always check the road condition- swhen you push the RES+ switch up to resume speed.

To turn off Smart Cruise Control

Pushing the CRUISE/ button.The cruise indicator will go off. If you wish not to use the cruise control system, always turn the function off by push- ing the CRUISE/ button.

Smart Cruise Control Reaction

With the engine on, select Driver Assistance SCC Reaction from the settings menu to select the sen- sitivity of vehicle speed when follow- ing the front vehicle to maintain the set distance.

i

OTM058037 OTM070142N

5-156

Driving your vehicle

Warning Volume

With the engine on, select ‘Driver Assistance Warning Volume’ from the Settings menu to change the Warning Volume to ‘High’, ‘Medium’, ‘Low’ or ‘Off’ for Smart Cruise Control. However, even if ‘Off’ is selected, Smart Cruise Control’s Warning Volume will not turn off but the vol- ume will sound as ‘Low’. If you change the warning volume, the Warning Volume of other Driver Assistance systems may change.

Information If the engine is restarted, Warning Volume will maintain the last setting.

Smart Cruise Control opera- tion Operating conditions Smart Cruise Control will operate when the following conditions are satisfied.

Basic function

The gear is in D (Drive) The drivers door is closed EPB (Electronic Parking Brake) is

not applied Your vehicle speed is within the

operating speed range — 6 — 105 mph (10 — 170 km/h): when there is no vehicle in front — 0 — 105 mph (0 — 170 km/h): when

there is a vehicle in front ESC (Electronic Stability Control)

or ABS is on ESC (Electronic Stability Control)

or ABS is not controlling the vehi- cle

Engine RPM is not in the red zone Forward Collision-Avoidance

Assist brake control is not operat- ing

Remote Smart Parking Assist brake control is not operating (if equipped)

ISG system is not operating Hands-off warning for Lane

Keeping Assist and Highway Driving Assist is off

Information At a stop, if there is no vehicle in front of your vehicle, Smart Cruise Control will turn on when the brake pedal is depressed

i

i

ONX4E070090

5-157

Driving your vehicle

5

Overtaking Acceleration Assist

Overtaking Acceleration Assist will operate when the turn signal indica- tor is turned on to the left (left-hand drive) or turned on to the right (right- hand drive) while Smart Cruise Control is operating, and the follow- ing conditions are satisfied: Your vehicle speed is above 40

mph (60 km/h) The hazard warning flasher is off A vehicle is detected in front of

your vehicle Deceleration is not needed to

maintain distance with the vehicle in front

Smart Cruise Control display and control Basic function You can see the status of the Smart Cruise Control operation in the Driving Assist view on the cluster. Refer to LCD Display Modes sec- tion in chapter 4. Smart Cruise Control will be dis- played as below depending on the status of the function.

When the turn signal indicator is turned on to the left (left- hand drive) or turned on to the right (right-hand drive) while there is a vehicle ahead, the vehicle may accelerate temporarily. Pay attention to the road conditions at all times.

Regardless of your countries driving direction, Overtaking Acceleration Assist will oper- ate when the conditions are satisfied. When using the function in countries with dif- ferent driving direction, always check the road condi- tions at all times.

WARNING

5-158

Driving your vehicle

When operating (1) Whether there is a vehicle ahead

and the selected distance level are displayed.

(2) Set speed is displayed. (3) Whether there is a vehicle ahead

and the target headway are dis- played.

When temporarily canceled (1) indicator is displayed. (2) The previous set speed is shad-

ed. (3) Vehicle ahead and distance level

are not displayed.

Information The distance of the front vehicle on

the cluster is displayed according to the actual distance between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead.

The target distance may vary according to the vehicle speed and the set distance level. If vehicle speed is low, even though the vehicle distance have changed, the change of the target vehicle distance may be small.

To temporarily accelerate If you want to speed up temporarily when the Smart Cruise Control is on, depress the accelerator pedal. Increased speed will not interfere with Smart Cruise Control operation or change the set speed. To return to the set speed, take your foot off the accelerator pedal. If you push the SET- switch down at increased speed, the cruising speed will be set again.

i

Be careful when accelerating temporarily, because the speed and distance is not controlled automatically even if there is a vehicle in front of you.

WARNING

OLX2059049N/OIK057104N

Operating Temporarily cancelled

5-159

Driving your vehicle

5

Smart Cruise Control temporari- ly canceled

Smart Cruise Control will be tem- porarily canceled automatically when: The vehicle speed is above 105

mph (170 km/h) The vehicle is stopped for a certain

period of time The accelerator pedal is continu-

ously depressed for a certain peri- od of time

The conditions for the Smart Cruise Control to operate is not satisfied

If Smart Cruise Control is temporari- ly canceled automatically, the Smart Cruise Control canceled warning message will appear on the cluster, and an audible warning will sound to warn the driver.

If Smart Cruise Control is temporari- ly canceled while the vehicle is at a standstill with the function activated, EPB (Electronic Parking Brake) maybe applied.

Smart Cruise Control conditions not satisfied

If the CRUISE/ button, is pushed or the toggle switches are pushed RES+ switch up /SET- switch down, when Smart Cruise Control operat- ing conditions are not satisfied, the Smart Cruise Control conditions not met will appear on the cluster, and an audible warning will sound.

When Smart Cruise Control is temporarily canceled, distance with the front vehicle will not be maintained. Always have your eyes on the road while driving, and if necessary, depress the brake pedal to reduce your driv- ing speed in order to maintain a safe distance.

WARNING OTM070112NOTM070113N

5-160

Driving your vehicle

In traffic situation

In traffic, your vehicle will stop if the vehicle ahead of you stops. Also, if the vehicle ahead of you starts mov- ing, your vehicle will start as well. In addition, after the vehicle has stopped and a certain time have passed, the Use switch or pedal to accelerate message will appear on the cluster. Depress the accelerator pedal or push RES+ switch up or push SET- switch down to start driv- ing.

Warning road conditions ahead

In the following situation, the Watch for surrounding vehicles warning message will appear on the cluster, and an audible warning will sound to warn the driver of road conditions ahead.

— The vehicle in front disappears when Smart Cruise Control is maintaining the distance with the vehicle ahead while driving below a certain speed.

— While the Use switch or pedal to accelerate message is displayed on the cluster, if there is no vehicle in front or the vehicle is far away from you, and the toggle switches are pushed RES+ switch up / SET- switch down or CRUISE/ button is pressed.

Always pay attention to vehi- cles or objects that may sud- denly appear in front of you, and if necessary, depress the brake pedal to reduce your driv- ing speed in order to maintain a safe distance.

WARNING

OLX2058054LOLX2058094L

5-161

Driving your vehicle

5

Collision Warning

While Smart Cruise Control is oper- ating, when the collision risk with the vehicle ahead is high, the Collision Warning warning message will appear on the cluster, and an audible warning will sound to warn the driver. Always have your eyes on the road while driving, and if necessary, depress the brake pedal to reduce your driving speed in order to main- tain a safe distance.

In the following situations, Smart Cruise Control may not warn the driver of a collision. The distance from the front

vehicle is near, or the vehicle speed of the front vehicle is faster or similar with your vehicle

The speed of the front vehicle is very slow or is at a stand- still

The accelerator pedal is depressed right after Smart Cruise Control is turned on

WARNING

OLX2058026L

Take the following precautions when using Smart Cruise Control: Smart Cruise Control does

not substitute for proper and safe driving. It is the responsi- bility of the driver to always check the speed and distance to the vehicle ahead.

Smart Cruise Control may not recognize unexpected and sudden situations or complex driving situations, so always pay attention to driving condi- tions and control your vehicle speed.

Keep Smart Cruise Control off when the function is not in use to avoid inadvertently set- ting a speed.

Do not open the door or leave the vehicle when Smart Cruise Control is operating, even if the vehicle is stopped.

WARNING

5-162

Driving your vehicle

Turn off Smart Cruise Control when your vehicle is being towed.

Smart Cruise Control may not operate normally if interfered by strong electromagnetic waves.

Smart Cruise Control may not detect an obstacle in front and lead to a collision. Always look ahead cautiously to pre- vent unexpected and sudden situations from occurring.

Vehicles moving in front of you with a frequent lane change may cause a delay in Smart Cruise Control reaction or may cause Smart Cruise Control to react to a vehicle actually in an adjacent lane. Always drive cautiously to prevent unexpected and sud- den situations from occur- ring.

Always be aware of the sur- roundings and drive safely, even though a warning mes- sage does not appear or an audible warning does not sound.

If any other systems warning message is displayed or warning sound is generated, Smart Cruise Control warning message may not be dis- played and warning sound may not be generated.

You may not hear the warning sound of Forward Collision- Avoidance Assist if the sur- rounding is noisy.

The vehicle manufacturer is not responsible for any traffic violation or accidents caused by the driver.

Always set the vehicle speed under the speed limit in your country.

Always be aware of the select- ed speed and headway dis- tance.

Keep a safe distance accord- ing to road conditions and vehicle speed. If the headway distance is too close during high-speed driving, a serious collision may result.

When maintaining distance with the vehicle ahead, if the front vehicle disappears, Smart Cruise Control may suddenly accelerate to the set speed. Always be aware of unexpected and sudden situa- tions from occurring.

Vehicle speed may decrease on an upward slope and increase on a downward slope.

Always be aware of situations such as when a vehicle cuts in suddenly.

When you are towing a trailer or another vehicle, we recom- mend that Smart Cruise Control is turned off due to safety reasons.

5-163

Driving your vehicle

5

Information Smart Cruise Control may not oper-

ate for a certain time after the vehi- cle is started or the front view cam- era or front radar is initialized.

You may hear a sound when the brake is controlled by Smart Cruise Control.

Smart Cruise Control malfunc- tion and limitations Smart Cruise Control malfunc- tion

When Smart Cruise Control is not working properly, the Check Smart Cruise Control system warning mes- sage will appear, and the warning light will illuminate on the cluster. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Smart Cruise Control disabled

When the front radar cover or sensor is covered with snow, rain, or foreign material, it can reduce the detecting performance and temporarily limit or disable Smart Cruise Control. If this occurs the Smart Cruise Control disabled. Radar blocked warning message will appear for a certain period of time on the cluster. Smart Cruise Control will operate normally when snow, rain or foreign material is removed.

i

OTM070116N

OTM070116N

5-164

Driving your vehicle

Limitations of Smart Cruise Control Smart Cruise Control may not oper- ate normally, or it may operate unex- pectedly under the following circum- stances: The detecting sensor or the sur-

roundings are contaminated or damaged

fluid is continuously sprayed, or the wiper is on

The camera lens is contaminated due to tinted, filmed or coated windshield, damaged glass, or sticky foreign material (sticker, bug, etc.) on the glass

Moisture is not removed or frozen on the windshield

The field of view of the front view camera is obstructed by sun glare

Street light or light from an oncom- ing vehicle is reflected on the wet road surface, such as a puddle on the road

The temperature around the front view camera is high or low

An object is placed on the dash- board

The surrounding is very bright The surrounding is very dark, such

as in a tunnel, etc. The brightness changes suddenly,

for example when entering or exit- ing a tunnel

The brightness outside is low, and the headlamps are not on or are not bright

Driving in heavy rain or snow, or thick fog

Driving through steam, smoke or shadow

Only part of the vehicle is detected The vehicle in front has no tail

lights, tail lights are located unusu- ally, etc.

The brightness outside is low, and the tail lamps are not on or are not bright

The rear of the front vehicle is small or does not look normal (for example, tilted, overturned, etc.)

The front vehicles ground clear- ance is low or high

Even though the warning mes- sage does not appear on the cluster, Smart Cruise Control may not properly operate.

WARNING

Smart Cruise Control may not properly operate in an area (for example, open terrain), where there is nothing to detect after turning ON the engine.

CAUTION

5-165

Driving your vehicle

5

A vehicle suddenly cuts in front Your vehicle is being towed Driving through a tunnel or iron

bridge Driving near areas containing

metal substances, such as a con- struction zone, railroad, etc.

A material is near that reflects very well on the front radar, such as a guardrail, nearby vehicle, etc.

The bumper around the front radar is impacted, damaged or the front radar is out of position

The temperature around the front radar is high or low

Driving in large areas where there are few vehicles or structures (for example, desert, meadow, suburb, etc.)

The vehicle in front is made of material that does not reflect on the front radar

Driving near a highway (or motor- way) interchange or tollgate

Driving on a slippery surface due to snow, water puddle, ice, etc.

Driving on a curved road

The vehicle in front is detected late The vehicle in front is suddenly

blocked by a obstacle The vehicle in front suddenly

changes lane or suddenly reduces speed

The vehicle in front is bent out of shape

The front vehicles speed is fast or slow

With a vehicle in front, your vehicle changes lane at low speed

The vehicle in front is covered with snow

Unstable driving You are on a roundabout and the

vehicle in front is not detected You are continuously driving in a

circle Driving in a parking lot Driving through a construction

area, unpaved road, partial paved road, uneven road, speed bumps, etc.

Driving on an incline road, curved road, etc.

Driving through a roadside with trees or streetlights

The adverse road conditions cause excessive vehicle vibrations while driving

Your vehicle height is low or high due to heavy loads, abnormal tire pressure, etc.

Driving through a narrow road where trees or grass are over- grown

There is interference by electro- magnetic waves, such as driving in an area with strong radio waves or electrical noise

5-166

Driving your vehicle

Driving on a curved road

On curves, Smart Cruise Control may not detect a vehicle in the same lane, and may accelerate to the set speed. Also, vehicle speed may rapidly decrease when the vehicle ahead is detected sudden- ly. Select the appropriate set speed on curves and apply the brake pedal or accelerator pedal accord- ing to the road and driving condi- tions ahead.

Your vehicle speed can be reduced due to a vehicle in the adjacent lane. Apply the accelerator pedal and select the appropriate set speed. Check to be sure that the road con- ditions permit safe operation of the Smart Cruise Control.

Driving on an inclined road

During uphill or downhill driving, the Smart Cruise Control may not detect a moving vehicle in your lane, and cause your vehicle to accelerate to the set speed. Also, vehicle speed will rapidly decrease when the vehicle ahead is detected suddenly. Select the appropriate set speed on inclines and apply the brake pedal or accelerator pedal accord- ing to the road and driving condi- tions ahead.

OADAS015

OADAS012OADAS014

5-167

Driving your vehicle

5

Changing lanes

[A] : Your vehicle, [B] : Lane changing vehicle

When a vehicle moves into your lane from an adjacent lane, it can- not be detected by the sensor until it is in the sensor’s detection range.

Smart Cruise Control may not immediately detect the vehicle when the vehicle changes lanes abruptly. In this case, you must maintain a safe braking distance, and if necessary, depress the brake pedal to reduce your driving speed in order to maintain a safe distance.

Detecting vehicle

In the following cases, some vehi- cles in your lane cannot be detect- ed by the sensor: — Vehicles offset to one side — Slow-moving vehicles or sudden-

decelerating vehicles — Vehicles within approximately 6

feet (2 m) from your vehicle — Oncoming vehicles — Stopped vehicles — Vehicles with small rear profile,

such as trailers — Narrow vehicles, such as motor-

cycles or bicycles — Special vehicles

OJX1070181R

OADAS030

5-168

Driving your vehicle

— Animals and pedestrians — Nearby vehicles within 6.6 ft. (2 m) Adjust your vehicle speed by depressing the brake pedal according to the road and driving conditions ahead.

In the following cases, the vehicle in front cannot be detected by the sensor: — Vehicles with higher ground

clearance or vehicles carrying loads that stick out of the back of the vehicle

— Vehicles that has the front lifted due to heavy loads

— You are steering your vehicle — Driving on narrow or sharply

curved roads

Adjust your vehicle speed by depressing the brake pedal according to the road and driving conditions ahead.

When a vehicle ahead disappears at an intersection, your vehicle may accelerate. Always pay attention to road and driving conditions while driving.

When a vehicle in front of you merges out of the lane, Smart Cruise Control may not immediate- ly detect the new vehicle that is now in front of you. Always pay attention to road and driving conditions while driving.

OTM058129

OTM058119

OLX2051077N

5-169

Driving your vehicle

Always look out for pedestrians when your vehicle is maintaining a distance with the vehicle ahead.

Information This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules.

Operation is subject to the following three conditions:

1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and

2. This device must accept any inter- ference received, including interfer- ence that may cause undesired operation.

3. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the device.

Information Radio frequency radiation exposure information:

This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment.

This equipment should be installed and operated with minimum distance of 8 in. (20 cm) between the radiator (antenna) and your body.

This transmitter must not be co-locat- ed or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.

ii

5

OTM058124

5-170

Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control will help drive at a certain speed according to the road condi- tions when driving on highways (or motorways) by using road informa- tion from the navigation system while Smart Cruise Control is operating.

Information Navigation-based Smart Cruise

Control is available only on con- trolled access road of certain high- ways.

Controlled access road indicates roads with limited entrances and exits that allow uninterrupted high speed traffic flow. Only passenger cars and motorcycles are allowed on controlled access roads.

Additional highways may be expand- ed by future navigation updates.

Information Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control operates on main roads of highways (or motorways), and does not operate on interchanges or junc- tions.

Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown If vehicle speed is high, Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown function will temporarily decelerate your vehi- cle or limit acceleration to help you drive safely on a curve based on the curve information from the naviga- tion.

Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control Settings Setting features

Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown

With the engine on, select Driver Assistance Driving Convenience Highway Auto Curve Slowdown (or Curve slowdown (motorway)) from the Settings menu to turn on Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown and deselect to turn off the function.i

i

NAVIGATION-BASED SMART CRUISE CONTROL (NSCC) (IF EQUIPPED)

Driving your vehicle

OLX2071066N

5-171

Driving your vehicle

Information When there is a problem with Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control, the function cannot be set from the Settings menu.

Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control Operation Operating conditions Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control is ready to operate if all of the following conditions are satisfied: Smart Cruise Control is operating Driving on main roads of highways

(or motorways)

Information For more details on how to operate Smart Cruise Control, refer to Smart Cruise Control (SCC) section in this chapter.

Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control display and control When Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control operates, it will be displayed on the cluster as follows: Navigation-based Smart Cruise

Control standby

If the operating conditions are satis- fied, the white indicator will illuminate.

i

i

5

OTMA070006

5-172

Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control operating

If temporary deceleration is required in the standby state and Navigation- based Smart Cruise Control is oper- ating, the green symbol will illuminate on the cluster. If the Highway Set Speed Auto Change function operates, the symbol and set speed will illu- minate in green on the cluster, and an audible warning will sound.

Information Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown and Highway Set Speed Auto Change function uses the same symbol.

Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown

Depending on the curve ahead on the highway, the vehicle will decel- erate, and after passing the curve, the vehicle will accelerate to Smart Cruise Control set speed.

Vehicle deceleration time may dif- fer depending on the vehicle speed and the degree of the curve on the road. The higher the driving speed, deceleration will start faster.

i

Driving your vehicle

OTMA070005/OTMA070007 Drive carefully warning mes- sage will appear in the following circumstances: — Navigation-based Smart

Cruise Control is not able to slow down your vehicle to a safe speed

WARNING

OLX2051150L

5-173

Driving your vehicle

Highway Set Speed Auto Change

Highway Set Speed Auto Change function will operate when Smart Cruise Control set speed and the highway (or motorway) speed limit is matched.

While Highway Set Speed Auto Change function is operating, when the highway (or motorway) speed limit changes, Smart Cruise Control set speed automatically changes to the changed speed limit.

If Smart Cruise Control set speed is adjusted different from the speed limit, Highway Set Speed Auto Change function will be in the standby state.

If Highway Set Speed Auto Change function has changed to the standby state by driving on a road other than the highway (or motorway) main road, Highway Set Speed Auto Change function will operate again when you drive on the main road again without setting the set speed.

If Highway Set Speed Auto Change function has changed to the standby state by depressing the brake pedal or pressing the

switch on the steering wheel, press the switch to restart the function.

Highway Set Speed Auto Change function does not operate on high- way interchanges or junctions.

Information Highway Set Speed Auto Change

function only operates based on the speed limits of the highway (or motorway), it does not work with speed cameras.

When Highway Set Speed Auto Change function is operating, the vehicle automatically accelerates or decelerates when the highway (or motorway) speed limit changes.

The maximum set speed for Highway Set Speed Auto Change function is 86 mph (140 km/h).

If the speed limit of a new road is not updated in the navigation, Highway Set Speed Auto Change function may not operate properly.

If the speed unit is set to a unit other than the speed unit used in your country, Highway Set Speed Auto Change function may not operate properly.

i

5

5-174

Limitations of Navigation- based Smart Cruise Control Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control may not operate normally under the following circumstances: The navigation is not working prop-

erly Speed limit and road information in

the navigation is not updated The map information and the actu-

al road is different because of real- time GPS data or map information error

The navigation searches for a route while driving

GPS signals are blocked in areas such as a tunnel

The navigation is updated while driving

Map information is not transmitted due to infotainment system’s abnormal operation

A road that divides into two or more roads and joins again

The driver goes off course the route set in the navigation

The route to the destination is changed or canceled by resetting the navigation

The vehicle enters a service sta- tion or rest area

The speed limit of some sections changes according to the road sit- uations

Android Auto or Car Play is operat- ing

The navigation cannot detect the current vehicle position (ex: elevat- ed roads including overpass adja- cent to general roads or nearby roads exist in a parallel way)

The navigation is being updated while driving

The navigation is being restarted while driving

There is bad weather, such as heavy rain, heavy snow, etc.

Driving on a road under construc- tion

Driving on a road that is controlled Driving on a road that is sharply

curved

[1] : Set route, [2] : Branch line, [3] : Driving route,

[4] : Main road, [5] : Curved road section

When there is a difference between the navigation set route (branch line) and the driving route (main road), Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown function may not operate until the driving route is recognized as the main road.

When the vehicle’s driving route is recognized as the main road by maintaining the main road instead of the navigation set route, Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown function will operate. Depending on the distance to the curve and the current vehicle speed, vehicle deceleration may not be sufficient or may decelerate rapidly.

Driving your vehicle

OJX1070280L

5-175

Driving your vehicle

[1] : Set route, [2] : Branch line, [3] : Driving route,

[4] : Main road, [5] : Curved road section

When there is a difference between the navigation route (main road) and the driving route (branch line), Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown function will oper- ate based on the curve information on the main road.

When it is judged that you are driv- ing out of the route by entering the highway interchange or junction, Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown function will not operate.

[1] : Driving route, [2] : Branch line,

[3] : Curved road section, [4] : Main road

If there is no destination set on the navigation, Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown function will oper- ate based on the curve information on the main road.

Even if you depart from the main road, Highway Curve Zone Auto Slowdown function may temporari- ly operate due to navigation infor- mation of the highway curve sec- tion.

5

OJX1070281L OJX1070282L

Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control is not a substi- tute for safe driving practices, but a convenience function. Always have your eyes on the road, and it is the responsibil- ity of the driver to avoid vio- lating traffic laws.

The navigations speed limit information may differ from the actual speed limit informa- tion on the road. It is the dri- ver’s responsibility to check the speed limit on the actual driving road or lane.

Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control will automati- cally be cancelled when you leave the highway (or motor- way) main road. Always pay attention to road and driving conditions while driving.

WARNING

5-176

Information The time gap could occur between

the navigations guidance and when Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control operation starts and ends.

The speed information on the clus- ter and navigation may differ.

Even if you are driving at a speed lower than Smart Cruise Control set speed, acceleration may be limited by the curve sections ahead.

If Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control is operating while leaving the main road to enter an inter- change, junction, rest area, etc., the function may operate for a certain period of time.

Deceleration by Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control may feel it is not sufficient due to road conditions such as uneven road surfaces, nar- row lanes, etc.

i

Driving your vehicle

Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control may not oper- ate due to the existence of leading vehicles and the driv- ing conditions of the vehicle. Always pay attention to road and driving conditions while driving.

When you are towing a trailer or another vehicle, we recom- mend that Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control is turned off due to safety rea- sons.

After you pass through a toll- gate on a highway (or motor- way), Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control will operate based on the first lane. If you enter one of the other lanes, Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control may not oper- ate properly.

The vehicle will accelerate if the driver depresses the accelerator pedal while Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control is operating, and the function will not decelerate the vehicle. However, if the accelerator pedal is depressed insuffi- ciently, the vehicle may decel- erate.

If the driver accelerates and releases the accelerator pedal while Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control is operating, the vehicle may not deceler- ate sufficiently or may rapidly decelerate to a safe speed.

If the curve is too large or too small, Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control may not operate.

5-177

Driving your vehicle

Information This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules.

Operation is subject to the following three conditions:

1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and

2. This device must accept any inter- ference received, including interfer- ence that may cause undesired operation.

3. Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the device.

Information Radio frequency radiation exposure information:

This equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits set forth for an uncontrolled environment.

This equipment should be installed and operated with minimum distance of 8 in. (20 cm) between the radiator (antenna) and your body.

This transmitter must not be co-locat- ed or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.

ii

5

5-178

Driving your vehicle

Hazardous Driving Conditions When hazardous driving elements are encountered such as water, snow, ice, mud and sand, take the below suggestions: Drive cautiously and keep a longer

braking distance. Avoid abrupt braking or steering. When your vehicle is stuck in snow,

mud, or sand, use second gear. Accelerate slowly to avoid unnec- essary wheel spin.

Put sand, rock salt, tire chains or other non-slip materials under the wheels to provide additional trac- tion while the vehicle becomes stuck in ice, snow, or mud.

Rocking the Vehicle If it is necessary to rock the vehicle to free it from snow, sand, or mud, first turn the steering wheel right and left to clear the area around your front wheels. Then, shift back and forth between R (Reverse) and a for- ward gear. Try to avoid spinning the wheels, and do not race the engine. To prevent transmission wear, wait until the wheels stop spinning before shifting gears. Release the accelera- tor pedal while shifting, and press lightly on the accelerator pedal while the transmission is in gear. Slowly spinning the wheels in forward and reverse directions causes a rocking motion that may free the vehicle.

SPECIAL DRIVING CONDITIONS

Downshifting with an automatic transmission while driving on slippery surfaces can cause an accident. The sudden change in tire speed could cause the tires to skid. Be careful when down- shifting on slippery surfaces.

WARNING

If the vehicle is stuck and excessive wheel spin occurs, the temperature in the tires can increase very quickly. If the tires become damaged, a tire blow out or tire explosion can occur. This condition is dangerous — you and others may be injured. Do not attempt this procedure if people or objects are anywhere near the vehicle. If you attempt to free the vehicle, the vehicle can overheat quickly, possibly causing an engine compartment fire or other dam- age. Try to avoid spinning the wheels as much as possible to prevent overheating of either the tires or the engine. DO NOT allow the vehicle to spin the wheels above 35 mph (56 km/h).

WARNING

5-179

Driving your vehicle

5

Information The ESC system must be turned OFF before rocking the vehicle.

If you are still stuck after rocking the vehicle a few times, have the vehicle pulled out by a tow vehicle to avoid engine overheating, pos- sible damage to the transmission, and tire damage. See «Towing» in chapter 6.

Smooth Cornering Avoid braking or gear changing in corners, especially when roads are wet. Ideally, corners should always be taken under gentle acceleration.

Driving at Night Night driving presents more hazards than driving in the daylight. Here are some important tips to remember: Slow down and keep more dis-

tance between you and other vehi- cles, as it may be more difficult to see at night, especially in areas where there may not be any street lights.

Adjust your mirrors to reduce the glare from other driver’s head- lamps.

Keep your headlamps clean and properly aimed. Dirty or improperly aimed headlamps will make it much more difficult to see at night.

Avoid staring directly at the head- lamps of oncoming vehicles. You could be temporarily blinded, and it will take several seconds for your eyes to readjust to the darkness.

Driving in the Rain Rain and wet roads can make driving dangerous. Here are a few things to consider when driving in the rain or on slick pavement: Slow down and allow extra follow-

ing distance. A heavy rainfall makes it harder to see and increas- es the distance needed to stop your vehicle.

Turn OFF your Cruise Control. Replace your windshield wiper

blades when they show signs of streaking or missing areas on the windshield.

Tires should be properly main- tained with at least 2/32nds of an inch of tread depth. If your tires do not have enough tread, making a quick stop on wet pavement can cause a skid and possibly lead to an accident. See «Tire replace- ment» in chapter 7.

Turn on your headlamps to make it easier for others to see you.

NOTICE

i

5-180

Driving your vehicle

Driving too fast through large pud- dles can affect your brakes. If you must go through puddles, try to drive through them slowly.

If you believe your brakes may be wet, apply them lightly while driv- ing until normal braking operation returns.

Hydroplaning If the road is wet enough and you are going fast enough, your vehicle may have little or no contact with the road surface and actually ride on the water. The best advice is SLOW DOWN when the road is wet.

The risk of hydroplaning increas- es as the depth of tire tread decreases, refer to «Tire replace- ment » in chapter 7.

Driving in Flooded Areas Avoid driving through flooded areas unless you are sure the water is no higher than the bottom of the wheel hub. Drive through any water slowly. Allow adequate stopping distance because brake performance may be reduced. After driving through water, dry the brakes by gently applying them sev- eral times while the vehicle is moving slowly.

Highway Driving Tires Adjust the tire inflation, as specified. Under-inflation may overheat or damage the tires. Do not install worn-out or damaged tires, which may reduce traction or adversely affect vehicle handling. This could lead to sudden tire failure that may cause loss of vehicle con- trol resulting in an accident.

Information Never over-inflate your tires above the maximum inflation pressure, as speci- fied on your tires.

i

5-181

Driving your vehicle

5

Fuel, engine coolant and engine oil Driving at higher speeds on the high- way consumes more fuel and is less efficient than driving at a slower, more moderate speed. Maintain a moderate speed in order to conserve fuel when driving on the highway. Be sure to check both the engine coolant level and the engine oil before driving.

Drive belt A loose or damaged drive belt may overheat the engine.

Reducing the Risk of a Rollover Your multi-purpose passenger vehi- cle is defined as a Sports Utility Vehicle (SUV). SUV’s have higher ground clearance and a narrower track to make them capable of per- forming in a wide variety of off-road applications. The specific design characteristics give them a higher center of gravity than ordinary vehi- cles making them more likely to roll over if you make abrupt turns. Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover rate than other types of vehi- cles. Due to this risk, driver and pas- sengers are strongly recommended to buckle their seat belts. In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is signifi- cantly more likely to die than a per- son wearing a seat belt. There are steps that a driver can make to reduce the risk of a rollover. If at all possible, avoid sharp turns or abrupt maneuvers, do not load your vehicle with heavy cargo on the roof, and never modify your vehicle in any way.

Utility vehicles have a signifi- cantly higher rollover rate than other types of vehicles. To pre- vent rollovers or loss of control: Take corners at slower speeds

than you would with a passen- ger vehicle.

Avoid sharp turns and abrupt maneuvers.

Do not modify your vehicle in any way that you would raise the center of gravity.

Keep tires properly inflated. Do not carry heavy cargo on

the roof.

WARNING

5-182

Driving your vehicle

WINTER DRIVING The severe weather conditions of winter quickly wear out tires and cause other problems. To minimize winter driving problems, you should take the following suggestions:

Snow or Icy Conditions You need to keep sufficient distance between your vehicle and the vehicle in front of you. Apply the brakes gently. Speeding, rapid acceleration, sudden brake applications, and sharp turns are potentially very hazardous practices. During deceleration, use engine braking to the fullest extent. Sudden brake applications on snowy or icy roads may cause the vehicle to skid. To drive your vehicle in deep snow, it may be necessary to use snow tires or to install tire chains on your tires. Always carry emergency equipment. Some of the items you may want to carry include tire chains, tow straps or chains, a flashlight, emergency flares, sand, a shovel, jumper cables, a window scraper, gloves, ground cloth, coveralls, a blanket, etc.

Snow tires

If you mount snow tires on your vehi- cle, make sure to use radial tires of the same size and load range as the original tires. Mount snow tires on all four wheels to balance your vehicles handling in all weather conditions. The traction provided by snow tires on dry roads may not be as high as your vehicle’s original equipment tires. Check with the tire dealer for maximum speed recommendations.

Information Do not install studded tires without first checking local, state and munici- pal regulations for possible restric- tions against their use.

Tire chains

The mounting of some types of tire chains may cause damage to the tire. Therefore the use of snow tires is preferred over the use of tire chains. If the road and weather conditions require the use of tire chains, be sure to use tire chains that have been properly selected for the size of tire on your HYUNDAI vehicle. Be sure to follow the guidelines and installation instructions provided from the tire chain manufacturer.

i

Snow tires should be equivalent in size and type to the vehicles standard tires. Otherwise, the safety and handling of your vehicle may be adversely affect- ed.

WARNING

OLX2058096L

5-183

Driving your vehicle

5

Damage to your vehicle caused by improper tire chain use is not cov- ered by your vehicle manufacturers warranty.

Information Install tire chains on both left and

right front tires. It should be noted that installing tire chains on the tires will provide a greater driving force, but will not prevent side skids.

Do not install studded tires without first checking local, state and municipal regulations for possible restrictions against their use.

Chain installation

When installing tire chains, follow the manufacturers instructions and mount them as tightly possible. Drive slowly (less than 20 mph (30 km/h)) with chains installed. If you hear the chains contacting the body or chas- sis, stop and tighten them. If they still make contact, slow down until the noise stops. Remove the tire chains as soon as you begin driving on cleared roads. When mounting snow chains, park the vehicle on level ground away from traffic. Turn on the vehicle Hazard Warning Flasher and place a triangular emergency warning device behind the vehicle (if available). Always place the vehicle in P (Park), apply the parking brake and turn off the engine before installing snow chains.

i

The use of tire chains may adversely affect vehicle han- dling: Drive less than 20 mph

(30 km/h) or the chain manu- facturer’s recommended speed limit, whichever is lower.

Drive carefully and avoid bumps, holes, sharp turns, and other road hazards, which may cause the vehicle to bounce.

Avoid sharp turns or locked wheel braking.

WARNING

5-184

Driving your vehicle

— When using tire chains: Wrong size chains or improperly

installed chains can damage your vehicle’s brake lines, sus- pension, body and wheels.

Use SAE «S» class or wire chains.

If you hear noise caused by chains contacting the body, retighten the chain to prevent contact with the vehicle body.

To prevent body damage, retighten the chains after driving 0.3~0.6 miles (0.5~1.0 km).

Do not use tire chains on vehi- cles equipped with aluminum wheels. If unavoidable, use a wire type chain.

Use wire chains less than 0.59 inch (15 mm) wide to prevent damage to the chains connec- tion.

Winter Precautions Use high quality ethylene glycol coolant Your vehicle is delivered with high quality ethylene glycol coolant in the cooling system. It is the only type of coolant that should be used because it helps prevent corrosion in the cool- ing system, lubricates the water pump and prevents freezing. Be sure to replace or replenish your coolant in accordance with the maintenance schedule in chapter 7. Before winter, have your coolant tested to assure that its freezing point is sufficient for the temperatures anticipated during the winter.

Change to «winter weight» oil if necessary In some climates it is recommended that a lower viscosity «winter weight» oil be used during cold weather. See chapter 8 for recommendations. If you aren’t sure what weight oil you should use, consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Check battery and cables Winter puts additional burdens on the battery system. Visually inspect the battery and cables as described in chapter 7. The level of charge in your battery can be checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer or a service station.

NOTICE

5-185

Driving your vehicle

5

Check spark plugs and ignition system Inspect your spark plugs as described in chapter 7 and replace them if necessary. Also check all ignition wiring and components to be sure they are not cracked, worn or damaged in any way.

Use approved window washer anti-freeze in system To keep the water in the window washer system from freezing, add an approved window washer anti-freeze solution in accordance with instruc- tions on the container. Window wash- er anti-freeze is available from an authorized HYUNDAI dealer and most auto parts outlets. Do not use engine coolant or other types of anti- freeze as these may damage the paint finish.

Do not let your parking brake freeze Under some conditions your parking brake can freeze in the engaged position.This is most likely to happen when there is an accumulation of snow or ice around or near the rear brakes or if the brakes are wet. If there is a risk the parking brake may freeze, apply it only temporarily while you put the gear in P and block the rear wheels so the car cannot roll. Then release the parking brake.

Do not let ice and snow accu- mulate underneath Under some conditions, snow and ice can build up under the fenders and interfere with the steering. When driving in severe winter conditions where this may happen, you should periodically check underneath the car to be sure the movement of the front wheels and the steering com- ponents is not obstructed.

Don’t place foreign objects or materials in the engine com- partment Placement of foreign object or mate- rials which prevent cooling of the engine, in the engine compartment, may cause a failure or combustion. The manufacturer is not responsible for the damage caused by such placement.

To keep locks from freezing To keep the locks from freezing, squirt an approved de-icer fluid or glycerine into the key opening. If a lock is covered with ice, squirt it with an approved de-icing fluid to remove the ice. If the lock is frozen internally, you may be able to thaw it out by using a heated key. Handle the heat- ed key with care to avoid injury.

5-186

Driving your vehicle

If you are considering to tow with your vehicle, you should first check with your state’s Department of Motor Vehicles to determine legal require- ments. Since laws vary from state to state the requirements for towing trailers, vehicles, or other types of vehicles or apparatus may differ. Ask an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for further details before towing. Remember that trailering is different than just driving your vehicle by itself. Trailering means changes in han- dling, durability, and fuel economy. Successful, safe trailering requires correct equipment, and it has to be used properly. Damage to your vehi- cle caused by improper trailer towing is not covered by your vehicle manu- facturers warranty. This section contains many time- tested, important trailering tips and safety rules. Many of these are important for your safety and that of your passengers. Please read this section carefully before you pull a trailer.

If you decide to pull a trailer Here are some important points if you decide to pull a trailer: Consider using a sway control. You

can ask a trailer hitch dealer about sway control.

Do not do any towing with your vehicle during its first 1,200 miles (2,000 km) in order to allow the engine to properly break in. Failure to heed this caution may result in serious engine or transmission damage.

When towing a trailer, be sure to consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for further information on additional requirements such as a towing kit, etc.

Always drive your vehicle at a mod- erate speed (less than 60 mph (100 km/h)) or posted towing speed limit.

On a long uphill grade, do not exceed 45 mph (70 km/h) or the posted towing speed limit, whichever is lower.

Carefully observe the weight and load limits provided in the following pages.

TRAILER TOWING

Take the following precautions: If you don’t use the correct

towing equipment, or if you drive improperly while towing, you can lose control of the vehicle when pulling a trailer. For example, if the trailer is too heavy, the braking per- formance may be reduced. You and your passengers could be seriously or fatally injured. Pull a trailer only if you have followed all the steps in this section.

Before towing, make sure the total trailer weight, GCW (Gross Combination Weight), GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight), GAW (Gross Axle Weight ) and trailer tongue load are all with- in the limits.

When you tow a trailer, make sure to turn off the Idle Stop and Go system.

WARNING

5-187

Driving your vehicle

5

Total trailer weight

What is the maximum safe weight of a trailer? It should never weigh more than the maximum trailer weight with trailer brakes. But even that can be too heavy. It depends on how you plan to use your trailer. For example, speed, altitude, road grades, outside temperature and how often your vehi- cle is used to pull a trailer are all important.The ideal trailer weight can also depend on any special equip- ment that you have on your vehicle.

Tongue load

The tongue load is an important weight to measure because it affects the total Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW) of your vehicle. The trailer tongue should weigh a maximum of 10% of the total loaded trailer weight, within the limits of the maximum trail- er tongue load permissible. After you’ve loaded your trailer, weigh the trailer and then the tongue, separately, to see if the weights are proper. If they arent, you may be able to correct them simply by mov- ing some items around in the trailer.

OLMB053047

Tongue Load Total Trailer Weight

OLMB053048

Gross Axle Weight Gross Vehicle Weight

Take the following precautions: Never load a trailer with more

weight in the rear than in the front. The front should be loaded with approximately 60% of the total trailer load; the rear should be loaded with approximately 40% of the total trailer load.

Never exceed the maximum weight limits of the trailer or trailer towing equipment. Improper loading can result in damage to your vehicle and/or personal injury. Check weights and loading at a commercial scale or highway patrol office equipped with scales.

WARNING

5-188

Driving your vehicle

lbs (kg)

Trailer towing equipment Hitches It’s important to have the correct hitch equipment. Crosswinds, large trucks going by, and rough roads are a few reasons why you’ll need the right hitch. Here are some rules to follow: The bumpers on your vehicle are

not intended for hitches. Do not attach rental hitches or other bumper-type hitches to them. Use only a frame-mounted hitch that does not attach to the bumper.

A HYUNDAI trailer hitch accessory is available at an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Item 7 seater 8 seater

Maximum trailer weight

Without brake system 1,653 (750) 1,653 (750)

With brake system 5,000 (2,267) 5,000 (2,267)

Maximum permissible static vertical load on the coupling device

500 (227) 500 (227)

Reference weight and distance when towing a trailer

5-189

Driving your vehicle

5

Safety chains You should always attach chains between your vehicle and your trail- er. Cross the safety chains under the tongue of the trailer so that the tongue will not drop to the road if it becomes separated from the hitch. Instructions about safety chains may be provided by the hitch manufactur- er or trailer manufacturer. Follow the manufacturer’s recommendation for attaching safety chains. Always leave just enough slack so you can turn with your trailer. And, never allow safety chains to drag on the ground.

Trailer brakes If your trailer is equipped with a brak- ing system, make sure it conforms to federal and/or local regulations and that it is properly installed and oper- ating correctly. If your trailer weighs more than the maximum trailer weight without trail- er brakes loaded, then it needs its own brakes and they must be ade- quate. Be sure to read and follow the instructions for the trailer brakes so youll be able to install, adjust and maintain them properly. Do not tap into your vehicle’s brake system. Trailer brakes must be applied sepa- rately from your vehicle’s brake sys- tem.

Driving with a trailer Towing a trailer requires a certain amount of experience. Before setting out for the open road, you must get to know your trailer. Acquaint your- self with the feel of handling and braking with the added weight of the trailer. And always keep in mind that the vehicle you are driving is now longer and not nearly as responsive as your vehicle is by itself. Before you start, check the trailer hitch and platform, safety chains, electrical connector(s), lights, tires and brakes. During your trip, occasionally check to be sure that the load is secure, and that the lights and trailer brakes are still working.

Do not use a trailer with its own brakes unless you are absolute- ly certain that you have properly set up the brake system. Use an experienced, competent trailer shop for this work.

WARNING

5-190

Driving your vehicle

Distance Stay at least twice as far behind the vehicle ahead as you would when driving your vehicle without a trailer. This can help you avoid situations that require heavy braking and sud- den turns.

Passing You will need more passing distance up ahead when youre towing a trail- er. And, because of the increased vehicle length, youll need to go much farther beyond the passed vehicle before you can return to your lane.

Backing up Hold the bottom of the steering wheel with one hand. Then, to move the trailer to the left, move your hand to the left. To move the trailer to the right, move your hand to the right. Always back up slowly and, if possi- ble, have someone guide you.

Making turns When you’re turning with a trailer, make wider turns than normal. Do this so your trailer won’t strike soft shoulders, curbs, road signs, trees, or other objects. Avoid jerky or sudden maneuvers. Signal well in advance.

Turn signals When you tow a trailer, your vehicle has to have a different turn signal flasher and extra wiring. The green arrows on your instrument panel will flash whenever you signal a turn or lane change. Properly connected, the trailer lights will also flash to alert other drivers you’re about to turn, change lanes, or stop. When towing a trailer, the green arrows on your instrument panel will flash for turns even if the bulbs on the trailer are burned out. Thus, you may think drivers behind you are seeing your signals when, in fact, they are not. It’s important to check periodical- ly to be sure the trailer bulbs are still working. You must also check the lights every time you disconnect and then reconnect the wires.

Do not connect a trailer lighting system directly to your vehi- cle’s lighting system. Use an approved trailer wiring harness. Failure to do so could result in damage to the vehicle electrical system and/or personal injury. Consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for assistance.

WARNING

5-191

Driving your vehicle

5

Driving on hills Reduce speed and shift to a lower gear before you start down a long or steep downgrade. If you don’t shift down, you might have to use your brakes so much that they would get overheated and may not operate effi- ciently. On a long uphill grade, shift down and reduce your speed to around 45 mph (70 km/h) to reduce the possi- bility of engine and transmission overheating. If your trailer weighs more than the maximum trailer weight without trailer brakes, you should drive in D (Drive) when towing a trailer. Operating your vehicle in D (Drive) when towing a trailer will minimize heat build-up and extend the life of your transmission.

To prevent engine and/or trans- mission overheating: When towing a trailer on steep

grades (in excess of 6%) pay close attention to the engine coolant temperature gauge to ensure the engine does not overheat. If the needle of the coolant temperature gauge moves towards «H» (HOT), pull over and stop as soon as it is safe to do so, and allow the engine to idle until it cools down.You may proceed once the engine has cooled sufficiently.

When towing a trailer, your vehi- cle speed may be much slower than the general flow of traffic, especially when climbing an uphill grade. Use the right hand lane when towing a trailer on an uphill grade. Choose your vehi- cle speed according to the max- imum posted speed limit for vehicles with trailers, the steep- ness of the grade, and your trail- er weight.

Parking on hills Generally, if you have a trailer attached to your vehicle, you should not park your vehicle on a hill.

However, if you ever have to park your trailer on a hill, here’s how to do it: 1. Pull the vehicle into the parking

area. Turn the steering wheel in the direction of the curb (right if head- ed down hill, left if headed up hill).

2. Shift the vehicle to P (Park). 3. Set the parking brake and shut off

the vehicle. 4. Place wheel chocks under the

trailer wheels on the down hill side of the wheels.

NOTICE

5-192

Driving your vehicle

5. Start the vehicle, apply the brakes, shift to neutral, release the park- ing brake and slowly release the brakes until the trailer chocks absorb the load.

6. Reapply the brakes and parking brakes.

7. Move the shift lever to P (Park). 8. Shut off the vehicle and release

the vehicle brakes but leave the parking brake set.

Driving the vehicle after it has been parked on a hill 1. With the gear shift lever in P

(Park), apply the brakes and hold the brake pedal down while per- forming the following: Start your engine; Shift into gear; and Release the parking brake.

2. Slowly remove your foot from the brake pedal.

3. Drive slowly until the trailer is clear of the chocks.

4. Stop and have someone pick up and store the chocks.

Maintenance when trailer tow- ing Your vehicle will need service more often when you regularly pull a trail- er. Important items to pay particular attention to include engine oil, auto- matic transmission fluid, axle lubri- cant and cooling system fluid. Brake condition is another important item to frequently check. If you’re trailering, its a good idea to review these items before you start your trip. Don’t forget to also maintain your trailer and hitch. Follow the maintenance sched- ule that accompanied your trailer and check it periodically. Preferably, inspect the vehicle and trailer at the start of each day’s driving. Inspect the hitch mounting to make sure the hitch is properly secured to the vehi- cle. Inspect the trailer electrical wiring to make sure brake lights, turn signal lights, running lights, and haz- ard lights are working properly.

Do not get out of the vehicle without the parking brake firmly set. If you have left the engine running, the vehicle can move suddenly. You and others could be seriously or fatally injured.

Do not apply the accelerator pedal to hold the vehicle on an uphill.

WARNING

5-193

Driving your vehicle

5

To prevent vehicle damage: Due to higher load during trailer

usage, overheating might occur on hot days or during uphill driv- ing. If the coolant gauge indi- cates over-heating, switch off the air conditioner and stop the vehicle in a safe area to cool down the engine.

When towing check the automat- ic transmission fluid more fre- quently.

NOTICE

5-194

Driving your vehicle

Two labels on your driver’s door sill show how much weight your vehicle was designed to carry: the Tire and Loading Information Label and the Certification Label. Before loading your vehicle, familiar- ize yourself with the following terms for determining your vehicle’s weight ratings, from the vehicle’s specifica- tions and the Certification Label:

Base Curb Weight This is the weight of the vehicle including a full tank of fuel and all standard equipment. It does not include passengers, cargo, or option- al equipment.

Vehicle Curb Weight This is the weight of your new vehicle when you picked it up from your deal- er plus any aftermarket equipment.

Cargo Weight This figure includes all weight added to the Base Curb Weight, including cargo and optional equipment.

GAW (Gross Axle Weight) This is the total weight placed on each axle (front and rear) — including vehicle curb weight and all payload.

GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) This is the maximum allowable weight that can be carried by a single axle (front or rear). These numbers are shown on the Certification Label. The total load on each axle must never exceed its GAWR.

GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) This is the Base Curb Weight plus actual Cargo Weight plus passen- gers.

GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) This is the maximum allowable weight of the fully loaded vehicle (including all options, equipment, passengers and cargo). The GVWR is shown on the Certification Label located on the drivers door sill.

VEHICLE LOAD LIMIT

5-195

Driving your vehicle

5

Tire Loading Information Label Vehicle capacity weight

1. 7 persons : 1173 lbs. (532 kg) 2. 8 persons : 1323 lbs. (600 kg)

Vehicle capacity weight is the maxi- mum combined weight of occupants and cargo. If your vehicle is equipped with a trailer, the combined weight includes the tongue load.

Seating capacity 1. Total : 7 persons

(Front seat : 2 persons, Rear seat : 5 persons)

2. Total : 8 persons (Front seat : 2 persons, Rear seat : 6 persons)

Seating capacity is the maximum number of occupants including a driver, your vehicle may carry. However, the seating capacity may be reduced based upon the weight of all of the occupants, and the weight of the cargo being carried or towed. Do not overload the vehicle as there is a limit to the total weight, or load limit including occupants and cargo, the vehicle can carry.

OLX2079056N

Type A

OLX2079057N

Type B

OLX2079058N

Type C

OLX2079059N

Type D

The label located on the driver’s door sill gives the original tire size, cold tire pressures recommended for your vehicle, the number of people that can be in your vehicle and vehicle capacity weight.

5-196

Driving your vehicle

Cargo capacity The cargo capacity of your vehicle will increase or decrease depending on the weight and the number of occupants and the tongue load, if your vehicle is equipped with a trailer.

Steps for determining correct load limit 1. Locate the statement «The com-

bined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs.» on your vehicle’s placard.

2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.

3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg or XXX lbs.

4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and lug- gage load capacity. For example, if the «XXX» amount equals 1400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb. passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and lug- gage load capacity is 650 lbs. (1400 — 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs.)

5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4.

6. If your vehicle will be towing a trail- er, load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.

Do not overload the vehicle as there is a limit to the total weight, or load limit, including occupants and cargo, the vehi- cle can carry. Overloading can shorten the life of the vehicle. If the GVWR or the GAWR is exceeded, parts on the vehicle can break, and it can change the handling of your vehicle. These could cause you to lose control and result in an acci- dent.

WARNING

5-197

Driving your vehicle

5

Example 1

Maximum Load (1400 lbs.) (635 kg)

Passenger Weight (150 lbs. 2 = 300 lbs.)

(68 kg 2 = 136 kg)

Cargo Weight (1100 lbs.) (499 kg)

Example 2

Maximum Load (1400 lbs.) (635 kg)

Passenger Weight (150 lbs. 5 = 750 lbs.)

(68 kg 5 = 340 kg)

Cargo Weight (650 lbs.) (295 kg)

Example 3

Maximum Load (1400 lbs.) (635 kg)

Passenger Weight (172 lbs. 5 = 860 lbs.)

(78 kg 5 = 390 kg)

Cargo Weight (540 lbs.) (245 kg)

+

+

+

5-198

Driving your vehicle

Certification label

The certification label is located on the drivers door sill at the center pil- lar and shows the maximum allow- able weight of the fully loaded vehi- cle. This is called the GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating). The GVWR includes the weight of the vehicle, all occupants, fuel and cargo. This label also tells you the maxi- mum weight that can be supported by the front and rear axles, called Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR).

The total weight of the vehicle, including all occupants, accessories, cargo, and trailer tongue load must not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). To find out the actual loads on your front and rear axles, you need to go to a weigh station and weigh your vehicle. Be sure to spread out your load equally on both sides of the centerline.

OBH059070

Overloading

Never exceed the GVWR for your vehicle, the GAWR for either the front or rear axle and vehicle capacity weight. Exceeding these ratings can affect your vehicles handling and braking ability, and cause an accident.

Do not overload your vehicle. Overloading your vehicle can cause heat buildup in your vehicles tires and possible tire failure, increased stop- ping distances and poor vehi- cle handling-all of which may result in a crash.

WARNING

5-199

Driving your vehicle

5

Overloading your vehicle may cause damage. Repairs would not be covered by your warranty. Do not overload your vehicle.

NOTICE

If you carry items inside your vehicle (e.g., suitcases, tools, packages, or anything else), they are moving as fast as the vehicle. If you have to stop or turn quickly, or if there is a crash, the items will keep going and can cause an injury if they strike the driver or a passenger. Put items in the cargo area of

your vehicle. Try to spread the weight evenly.

Do not stack items, like suit- cases, inside the vehicle above the tops of the seats.

Do not leave an unsecured child restraint in your vehicle.

When you carry something inside the vehicle, secure it.

WARNING

5-200

Front radar Rear corner radar

DECLARATION OF CONFIRMITY (IF EQUIPPED) The radio frequency components complies:

Driving your vehicle

OANATEL125

OANATEL002

OANATEL003

What to do in an emergency

6

Hazard Warning Flasher …………………………………6-2 In Case of an Emergency While Driving………….6-2

If the Engine Stalls While Driving ……………………………6-2 If the Engine Stalls at a Crossroad or Crossing……..6-2 If you Have a Flat Tire While Driving ……………………..6-3

If the Engine Will Not Start…………………………….6-3 If the Engine Doesn’t Turn Over or Turns Over Slowly …………………………………………………….6-3 If the Engine Turns Over Normally but Doesn’t Start …………………………………………………………….6-3

Jump Starting………………………………………………….6-4 If the Engine Overheats………………………………….6-6 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)………6-8

Check Tire Pressure …………………………………………………6-8 Tire Pressure Monitoring System……………………………6-9 Low Tire Pressure Telltale ……………………………………..6-10 Low Tire Pressure LCD Display with Position Indicator ……………………………………………………6-10 TPMS Malfunction Indicator ………………………………….6-11 Changing a Tire with TPMS……………………………………6-12

If You Have a Flat Tire………………………………….6-14 Jack and Tools ………………………………………………………..6-14 Removing and Storing the Spare Tire …………………..6-15 Changing Tires ………………………………………………………..6-16

Towing ………………………………………………………….6-22 Towing Service………………………………………………………..6-22 Removable Towing Hook ………………………………………..6-23 Emergency Towing………………………………………………….6-24

6-2

The hazard warning flasher serves as a warning to other drivers to exer- cise extreme caution when approach- ing, overtaking, or passing your vehi- cle. It should be used whenever emer- gency repairs are being made or when the vehicle is stopped near the edge of a roadway.

To turn the hazard warning flasher on or off, press the hazard warning flasher button. The button is located in the center fascia panel. Both the left and right turn signal lights will flash simultaneously. The hazard warning flasher oper-

ates whether your vehicle is run- ning or not.

The turn signals do not work when the hazard flasher is on.

If the Engine Stalls While Driving Reduce your speed gradually,

keeping a straight line. Move cau- tiously off the road to a safe place.

Turn on your hazard warning flash- er.

Try to start the engine again. If your vehicle will not start, contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer or seek other qualified assistance.

If the Engine Stalls at a Crossroad or Crossing If the engine stalls at a crossroads or crossing, if safe to do so, move the shift button to the N (Neutral) posi- tion and then push the vehicle to a safe location.

HAZARD WARNING FLASHER

What to do in an emergency

IN CASE OF AN EMERGENCY WHILE DRIVING

OLX2068001

6-3

W hat to do in an em

ergency

If you Have a Flat Tire While Driving If a tire goes flat while you are driving: Take your foot off the accelerator

pedal and let the vehicle slow down while driving straight ahead. Do not apply the brakes immediately or attempt to pull off the road as this may cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident. When the vehicle has slowed to such a speed that it is safe to do so, brake care- fully and pull off the road. Drive off the road as far as possible and park on firm, level ground. If you are on a divided highway, do not park in the median area between the two traffic lanes.

When the vehicle is stopped, press the hazard warning flasher button, move the shift button into P (Park), and apply the parking brake, and place the ignition switch in the OFF position.

Have all passengers get out of the vehicle. Be sure they all get out on the side of the vehicle that is away from traffic.

When changing a flat tire, follow the instructions provided later in this chapter.

If the Engine Doesn’t Turn Over or Turns Over Slowly Be sure the shift button is in N

(Neutral) or P (Park). The engine starts only when the shift button is in N (Neutral) or P (Park).

Check the battery connections to be sure they are clean and tight.

Turn on the interior light. If the light dims or goes out when you oper- ate the starter, the battery is drained.

Do not push or pull the vehicle to start it. This could cause damage to your vehicle. See instructions for «Jump Starting» provided in this chapter.

If the Engine Turns Over Normally but Doesn’t Start Check the fuel level and add fuel if necessary. If the engine still does not start, have your vehicle checked by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer.

6

IF THE ENGINE WILL NOT START

Push or pull starting the vehicle may cause the catalytic con- verter to overload which can lead to damage to the emission control system.

CAUTION

6-4

What to do in an emergency

Jump starting can be dangerous if done incorrectly. Follow the jump starting procedure in this section to avoid serious injury or damage to your vehicle. If in doubt about how to properly jump start your vehicle, we strongly recommend that you have a service technician or towing service do it for you.

Information An inappropriately disposed battery can be harmful to the environment and human health. Dispose of the battery according to your local law(s) or regulations.

i

Pb

JUMP STARTING

To prevent SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH to you or bystanders, always follow these precautions when working near or handling the battery:

Always read and follow instructions carefully when handling a battery. Wear eye protection designed to protect the eyes from acid splashes. Keep all flames, sparks, or smoking materials away from the battery.

WARNING

Hydrogen is always present in battery cells, is highly combustible, and may explode if ignit- ed. Keep batteries out of reach of children.

Batteries contain sulfu- ric acid which is highly corrosive. Do not allow acid to contact your eyes, skin or clothing.

If acid gets into your eyes, flush your eyes with clean water for at least 15 minutes and get imme- diate medical attention. If acid gets on your skin, thoroughly wash the area. If you feel pain or a burning sensation, get med- ical attention immediately. When lifting a plastic-cased

battery, excessive pressure on the case may cause battery acid to leak. Lift with a battery carrier or with your hands on opposite corners.

Do not attempt to jump start your vehicle if your battery is frozen.

NEVER attempt to recharge the battery when the vehicle’s battery cables are connected to the battery.

The electrical ignition system works with high voltage. NEVER touch these compo- nents with the engine running or when the ignition switch is in the ON position.

6-5

W hat to do in an em

ergency

6

To prevent damage to your vehicle: Only use a 12-volt power supply

(battery or jumper system) to jump start your vehicle.

Do not attempt to jump start your vehicle by push-starting.

Jump starting procedure 1. Position the vehicles close enough

that the jumper cables will reach, but do not allow the vehicles to touch.

2. Avoid fans or any moving parts in the engine compartment at all times, even when the vehicles are turned off.

3. Turn off all electrical devices such as radios, lights, air conditioning, etc. Put the vehicles in P (Park) and set the parking brakes. Turn both vehicles OFF.

4. Connect the jumper cables in the exact sequence shown in the illus- tration. First connect one jumper cable to the red, positive (+) jumper terminal of your vehicle (1).

5. Connect the other end of the jumper cable to the red, positive (+) battery/jumper terminal of the assisting vehicle (2).

6. Connect the second jumper cable to the black, negative (-) battery/jumper terminal of the assisting vehicle (3).

7. Connect the other end of the sec- ond jumper cable to the black, negative (-) chassis ground of your vehicle (4).

NOTICE

1VQA4001

While jump starting your vehi- cle, avoid the positive (+) and negative (-) cables to come in contact. A spark could cause personal injury.

WARNING

Before jump starting, make sure to correctly identify the positive (+) and negative (-) terminals to avoid reverse polarity connec- tions.

CAUTION

6-6

What to do in an emergency

Do not allow the jumper cables to contact anything except the cor- rect battery or jumper terminals or the correct ground. Do not lean over the battery when making con- nections.

8. Start the engine of the assisting vehicle and let it run at approxi- mately 2,000 RPM for a few min- utes. Then start your vehicle.

9. Operate your vehicle for at least 30 minutes of driving or at least 60 minutes of engine running at idle before shutting off the engine. Without sufficient time to charge the battery, another no-start will occur.You can also visit your near- est dealer to request the battery be charged and tested.

If your vehicle will not start after a few attempts, it probably requires servicing. In this event please seek qualified assistance. If the cause of your battery discharging is not apparent, have your vehicle checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Disconnect the jumper cables in the exact reverse order you connected them: 1. Disconnect the jumper cable from

the black, negative (-) chassis ground of your vehicle (4).

2. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the black, neg- ative (-) battery/chassis ground of the assisting vehicle (3).

3. Disconnect the second jumper cable from the red, positive (+) battery/jumper terminal of the assisting vehicle (2).

4. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the red, posi- tive (+) jumper terminal of your vehicle (1).

If your temperature gage indicates overheating, you experience a loss of power, or hear loud pinging or knocking, the engine may be over- heating. If this happens, you should: 1. Pull off the road and stop as soon

as it is safe to do so. 2. Put the vehicle in P (Park) and set

the parking brake. If the air condi- tioning is ON, turn it OFF.

3. If engine coolant is running out under the vehicle or steam is com- ing out from the hood, stop the engine. Do not open the hood until the coolant has stopped running or the steaming has stopped. If there is no visible loss of engine coolant and no steam, leave the engine running and check to be sure the engine cooling fan is operating. If the fan is not running, turn the engine off.

IF THE ENGINE OVERHEATS

Do not connect the jumper cable to the negative (-) jumper terminal of the discharged bat- tery. A spark could cause the battery to explode and lead to a personal injury or vehicle dam- age.

WARNING

6-7

W hat to do in an em

ergency

6

4. Check for coolant leaking from the radiator, hoses or under the vehi- cle. (If the air conditioning had been in use, it is normal for cold water to be draining from it when you stop.)

5. If engine coolant is leaking out, stop the engine immediately and call the nearest authorized HYUNDAI dealer for assistance.

6. If you cannot find the cause of the overheating, wait until the engine temperature has returned to nor- mal. Then, if coolant has been lost, carefully add coolant to the reser- voir to bring the fluid level in the reservoir up to the halfway mark.

7. Proceed with caution, keeping alert for further signs of overheat- ing. If overheating happens again, call an authorized HYUNDAI deal- er for assistance.

While the engine is running, keep hands, clothing and tools away from the mov- ing parts such as the cooling fan and drive belt to prevent seri- ous injury.

WARNING

Serious loss of coolant indi- cates a leak in the cooling sys- tem and should be checked as soon as possible by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer.

CAUTION

Your vehicle is equipped with a pres- surized coolant reserve tank. NEVER remove the radiator

cap or the drain plug while the engine and radiator are HOT. Hot coolant and steam may blow out under pressure, caus- ing serious injury. Turn the engine off and wait until the engine cools down. Use extreme care when remov- ing the radiator cap. Wrap a towel or thick rag around it, and turn it counterclockwise slowly to release some of the pressure from the system. Step back while the pressure is released. When you are sure all the pres- sure has been released, contin- ue turning the cap counter- clockwise to remove it.

WARNING

6-8

What to do in an emergency

(1) Low Tire Pressure / TPMS Malfunction Indicator Lamp

(2) Low Tire Pressure / Tire Pressure Monitor / TPMS Malfunction Display (shown on the cluster LCD display)

Check Tire Pressure

You can check the tire pressure in the Assist mode on the cluster. Refer to the «LCD Display Mode» section in chapter 3.

A «Drive to display» message will appear for the first few minutes of driving after initial engine start up. If the tire pressure is not displayed after a few minutes of driving, check the tire pressures.

The displayed tire pressure values may differ from those measured with a tire pressure gage.

You can change the tire pressure unit in the User Settings mode on the cluster. — psi, kpa, bar (Refer to the «User

Settings Mode» section in chapter 3).

TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS)

OLX2068003

OLX2068004L

OLX2048120L

6-9

W hat to do in an em

ergency

6

Tire Pressure Monitoring System

Each tire, including the spare (if pro- vided), should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehi- cle manufacturer on the vehicle plac- ard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pres- sure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.)

As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pres- sure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a signifi- cantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel effi- ciency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicles handling and stopping ability. Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire mainte- nance, and it is the driver’s responsi- bility to maintain correct tire pres- sure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumina- tion of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.

Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS mal- function indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximate- ly one minute and then remain con- tinuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehi- cle start-ups as long as the malfunc- tion exists. When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pres- sure as intended. TPMS malfunc- tions may occur for a variety of rea- sons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alter- nate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly.

Over-inflation or under-inflation can reduce tire life, adversely affect vehicle handling, and lead to sudden tire failure that may cause loss of vehicle con- trol resulting in an accident.

WARNING

6-10

What to do in an emergency

If any of the below happens, have the system checked by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer. 1.The Low Tire Pressure TPMS

Malfunction Indicator does not illuminate for 3 seconds when the ignition switch is placed to the ON position or engine is run- ning.

2.The TPMS Malfunction Indicator remains illuminated after blink- ing for approximately 1 minute.

3.The Low Tire Pressure LCD dis- play remains illuminated

Low Tire Pressure Telltale

Low Tire Pressure LCD Display with Position Indicator

When the tire pressure monitoring system warning indicators are illumi- nated and the warning message is displayed on the cluster LCD display, one or more of your tires is signifi- cantly under-inflated. The LCD posi- tion indicator will indicate which tire is significantly under-inflated by illu- minating the corresponding position light.

If any of your tire pressures are indi- cated as being low, immediately reduce your speed, avoid hard cor- nering, and anticipate increased stopping distances. You should stop and check your tires as soon as pos- sible. Inflate the tires to the proper pressure as indicated on the vehi- cles placard or tire inflation pressure label located on the driver’s side cen- ter pillar outer panel. If you cannot reach a service station or if the tire cannot hold the newly added air, replace the low pressure tire with the spare tire. The Low Tire Pressure LCD position indicator will remain on and the TPMS Malfunction Indicator may blink for one minute and then remain illuminated until you have the low pressure tire repaired and replaced on the vehicle.

The spare tire is not equipped with a tire pressure sensor.

NOTICE

NOTICE

OLX2068004L

6-11

W hat to do in an em

ergency

6

TPMS Malfunction Indicator

The TPMS Malfunction Indicator will illuminate after it blinks for approxi- mately one minute when there is a problem with the Tire Pressure Monitoring System. Have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible.

If there is a malfunction with the TPMS, the individual tire pres- sures in the cluster LCD display will not be available. Have the sys- tem checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possi- ble.

NOTICE

In winter or cold weather, the Low Tire Pressure Telltale may be illuminated if the tire pres- sure was adjusted to the recom- mended tire inflation pressure in warm weather. It does not mean your TPMS is malfunc- tioning because the decreased temperature leads to a propor- tional lowering of tire pressure. When you drive your vehicle from a warm area to a cold area or from a cold area to a warm area, or the outside temperature is greatly higher or lower, you should check the tire inflation pressure and adjust the tires to the recommended tire inflation pressure.

CAUTION

Low pressure damage

Significantly low tire pressure makes the vehicle unstable and can contribute to loss of vehicle control and increased braking distances. Continued driving on low pres- sure tires can cause the tires to overheat and fail.

WARNING

6-12

What to do in an emergency

The TPMS Malfunction Indicator may illuminate after blinking for one minute if the vehicle is near electric power supply cables or radio transmitters such as police stations, government and public offices, broadcasting stations, military installations, airports, transmitting towers, etc. Additionally, the TPMS Malfunction Indicator may illuminate if snow chains are used or electronic devices such as computers, charg- ers, remote starters, navigation, etc. This may interfere with normal operation of the TPMS.

Changing a Tire with TPMS If you have a flat tire, the Low Tire Pressure and LCD position indicator will come on. Have the flat tire repaired by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer as soon as possible or replace the flat tire with the spare tire.

The spare tire does not come with a tire pressure monitoring sensor. When the low pressure tire or the flat tire is replaced with the spare tire, the Low Tire Pressure LCD position indicator will remain on. Also, the TPMS Malfunction Indicator will illu- minate after blinking for one minute if the vehicle is driven at speed above 15.5 mph (25 km/h) for approximate- ly 20 minutes.

Once the original tire equipped with a tire pressure monitoring sensor is reinflated to the recommended pres- sure and reinstalled on the vehicle, the Low Tire Pressure LCD position indicator and TPMS Malfunction Indicator will go off within a few min- utes of driving. If the indicators do not disappear after a few minutes, please visit an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. Each wheel is equipped with a tire pressure sensor mounted inside the tire behind the valve stem (except for the spare tire). You must use TPMS specific wheels. It is recommended that you always have your tires serv- iced by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

NOTICE

Never use a puncture-repairing agent not approved by HYUNDAI dealer to repair and/or inflate a low pressure tire. Tire sealant not approved by HYUNDAI deal- er may damage the tire pressure sensor.

CAUTION

6-13

W hat to do in an em

ergency

6

You may not be able identify a tire with low pressure by simply looking at it. Always use a good quality tire pressure gauge to measure the tire’s inflation pressure. Please note that a tire that is hot (from being driven) will have a higher pressure measure- ment than a tire that is cold. A cold tire means the vehicle has been sitting for 3 hours and driven for less than 1 mile (1.6 km) in that 3 hour period. Allow the tire to cool before measur- ing the inflation pressure. Always be sure the tire is cold before inflating to the recommended pressure.

Information This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules.

Operation is subject to the following three conditions:

1.This device may not cause harmful interference.

2.This device must accept any inter- ference received, including interfer- ence that may cause undesired oper- ation.

3.Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.

i

The TPMS cannot alert you to severe and sudden tire dam- age caused by external fac- tors such as nails or road debris.

If you feel any vehicle instabil- ity, immediately take your foot off the accelerator, apply the brakes gradually with light force, and slowly move to a safe position off the road.

WARNING

Tampering with, modifying, or disabling the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) components may interfere with the system’s ability to warn the driver of low tire pressure con- ditions and/or TPMS malfunc- tions. Tampering with, modify- ing, or disabling the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) components may void the warranty for that portion of the vehicle.

WARNING

6-14

What to do in an emergency

Jack and Tools

Jack handle Jack Wheel lug nut wrench Socket Wheel cap removing tool

Screwdriver Towing hook

The jack, jack handle, wheel lug nut wrench and socket are stored in the luggage compartment under the lug- gage box cover. The jack is provided for emergency tire changing only.

IF YOU HAVE A FLAT TIRE

Changing a tire can be danger- ous. Follow the instructions in this section when changing a tire to reduce the risk of serious injury or death.

WARNING

Be careful as you use the jack handle to stay clear of the flat end. The flat end has sharp edges that could cause cuts.

CAUTION OLX2069024N

OLX2069025N

6-15

W hat to do in an em

ergency

Removing and Storing the Spare Tire

Your spare tire is stored underneath your vehicle, directly below the cargo area. To remove the spare tire: 1. Open the liftgate. 2. Find the plastic hex bolt cover and

remove the cover with a coin or flat-blade screwdriver.

3. Connect the socket (A) and wheel lug nut wrench (B).

4. Loosen the bolt enough to lower the spare tire. Turn the wrench counterclockwise until the spare tire reaches the ground.

5. After the spare tire reaches the ground, continue to turn the wrench counterclockwise, and draw the spare tire outside. Never rotate the wrench excessively, otherwise the spare tire carrier may be damaged.

6. Draw out the retainer guide (1) through the center hole of the spare tire.

6

OLX2068026L

OLX2068027L OLX2069028N

6-16

What to do in an emergency

To store the spare tire: 1. Lay the tire on the ground with the

valve stem facing up. 2. Place the wheel under the vehicle

and install the retainer guide and chain through the wheel center.

3. Turn the wrench clockwise until it clicks.

Changing Tires

Follow these steps to change your vehicle’s tire: 1. Park on a level, firm surface. 2. Move the shift button into P

(Park), apply the parking brake, and place the ignition switch in the OFF position.

3. Press the hazard warning flasher button.

4. Remove the wheel lug nut wrench, jack, jack handle, wheel cap remover (big cap only) and spare tire from the vehicle.

5. Block both the front and rear of the tire diagonally opposite of the tire you are changing.

A vehicle can slip or roll off of a jack causing serious injury or death to you or those nearby. Take the following safety pre- cautions: Never place any portion of

your body under a vehicle that is supported by a jack.

NEVER attempt to change a tire in the lane of traffic. ALWAYS move the vehicle completely off the road on level, firm ground away from traffic before trying to change a tire. If you cannot find a level, firm place off the road, call a towing service for assistance.

Be sure to use the jack pro- vided with the vehicle.

ALWAYS place the jack on the designated jacking positions on the vehicle and NEVER on the bumpers or any other part of the vehicle for jacking sup- port.

Do not start or run the engine while the vehicle is on the jack.

Do not allow anyone to remain in the vehicle while it is on the jack.

Keep children away from the road and the vehicle.

WARNING

Ensure the spare tire retainer guide is properly aligned with the center of the spare tire to prevent the spare tire from «rat- tling». Otherwise, it may cause the spare tire to fall off the carrier and lead to an accident.

CAUTION

6-17

W hat to do in an em

ergency

6

6. Insert the tool (1, if equipped) into the hole and pull out the wheel cover.

When removing the wheel cover, if you use any other tool except the tool (1) provided, the wheel cover may be damaged.

7. Loosen the wheel lug nuts coun- terclockwise one turn each in the order shown above, but do not remove any lug nuts until the tire has been raised off of the ground.

8. Place the jack at the designated jacking position under the frame closest to the tire you are chang- ing. The jacking positions are plates welded to the frame with two notches. Never jack at any other position or part of the vehi- cle. Doing so may damage the side seal molding or other parts of the vehicle.

NOTICE

OLX2068030LOLX2069034N OLX2068031L

Front

Rear

6-18

What to do in an emergency

9. Insert the jack handle into the jack and turn it clockwise, raising the vehicle until the tire clears the ground. Make sure the vehicle is stable on the jack.

10. Loosen the lug nuts with the wheel lug nut wrench and remove them with your fingers. Remove the wheel from the studs and lay it flat on the ground out of the way. Remove any dirt or debris from the studs, mount- ing surfaces, and wheel.

11. Install the spare tire onto the studs of the hub.

12. Tighten the lug nuts with your fin- gers onto the studs with the smaller end of the lug nuts clos- est to the wheel.

13. Lower the vehicle to the ground by turning the jack handle coun- terclockwise.

14. Use the wheel lug nut wrench to tighten the lug nuts in the order shown. Double-check each lug nut until they are tight. After changing tires, have an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer tighten the lug nuts to their proper torque as soon as possible. The wheel lug nut should be tightened to 79~94 lbfft (11~13 kgfm).

OLX2068033LOLX2068032L

6-19

W hat to do in an em

ergency

6

If you have a tire gauge, check the tire pressure (see «Tires and Wheels» in chapter 8 for tire pressure instructions.). If the pressure is lower or higher than recommended, drive slowly to the nearest service station and adjust it to the recommended pressure. Always reinstall the valve cap after checking or adjusting tire pressure. If the cap is not replaced, air may leak from the tire. If you lose a valve cap, buy another and install it as soon as possible. After changing tires, secure the flat tire and return the jack and tools to their proper stor- age locations. If it is hard to secure the flat tire, put the flat tire in the lug- gage compartment.

Check the tire pressure as soon as possible after installing a spare tire. Adjust it to the rec- ommended pressure.

Check and tighten the wheel lug nuts after driving over 30 mile (50 km) if tires are replaced. Recheck the tire wheel lug nuts after driving over 600 mile (1,000 km).

If any of the equipment such as the jack, lug nuts, studs, or other equip- ment is damaged or in poor condi- tion, do not attempt to change the tire and call for assistance.

Use of compact spare tires Compact spare tires are designed for emergency use only. Drive carefully on the compact spare tire and always follow the safety precautions.

NOTICE

Your vehicle has metric threads on the studs and lug nuts. Make certain during tire changing that the same nuts that were removed are reinstalled. If you have to replace your lug nuts make sure they have metric threads to avoid damaging the studs and ensure the wheel is properly secured to the hub. Consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for assistance.

CAUTION

To prevent compact spare tire failure and loss of control pos- sibly resulting in an accident: Use the compact spare tire

only in an emergency. NEVER operate your vehicle

over 50 mph (80 km/h). Do not exceed the vehicle’s

maximum load rating or the load carrying capacity shown on the sidewall of the com- pact spare tire.

Do not use the compact spare tire continuously. Repair or replace the original tire as soon as possible to avoid fail- ure of the compact spare tire.

WARNING

6-20

What to do in an emergency

When driving with the compact spare tire mounted to your vehicle: Check the tire pressure after

installing the compact spare tire. The compact spare tire should be inflated to 60 psi (420 kPa).

Do not take this vehicle through an automatic car wash while the com- pact spare tire is installed.

Do not use the compact spare tire on any other vehicle because this tire has been designed especially for your vehicle.

The compact spare tires tread life is shorter than a regular tire. Inspect your compact spare tire regularly and replace worn compact spare tires with the same size and design, mounted on the same wheel.

Do not use more than one com- pact spare tire at a time.

Do not tow a trailer while the com- pact spare tire is installed.

When the original tire and wheel are repaired and reinstalled on the vehicle, the lug nut torque must be set correctly. The correct lug nut tightening torque is 79~94 lbfft (11~13 kgfm).

NOTICE

To prevent damaging the com- pact spare tire and your vehicle: Drive slowly enough for the

road conditions to avoid all hazards, such as a potholes or debris.

Avoid driving over obstacles. The compact spare tire diame- ter is smaller than the diame- ter of a conventional tire and reduces the ground clearance approximately 1 inch (25 mm).

Do not use tire chains on the compact spare tire. Because of the smaller size, a tire chain will not fit properly.

Do not use the compact spare tire on any other wheels, nor should standard tires, snow tires, wheel covers or trim rings be used with the com- pact spare wheel.

Do not suddenly accelerate or decelerate 0 ~ 25 mph (0 ~ 40 km/h) in any driving mode. It may cause leakage of transfer oil.

CAUTION

6-21

W hat to do in an em

ergency

Jack label

6

The actual Jack label in the vehicle may differ from the illustration. For more detailed specifications, refer to the label attached to the jack.

1. Model Name 2. Maximum allowable load 3. When using the jack, set your

parking brake. 4. When using the jack, stop the

engine. 5. Do not get under a vehicle that is

supported by a jack. 6. The designated locations under

the frame 7. When supporting the vehicle, the

base plate of jack must be vertical under the lifting point.

8. Shift into Reverse gear on vehicles with manual transmission or move the shift button to the P (Park) position on vehicles with automat- ic transmission.

9. The jack should be used on firm level ground.

10.Jack manufacture 11.Production date 12.Representative company and

address

Example

OOS067043

6-22

What to do in an emergency

Towing Service

[A] : Dollies

If emergency towing is necessary, we recommend having it done by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer or a commercial tow-truck service. Proper lifting and towing procedures are necessary to prevent damage to the vehicle. The use of wheel dollies or flatbed is recommended.

On 2WD vehicles, it is acceptable to tow the vehicle with the rear wheels on the ground (without dollies) and the front wheels off the ground. If any of the loaded wheels or suspension components are damaged or the vehicle is being towed with the front wheels on the ground, use a towing dolly under the front wheels. When being towed by a commercial tow truck and wheel dollies are not used, the front of the vehicle should always be lifted, not the rear. If your vehicle is an AWD vehicle, it must be towed with a wheel lift and dollies or flatbed equipment with all the wheels off the ground.

An AWD vehicle should never be towed with the wheels on the ground. This can cause serious damage to the transaxle or the AWD system.

Do not tow the vehicle with the front wheels on the ground as this may cause damage to the vehicle.

Do not tow with sling-type equipment. Use a wheel lift or flatbed equipment.

NOTICE

NOTICE

TOWING

OLX2068011L

OLX2068014

OLX2068013

6-23

W hat to do in an em

ergency

6

When towing your vehicle in an emergency without wheel dollies: 1. Place the ignition switch in the

ACC position. 2. Place the shift button in N

(Neutral). 3. Release the parking brake.

Removable Towing Hook

1. Open the liftgate, and remove the towing hook from the tool case.

2. Remove the hole cover by press- ing the lower part of the cover on the front or rear bumper.

3. Install the towing hook by turning it clockwise into the hole until it is fully secured.

4. Remove the towing hook and install the cover after use.

OLX2069016N

Front

OLX2068017

If your vehicle is equipped with a rollover sensor, place the igni- tion switch in the OFF or ACC position when the vehicle is being towed. The side impact and curtain air bag may deploy if the sensor detects the situa- tion as a rollover.

WARNING

Failure to place the shift button in N (Neutral) when being towed with the front wheels on the ground can cause internal dam- age to the transmission.

CAUTION

OLX2068015 Rear

6-24

What to do in an emergency

Emergency Towing

If towing is necessary, we recom- mend you have it done by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer or a commer- cial tow truck service.

If towing service is not available in an emergency, your vehicle may be temporarily towed using a cable or chain secured to the emergency tow- ing hook at the front (or rear) of the vehicle. Use extreme caution when towing the vehicle with a cable or chain. A driver must be in the vehicle to steer it and operate the brakes. Towing in this manner may be done only on hard-surfaced roads for a short distance and at low speeds. Also, the wheels, axles, power train, steering and brakes must all be in good condition.

Always follow these emergency tow- ing precautions: While depressing the brake pedal

shift to the N (Neutral) position and turn the vehicle off. The POWER button will be in the ACC position.

Release the parking brake. Depress the brake pedal with more

force than normal since you will have reduced braking perform- ance.

More steering effort will be required because the power steer- ing system will be disabled.

Use a vehicle heavier than your own to tow your vehicle.

The drivers of both vehicles should communicate with each other fre- quently.

Before emergency towing, check that the hook is not broken or dam- aged.

Fasten the towing cable or chain securely to the hook.

Do not jerk the hook. Apply steady and even force.

OLX2069018N

OLX2068019

The driver must be in the vehi- cle for steering and braking operations when the vehicle is being towed. Passengers other than the driver must not be in the vehicle.

CAUTION

6-25

W hat to do in an em

ergency

6

Use a towing cable or chain less than 16 feet (5 m) long. Attach a white or red cloth (about 12 inch (30 cm) wide) in the middle of the cable or chain for easy visibility.

Drive carefully so the towing cable or chain remains tight during tow- ing.

Before towing, check the reduction gear for fluid leaks under your vehi- cle. If the reduction gear is leaking, flatbed equipment or a towing dolly must be used.

Accelerate or decelerate the vehi- cle in a slow and gradual manner while maintaining tension on the tow rope or chain to start or drive the vehicle, otherwise tow hooks and the vehicle may be damaged.

To avoid damage to your vehicle and vehicle components when towing: Always pull straight ahead when

using the towing hooks. Do not pull from the side or at a vertical angle.

Do not use the towing hooks to pull a vehicle out of mud, sand or other conditions from which the vehicle cannot be driven out under its own power.

Limit the vehicle speed to 10 mph (15 km/h) and drive less than 1 mile (1.5 km) when towing to avoid serious damage to the reduction gear.

NOTICE

NOTICE

OFE068022

7

M aintenance

Maintenance

Engine compartment ………………………………………7-3 Maintenance services …………………………………….7-4

Owner’s Responsibility……………………………………………..7-4 Owner Maintenance Precautions…………………………….7-4

Owner maintenance………………………………………..7-5 Owner Maintenance Schedule …………………………………7-6

Scheduled maintenance services…………………….7-7 Normal Maintenance Schedule (3.8 GDI) ………………..7-8 Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions (3.8 GDI) …………………………………………………………………..7-11

Explanation of scheduled maintenance items.7-13 Engine oil ……………………………………………………..7-16

Checking the Engine Oil Level ……………………………….7-16 Checking the Engine Oil and Filter………………………..7-17

Engine coolant………………………………………………7-18 Checking the Engine Coolant Level……………………….7-18 Changing Engine Coolant ……………………………………….7-20

Brake fluid ……………………………………………………7-21 Checking the Brake Fluid Level……………………………..7-21

Washer fluid …………………………………………………7-22 Checking the Washer Fluid Level…………………………..7-22

Air cleaner ……………………………………………………7-22 Filter Replacement………………………………………………….7-22

Climate control air filter ……………………………….7-24 Filter Inspection………………………………………………………7-24

Wiper blades …………………………………………………7-26 Blade Inspection ……………………………………………………..7-26 Blade Replacement …………………………………………………7-26

Battery………………………………………………………….7-29 For Best Battery Service ……………………………………….7-30 Battery Recharging ………………………………………………..7-31 Reset Features………………………………………………………..7-32

Tires and wheels …………………………………………..7-33 Tire Care………………………………………………………………….7-33 Recommended Cold Tire Inflation Pressures………..7-34 Check Tire Inflation Pressure ………………………………..7-35 Tire Rotation……………………………………………………………7-35 Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance ……………………….7-36 Tire Replacement …………………………………………………..7-37 Wheel Replacement ………………………………………………..7-38 Tire Traction ……………………………………………………………7-38 Tire Maintenance ……………………………………………………7-39 Tire Sidewall Labeling …………………………………………….7-39 Tire Terminology and Definitions…………………………..7-43 All Season Tires………………………………………………………7-46 Snow Tires ………………………………………………………………7-46 Radial-Ply Tires ………………………………………………………7-46

7

Fuses…………………………………………………………….7-48 Instrument Panel Fuse Replacement……………………..7-49 Engine Compartment Panel Fuse Replacement…….7-50 Fuse/Relay Panel Description………………………………..7-51

Light bulbs…………………………………………………….7-61 Headlamp, Parking lamp, Daytime Running Light, Turn signal lamp and Side marker …………………………7-61 Side Repeater Lamp Replacement …………………………7-64 Rear combination lamp light replacement …………….7-64 High Mounted Stop Lamp Bulb Replacement ……….7-66 License Plate Light Bulb Replacement …………………7-66 Interior Light Bulb Replacement ……………………………7-67

Appearance care…………………………………………..7-69 Exterior Care …………………………………………………………..7-69 Interior Care ……………………………………………………………7-74

Emission control system ……………………………….7-77 Crankcase Emission Control System ……………………..7-77 Evaporative Emission Control System Including Onboard Refueling Vapor Recovery (ORVR)…………7-77 Exhaust Emission Control System …………………………7-78

California perchlorate notice ………………………..7-81

ENGINE COMPARTMENT

OLX2078002L

3.8 GDI

1. Engine coolant reservoir

2. Radiator cap

3. Brake fluid reservoir

4. Air cleaner

5. Engine oil filler cap

6. Engine oil dipstick

7. Windshield washer fluid reservoir

8. Fuse box

9. Battery terminal [+]

10. Battery terminal [-]

The actual engine compartment in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.

The actual engine compartment in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.

M aintenance

7

7-3

MAINTENANCE SERVICES You should exercise the utmost care to prevent damage to your vehicle and injury to yourself whenever per- forming any maintenance or inspec- tion procedures. We recommend you have your vehi- cle maintained and repaired by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. An authorized HYUNDAI dealer meets HYUNDAI’s high service quality standards and receives technical support from HYUNDAI in order to provide you with a high level of serv- ice satisfaction.

Owner’s Responsibility Maintenance service and record retention are the owner’s responsibil- ity. You should retain documents that show proper maintenance has been performed on your vehicle in accor- dance with the scheduled mainte- nance service charts shown on the following pages. You need this infor- mation to establish your compliance with the servicing and maintenance requirements of your vehicle war- ranties.

Detailed warranty information is pro- vided in your Owner’s Handbook & Warranty Information booklet. Repairs and adjustments required as a result of improper maintenance or a lack of required maintenance are not covered.

Owner Maintenance Precautions Inadequate, incomplete or insuffi- cient servicing may result in opera- tional problems with your vehicle that could lead to vehicle damage, an accident, or personal injury. This chapter provides instructions only for the maintenance items that are easy to perform. Several procedures can be done only by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer with special tools. Your vehicle should not be modified in any way. Such modifications may adversely affect the performance, safety or durability of your vehicle and may, in addition, violate condi- tions of the limited warranties cover- ing the vehicle.

Certain modifications may also be in violation of regulations established by the U.S. Department of Transportation and other federal or state agencies.

Improper owner maintenance dur- ing the warranty period may affect warranty coverage. For details, read the separate Owner’s Handbook & Warranty Information booklet provided with the vehicle. If you’re unsure about any service or maintenance procedure, have it done by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

NOTICE

Maintenance

7-4

OWNER MAINTENANCE The following lists are vehicle checks and inspections that should be per- formed by the owner or an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer at the frequen- cies indicated to help ensure safe, dependable operation of your vehi- cle. Any adverse conditions should be brought to the attention of your deal- er as soon as possible. These Owner Maintenance vehicle checks are generally not covered by warranties and you may be charged for labor, parts and lubricants used.

Performing maintenance work on a vehicle can be dangerous. If you lack sufficient knowledge and experience or the proper tools and equipment to do the work, have it done by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer. ALWAYS follow these precau- tions for performing mainte- nance work: Park your vehicle on level

ground, move the shift button into the P (Park) position, place the ignition switch in the OFF position.

WARNING Block the tires (front and back) to prevent the vehicle from moving. Remove loose clothing or jew- elry that can become entan- gled in moving parts.

If you must run the engine during maintenance, do so out doors or in an area with plenty of ventilation.

Keep flames, sparks, or smok- ing materials away from the battery and fuel-related parts. M

aintenance

7

7-5

Owner Maintenance Schedule When you stop for fuel: Check the coolant level in the

engine coolant reservoir. Check the windshield washer fluid

level. Check the tire for low or under-

inflated tires.

While operating your vehicle: Note any changes in the sound of

the exhaust or any smell of exhaust fumes in the vehicle.

Check for vibrations in the steering wheel. Notice if there is any increased steering effort or loose- ness in the steering wheel, or change in its straight-ahead posi- tion.

Notice if your vehicle constantly turns slightly or «pulls» to one side when traveling on smooth, level road.

When stopping, listen and check for unusual sounds, pulling to one side, increased brake pedal travel or «hard-to-push» brake pedal.

If any slipping or changes in the operation of your transmission occurs, check the transmission fluid level.

Check the automatic transmission P (Park) function.

Check the parking brake. Check for fluid leaks under your

vehicle (water dripping from the air conditioning system during or after use is normal).

At least monthly: Check coolant level in the engine

coolant reservoir. Check the operation of all exterior

lights, including the brake lights, turn signals and hazard warning flashers.

Check the inflation pressures of all tires including the spare for tires that are worn, show uneven wear, or are damaged.

Check for loose wheel lug nuts.

At least twice a year: (i.e., every Spring and Autumn) Check radiator, heater and air con-

ditioning hoses for leaks or dam- age.

Check windshield washer spray and wiper operation. Clean wiper blades with a clean cloth damp- ened with washer a fluid.

Check headlamp alignment. Check muffler, exhaust pipes,

shields and clamps. Check seat belts for wear and

function.

Be careful when checking your engine coolant level when the engine is hot. This may result in coolant being blown out of the opening and cause serious burns and other injuries.

WARNING

Maintenance

7-6

At least once a year: Clean body and door drain holes. Lubricate door hinges and hood

hinges. Lubricate door and hood locks and

latches. Lubricate door rubber weather

strips. Lubricate door checker. Check the air conditioning system. Inspect and lubricate automatic

transmission linkage and controls. Clean the battery and terminals. Check the brake fluid level.

Follow Normal Maintenance Schedule if the vehicle is usually operated where none of the following conditions apply. If any of the follow- ing conditions apply, you must follow the Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions. Repeatedly driving short distances

of less than 5 miles (8 km) in normal temperature or less than 10 miles (16 km) in freezing temperature

Extensive engine idling or low speed driving for long distances

Driving on rough, dusty, muddy, unpaved, graveled or salt-spread roads

Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive materials or in very cold weather

Driving in heavy dust conditions Driving in heavy traffic area Driving on uphill, downhill, or moun-

tain road repeatedly Using for towing or camping, and

driving with loads on the roof Driving as a patrol car, taxi, other

commercial use or vehicle towing Frequently driving under high speed

or rapid acceleration/deceleration

Frequently driving in stop-and-go conditions

Engine oil usage which is not rec- ommended (Mineral type, Semi- synthetic, Lower grade spec, etc.)

Driving more than 10 years or 100,000 miles

For additional information or assis- tance see your authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

After 10 years or 100,000 miles, we recommend to use severe mainte- nance schedule.

Information As it is normal for engine oil to be

consumed during driving, the engine oil level should be checked on regular basis.

The engine oil change interval for normal operating conditions is based on the use of the recommended engine specification. If the recom- mended engine oil specification is not used, then replace the engine oil according to the maintenance sched- ule under severe operating condi- tions.

i

NOTICE

SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE SERVICES

M aintenance

7

7-7

Maintenance

7-8

Normal Maintenance Schedule (3.8 GDI)

I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace. R : Replace or change. *1 : The drive belt should be replaced when cracks occur or tension is reduced. *2 : If TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is not available, one bottle of additive is recommended. Additives are available from your

authorized HYUNDAI dealer along with information on how to use them. Do not mix other additives. *3 : Inspect for excessive valve noise and/or engine vibration and adjust if necessary. Have an authorized authorized HYUNDAI

dealer perform the operation. * As it is normal for engine oil to be consumed during driving, the amount of engine oil should be checked regularly. * The replacement cycle of engine oil is set by the period which the performance of our recommended engine oil is maintained.

So, if recommended engine oil is not used, a replacement is required as indicated severe usage condition.

Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first Months 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96 108 120 132 144 156 Miles1,000 7.5 15 22.5 30 37.5 45 52.5 60 67.5 75 82.5 90 97.5 Km1,000 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96 108 120 132 144 156

Drive belts *1 At first, inspect at 48,000 miles (78,000 km) or 72 months, after that, inspect every 8,000 miles (13,000 km) or 24 months

Engine oil and engine oil filter R R R R R R R R R R R R R

Fuel additives *2 Add every 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or 12 months

Air cleaner filter I I R I I R I I R I I R I

Spark plugs Replace every 96,000 miles (156,000 km)

Valve clearance *3 Inspect every 64,000 miles (104,000 km) or 72 months

Rotate tires Rotate every 7,500 miles (12,000 km)

MAINTENANCE INTERVALS

MAINTENANCE ITEM

M aintenance

7

7-9

I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace. R : Replace or change.

Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first Months 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96 108 120 132 144 156 Miles1,000 7.5 15 22.5 30 37.5 45 52.5 60 67.5 75 82.5 90 97.5 Km1,000 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96 108 120 132 144 156

Climate control air filter (if equipped) R R R R R R R R R R R R R

Vacuum hose I I I I I I I I I I I I I

Engine coolant At first, replace at 120,000 miles (192,000 km) or 10 years :

after that, replace every 30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 24 months

Battery condition I I I I I I I I I I I I I

Brake lines, hoses and connections I I I I I I I I I I I I I

Disc brakes and pads I I I I I I I I I I I I I

Steering gear rack, linkage and boots I I I I I I I I I I I I I

Driveshaft and boots I I I I I I

Suspension mounting bolts I I I I I I I I I I I I I

Air conditioner refrigerant I I I I I I I I I I I I I

Air conditioner compressor I I I I I I I I I I I I I

Propeller shaft (AWD) I I I I I I

Exhaust pipe and muffler I I I I I I I I I I I I I

MAINTENANCE INTERVALS

MAINTENANCE ITEM

Normal Maintenance Schedule (3.8 GDI) (CONT.)

Maintenance

7-10

I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace. R : Replace or change. *4 : Rear differential oil and transfer case oil should be changed anytime they have been submerged in water. *5 : Fuel filter & Fuel tank air filter are considered to be maintenance free but periodic inspection is recommended for this mainte-

nance schedule depends on fuel quality. If there are some important safety matters like fuel flow restriction, surging, loss of power, hard starting problem, etc. replace the fuel filter immediately regardless of maintenance schedule and consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for details.

Number of months or driving distance, whichever comes first Months 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96 108 120 132 144 156 Miles1,000 7.5 15 22.5 30 37.5 45 52.5 60 67.5 75 82.5 90 97.5 Km1,000 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96 108 120 132 144 156

Automatic transmission fluid No check, No service required

Rear differential oil (AWD) *4 I I I

Transfer case oil (AWD) *4 I I I

Vapor hose, fuel filler cap and fuel tank I I I I I I

Fuel tank air filter *5 I I I I I I

Fuel filter *5 I I I I I I

Fuel lines, hoses and connections I I I

Parking brake I I I I I I

Brake fluid At first, inspect every 8,000 miles (13,000 km) or 12 months,

after that, replace every 48,000 miles (78,000 km) or 48 months

MAINTENANCE INTERVALS

MAINTENANCE ITEM

Normal Maintenance Schedule (3.8 GDI) (CONT.)

M aintenance

7

7-11

Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions (3.8 GDI) The following items must be serviced more frequently on cars normally used under severe driving conditions. Refer to the chart below for the appropriate maintenance intervals. R : Replace or change. I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.

MAINTENANCE ITEM MAINTENANCE

OPERATION MAINTENANCE INTERVALS

DRIVING CONDITION

Engine oil and filter R Every 5,000 miles (6,500 km) or

6 months A, B, C, D, E, F, G,

H, I, J, K, L

Air cleaner filter R More frequently C, E

Spark plugs R More frequently A, B, F, H, I ,K

Automatic transaxle fluid R Every 60,000 miles (96,000 km) A, C, D, E, F, G, H, J, I

Front brake disc/pads, calipers I More frequently C, D, ,E, J, G, H, K

Rear brake disc/pads, calipers I More frequently C, D, ,E, J, G, H, K

Parking brake I More frequently C, D, G, H

Maintenance

7-12

Severe driving conditions A — Repeatedly driving short distance of less than 5 miles (8

km) in normal temperature or less than 10 miles (16 km) in freezing temperature

B — Extensive engine idling or low speed driving for long dis- tances

C — Driving on rough, dusty, muddy, unpaved, graveled or salt- spread roads

D — Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive materials or in very cold weather

E — Driving in heavy dust conditions F — Driving in heavy traffic area

G — Driving on uphill, downhill, or mountain road repeatedly H — Using for towing or camping, and driving with loads on the

roof I — Driving as a patrol car, taxi, other commercial use or vehicle

towing J — Frequently driving under high speed or rapid

acceleration/deceleration K — Frequently driving in stop-and-go conditions L — Engine oil usage which is not recommended (Mineral type,

Semi-synthetic, Lower grade spec, etc.)

MAINTENANCE ITEM MAINTENANCE

OPERATION MAINTENANCE INTERVALS

DRIVING CONDITION

Steering gear box, linkage & boots/ Lower arm ball joint, upper arm ball joint

I More frequently C, D, E, F, G, H, I

Drive shafts and boots I More frequently C, D, E, F, G, H, I, J

Rear differential oil R Every 80,000 miles (120,000 km) C, G, H, I, J, E

Transfer case oil (AWD) R Every 80,000 miles (120,000 km) C, G, H, I, J, E

Climate control air filter (for evaporator and blower unit) R More frequently C, E

Propeller shaft I More frequently C, D, E, F, G, H, I, J

7-13

7

M aintenance

EXPLANATION OF SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE ITEMS Engine Oil and Filter The engine oil and filter should be changed at the intervals specified in the maintenance schedule. If the vehicle is being driven in severe con- ditions, more frequent oil and filter changes are required.

Drive Belts Inspect all drive belts for evidence of cuts, cracks, excessive wear or oil saturation and replace if necessary. Drive belts should be checked peri- odically for proper tension and adjusted as necessary.

Fuel Filter A clogged-up fuel filter may limit the vehicle driving speed, damage the emission system, and cause the hard starting. When a considerable amount of foreign substances are accumulated in the fuel tank, the fuel filter should be replaced. Upon installing a new fuel filter, oper- ate the engine for several minutes, and check the connections for any leakages. Fuel filters should be installed by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Fuel Lines, Fuel Hoses and Connections Check the fuel lines, fuel hoses and connections for leakage and dam- age. Have an authorized HYUNDAI dealer replace any damaged or leak- ing parts immediately.

Vapor Hose and Fuel Filler Cap The vapor hose and fuel filler cap should be inspected at those inter- vals specified in the maintenance schedule. Make sure a new vapor hose or fuel filler cap is correctly replaced.

Vacuum Crankcase Ventilation Hoses Inspect the surface of hoses for evi- dence of heat and/or mechanical damage. Hard and brittle rubber, cracking, tears, cuts, abrasions, and excessive swelling indicate deterio- ration. Particular attention should be paid to examine those hose surfaces nearest to high heat sources, such as the exhaust manifold. Inspect the hose routing to ensure that the hoses do not come in con- tact with any heat source, sharp edges or moving component which might cause heat damage or mechanical wear. Inspect all hose connections, such as clamps and couplings, to make sure they are secure, and that no leaks are pres- ent. Hoses should be replaced immediately if there is any evidence of deterioration or damage.

7-14

Maintenance

Air Cleaner Filter A genuine HYUNDAI air cleaner filter is recommended when the filter is replaced.

Spark Plugs Make sure to install new spark plugs of the correct heat range. When assembling parts, be sure to wipe out foreign substances inside and outside of the boot bottom of the ignition coil and the insulator of the spark plug with a soft cloth to prevent contamination of the spark plug insu- lator.

Cooling System Check cooling system components, such as radiator, coolant reservoir, hoses and connections for leakage and damage. Replace any damaged parts.

Engine Coolant The coolant should be changed at the intervals specified in the mainte- nance schedule.

Automatic Transmission Fluid Automatic transmission fluid should not be checked under normal usage conditions. But in severe conditions, the fluid should be changed at an authorized HYUNDAI dealer in accordance to the scheduled mainte- nance at the beginning of this chap- ter.

Information Automatic transmission fluid color is red when new.

As the vehicle is driven, the automatic transmission fluid will begin to look darker. This is a normal condition and you should not judge the need to replace the fluid based upon the changed color.

The use of a non-specified fluid could result in transmission mal- function and failure. Use only the specified automatic transmission fluid (refer to «Recommended Lubricants and Capacities» in chapter 8).

NOTICE

i

7-15

7

M aintenance

Brake Hoses and Lines Visually check for proper installation, chafing, cracks, deterioration and any leakage. Replace any deteriorat- ed or damaged parts immediately.

Brake Fluid Check the brake fluid level in the brake fluid reservoir. The level should be between the MIN and the MAX marks on the side of the reservoir. Use only hydraulic brake fluid con- forming to DOT 3 or DOT 4 specifi- cation.

Parking Brake Inspect the parking brake system.

Brake Discs, Pads, Calipers and Rotors Check the pads for excessive wear, discs for run out and wear, and calipers for fluid leakage.

Exhaust Pipe and Muffler Visually inspect the exhaust pipes, muffler and hangers for cracks, dete- rioration, or damage. Start the engine and listen carefully for any exhaust gas leakage. Tighten con- nections or replace parts as neces- sary.

Suspension Mounting Bolts Check the suspension connections for looseness or damage. Retighten to the specified torque.

Steering Gear Box, Linkage & Boots/Lower Arm Ball Joint With the vehicle stopped and the engine off, check for excessive free- play in the steering wheel. Check the linkage for bends or damage. Check the dust boots and ball joints for deterioration, cracks, or damage. Replace any damaged parts.

Drive Shafts and Boots Check the drive shafts, boots and clamps for cracks, deterioration, or damage. Replace any damaged parts and, if necessary, repack the grease.

Air Conditioning Refrigerant Check the air conditioning lines and connections for leakage and dam- age.

7-16

Maintenance

Checking the Engine Oil Level Engine oil is used for lubricating, cooling, and operating various hydraulic components in the engine. Engine oil consumption while driving is normal, and it is necessary to check and refill the engine oil regu- larly. Also, check and refill the oil level within the recommended main- tenance schedule to prevent deterio- ration of oil performance. Check the engine oil following the below procedure.

1. Follow all of the oil manufacturer’s precautions.

2. Be sure the vehicle is on the level ground in P (Park) with the parking brake set. If possible, block the wheels.

3. Turn the engine on and warm the engine up until the coolant tem- perature reaches a constant nor- mal temperature.

4. Turn the engine off, remove the oil filler cap and pull the dipstick out. Wait for 15 minutes for the oil to return to the oil pan.

5. Wipe the dipstick clean and re- insert it fully.

6. Pull the dipstick out again and check the level.

7. If the oil level is below L, add enough oil to bring the level to F.

Use only the specified engine oil. (refer to «Recommended Lubricants and Capacities» in chapter 8).OLX2079005N

OLX2078006

ENGINE OIL

7-17

7

M aintenance

To prevent damage to your engine: Do not spill engine oil when

adding or changing engine oil. Wipe off spilled oil immediately.

The engine oil consumption may increase while you break in a new vehicle and it will be stabi- lized after driving 4,000 miles (6,000 km).

The engine oil consumption can be affected by driving habits, cli- mate conditions, traffic condi- tions, oil quality, etc.Therefore, it is recommended that you inspect the engine oil level regu- larly and refill it if necessary.

Checking the Engine Oil and Filter

Have engine oil and filter changed by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer according to the Maintenance Schedule at the beginning of this chapter.

If the maintenance schedule to replace engine oil is exceeded, the engine oil performance may deteri- orate, and the engine condition may be affected. Therefore, replace the engine oil according to the maintenance schedule.

To keep the engine in optimal con- dition, use the recommended engine oil and filter. If the recom- mended engine oil and filter are not used, replace it according to the maintenance schedule under severe usage conditions.

The purpose of the maintenance schedule for engine oil replace- ment is to prevent oil deterioration and it is irrelevant to oil consump- tion. Check and refill engine oil reg- ularly.

NOTICE

The engine oil is very hot imme- diately after the vehicle has been driven and can cause burns during replacement. Replace the engine oil after the engine oil has cooled down.

CAUTION

7-18

Maintenance

ENGINE COOLANT The high-pressure cooling system has a reservoir filled with year-round antifreeze coolant. The reservoir is filled at the factory. Check the antifreeze protection and coolant level at least once a year, at the beginning of the winter season and before traveling to a colder cli- mate.

Checking the Engine Coolant Level

Check the condition and connections of all cooling system hoses and heater hoses. Replace any swollen or deteriorated hoses. The coolant level should be filled between the F and the L marks on the side of the coolant reservoir when the engine is cool. If the coolant level is low, add enough distilled (deionized) water to bring the level to the F mark, but do not overfill. If frequent additions are required, see an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for a cooling system inspection.

OLX2078007

CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65 WARNING

Engine oil contains chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer, birth defects and reproductive harm. Used engine oil may cause irritation or cancer of the skin if left in contact with the skin for pro- longed periods of time. Always protect your skin by washing your hands thoroughly with soap and warm water as soon as possible after handling used oil. For more information go to https://www.p65warnings.ca.go v/passenger-vehicle

WARNING

7-19

7

M aintenance

Recommended engine coolant When adding coolant, use only dis-

tilled (deionized) water for your vehicle and never mix hard water in the coolant filled at the factory.

An improper coolant mixture can result in severe malfunction or engine damage.

The engine in your vehicle has alu- minum engine parts and must be protected by an ethylene-glycol with phosphate based coolant to prevent corrosion and freezing.

Do not use alcohol or methanol coolant or mix them with the spec- ified coolant.

Do not use a solution that contains more than 60% antifreeze or less than 35% antifreeze, which would reduce the effectiveness of the solution.

For mixing percentage, refer to the following table:

Information If in doubt about the mix ratio, a 50% water and 50% antifreeze mix is the easiest to mix together as it will be the same quantity of each. It is suitable to use for most temperature ranges of — 31F and higher.

iAmbient Temperature

Mixture Percentage (volume)

Antifreeze Water 5F (-15C) 35 65

-13F (-25C) 40 60

-31F (-35C) 50 50

-49F (-45C) 60 40

Never remove the radiator cap or the drain plug while the engine and radiator are hot. Hot coolant

and steam may blow out under pressure, causing serious injury.

Turn the engine off and wait until the engine cools down. Use extreme care when remov- ing the radiator cap. Wrap a thick towel around it, and turn it counterclockwise slowly to the first stop.

WARNING

OLX2078008

7-20

Maintenance

Changing Engine Coolant Have coolant changed by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer according to the Maintenance Schedule at the beginning of this chapter.

To prevent damage to engine parts, put a thick towel around the radiator cap before refilling the coolant to prevent the coolant from overflowing into engine parts, such as the alternator.

NOTICE

Do not use engine coolant or antifreeze in the washer fluid reservoir. Engine coolant can severely obscure visibility when sprayed on the windshield and may cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident. Engine coolant may also cause damage to paint and body trim.

WARNING

The electric motor for the cooling fan may continue to operate or start up when the engine is not running

and can cause serious injury. Keep hands, clothing and tools away from the rotating fan blades of the cooling fan. Always turn off the engine unless the vehicle has to be inspected with the engine on. Be cautious as the cooling fan may operate if the negative (-) battery terminal is not discon- nected.

WARNING

Step back while the pressure is released from the cooling sys- tem. When you are sure all the pressure has been released, press down on the cap, using a thick towel, and continue turn- ing counterclockwise to remove it.

7-21

7

M aintenance

BRAKE FLUID Checking the Brake Fluid

Level Check the fluid level in the reservoir periodically. The fluid level should be between MAX and MIN marks on the side of the reservoir. Before removing the reservoir cap and adding brake fluid, clean the area around the reservoir cap thor- oughly to prevent brake fluid contam- ination.

If the level is low, add the specified brake fluid to the MAX level.The level will fall with accumulated mileage. This is a normal condition associated with the wear of the brake linings. If the fluid level is excessively low, have the brake system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Do not allow brake fluid to con- tact the vehicle’s body paint, as paint damage will result.

Brake fluid, which has been exposed to open air for an extended time should NEVER be used as its quality cannot be guaranteed. It should be dis- posed of properly.

Do not use the incorrect brake fluid. A few drops of mineral based oil, such as engine oil, in your brake system can damage brake system parts.

Information Use only the specified brake fluid (refer to «Recommended Lubricants and Capacities» in chapter 8).

i

NOTICE

If the brake system requires fre- quent additions of fluid this could indicate a leak in the brake system. Have the vehicle inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

WARNING

Do not allow brake fluid to come in contact with your eyes. If brake fluid comes in contact with your eyes, flush your eyes with clean water for at least 15 minutes and get immediate medical attention.

WARNING

OLX2078009

7-22

Maintenance

WASHER FLUID Checking the Washer Fluid Level

Check the fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir and add fluid if neces- sary. Plain water may be used if washer fluid is not available. However, use washer solvent with antifreeze characteristics in cold cli- mates to prevent freezing.

Filter Replacement

The air cleaner filter can be cleaned for inspection using compressed air. Do not attempt to wash or to rinse it, as water will damage the filter. If soiled, the air cleaner filter must be replaced. Replace the filter according to the Maintenance Schedule.

AIR CLEANER

To prevent serious injury or death, take the following safety precautions when using washer fluid: Do not use engine coolant or

antifreeze in the washer fluid reservoir. Engine coolant can severely obscure visibility when sprayed on the windshield and may cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an acci- dent or damage to paint and body trim.

Do not allow sparks or flames to contact the washer fluid or the washer fluid reservoir. Washer fluid may contain alcohol and can be flamma- ble.

Do not drink washer fluid and avoid contact with skin. Washer fluid is harmful to humans and animals.

Keep washer fluid away from children and animals.

WARNING

OLX2078010

OLX2078011

7-23

7

M aintenance

1. Pull down the air cleaner filter cover (1).

2. Pull down the lever (2) to the UNLOCK position.

3. Replace the air cleaner filter. 4. Reassemble the air cleaner cover

in the reverse order. 5. Check that the cover is firmly

installed.

OLX2078012 OLX2078013 OLX2078014

7-24

Maintenance

Information If the vehicle is operated in extremely dusty or sandy areas, replace the air cleaner filter more often than the usual recommended intervals (refer to «Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions» in this chapter).

Do not drive with the air cleaner filter removed. This will result in excessive engine wear.

When removing the air cleaner filter, be careful that dust or dirt does not enter the air intake, or damage may result.

Use HYUNDAI genuine parts. Use of non-genuine parts could damage the air flow sensor.

Filter Inspection The climate control air filter should be replaced according to the Maintenance Schedule. If the vehicle is operated in severely air-polluted cities or on dusty rough roads for a long period and/or if transporting pets or occupants smoke inside the vehicle, then it should be inspected more frequently and replaced soon- er. Replace the climate control air fil- ter by following the procedure below and be careful to avoid damaging other components.

1. With the glove box open, remove the stoppers on both sides to allow the glove box to hang freely on the hinges.

NOTICE

i CLIMATE CONTROL AIR FILTER

OLX2078017

7-25

7

M aintenance

2. Remove the support rod (1). 3. Remove the climate control air fil- ter case while pressing the lock on right side of the cover.

4. Replace the climate control air fil- ter.

5. Reassemble in the reverse order of disassembly.

Install a new climate control air fil- ter in the correct direction with the arrow symbol () facing down- wards, to prevent noise and reduce effectiveness.

NOTICE

OLX2078016 OLX2078015 OPD076026

7-26

Maintenance

WIPER BLADES Blade Inspection Contamination of either the windshield or the wiper blades with foreign matter can reduce the effectiveness of the windshield wiper functionality. Common sources of contamination are insects, tree sap, and hot wax treatments used by some commercial car washes. If the blades are not wip- ing properly, clean both the window and the blades with a clean cloth dampened with washer fluid.

To prevent damage to the wiper blades, arms or other compo- nents, do not: Use gasoline, kerosene, paint

thinner, or other solvents on or near them.

Attempt to move the wipers manually.

Use non-specified wiper blades.

Information Commercial hot waxes applied by auto- matic car washes have been known to make the windshield difficult to clean.

Blade Replacement When the wipers no longer clean adequately, the blades may be worn or cracked, and require replacement.

To prevent damage to the wiper arms or other components, do not attempt to move the wipers manu- ally.

The use of a non-specified wiper blade could result in wiper mal- function and failure.

In order to prevent damage to the hood and the wiper arms, the wiper arms should only be lifted when in the top wiping position.

Always return the wiper arms to the windshield before driving.

NOTICE

NOTICE

NOTICE

i

NOTICE

7-27

7

M aintenance

Front windshield wiper service positions

This vehicle has a «hidden» wiper design which means that the wipers cannot be lifted when they are in their bottom resting position. 1. Within 20 seconds of turning off

the engine, lift and hold the wiper lever up to the MIST position for about 2 seconds until the wipers move to the top wipe position.

2. At this time you can lift the wipers off the windshield.

3. Gently put the wipers back down onto the windshield.

4. Turn the wipers to any ON position to return the wipers to the bottom resting position.

Blade replacement

1. Lift up the wiper blade clip. Then lift up the wiper blade.

2. While pushing the lock (1), pull down the wiper blade (2).

3. Remove the wiper blade from the wiper arm.

4. Install a new wiper blade assem- bly in the reverse order of removal.

5. Return the wiper arm on the wind- shield.

OLX2078018

OGSR076067

OGSR076066

OGSR076068

7-28

Maintenance

Rear window wiper blade

1. Raise the wiper arm and then rotate the wiper blade assembly (1).

2. Pull out the wiper blade assembly (2).

3. Install the new blade assembly by inserting the center part into the slot in the wiper arm until it clicks into place (1).

4. Make sure the blade assembly is installed firmly by trying to pull it slightly.

5. Rotate back the blade assembly so that it aligns with the wiper arm (2).

To prevent damage to the wiper arms or other components, we recom- mend that the wiper blades be replaced by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

OTM078057

OTM078058

BATTERY

7-29

7

M aintenance

To prevent SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH to you or bystanders, always follow these precautions when working near or handling the battery:

Always read and follow instructions carefully when handling a battery. Wear eye protection designed to protect the eyes from acid splashes. Keep all flames, sparks, or smoking materials away from the battery. Hydrogen is always pres- ent in battery cells, is highly combustible, and may explode if ignited. Keep batteries out of reach of children.

WARNING Batteries contain sulfu- ric acid which is highly corrosive. Do not allow acid to contact your eyes, skin or clothing.

If acid gets into your eyes, flush your eyes with clean water for at least 15 minutes and get imme- diate medical attention. If acid gets on your skin, thoroughly wash the area. If you feel pain or a burning sensation, get med- ical attention immediately. When lifting a plastic-cased

battery, excessive pressure on the case may cause battery acid to leak. Lift with a battery carrier or with your hands on opposite corners.

Do not attempt to jump start your vehicle if your battery is frozen.

NEVER attempt to recharge the battery when the vehicles battery cables are connected to the battery.

The electrical ignition system works with high voltage. NEVER touch these compo- nents with the engine running or when the ignition switch is in the ON position.

Always follow these instructions when handling your vehicle’s bat- tery to prevent damage to your battery: When you do not use the vehicle

for a long time in a low tempera- ture area, disconnect the battery and keep it indoors.

Always charge the battery fully to prevent battery case damage in low temperature areas.

Prevent liquid from wetting the battery terminals. The perform- ance of the battery may be degraded, and may cause injury. Be cautious when loading liquid in the trunk.

Do not tilt the battery. If you connect unauthorized

electronic devices to the battery, the battery may be discharged. Never use unauthorized devices.

For Best Battery Service

Keep the battery securely mount- ed.

Keep the battery top clean and dry. Keep the terminals and connec-

tions clean, tight, and coated with petroleum jelly or terminal grease.

Rinse any spilled acid from the bat- tery immediately with a solution of water and baking soda.

NOTICE

7-30

Maintenance

CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65 WARNING

Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds, chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer, birth defects and reproductive harm. Batteries also contain other chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer. Wash hands after handling. For more information go to https://www.p65warnings.ca.go v/passenger-vehicle

WARNING

OLX2078019

7-31

7

M aintenance

Information For vehicles with power liftgate, note that the power liftgate needs to be reset after the battery has been replaced. For more details, refer to « Power Liftgate » section in chapter 3.

Make sure the battery is installed securely when the it is replaced. If the battery vibrates while driving, the case and electrode plate can be damaged.

Battery Recharging

NOTICE

i

Always follow these instruc- tions when recharging your vehicle’s battery to avoid the risk of SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH from explosions or acid burns: Before performing mainte-

nance or recharging the bat- tery, turn off all accessories and place the ignition switch to the LOCK/OFF position.

Keep all flames, sparks, or smoking materials away from the battery.

Always work outdoors or in an area with plenty of ventilation.

Wear eye protection when checking the battery during charging.

The battery must be removed from the vehicle and placed in a well ventilated area.

WARNING

Watch the battery during charging, and stop or reduce the charging rate if the battery cells begin boiling violently.

The negative battery cable must be removed first and installed last when the battery is disconnected. Disconnect the battery charger in the fol- lowing order: (1)Turn off the battery charger

main switch. (2)Unhook the negative clamp

from the negative battery terminal.

(3)Unhook the positive clamp from the positive battery terminal.

Always use a genuine HYUNDAI approved battery when you replace the battery.

7-32

Maintenance

AGM battery Absorbent Glass Matt (AGM)

batteries are maintenance-free and we recommend that the AGM battery be serviced by an authorized retailer of HYUNDAI dealer. For charging your AGM battery, use only fully automatic battery chargers that are spe- cially developed for AGM batter- ies.

When replacing the AGM bat- tery, we recommend that you use parts for replacement from an authorized retailer of HYUNDAI dealer.

Do not open or remove the cap on top of the battery. This may cause leaks of internal elec- trolyte that could result in severe injury.

By jump starting After a jump start from a good bat- tery, drive the vehicle for at least 30 minutes or operate at idle for at least 60 minutes before it is shutoff. Alternatively you may visit a dealer for charge and battery test. The vehicle may not restart if you shut it off before the battery had a chance to adequately recharge. See «Jump Starting» in chapter 6 for more information on jump starting proce- dures.

Information An inappropriately disposed battery can be harmful to the environment and human health. Dispose of the bat- tery according to your local law(s) or regulations.

Reset Features The following items may need to be reset after the battery has been dis- charged or the battery has been dis- connected. See chapter 3 or 4 for: Power Windows Driver Position Memory System Trip Computer Climate Control System Clock Audio System Sunroof

i

NOTICE

7-33

7

M aintenance

TIRES AND WHEELS Tire Care For proper maintenance, safety, and maximum fuel economy, you must always maintain recommended tire inflation pressures and stay within the load limits and weight distribution recommended for your vehicle.

All specifications (sizes and pres- sures) can be found on a label attached to the driver’s side center pillar.

Replace tires that are worn, show uneven wear, or are damaged. Worn tires can cause loss of braking effec- tiveness, steering control, or traction.

ALWAYS replace tires with the same size as each tire that was originally supplied with this vehicle. Using tires and wheels other than the recom- mended sizes could cause unusual handling characteris- tics, poor vehicle control, or negatively affect your vehi- cle’s Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) resulting in a serious accident.

Tire failure may cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident. To reduce risk of SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH, take the following precautions: Inspect your tires monthly for

proper inflation as well as wear and damage.

The recommended cold tire pressure for your vehicle can be found in this manual and on the tire label located on the driver’s side center pillar. Always use a tire pressure gauge to measure tire pres- sure. Tires with too much or too little pressure wear unevenly causing poor han- dling.

Check the pressure of the spare every time you check the pressure of the other tires on your vehicle.

WARNING

OLX2088003L

7-34

Maintenance

Recommended Cold Tire Inflation Pressures All tire pressures (including the spare) should be checked when the tires are cold. «Cold tires» means the vehicle has not been driven for at least three hours or has been driven for less than one mile (1.6 km). Warm tires normally exceed recom- mended cold tire pressures by 4 to 6 psi (28 to 41 kPa). Do not release air from warm tires to adjust the pres- sure or the tires will be under-inflat- ed. For recommended inflation pres- sure, refer to «Tire and Wheels» in chapter 8.

Recommended pressures must be maintained for the best ride, vehicle handling, and minimum tire wear. Over-inflation or under-inflation can reduce tire life, adversely affect vehicle handling, and lead to sudden tire failure that could result in loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident. Severe under-inflation can lead to severe heat build-up, causing blowouts, tread separation and other tire failures that can result in the loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident. This risk is much higher on hot days and when driving for long peri- ods at high speeds.

WARNING

Under-inflation results in excessive wear, poor handling and reduced fuel economy. Wheel deformation is also possible. Keep your tire pres- sures at the proper levels. If a tire frequently needs refilling, have it checked by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer.

Over-inflation produces a harsh ride, excessive wear at the center of the tire tread, and a greater possibility of damage from road hazards.

CAUTION

7-35

7

M aintenance

Check Tire Inflation Pressure Check your tires, including the spare tire, once a month or more.

How to check Use a good quality tire pressure gauge to check tire pressure. You can not tell if your tires are properly inflated simply by looking at them. Radial tires may look properly inflat- ed when they are under-inflated. Remove the valve cap from the tire valve stem. Press the tire gauge firm- ly onto the valve to get a pressure measurement. If the cold tire inflation pressure matches the recommended pressure on the tire label located on the driver’s side center pillar or in this manual. No further adjustment is necessary. If the pressure is low, add air until you reach the recommended pressure. Make sure to put the valve caps back on the valve stems. Without the valve cap, dirt or mois- ture could get into the valve core and cause air leakage. If a valve cap is missing, install a new one as soon as possible.

If you overfill the tire, release air by pushing on the metal stem in the center of the tire valve. Recheck the tire pressure with the tire gauge. Be sure to put the valve caps back on the valve stems. Without the valve cap, dirt or moisture could get into the valve core and cause air leakage. If a valve cap is missing, install a new one as soon as possible. A cold tire means the vehicle has been sitting for 3 hours and driven for less than 1 mile (1.6 km) in that 3 hour period. Allow the tire to cool before measur- ing the inflation pressure. Always be sure the tire is cold before inflating to the recommended pressure.

Tire Rotation To equalize tread wear, HYUNDAI recommends that the tires be rotated according to the maintenance sched- ule or sooner if irregular wear devel- ops. During rotation, check the tires for correct balance. When rotating tires, check for uneven wear and damage. Abnormal wear is usually caused by incorrect tire pres- sure, improper wheel alignment, out- of-balance wheels, severe braking or severe cornering. Look for bumps or bulges in the tread or side of the tire. Replace the tire if you find any of these conditions. Replace the tire if fabric or cord is visible. After rotation, be sure to bring the front and rear tire pressures to specification and check lug nut tightness (proper torque is 79~94 lbfft [11~13 kgfm]).

7-36

Maintenance

Disc brake pads should be inspected for wear whenever tires are rotated.

Information Tires that are asymmetrical or direc- tional can only be installed on the wheel in one direction. The outside and inside of an asymmetrical tire is not easily distinguishable. Pay careful attention to the markings on the side- walls of the tires, noting the «outside» marking and also the rotating direc- tion before installing them on the vehicle.

Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance The wheels on your vehicle were aligned and balanced carefully at the factory to give you the longest tire life and best overall performance. In most cases, you will not need to have your wheels aligned again. However, if you notice unusual tire wear or your vehicle pulling one way or the other, the alignment may need to be reset. If you notice your vehicle vibrating when driving on a smooth road, your wheels may need to be rebalanced.

Improper wheel weights can dam- age your vehicle’s aluminum wheels. Use only approved wheel weights.

NOTICE

i

Do not use the compact spare tire for tire rotation.

Do not mix bias ply and radial ply tires under any circum- stances. This may cause unusual handling characteris- tics that may cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.

WARNING

S2BLA790A

Without a spare tire

CBGQ0707A

Directional tires (if equipped)

7-37

7

M aintenance

Tire Replacement

If the tire is worn evenly, a tread wear indicator will appear as a solid band across the tread. This shows there is less than 2/32 inch (1.6 mm) of tread left on the tire. Replace the tire when this happens. Do not wait for the tread surface to become level with the tread wear indicators before replacing the tire.

To reduce the risk of DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY: Replace tires that are worn,

show uneven wear, or are damaged. Worn tires can cause loss of braking effec- tiveness, steering control, and traction.

Always replace tires with the same size as each tire that was originally supplied with this vehicle. Using tires and wheels other than the recom- mended sizes could cause unusual handling characteris- tics, poor vehicle control, or negatively affect your vehi- cle’s Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) resulting in a serious accident.

WARNING

When replacing the tires, recheck and tighten the wheel nuts after driving about 600 miles (1,000 km). If the steering wheel shakes or the vehicle vibrates while driving, the tire is out of balance. Align the tire balance. If the problem is not solved, contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

CAUTION

OLMB073027

Tread wear indicator

7-38

Maintenance

Compact spare tire replacement A compact spare tire has a shorter tread life than a regular size tire. Replace it when you can see the tread wear indicator bars on the tire. The replacement compact spare tire should be the same size and design tire as the one provided with your new vehicle and should be mounted on the same compact spare tire wheel. The compact spare tire is not designed to be mounted on a regular size wheel, and the compact spare tire wheel is not designed for mount- ing a regular size tire.

Wheel Replacement When replacing the metal wheels for any reason, make sure the new wheels are equivalent to the original factory units in diameter, rim width and offset.

Tire Traction Tire traction can be reduced if you drive on worn tires, tires that are improperly inflated or on slippery road surfaces. Tires should be replaced when the tread depth is at least 2/32 inch (1.6 mm). To reduce the possibility of losing control, slow down whenever there is rain, snow or ice on the road.

The original tire should be repaired or replaced as soon as possible to avoid failure of the spare and loss of vehicle con- trol resulting in an accident.The compact spare tire is for emer- gency use only. Do not operate your vehicle over 50 mph (80 km/h) when using the compact spare tire.

WARNING

Tires degrade over time, even when they are not being used. Regardless of the remaining tread, HYUNDAI recommends that tires be replaced after six (6) years of normal service.

When replacing tires (or wheels), it is recommended to replace the two front or two rear tires (or wheels) as a pair. Replacing just one tire can seriously affect your vehicle’s handling. If only replacing one pair of tires, it is recommend- ed to install the pair of new tires on the rear axle.

Heat caused by hot climates or frequent high loading con- ditions can accelerate the aging process. Failure to fol- low this warning may cause sudden tire failure, which could lead to a loss of vehicle control resulting in an acci- dent.

7-39

7

M aintenance

Tire Maintenance In addition to proper inflation, correct wheel alignment helps to decrease tire wear. If you find a tire is worn unevenly, have your dealer check the wheel alignment. When you have new tires installed, make sure they are balanced. This will increase vehicle ride comfort and tire life. Additionally, a tire should always be rebalanced if it is removed from the wheel.

Tire Sidewall Labeling This information identifies and describes the fundamental charac- teristics of the tire and also provides the tire identification number (TIN) for safety standard certification. The TIN can be used to identify the tire in case of a recall.

1. Manufacturer or brand name Manufacturer or brand name is shown.

2. Tire size designation A tire’s sidewall is marked with a tire size designation. You will need this information when selecting replace- ment tires for your car. The following explains what the letters and num- bers in the tire size designation mean.

Example tire size designation: (These numbers are provided as an example only; your tire size designa- tor could vary depending on your vehicle.) 245/60R18 105H

245 — Tire width in millimeters. 60 — Aspect ratio. The tire’s section

height as a percentage of its width.

R — Tire construction code (Radial). 18 — Rim diameter in inches. 105 — Load Index, a numerical code

associated with the maximum load the tire can carry.

H — Speed Rating Symbol. See the speed rating chart in this section for additional information.

OLMB073028

1

1

2 3

4

5,6

7

7-40

Maintenance

Wheel size designation

Wheels are also marked with impor- tant information that you need if you ever have to replace one. The follow- ing explains what the letters and numbers in the wheel size designa- tion mean. Example wheel size designation: 7.5J x 18

7.5 — Rim width in inches. J — Rim contour designation. 18 — Rim diameter in inches.

Tire speed ratings

The chart below lists many of the dif- ferent speed ratings currently being used for passenger vehicle tires. The speed rating is part of the tire size designation on the sidewall of the tire. This symbol corresponds to that tires designed maximum safe oper- ating speed.

3. Checking tire life (TIN : Tire Identification Number)

Any tires that are over six years old, based on the manufacturing date, (including the spare tire) should be replaced by new ones. You can find the manufacturing date on the tire sidewall (possibly on the inside of the wheel), displaying the DOT Code. The DOT Code is a series of num- bers on a tire consisting of numbers and English letters. The manufactur- ing date is designated by the last four digits (characters) of the DOT code.

DOT : XXXX XXXX OOOO

The front part of the DOT shows a plant code number, tire size and tread pattern and the last four num- bers indicate week and year manu- factured. For example: DOT XXXX XXXX 1421 represents that the tire was produced in the 14th week of 2021.

Speed Rating Symbol

Maximum Speed

S 112 mph (180 km/h) T 118 mph (190 km/h) H 130 mph (210 km/h) V 149 mph (240 km/h) W 168 mph (270 km/h) Y 186 mph (300 km/h)

7-41

7

M aintenance

4. Tire ply composition and material

The number of layers or plies of rub- ber-coated fabric in the tire. Tire manufacturers also must indicate the materials in the tire, which include steel, nylon, polyester, and others. The letter «R» means radial ply con- struction; the letter «D» means diago- nal or bias ply construction; and the letter «B» means belted-bias ply con- struction.

5. Maximum permissible infla- tion pressure

This number is the greatest amount of air pressure that should be put in the tire. Do not exceed the maximum permissible inflation pressure. Refer to the Tire and Loading Information label for recommended inflation pressure.

6. Maximum load rating This number indicates the maximum load in kilograms and pounds that can be carried by the tire. When replacing the tires on the vehicle, always use a tire that has the same load rating as the factory installed tire.

7. Uniform tire quality grading Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maxi- mum section width. For example: TREAD WEAR 200 TRACTION AA TEMPERATURE A

Tread wear

The tread wear grade is a compara- tive rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified govern- ment test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one-and-a- half times (1) as well on the gov- ernment course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate. These grades are molded on the sidewalls of passenger vehicle tires. The tires available as standard or optional equipment on your vehicle may vary with respect to grade.

7-42

Maintenance

Traction — AA, A, B & C

The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B and C. Those grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on spec- ified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction perform- ance.

Temperature — A, B & C

The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C representing the tires resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled condi- tions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. Grade C responds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the labora- tory test wheel than the minimum required by law.

The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, under-inflation, over-inflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause heat build-up and possible sudden tire failure. This may cause loss of vehicle control resulting in an accident.

WARNING

The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight- ahead braking traction tests, and does not include accelera- tion, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction characteristics.

WARNING

7-43

7

M aintenance

Tire Terminology and Definitions Air Pressure The amount of air inside the tire pressing outward on the tire. Air pressure is expressed in pounds per square inch (psi) or kilopascal (kPa).

Accessory Weight This means the combined weight of optional accessories. Some exam- ples of optional accessories are automatic transmission, power seats, and air conditioning.

Aspect Ratio The relationship of a tire’s height to its width.

Belt A rubber coated layer of cords that is located between the plies and the tread. Cords may be made from steel or other reinforcing materials.

Bead The tire bead contains steel wires wrapped by steel cords that hold the tire onto the rim.

Bias Ply Tire A pneumatic tire in which the plies are laid at alternate angles less than 90 degrees to the centerline of the tread.

Cold Tire Pressure The amount of air pressure in a tire, measured in pounds per square inch (psi) or kilopascals (kPa) before a tire has built up heat from driving.

Curb Weight This means the weight of a motor vehicle with standard and optional equipment including the maximum capacity of fuel, oil and coolant, but without passengers and cargo.

DOT Markings A code molded into the sidewall of a tire signifying that the tire is in com- pliance with the U.S. Department of Transportation motor vehicle safety standards. The DOT code includes the Tire Identification Number (TIN), an alphanumeric designator which can also identify the tire manufactur- er, production plant, brand and date of production.

GVWR Gross Vehicle Weight Rating

GAWR FRT Gross Axle Weight Rating for the Front Axle.

GAWR RR Gross Axle Weight Rating for the Rear axle.

7-44

Maintenance

Intended Outboard Sidewall The side of an asymmetrical tire, that must always face outward when mounted on a vehicle.

Kilopascal (kPa) The metric unit for air pressure.

Light truck(LT) tire A tire designated by its manufacturer as primarily intended for use on light- weight trucks or multipurpose pas- senger vehicles.

Load ratings The maximum load that a tire is rated to carry for a given inflation pressure.

Load Index An assigned number ranging from 1 to 279 that corresponds to the load carrying capacity of a tire.

Maximum Inflation Pressure The maximum air pressure to which a cold tire may be inflated. The max- imum air pressure is molded onto the sidewall.

Maximum Load Rating The load rating for a tire at the maxi- mum permissible inflation pressure for that tire.

Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight The sum of curb weight; accessory weight; vehicle capacity weight; and production options weight.

Normal Occupant Weight The number of occupants a vehicle is designed to seat multiplied by 150 pounds (68 kg).

Occupant Distribution Designated seating positions.

Outward Facing Sidewall An asymmetrical tire has a particular side that faces outward when mount- ed on a vehicle. The outward facing sidewall bears white lettering or bears manufacturer, brand, and/or model name molding that is higher or deeper than the same moldings on the inner facing sidewall.

Passenger (P-Metric) tire A tire used on passenger cars and some light duty trucks and multipur- pose vehicles.

Ply A layer of rubber-coated parallel cords.

7-45

7

M aintenance

Pneumatic tire A mechanical device made of rubber, chemicals, fabric and steel or other materials, that, when mounted on an automotive wheel provides the trac- tion and contains the gas or fluid that sustains the load.

Pneumatic options weight The combined weight of installed regular production options weighing over 5 lb. (2.3 kg) in excess of the standard items which they replace, not previously considered in curb weight or accessory weight, includ- ing heavy duty breaks, ride levelers, roof rack, heavy duty battery, and special trim.

Recommended Inflation Pressure Vehicle manufacturer’s recommend- ed tire inflation pressure as shown on the tire placard.

Radial Ply Tire A pneumatic tire in which the ply cords that extend to the beads are laid at 90 degrees to the centerline of the tread.

Rim A metal support for a tire and upon which the tire beads are seated.

Sidewall The portion of a tire between the tread and the bead.

Speed Rating An alphanumeric code assigned to a tire indicating the maximum speed at which a tire can operate.

Traction The friction between the tire and the road surface. The amount of grip pro- vided.

Tread The portion of a tire that comes into contact with the road.

Treadwear Indicators Narrow bands, sometimes called «wear bars», that show across the tread of a tire when only 1/16 inch of tread remains.

UTQGS Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards is a tire information sys- tem that provides consumers with ratings for a tire’s traction, tempera- ture and treadwear. Ratings are determined by tire manufacturers using government testing proce- dures. The ratings are molded into the sidewall of the tire.

7-46

Maintenance

Vehicle Capacity Weight The number of designated seating positions multiplied by 150 lbs. (68 kg) plus the rated cargo and luggage load.

Vehicle Maximum Load on the Tire Load on an individual tire due to curb and accessory weight plus maximum occupant and cargo weight.

Vehicle Normal Load on the Tire Load on an individual tire that is determined by distributing to each axle its share of the curb weight, accessory weight, and normal occu- pant weight and dividing by 2.

Vehicle Placard A label permanently attached to a vehicle showing the original equip- ment tire size and recommended inflation pressure.

All Season Tires HYUNDAI specifies all season tires on some models to provide good performance for use all year round, including snowy road conditions. All season tires are identified by ALL SEASON and/or M+S (Mud and Snow) on the tire sidewall. Snow tires have better snow traction than all season tires and may be more appropriate in some areas.

Snow Tires If you equip your car with snow tires, they should be the same size and have the same load capacity as the original tires. Snow tires should be installed on all four wheels; other- wise, poor handling may result. Snow tires should carry 4 psi (28 kPa) more air pressure than the pressure recommended for the standard tires on the tire label on the drivers side of the center pillar, or up to the maxi- mum pressure shown on the tire sidewall, whichever is less. Do not drive faster than 75 mph (120 km/h) when your vehicle is equipped with snow tires.

Radial-Ply Tires Radial-ply tires provide improved tread life, road hazard resistance and smoother high speed ride. The radi- al-ply tires used on this vehicle are of belted construction, and are selected to complement the ride and handling characteristics of your vehicle. Radial-ply tires have the same load carrying capacity, as bias-ply or bias belted tires of the same size, and use the same recommended inflation pressure. Mixing of radial-ply tires with bias-ply or bias belted tires is not recommended. Any combina- tions of radial-ply and bias-ply or bias belted tires when used on the same vehicle will seriously deteriorate vehicle handling. The best rule to fol- low is: Identical pairs of radial-ply tires should always be used as a set for the front tires and a set for the rear tires.

7-47

7

M aintenance

Longer wearing tires can be more susceptible to irregular tread wear. It is very important to follow the tire rotation interval in this chapter to achieve the tread life potential of these tires. Cuts and punctures in radial-ply tires are repairable only in the tread area, because of sidewall flexing. Consult your tire dealer for radial-ply tire repairs.

When driving on a rough road or off road, drive cautiously because tires and wheels may be damaged. And after driv- ing, inspect tires and wheels.

When passing over a pothole, speed bump, manhole, or curb stone, drive slowly so that the tires and wheels are not damaged.

If the tire is subjected to a severe impact, have the tire and wheel inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

It is not easy to recognize tire damage with your own eyes. But if there is the slightest hint of tire damage, have the tire checked or replaced because the tire damage may cause air leakage from the tire.

If the tire is damaged by driv- ing on a rough road, off road, pothole, manhole, or curb stone, it will not be covered by the warranty.

CAUTION

Do not mix bias ply and radial ply tires under any circum- stances.This may cause unusu- al handling characteristics that may cause loss of vehicle con- trol resulting in an accident.

WARNING

7-48

Maintenance

FUSES A vehicle’s electrical system is pro- tected from electrical overload dam- age by fuses. This vehicle has 2 (or 3) fuse panels, one located in the driver’s side panel bolster, the other in the engine com- partment near the battery. If any of your vehicle’s lights, acces- sories, or controls do not work, check the appropriate circuit fuse. If a fuse has blown, the element inside the fuse will be melted or broken. If the electrical system does not work, first check the driver’s side fuse panel. Before replacing a blown fuse, turn the engine and all switches off, and then disconnect the negative battery cable. Always replace a blown fuse with one of the same rat- ing. If the replacement fuse blows, this indicates an electrical problem. Avoid using the system involved and imme- diately consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Do not use a screwdriver or any other metal object to remove fuses because it may cause a short circuit and damage the sys- tem.

NOTICE

NEVER replace a fuse with any- thing but another fuse of the same rating. A higher capacity fuse could

cause damage and possibly cause a fire.

Do not install a wire or alu- minum foil instead of the proper fuse — even as a tem- porary repair. It may cause extensive wiring damage and possibly a fire.

WARNING Blade type

Normal

Cartridge type

Blown

Normal Blown

Multi fuse

Normal Blown

OTM078035

7-49

7

M aintenance

Instrument Panel Fuse Replacement

1. Turn the engine off. 2. Turn all other switches OFF. 3. Open the fuse panel cover. 4. Refer to the label on the inside of

the fuse panel cover to locate the suspected fuse location.

5. Pull the suspected fuse straight out. Use the removal tool provided in the engine compartment fuse panel cover.

6. Check the removed fuse; replace it if it is blown. Spare fuses are provided in the instrument panel fuse panels (or in the engine com- partment fuse panel).

7. Push in a new fuse of the same rating, and make sure it fits tightly in the clips. If it fits loosely, consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

In an emergency, if you do not have a spare fuse, use a fuse of the same rating from a circuit you may not need for operating the vehicle. If the headlamps or other electrical components do not work and the fuses are undamaged, check the fuse panel in the engine compart- ment. If a fuse is blown, it must be replaced with the same rating.

OLX2079020L

OLX2078021

7-50

Maintenance

Engine Compartment Panel Fuse Replacement

1. Turn the engine off. 2. Turn all other switches OFF.

3. Remove the fuse panel cover by pressing the tap and pulling up.

4. Check the removed fuse; replace it if it is blown. To remove or insert the fuse, use the fuse puller in the engine compartment fuse panel.

5. Push in a new fuse of the same rating, and make sure it fits tightly in the clips. If it fits loosely, consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Multi fuse

If the multi fuse is blown, it must be removed as follows: 1. Turn off the engine. 2. Disconnect the negative battery

cable. 3. Remove the fuse panel cover by

pressing the tab and pulling it up. 4. Remove the nuts shown in the pic-

ture above. 5. Replace the fuse with a new one

of the same rating. 6. Reinstall in the reverse order of

removal.

Information If the multi fuse is blown, consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

i

After checking the fuse box in the engine compartment securely close the fuse box cover inside the engine com- partment, until it clicks. If the fuse box is not closed properly, water may leak in side, possibly causing a malfunction with the electrical system.

CAUTION OLX2078024

Blade type fuse

OLX2078025

Cartridge type fuse

OLX2078023

7-51

7

M aintenance

Fuse/Relay Panel Description Instrument panel fuse panel

Inside the fuse/relay box cover, you can find the fuse/relay label describ- ing fuse/relay names and ratings.

Information Not all fuse panel descriptions in this manual may be applicable to your vehicle; the information is accurate at the time of printing. When you inspect the fuse box on your vehicle, refer to the fuse box label.

i

OLX2079054N

OLX2079027L

7-52

Maintenance

Fuse Name Fuse Rating Protected Component

MODULE 4 7.5A Data Link Connector, Stop Lamp Switch, Driver Door Module

AIR BAG 1 15A SRS Control Module, Passenger Occupant Detection Sensor

BRAKE SWITCH

7.5A IBU, Stop Lamp Switch

MODULE 9 15A Front A/C Control Module, Low DC-DC Converter (Audio), Power Tail Gate Unit, Driver IMS Control Module, Head-up Display, Driver Door Module, Driver/Passenger Power Outside Mirror, Security Indicator, Rain Sensor, Rear Occupant Alert (ROA) Sensor, 3RD Seat Folding Control Module

MODULE 10 10A Blind-Spot Collision Warning Unit LH/RH, Front Console Switch, Rear A/C Control Module, Electro Chromic Mirror, Data Link Connector, Front Wireless Charger

AIR BAG IND 10A Seat Belt Indicator, Instrument Cluster

IBU 1 7.5A IBU

MODULE 2 7.5A 1ST Seat Warmer Control Module, 1ST Air Ventilation Seat Control Module, 2ND Air Ventilation Seat LH/RH Control Module, 2ND Seat LH/RH Warmer Control Module, 3RD Seat Folding Control Module, AC Inverter Outlet, Inverter Unit, Surround View Monitor Unit

MODULE 8 7.5A Driver/Passenger Smart Key Outside Handle, Driver/Passenger Outside Mirror, Key Solenoid, Center Fascia Keyboard (Hazard Switch)

S/HEATER FRT

20A 1ST Air Ventilation Control Module, 1ST Seat Warmer Control Module

AIR BAG 2 15A SRS Control Module

E-SHIFTER 2 10A Electronic ATM Shift Lever Switch (SBW), SCU

Instrument panel fuse panel

7-53

7

M aintenance

Fuse Name Fuse Rating Protected Component

MODULE 5 7.5A Crash Pad Switch, IBU, Smart Cruise Control Radar, 4WD ECM, Front Console Switch, Lane Keeping Assist Unit (Line)

IBU 2 15A IBU, Ignition Switch

SUNROOF 2 20A Panoramic Sunroof

MODULE 1 7.5A IBU

P/SEAT (3rd) 20A 3RD Seat Folding Control Module

P/WINDOW RH

25A Passenger Safety Power Window Module, Rear Power Window Switch RH

RR SEAT (LH) 25A 2ND Air Ventilation Seat LH Control Module, 2ND Seat LH Warmer, Control Module, 2ND Seat LH Reclining Folding Actuator

CLUSTER 7.5A Instrument Cluster, Head Up Display

MDPS 10A MDPS Unit

A/C 7.5A E/R Junction Block (Blower FRT Relay, Blower RR Relay, PTC Heater 1/2 Relay), Front A/C Control Module

CHILD LOCK 15A ICM Relay Box (Child Lock/Unlock Relay)

DOOR LOCK 20A Door Lock Relay, Door Unlock Relay, Liftgate Relay, Two Turn Unlock Relay

Instrument panel fuse panel

7-54

Maintenance

Fuse Name Fuse Rating Protected Component

SUNROOF 1 20A Sunroof

E-SHIFTER 1 10A Electronic ATM Shift Lever Switch (SBW), SCU, E/R Junction Block (FUSE -E-SHIFTER 2)

P/WINDOW LH

25A Driver Safety Power Window Module, Rear Power Window Switch LH

MODULE 3 7.5A IBU

MODULE 6 7.5A

Audio, A/V & Navigation Head Unit, Low DC-DC Converter (Audio/AMP), Front/Rear A/C Control Module Driver IMS Control Module, Electro Chromic Mirror, Center Facia Keyboard, 1ST Air Ventilation Seat Control Module, 1ST Seat Warmer Control Module, 2ND Air Ventilation Seat LH/RH Control Module, 2ND Seat LH/RH Warmer Control Module, 3RD Seat Folding Control Module

WASHER 15A Multifunction Switch

RR SEAT (RH) 25A 2ND Air Ventilation Seat Control Module, 2ND Seat RH Warmer Control Module, 2ND Seat RH Reclining Folding Actuator

WIPER (REAR)

15A Rear Wiper Relay, Rear Wiper Motor

AMP 25A AMP, Low DC-DC Converter (AMP)

ACC 7.5A IBU, Low DC-DC Converter (Audio/AMP)

P/SEAT (PASS)

30A Passenger Seat Manual Switch

P/SEAT (DRV) 30A Driver IMS Control Module, Driver Seat Manual Switch

Instrument panel fuse panel

7-55

7

M aintenance

Engine compartment fuse panel

Inside the fuse/relay box cover, you can find the fuse/relay label describ- ing fuse/relay names and ratings.

Information Not all fuse panel descriptions in this manual may be applicable to your vehicle; the information is accurate at the time of printing. When you inspect the fuse panel in your vehicle, refer to the fuse panel label.

i

OLX2078022

OLX2079055N

7-56

Maintenance

Engine compartment fuse panel

Fuse Name Fuse Rating Protected Component

MULTI FUSE (10P)

MDPS 80A MDPS Unit

COOLING FAN 1 80A Cooling Fan Relay (600W)

EPB 60A ESC Module

B+4 50A ICU Junction Block (Fuse — MODULE 8, S/HEATER FRT, P/WINDOW RH, AMP, SUN- ROOF)

B+3 50A ICU Junction Block (Fuse — P/WINDOW LH, RR SEAT (LH), P/SEAT (DRV), P/SEAT (PASS))

B+2 50A ICU Junction Block (IPS 8/IPS 10/IPS 11/IPS 12/IPS 13/IPS 14/IPS 15)

REAR HEATED 40A Rear Heated Relay

ESC 1 40A ESC Module

BLOWER 40A Blower Relay

ESC 2 40A ESC Module

MULTI FUSE (2P)

PTC HEATER 1 50A PTC Heater 1 Relay

PTC HEATER 2 50A PTC Heater 2 Relay

7-57

7

M aintenance

Engine compartment fuse panel

Fuse Name Fuse Rating Protected Component

FUSE

B+1 50A ICU Junction Block (IPS 1/IPS 2/IPS 3/IPS 5/IPS 6/IPS 7, Long/Short Term Load Latch Relay)

B+5 50A ICU Junction Block (Fuse — DOOR LOCK, IBU 1, IBU 2, BRAKE SWITCH, CHILD LOCK, RR SEAT (RH), SUNROOF 2)

INVERTER 30A AC Inverter Unit

POWER LIFTGATE 30A Power Tail Gate Module

TRAILER 1 40A Trailer Lamp

IG2 40A Start Relay, ICU Junction Block (Fuse — A/C, WASHER, WIPER (REAR), MODULE 1, MODULE 2, REAR A/C)

OIL PUMP 40A Electronic Oil Pump Module

COOLING FAN 2 50A Cooling Fan Relay

HEATED MIRROR 10A Driver/Passenger Power Outside Mirror, A/C Control Module

A/C 2 10A A/C Control Module

WIPER FRT 2 10A Wiper (LO) Relay, Front Wiper Motor

ECU 6 15A PCM

M aintenance

7-58

Maintenance

Engine compartment fuse panel

Fuse Name Fuse Rating Protected Component

FUSE

AMS 10A Battery Sensor

E-SHIFTER 1 20A Electronic Transmission

4WD 20A AWD ECM

E-SHIFTER2 10A Electronic Transmission

BLOWER 2 10A A/C Control Module

BLOWER 1 40A Rear Blower Relay

TCU 1 15A Transmission Range Switch

PCB Block

SENSOR 6 15A Glow Relay Unit

ECU 3 10A ESC Module

ICU 10A ICU Junction Block

SENSOR 5 10A Oxygen Sensor Up #1/#2

IGN COIL 20A Ignition Coil #1/#2/#3/#4/#5/#6

7-59

7

M aintenance

Engine compartment fuse panel

Fuse Name Fuse Rating Protected Component

PCB Block

SENSOR 1 10A Fuel Pump Relay

A/C 1 10A [2.4 GDI] A/CON Relay

WIPER FRT 1 30A Wiper Main Relay

TCU 2 10A TCM, SBW Controller

ECU 3 20A PCM

B/ALARM HORN 15A Burglar Alarm Horn Relay

HORN 15A Horn Relay

FUEL PUMP 20A Fuel Pump Relay

ECU 1 20A PCM

SENSOR 2 10A A/C Comp Relay, Variable Intake Solenoid Valve, Oil Pump Solenoid Valve, Oxygen Sensor Down, Oil Control Valve, Electronic Thermostat Heater, Purge Control Solenoid Valve

ECU 2 20A PCM

POWER OUTLET 1 20A Rear Power Outlet 1

M aintenance

7-60

Maintenance

Engine compartment fuse panel

Fuse Name Fuse Rating Protected Component

PCB Block

POWER OUTLET 2 20A Rear Power Outlet 2

ACC 3 10A ICU Junction Block (Fuse — ACC)

ECU 4 10A PCM

IG 1 40A PDM (IG1) Relay

ACC 1 40A ACC 1 Relay

ACC 2 40A ACC 2 Relay

ECU 5 30A Main Relay

POWER OUTLET 3 20A Luggage Power Outlet

POWER OUTLET 4 20A Front Power Outlet

SENSOR 4 15A Ignition Coil #1/#2/#3/#4/#5/#6, Cooling Fan Controller

7-61

7

M aintenance

LIGHT BULBS Consult an authorized HYUNDAI dealer to replace most vehicle light bulbs. It is difficult to replace vehicle light bulbs because other parts of the vehicle must be removed before you can get to the bulb. This is especially true for removing the headlamp assembly to get to the bulb(s). Removing/installing the headlamp assembly can result in damage to the vehicle.

Information The headlamp and tail lamp lenses could appear frosty if the vehicle is washed after driving or the vehicle is driven at night in wet weather. This condition is caused by temperature difference between the lamp inside and outside and, it does not indicate a problem with your vehicle. When moisture condenses in the lamp, it will be removed after driving with the headlamp on. The removable level may differ depending on lamp size, lamp position and environmental con- dition. However, if moisture is not removed, we recommend that your vehicle is inspected by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Headlamp, Parking lamp, Daytime Running Light, Turn signal lamp and Side marker Type A

(1) Turn signal lamp (2) Daytime running light /

Parking lamp (3) Side marker lamp (4) Headlamp (Low) (5) Headlamp (High) (6) Side reflex reflector

i

Prior to replacing a lamp, depress the brake pedal, move the shift button into P (Park) apply the parking brake, place the ignition switch to the OFF position, and take the key with you when leaving the vehicle to avoid sudden movement of the vehicle and to prevent possible electric shock.

Be aware the bulbs may be hot and may burn your fin- gers.

WARNING

OLX2079029N

7-62

Maintenance

Daytime running light (DRL), parking lamp, turn signal lamp and side marker lamp

If the LED lamp does not operate, have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. The LED lamps cannot be replaced as a single unit because it is an inte- grated unit. The LED lamps has to be replaced with the unit. A skilled technician should check or repair the LED lamp, for it may dam- age related parts of the vehicle.

Headlamp

1. Open the hood. 2. Disconnect the negative battery

cable.

3. Remove the headlamp bulb cover by turning it counterclockwise.

4. Disconnect the headlamp bulb socket-connector.

5. Remove the bulb socket from the headlamp assembly by turning it counterclockwise.

6. Install a new headlamp bulb. 7. Connect the headlamp bulb sock-

et-connector. 8. Install the headlamp bulb cover by

turning it clockwise.

Information The headlamp aiming should be adjusted after an accident or after the headlamp assembly is reinstalled at an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

i

OLX2078031L

Low beam

OLX2078032

High beam

7-63

7

M aintenance

Always handle them carefully, and avoid scratches and abrasions. If the bulbs are lit, avoid contact with liquids.

Never touch the glass with bare hands. Residual oil may cause the bulb to overheat and burst when lit.

A bulb should be operated only when installed in a headlamp.

If a bulb becomes damaged or cracked, replace it immediately and carefully dispose of it.

Type B

(1) Turn signal lamp (2) Daytime running light /

Parking lamp (3) Side marker lamp (4) Headlamp (Low/High) (5) Headlamp (High) (6) Side reflex reflector

Handle halogen bulbs with care. Halogen bulbs contain pressurized gas that will pro- duce flying pieces of glass that could cause injuries if broken.

Wear eye protection when changing a bulb. Allow the bulb to cool down before han- dling it.

WARNING

OLMB073042L OLX2079029N

7-64

Maintenance

Headlamp, parking lamp, daytime running light, turn signal lamp and side marker lamp

If the LED lamp does not operate, have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. The LED lamps cannot be replaced as a single unit because it is an inte- grated unit. The LED lamps has to be replaced with the unit. A skilled technician should check or repair the LED lamp, for it may dam- age related parts of the vehicle.

Side Repeater Lamp Replacement

If the LED lamp (1) does not operate, have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. The LED lamps cannot be replaced as a single unit because it is an inte- grated unit. The LED lamps has to be replaced with the unit. A skilled technician should check or repair the LED lamp, for it may dam- age related parts of the vehicle.

Rear combination lamp light replacement

OLX2078033 OLX2079037N

Type A (Standard)

OLX2079053N

Type B (LED)

7-65

7

M aintenance

Type A

(1) Tail lamp (2) Tail/Stop lamp (3) Turn signal lamp (4) Side marker lamp (5) Backup lamp

Type B

(1) Tail lamp, Side marker (2) Stop lamp (3) Turn signal lamp (4) Side marker lamp (5) Backup lamp (6) Garnish lamp

Stop/Tail lamp and turn signal lamp (Type A)

1. Turn off the engine. 2. Open the liftgate. 3. Loosen the lamp assembly retain-

ing screws with a cross-tip screw- driver.

4. Remove the rear combination lamp assembly from the body of the vehicle.

5. Remove the socket from the assembly by turning the socket counterclockwise until the tabs on the socket align with the slots on the assembly.

6. Remove the bulb from the socket by pressing it in and rotating it counterclockwise until the tabs on the bulb align with the slots in the socket. Pull the bulb out of the socket.

7. Insert a new bulb by inserting it into the socket and rotating it until it locks into place.

8. Install the socket into the assem- bly by aligning the tabs on the socket with the slots in the assem- bly. Push the socket into the assembly and turn the socket clockwise.

9. Reinstall the lamp assembly to the body of the vehicle.

OLX2078035 OLX2078036

7-66

Maintenance

Side maker lamp (Type A,B), tail/stop lamp, turn signal lamp (Type B), garnish lamp

If the LED lamp does not operate, have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. The LED lamps cannot replaced as a single unit because it is an integrated unit. The LED lamps has to be replaced with the unit. A skilled technician should check or repair the LED lamp, for it may dam- age related parts of the vehicle.

Back up lamp

If the light bulb does not operate, have the vehicle checked by an authorized HYUNDI dealer.

High Mounted Stop Lamp Bulb Replacement

If the LED lamp (1) does not operate, have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. The LED lamps cannot be replaced as a single unit because it is an inte- grated unit. The LED lamps has to be replaced with the unit. A skilled technician should check or repair the LED lamp, for it may dam- age related parts of the vehicle.

License Plate Light Bulb Replacement

1. Loosen the lens retaining screws with a cross-tip screwdriver.

2. Using a flat-blade screwdriver, gently pry the lens cover from the lamp housing.

3. Remove the socket by turning it counterclockwise.

4. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight out.

5. Install a new bulb. 6. Reinstall in the reverse order.

OLX2078038 OLX2078039

7-67

7

M aintenance

1. Using a flat-blade screwdriver, gently pry the lens from the interi- or lamp housing.

Map lamp, room lamp, vanity mirror lamp and luggage compartment lamp (Bulb type)

Interior Light Bulb Replacement

Prior to working on the Interior Lights, ensure that the «OFF» button is depressed to avoid burning your fingers or receiv- ing an electric shock.

WARNING

OLX2078050L

Map lamp

OLX2078051L

Room lamp

OLX2078052L

Luggage compartment lamp

OLX2078043

Glove box lamp

OLF074069

Vanity mirror lamp

7-68

Maintenance

2. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight out.

3. Install a new bulb in the socket. 4. Align the lens tabs with the interi-

or lamp housing notches and snap the lens into place.

Use care not to dirty or damage lens, lens tab, and plastic hous- ings.

If the LED lamp (1) does not operate, have the system checked by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer. The LED lamps cannot be replaced as a single unit because it is an inte- grated unit. The LED lamps has to be replaced with the unit. A skilled technician should check or repair the LED lamp, for it may dam- age related parts of the vehicle

NOTICE

Map lamp / Room lamp / Luggage compartment lamp (LED Type)

OLX2078040

Map lamp

OLX2078041

Room lamp

OLX2078042

Luggage compartment lamp

7-69

7

M aintenance

APPEARANCE CARE Exterior Care Exterior general caution It is very important to follow the label directions when using any chemical cleaner or polish. Read all warning and caution statements that appear on the label.

Protecting your vehicle’s finish Washing

To help protect your vehicles finish from rust and deterioration, wash it thoroughly and frequently at least once a month with lukewarm or cold water. If you use your vehicle for off-road driving, you should wash it after each off-road trip. Pay special attention to the removal of any accumulation of salt, dirt, mud, and other foreign materials. Make sure the drain holes in the lower edges of the doors and rocker panels are kept clear and clean.

Insects, tar, tree sap, bird droppings, industrial pollution and similar deposits can damage your vehicles finish if not removed immediately. Even prompt washing with plain water may not completely remove all these deposits. A mild soap, safe for use on painted surfaces, should be used. After washing, rinse the vehicle thor- oughly with lukewarm or cold water. Do not allow soap to dry on the fin- ish.

Do not use strong soap, chemi- cal detergents or hot water, and do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight or when the body of the vehicle is warm.

Be careful when washing the side windows of your vehicle. Especially, with high-pressure water, water may leak through the windows and wet the interi- or.

To prevent damage to the plastic parts, do not clean with chemi- cal solvents or strong deter- gents.

NOTICE

After washing the vehicle, test the brakes while driving slowly to see if they have been affected by water before getting on the road. If braking performance is impaired, dry the brakes by applying them lightly while maintaining a slow forward speed.

WARNING

7-70

Maintenance

High-pressure washing When using high-pressure wash-

ers, make sure to maintain suffi- cient distance from the vehicle. Insufficient clearance or excessive pressure can lead to component damage or water penetration.

Do not spray the camera, sensors or its surrounding area directly with a high pressure washer. Shock applied from high pressure water may cause the device to not oper- ate normally.

Do not bring the nozzle tip close to boots (rubber or plastic covers)or connectors as they may be dam- aged if they come into contact with high pressure water.

Do not use any high-pressure noz- zles, which induce either one-direct water stream or water swirling.

Water washing in the engine compartment including high pressure water washing may cause the failure of electrical cir- cuits located in the engine com- partment.

Never allow water or other liq- uids to come in contact with electrical/electronic compo- nents inside the vehicle as this may damage them.

Matte paint finish vehicle (if equipped)

Automatic car wash which uses rotating brushes should not be used as this can damage the sur- face of your vehicle. A steam cleaner which washes the vehicle surface at high temperature may result the oil to adhere and leave stains that is difficult to remove. Use a soft cloth (e.g. microfiber towel or sponge) when washing your vehicle and dry with a microfiber towel. When you hand wash your vehicle, you should not use a cleaner that finishes with wax. If the vehicle surface is too dirty (sand, dirt, dust, contami- nant, etc.), clean the surface with water before washing the car.

NOTICE

NOTICE

OLX2078045

7-71

7

M aintenance

Waxing

A good coat of wax provides a barri- er between your paint and environ- mental contamination. Keeping a good coat of wax on your vehicle will help protect it. Wax the vehicle when water will no longer bead on the paint. Always wash and dry the vehicle before waxing. Use a good quality liquid or paste wax, and follow the manufacturers instructions. Wax all metal trim to protect it and to main- tain its luster. Removing oil, tar, and similar materi- als with a spot remover will usually strip the wax from the finish. Be sure to re-wax these areas even if the rest of the vehicle does not yet need wax- ing.

Wiping dust or dirt off the body with a dry cloth will scratch the finish.

Do not use steel wool, abrasive cleaners, or strong detergents containing highly alkaline or caustic agents on chrome-plat- ed or anodized aluminum parts. This may result in damage to the protective coating and cause discoloration or paint deteriora- tion.

Matte paint finish vehicle (if equipped)

Do not use any polish protector such as a detergent, an abrasive and a polish. In case wax is applied, remove the wax immedi- ately using a silicon remover and if any tar or tar contaminant is on the surface use a tar remover to clean. However, be careful not to apply too much pressure on the painted area.

Repairing your vehicle’s finish Deep scratches or stone chips in the painted surface must be repaired promptly. Exposed metal will quickly rust and may develop into a major repair expense.

If your vehicle is damaged and requires any metal repair or replacement, be sure the body shop applies anti-corrosion mate- rials to the parts repaired or replaced.

Matte paint finish vehicle (if equipped)

In case of matte paint finish vehi- cles, it is impossible to modify only the damaged area and repair of the whole part is necessary. If the vehicle is damaged and paint- ing is required, we recommend that you have your vehicle main- tained and repaired by an author- ized HYUNDAI dealer. Take extreme care, as it is difficult to restore the quality after the repair.

NOTICE

NOTICE

NOTICE

NOTICE

7-72

Maintenance

Bright-metal maintenance To remove road tar and insects,

use a tar remover, not a scraper or other sharp object.

To protect the surfaces of bright- metal parts from corrosion, apply a coating of wax or chrome preser- vative and rub to a high luster.

During winter weather or in coastal areas, cover the bright metal parts with a heavier coating of wax or preservative. If necessary, coat the parts with non-corrosive petroleum jelly or other protective compound.

Underbody maintenance Corrosive materials used for ice and snow removal and dust control may collect on the underbody. If these materials are not removed, acceler- ated rusting can occur on underbody parts such as the fuel lines, frame, floor pan and exhaust system, even though they have been treated with rust protection.

Thoroughly flush the vehicle under- body and wheel openings with luke- warm or cold water once a month, after off-road driving and at the end of each winter. Pay special attention to these areas because it is difficult to see all the mud and dirt. It will do more harm than good to wet down the road grime without removing it. The lower edges of doors, rocker panels, and frame members have drain holes that should not be allowed to clog with dirt; trapped water in these areas can cause rust- ing.

Aluminum wheel maintenance The aluminum wheels are coated with a clear protective finish.

Do not use abrasive cleaner, pol- ishing compound, solvent, or wire brushes on aluminum wheels.

Clean the wheel when it has cooled.

Use only a mild soap or neutral detergent, and rinse thoroughly with water. Also, clean the wheels after driving on salted roads.

Do not wash the wheels with high-speed car wash brushes.

Do not use any cleaners con- taining acid or alkaline deter- gents.

NOTICE

After washing the vehicle, test the brakes while driving slowly to see if they have been affected by water. If braking performance is impaired, dry the brakes by applying them lightly while maintaining a slow forward speed.

WARNING

7-73

7

M aintenance

Corrosion protection Protecting your vehicle from corro- sion

By using the most advanced design and construction practices to combat corrosion, HYUNDAI produces vehi- cles of the highest quality. However, this is only part of the job. To achieve the long-term corrosion resistance your vehicle can deliver, the owners cooperation and assistance is also required.

Common causes of corrosion

The most common causes of corro- sion on your vehicle are: Road salt, dirt and moisture that is

allowed to accumulate underneath the vehicle.

Removal of paint or protective coatings by stones, gravel, abra- sion or minor scrapes and dents which leave unprotected metal exposed to corrosion.

High-corrosion areas

If you live in an area where your vehi- cle is regularly exposed to corrosive materials, corrosion protection is particularly important. Some of the common causes of accelerated cor- rosion are road salts, dust control chemicals, ocean air and industrial pollution.

Moisture breeds corrosion

Moisture creates the conditions in which corrosion is most likely to occur. For example, corrosion is accelerated by high humidity, partic- ularly when temperatures are just above freezing. In such conditions, the corrosive material is kept in con- tact with the car surfaces by moisture that is slow to evaporate. Mud is particularly corrosive because it is slow to dry and holds moisture in contact with the vehicle. Although the mud appears to be dry, it can still retain the moisture and promote corrosion.

High temperatures can also acceler- ate corrosion of parts that are not properly ventilated so the moisture can be dispersed. For all these rea- sons, it is particularly important to keep your vehicle clean and free of mud or accumulations of other mate- rials. This applies not only to the vis- ible surfaces but particularly to the underside of the vehicle.

To help prevent corrosion

Keep your vehicle clean The best way to prevent corrosion is to keep your vehicle clean and free of corrosive materials. Attention to the underside of the vehicle is partic- ularly important.

If you live in a high-corrosion area where road salts are used, near the ocean, areas with industrial pollution, acid rain, etc., you should take extra care to prevent corrosion. In winter, hose off the underside of your vehicle at least once a month and be sure to clean the underside thoroughly when winter is over.

7-74

Maintenance

When cleaning underneath the vehicle, pay particular attention to the components under the fenders and other areas that are hidden from view. Do a thorough job; just dampening the accumulated mud rather than washing it away will accelerate corrosion rather than prevent it. Water under high pres- sure and steam are particularly effective in removing accumulated mud and corrosive materials.

When cleaning lower door panels, rocker panels and frame members, be sure that drain holes are kept open so that moisture can escape and not be trapped inside to accel- erate corrosion.

Keep your garage dry Don’t park your vehicle in a damp, poorly ventilated garage. This cre- ates a favorable environment for cor- rosion. This is particularly true if you wash your vehicle in the garage or drive it into the garage when it is still wet or covered with snow, ice or mud. Even a heated garage can con- tribute to corrosion unless it is well ventilated so moisture is dispersed.

Keep paint and trim in good condition Scratches or chips in the finish should be covered with «touch-up» paint as soon as possible to reduce the possibility of corrosion. If bare metal is showing through, the atten- tion of a qualified body and paint shop is recommended. Bird droppings are highly corrosive and may damage painted surfaces in just a few hours. Always remove bird droppings as soon as possible.

Interior Care Interior general precautions Prevent caustic solutions such as perfume and cosmetic oil, from con- tacting the interior parts because they may cause damage or discol- oration. If they do contact the interior parts, wipe them off immediately. See the instructions for the proper way to clean vinyl.

Never allow water or other liq- uids to come in contact with electrical/electronic compo- nents inside the vehicle as this may damage them.

When cleaning leather products (steering wheel, seats etc.), use neutral detergents or low alco- hol content solutions. If you use high alcohol content solutions or acid/alkaline detergents, the color of the leather may fade or the surface may get stripped off.

NOTICE

7-75

7

M aintenance

Cleaning the upholstery and interior trim Vinyl (if equipped)

Remove dust and loose dirt from vinyl with a whisk broom or vacuum cleaner. Clean vinyl surfaces with a vinyl cleaner.

Fabric (if equipped)

Remove dust and loose dirt from fab- ric with a whisk broom or vacuum cleaner. Clean with a mild soap solu- tion recommended for upholstery or carpets. Remove fresh spots imme- diately with a fabric spot cleaner. If fresh spots do not receive immediate attention, the fabric can be stained and its color can be affected. Also, its fire-resistant properties can be reduced if the material is not proper- ly maintained.

Using anything but recommended cleaners and procedures may affect the fabric’s appearance and fire-resistant properties.

Leather (if equipped)

Features of seat leather — Leather is made from the outer

skin of an animal, which goes through a special process to be available for use. Since it is a nat- ural product, each part differs in thickness or density. Wrinkles may appear as a natural result of stretching and shrinking depending on the temperature and humidity.

— The seat is made of stretchable fabric to improve comfort.

— The parts contacting the body are curved and the side supporting area is high which provides driv- ing comfort and stability.

— Wrinkles may appear naturally from usage. It is not a fault of the products.

NOTICE

Wrinkles or abrasions which appear naturally from usage are not covered by warranty.

Belts with metallic acces- sories, zippers or keys inside the back pocket may damage the seat fabric.

Make sure not to wet the seat. It may change the nature of natural leather.

Jeans or clothes which could bleach may contaminate the surface of the seat covering fabric.

CAUTION

7-76

Maintenance

Caring for the leather seats — Vacuum the seat periodically to

remove dust and sand on the seat. It will prevent abrasion or damage of the leather and main- tain its quality.

— Wipe the natural leather seat cover often with dry or soft cloth.

— Use of proper leather protector may prevent abrasion of the cover and helps maintain the color. Be sure to read the instruc- tions and consult a specialist when using leather coating or protective agent.

— Light colored (beige, cream beige) leather is easily contami- nated and the stain is noticeable. Clean the seats frequently.

— Avoid wiping with wet cloth. It may cause the surface to crack.

Cleaning the leather seats — Remove all contaminations

instantly. Refer to instructions below for removal of each con- taminant.

— Cosmetic products (sunscreen, foundation, etc.) Apply cleansing cream on a cloth and wipe the contaminated spot. Wipe off the cream with a wet cloth and remove water with a dry cloth.

— Beverages (coffee, soft drink, etc.) Apply a small amount of neutral detergent and wipe until contami- nations do not smear.

— Oil Remove oil instantly with absorbable cloth and wipe with stain remover used only for natu- ral leather.

— Chewing gum Harden the gum with ice and remove gradually.

Cleaning the seat belt webbing Clean the belt webbing with any mild soap solution recommended for cleaning upholstery or carpet. Follow the instructions provided with the soap. Do not bleach or re-dye the webbing because this may weaken the seat belt.

Cleaning the interior window glass If the interior glass surfaces of the vehicle become fogged (that is, cov- ered with an oily, greasy or waxy film), they should be cleaned with glass cleaner. Follow the directions on the glass cleaner container.

Do not scrape or scratch the inside of the rear window. This may result in damage to the rear window defroster grid.

NOTICE

7-77

7

M aintenance

The emission control system of your vehicle is covered by a written limited warranty. Please see the warranty information contained in the Owners Handbook & Warranty Information booklet in your vehicle. Your vehicle is equipped with an emission control system to meet all applicable emission regulations. There are three emission control systems, as follows.

(1) Crankcase emission control sys- tem

(2) Evaporative emission control sys- tem

(3) Exhaust emission control system

In order to ensure the proper func- tion of the emission control systems, it is recommended that you have your vehicle inspected and main- tained by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer in accordance with the main- tenance schedule in this manual.

For the Inspection and Maintenance Test (with Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system) To prevent the vehicle from mis-

firing during dynamometer test- ing, turn the Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system off by pressing the ESC switch (ESC OFF light illuminated).

After dynamometer testing is completed, turn the ESC system back on by pressing the ESC switch again.

1. Crankcase Emission Control System

The positive crankcase ventilation system is employed to prevent air pollution caused by blow-by gases being emitted from the crankcase. This system supplies fresh filtered air to the crankcase through the air intake hose. Inside the crankcase, the fresh air mixes with blow-by gases, which then pass through the PCV valve into the induction system.

2. Evaporative Emission Control System Including Onboard Refueling Vapor Recovery (ORVR)

The Evaporative Emission Control System is designed to prevent fuel vapors from escaping into the atmos- phere. The ORVR system is designed to allow the vapors from the fuel tank to be loaded into a can- ister while refueling at the gas sta- tion, preventing the escape of fuel vapors into the atmosphere.

NOTICE

EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM

7-78

Maintenance

Canister Fuel vapors generated inside the fuel tank are absorbed and stored in the onboard canister. When the engine is running, the fuel vapors absorbed in the canister are drawn into the surge tank through the purge control sole- noid valve.

Purge Control Solenoid Valve (PCSV) The purge control solenoid valve is controlled by the Engine Control Module (ECM); when the engine coolant temperature is low during idling, the PCSV closes so that evap- orated fuel is not taken into the engine. After the engine warms-up during ordinary driving, the PCSV opens to introduce evaporated fuel to the engine.

3. Exhaust Emission Control System

The Exhaust Emission Control System is a highly effective system which controls exhaust emissions while maintaining good vehicle per- formance. When the engine starts or fails to start, excessive attempts to restart the engine may cause damage to the emission system.

Engine exhaust (carbon monox- ide) precautions Carbon monoxide can be present

with other exhaust fumes. If you smell exhaust fumes of any kind in your vehicle, drive with all the win- dows fully open. Have your vehicle checked and repaired immediately.

Engine exhaust gases contain carbon monoxide (CO). Though colorless and odorless, it is dangerous and could be lethal if inhaled. Follow the instructions on this page to avoid CO poi- soning.

WARNING

7-79

7

M aintenance

Do not operate the engine in con- fined or closed areas (such as garages) any more than what is necessary to move the vehicle in or out of the area.

When the vehicle is stopped in an open area for more than a short time with the engine running, adjust the ventilation system (as needed) to draw outside air into the vehicle.

Never sit in a parked or stopped vehicle for any extended time with the engine running.

When the engine stalls or fails to start, excessive attempts to restart the engine may cause damage to the emission control system.

Operating precautions for cat- alytic converters (if equipped)

The exhaust system and cat- alytic converter are very hot during and immediately after the engine has been running.To avoid SERIOUS INJURY or DEATH: Do not park, idle, or drive the

vehicle over or near flamma- ble objects, such as grass, vegetation, paper, leaves, etc. A hot exhaust system can ignite flammable items under your vehicle.

Keep away from the exhaust system and catalytic convert- er or you may get burned. Also, Do not remove the heat sink around the exhaust sys- tem, do not seal the bottom of the vehicle, and do not coat the vehicle for corrosion con- trol. It may present a fire risk under certain conditions.

WARNING CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65 WARNING

Engine exhaust and a wide vari- ety of automobile components and parts, including compo- nents found in the interior fur- nishings in a vehicle, contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause can- cer and birth defects and repro- ductive harm. In addition, cer- tain fluids contained in vehicles and certain products of compo- nent wear contain or emit chem- icals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproduc- tive harm. For more information go to https://www.p65warnings.ca.go v/passenger-vehicle

WARNING

7-80

Maintenance

Your vehicle is equipped with a cat- alytic converter emission control device. To prevent damage to the catalytic converter and to your vehi- cle, take the following precautions: Use only UNLEADED FUEL for

gasoline engines. Do not operate the vehicle when

there are signs of engine malfunc- tion, such as misfire or a noticeable loss of performance.

Do not misuse or abuse the engine. Examples of misuse are coasting with the engine off and descending steep grades in gear with the engine off.

Do not operate the engine at high idle speed for extended periods (5 minutes or more).

Do not modify or tamper with any part of the engine or emission con- trol system. All inspections and adjustments must be made by an authorized HYUNDAI dealer.

Avoid driving with extremely low fuel level. If you run out of gasoline, it could cause the engine to misfire and result in excessive loading of the catalytic converter.

7-81

7

M aintenance

CALIFORNIA PERCHLORATE NOTICE Perchlorate Material-special handling may apply, See: http//dtsc.ca.gov/perchlorate

Notice to California Vehicle Dismantlers: Perchlorate containing materials, such as air bag inflators, seatbelt pretensioners and keyless remote entry batteries, must be disposed of according to Title 22 California Code of Regulations Section 67384.10 (a).

8

Specifications & Consum

er inform ation

Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects

Dimensions ……………………………………………………..8-2 Engine…………………………………………………………….8-2 Bulb Wattage ………………………………………………….8-3 Tires and Wheels ……………………………………………8-5 Volume and Weight…………………………………………8-6 Air Conditioning System………………………………….8-6 Recommended Lubricants and Capacities……….8-7

Recommended SAE Viscosity Number …………………….8-9 Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) ……………..8-10 Vehicle Ccertification Label…………………………..8-10 Tire Specification and Pressure Label ………….8-11 Engine Number ……………………………………………..8-11 Consumer Information…………………………………..8-12 Reporting Safety Defects ……………………………..8-13

8-2

Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects

DIMENSIONS

ENGINE

Items in (mm)

Overall length 196.06 (4,980)

Overall width 77.75 (1,975)

Overall height 68.89 (1,750)

Front tread 245/60 R18 67.24 (1,708)

245/50 R20 67.24 (1,708)

Rear tread 245/60 R18 67.56 (1,716)

245/50 R20 67.56 (1,716)

Wheelbase 114.17 (2,900)

Item Gasoline 3.8 GDI

Displacement cu. in (cc)

230.55 (3,778)

Bore x Stroke

in. (mm) 3.78 x 3.43 (96 x 87)

Firing order 1-2-3-4-5-6

No. of cylinders 6, V-type

BULB WATTAGE

8

Specifications, Consum er inform

ation and Reporting safety defects

Light Bulb Bulb Type Wattage

Front

Headlamp

Low Type A HB3 60

Type B LED LED

High Type A H7 55

Type B LED LED

Daytime running lamp(DRL) & Parking lamp Type A LED LED

Type B LED LED

Turn signal lamp LED LED

Turn signal lamp (Outside mirror) LED LED

Side marker lamp LED LED

Rear

Tail lamp Type A P28/8W 28/8

Type B LED LED

Tail/Stop lamp Type A P28/8W 28/8

Type B LED LED

Turn signal lamp Type A P28/8W 28/8

Type B LED LED

Side marker lamp Type A LED LED

Type B LED LED

Back up lamp P21W 21

Rear fog lamp LED LED

High mounted stop lamp LED LED

License plate lamp W5W 5

8-3

8-4

Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects

Light Bulb Bulb Type Wattage

Interior

Map lamp Type A W8W 8

Type B LED LED

Room lamp Type A W8W 28/8

Type B LED LED

Luggage compartment lamp

Type A FESTOON 8

Type B LED LED

Vanity mirror lamp Type A 5W 5

Type B LED LED

Grove box lamp FESTOON 5

TIRES AND WHEELS

8-5

8

Specifications, Consum er inform

ation and Reporting safety defects

It is permissible to add 3 psi to the standard tire pressure specification if colder temperatures are expect- ed soon. Tires typically loose 1psi (7kPa) for every 12F temperature drop. If extreme temperature variations are expected, recheck your tire pressure as necessary to keep them properly inflated.

An air pressure generally decreases, as you drive up to a high-altitude area above sea level. Thus, if you plan to drive a high-altitude area, check the tire pressures in advance. If necessary, inflate them to a prop- er level. (Air inflation per altitude : +2.4 psi/1 mile)

NOTICE

Item Tire Size Wheel Size Cold tire inflation pressure, kPa (psi) Wheel Lug Nut

Torque kgfm (lbfft, Nm)Front Rear

Full size tire 245/60 R18 7.5J X 18

240 (35) 240 (35) 11~13 (79~94,107~127)

245/50 R20 7.5J X 20

Compact spare tire T155/90 R18 4.0T X 18 420 (60)

When replacing tires, use the same size originally supplied with the vehicle. Using tires of a different size can damage the related parts or not work properly.

CAUTION

8-6

Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects

VOLUME AND WEIGHT

AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM

Contact an authorized HYUNDAI dealer for more details.

Items 3.8 GDI

2WD AWD

Gross vehicle weight

7 Seater lbs. (kg)

5,732 (2,600) 5,871 (2,663)

8 Seater lbs. (kg)

5,732 (2,600) 5,871 (2,663)

Luggage volume (SAE) cu. ft (l)

Behind 1st row : 86.4 (2447) Behind 2st row : 45.8 (1297)

Behind 3st row : 18 (509)

Items Weight of Volume Classification

Refrigerant oz. (g)

31.75 (900) 0.88 (25) R134a

Compressor lubricant oz. (cc)

6.35 (180) PAG

8-7

8

Specifications, Consum er inform

ation and Reporting safety defects

To help achieve proper engine and powertrain performance and durability, use only lubricants of the proper quality. The correct lubricants also help promote engine efficiency that results in improved fuel economy.

RECOMMENDED LUBRICANTS AND CAPACITIES

Lubricant Volume Classification

Engine oil *1 *2 (drain and refill)

Recommends 1.71 US gal. (6.5 l) ACEA A5 or above*3 /

5W-30 /(SAE Viscosity Number)

Automatic transmission fluid 1.85 US gal. (7.0 l)

MICHANG ATF SP-IV, SK ATF SP-IV, NOCA ATF SP-IV, HYUNDAI genuine ATF SP-IV or other brands meeting the above specification approved by HYUNDAI Motor Co.

*1 : Refer to the recommended SAE viscosity numbers on the 9 page. *2 : Engine oils labeled Energy Conserving Oil are now available. Along with other additional benefits, they contribute to fuel econ-

omy by reducing the amount of fuel necessary to overcome engine friction. Often, these improvements are difficult to measure in everyday driving, but in a year’s time, they can offer significant cost and energy savings.

*3 : If the ACEA A5 engine oil is not available in your country, you are able to use API SM & ILSAC GF-4 (or above) or ACEA A3.

8-8

Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects

Lubricant Volume Classification

Transfer case oil (AWD) 0.19 US gal. (0.7 l) HYPOID GEAR OIL API GL-5, SAE 75W/85 (SK HCT-5 GEAR OIL 75W/85 or EQUIVALENT)

Rear differential oil (AWD) 0.19 US gal. (0.7 l)

Coolant 2.35 US gal. (8.9 l) Mixture of antifreeze and water (Phosphate-based Ethylene glycol coolant for alu- minum radiator)

Brake fluid As required FMVSS116 DOT-4

Fuel 18.75 US gal. (71 l) Refer to «Fuel requirements» in the Foreword chapter.

8-9

8

Specifications, Consum er inform

ation and Reporting safety defects

Recommended SAE viscosity number

Always be sure to clean the area around any filler plug, drain plug, or dipstick before check- ing or draining any lubricant. This is especially important in dusty or sandy areas and when the vehicle is used on unpaved roads. Cleaning the plug and dipstick areas will prevent dirt and grit from entering the engine and other mechanisms that could be damaged.

CAUTION

*1 : For better fuel economy, it is recommended to use the engine oil of a viscosity grade SAE 5W-30. However, if the engine oil is not available in your country, select the proper engine oil using the engine oil viscosity chart.

An engine oil displaying this American Petroleum Institute(API) Certification Mark conforms to the International Lubricant Specification Advisory Committee (ILSAC). It is recommended to only use engine oils that uphold this API Certification Mark.

Engine oil viscosity (thickness) has an effect on fuel economy and cold weather operating (engine start and engine oil flowability). Lower viscosity engine oils can provide better fuel economy and cold weather performance, however, higher viscosity engine oils are required for satisfactory lubrication in hot weather. Using oils of any viscosity other than those recommended could result in engine damage. When choosing an oil, consider the range of temperature your vehicle will be operated in before the next oil change. Proceed to select the recommended oil viscosity from the chart.

Temperature Range for SAE Viscosity Numbers

Temperature -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50

-10 0 20 40 60 80 100 120

Engine Oil *1

C (F)

5W-30

8-10

Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects

The vehicle identification number (VIN) is the number used in register- ing your car and in all legal matters pertaining to its ownership, etc. The number is punched on the engine compartment frame and back side of the engine.

The VIN is also on a plate attached to the top of the dashboard. The number on the plate can easily be seen through the windshield from outside.

The vehicle certification label attached on the driver’s side center pillar gives the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN).

VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER (VIN) VEHICLE CERTIFICATION LABEL

OLX2089002N OLX2088008L

VIN label

OLX2088003

8-11

8

Specifications, Consum er inform

ation and Reporting safety defects

The tires supplied on your new vehi- cle are chosen to provide the best performance for normal driving. The tire label located on the drivers side center pillar gives the tire pres- sures recommended for your car.

The engine number is stamped on the engine block as shown in the drawing.

ENGINE NUMBERTIRE SPECIFICATION AND PRESSURE LABEL

OLX2088003L

OLX2088006L

Gasoline engine 3.8 GDI

8-12

Specifications, Consumer information and Reporting safety defects

CONSUMER INFORMATION This consumer information has been prepared in accordance with regulations issued by the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration of the U.S. Department of Transportation.Your HYUNDAI dealer will help answer any questions you may have as you read this information. HYUNDAI motor vehicles are designed and manufactured to meet or exceed all applicable safety standards. For your safety, however, we strongly urge you to read and follow all directions in this Owners Manual, particularly the information under the headings «NOTICE», «CAUTION» and «WARNING». If, after reading this manual, you have any questions regarding the operation of your vehicle, please contact the Hyundai Customer Care Center.

Hyundai Customer Care P.O. Box 20850 Fountain Valley, CA 92728 800-633-5151 consumeraffairs@hmausa.com

Hyundais Customer Care Center representatives are available Monday through Friday, between the hours of 6:00 AM and 5:00 PM PST and Saturday between 6:30 AM and 3:00 PM PST (English). For Customer Care Center assistance in Spanish or Korean, representatives are available Monday through Friday between 6:30 AM and 3:00 PM PST.

8-13

8

Specifications, Consum er inform

ation and Reporting safety defects

If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying HYUNDAI MOTOR AMERICA.

To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888- 327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; download the SaferCar mobile application; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA

1200 New Jersey Ave, SE, West Building Washington, D.C. 20590.

You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov.

If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual prob- lems between you, your dealer, or HYUNDAI MOTOR AMERICA.

REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS

I-2

Accessing Your Vehicle …………………………………………….3-4

Immobilizer System …………………………………………..3-14

Remote Key ………………………………………………………..3-4

Smart Key …………………………………………………………..3-8

Air Bag — Advanced Supplemental Restraint System…..2-57

Additional Safety Precautions………………………………2-79

Air Bag Warning Label ……………………………………….2-79

How Does the Air Bag System Operate?……………….2-63

Occupant Classification System (OCS) …………………2-68

SRS Care …………………………………………………………..2-78

What to Expect After an Air Bag Inflates ………………2-67

Where Are the Air Bags? …………………………………….2-59

Why Didn’t My Air Bag Go Off in a Collision?……..2-73

Air cleaner……………………………………………………………..7-22

Filter Replacement ……………………………………………..7-22

All Wheel Drive (AWD) …………………………………………5-43

Air Conditioning System …………………………………………..8-6

AWD Operation………………………………………………….5-44

Emergency Precautions ……………………………………….5-48

LCD display message………………………………………….5-47

Appearance care……………………………………………………..7-69

Exterior Care ……………………………………………………..7-69

Interior Care ………………………………………………………7-74

Automatic Climate Control System…………………………3-196

Automatic Temperature Control Mode ………………..3-197

Manual Temperature Control Mode…………………….3-198

Rear climate control ………………………………………….3-204

System Maintenance …………………………………………3-209

System Operation ……………………………………………..3-207

Automatic transmission …………………………………………..5-15

Automatic transmission operation ……………………….5-15

Good driving practices ……………………………………….5-20

LCD display message………………………………………….5-19

Paddle Shifter (Manual Shift Mode)……………………..5-22

Parking………………………………………………………………5-18

Battery…………………………………………………………………..7-29

Battery Recharging……………………………………………..7-31

For Best Battery Service ……………………………………..7-30

Reset Features ……………………………………………………7-32

Before driving ………………………………………………………….5-5

Before Entering the Vehicle …………………………………..5-5

Before Starting …………………………………………………….5-5

Key Ignition Switch ……………………………………………..5-7

Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist (BCA) …………..5-96

Blind-Spot Collision Warning settings…………………..5-86

Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist malfunction and limitations ……………………………..5-105

Blind-Spot Collision-Avoidance Assist operation …5-101

Index

A

B

I-3

Blind-spot Collison Warning(BCW)………………………….5-85

Blind-Spot Collision Warning malfunction and limitations………………………………………………….5-90

Blind-Spot Collision Warning operation ……………….5-89

Blind-Spot Collision Warning settings settings ………5-86

Blind-Spot View Monitor (BVM) ………………………….3-182

Blind-Spot View Monitor malfunction ………………..3-183

Blind-Spot View Monitor operation…………………….3-183

Blind-Spot View Monitor settings ………………………3-182

Brake fluid …………………………………………………………….7-21

Checking the Brake Fluid Level …………………………..7-21

Braking system ………………………………………………………5-23

Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)…………………………….5-33

Auto Hold………………………………………………………….5-29

Disc Brakes Wear Indicator………………………………….5-24

Downhill Brake Control (DBC) …………………………..5-39

Electronic Parking Brake (EPB) …………………………..5-24

Electronic Stability Control (ESC)………………………..5-35

Good Braking Practices ……………………………………..5-42

Hill-Start Assist Control (HAC)……………………………5-39

Power Brakes……………………………………………………..5-23

Trailer Stability Assist (TSA)……………………………….5-42

Vehicle Stability Management (VSM) …………………..5-38

Bulb Wattage……………………………………………………………8-3

California perchlorate notice ……………………………………7-81

Child Restraint System (CRS)………………………………….2-45

Children Always in the Rear ………………………………..2-45

Installing a Child Restraint System (CRS) …………….2-49

Selecting a Child Restraint System (CRS)……………..2-47

Climate Control Additional Features ……………………….3-216

Automatic Ventilation………………………………………..3-216

Cluster ionizer …………………………………………………3-216

Sunroof Inside Air Recirculation ……………………….3-216

Climate control air filter ………………………………………….7-24

Filter Inspection………………………………………………….7-24

Consumer Information…………………………………………….8-12

Declaration of confirmity ………………………………………5-200

Front radar ………………………………………………………5-200

Rear corner radar ……………………………………………..5-200

Dimensions ……………………………………………………………..8-2

Door Locks ……………………………………………………………3-16

Automatic Door Lock and Unlock Features …………..3-20

Child-Protector Rear Door Locks ………………………..3-21

Electronic Child Safety Lock System …………………..3-21

Operating Door Locks from Inside the Vehicle ……..3-17

Operating Door Locks from Outside the Vehicle …..3-16 I

Index

C

D

I-4

Drive Mode Integrated Control System (2WD) ………….5-55

Drive Mode ……………………………………………………….5-55

Drive Mode Integrated Control System(AWD)…………..5-59

Drive Mode ……………………………………………………….5-59

Driver Attention Warning (DAW) …………………………..5-136

Driver Attention Warning malfunction and limitations………………………………………………..5-140

Driver Attention Warning operation…………………….5-138

Driver Attention Warning settings ……………………..5-137

Driver position memory system ………………………………3-32

Easy Access Function………………………………………….3-34

Recalling Positions from Memory ………………………..3-33

Resetting the Driver’s Seat Memory System ………….3-33

Storing Positions into Memory ……………………………3-32

Emission control system ………………………………………….7-77

Crankcase Emission Control System …………………….7-77

Evaporative Emission Control System Including Onboard Refueling Vapor Recovery (ORVR)…………7-77

Exhaust Emission Control System………………………..7-78

Engine …………………………………………………………………….8-2

Engine Compartment ………………………………………………..1-6

Engine compartment …………………………………………………7-3

Engine coolant ……………………………………………………….7-18

Changing Engine Coolant ……………………………………7-20

Checking the Engine Coolant Level ……………………..7-18

Engine Number ………………………………………………………8-11

Engine oil ………………………………………………………………7-16

Checking the Engine Oil and Filter ………………………7-17

Checking the Engine Oil Level…………………………….7-16

Explanation of scheduled maintenance items……………..7-13

Exterior Features…………………………………………………….3-66

Fuel Filler Door………………………………………………….3-79

Hood …………………………………………………………………3-66

Non-Powered Liftgate …………………………………………3-67

Power Liftgate …………………………………………………..3-69

Smart Liftgate…………………………………………………….3-75

Exterior features……………………………………………………3-234

Roof Side Rails ………………………………………………..3-234

Exterior Overview…………………………………………………….1-2

Forward Collision-avoidance Assist(FCA) (Sensor Fusion)…………………………………………………….5-63

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist malfunction and limitations………………………………………………….5-70

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist operation ……..5-66

Forward Collision-Avoidance Assist settings …………5-64

Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning (PDW) …3-170

Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning malfunction and precautions …………………………….3-173

Forward/Reverse Parking Distance Warning operation………………………………………………………..3-171

Reverse Parking Distance Warning settings …………3-170

Index

E F

I-5

Fuses …………………………………………………………………….7-48

Engine Compartment Panel Fuse Replacement ………7-50

Fuse/Relay Panel Description ………………………………7-51

Instrument Panel Fuse Replacement ……………………..7-49

Hazard Warning Flasher ……………………………………………6-2

Head Up Display (HUD) ……………………………………….3-143

High Beam Assist (HBA) ………………………………………3-154

High Beam Assist malfunction and limitations …….3-156

High Beam Assist operation……………………………….3-155

High Beam Assist setting …………………………………..3-154

Highway Driving Assist (HDA) …………………………….5-143

Highway Driving Assist Malfunction and Limitations …………………………………………………….5-148

Highway Driving Assist Operation ……………………..5-145

Highway Driving Assist Settings ………………………..5-144

If the Engine Overheats …………………………………………….6-6

If the Engine Will Not Start……………………………………….6-3

If the Engine Doesn’t Turn Over or Turns Over Slowly ……………………………………………..6-3

If the Engine Turns Over Normally but Doesn’t Start ………………………………………………………6-3

If You Have a Flat Tire ……………………………………………6-14

Changing Tires …………………………………………………..6-16

Jack and Tools ……………………………………………………6-14

Removing and Storing the Spare Tire ……………………6-15

Ignition switch …………………………………………………………5-7

Engine Start/Stop Button……………………………………..5-10

Important Safety Precautions……………………………………..2-2

Air Bag Hazards …………………………………………………..2-2

Always Wear Your Seat Belt ………………………………….2-2

Control Your Speed ………………………………………………2-3

Driver Distraction…………………………………………………2-2

Keep Your Vehicle in Safe Condition ……………………..2-3

Restrain All Children…………………………………………….2-2

In Case of an Emergency While Driving …………………….6-2

If the Engine Stalls at a Crossroad or Crossing ………..6-2

If the Engine Stalls While Driving………………………….6-2

If you Have a Flat Tire While Driving…………………….6-3

Infotainment System …………………………………………………4-2

Antenna ………………………………………………………………4-2

Audio (Display Audio) / Video / Navigation System (AVN) …………………………………..4-4

Bluetooth Wireless Technology ……………………………4-4

Steering Wheel Audio Controls………………………………4-3

USB Port …………………………………………………………….4-2

Instrument Cluster…………………………………………………..3-82

Gauges and Meters ……………………………………………..3-84

Instrument Cluster Control…………………………………..3-84

LCD Display Messages……………………………………..3-103

Transmission Shift Indicator ………………………………..3-89

Warning and Indicator Lights……………………………….3-89

Instrument Panel Overview ……………………………………….1-5

I

Index

H

I

I-6

Interior features ……………………………………………………3-219

AC Inverter ……………………………………………………..3-223

Cargo Security Screen……………………………………….3-230

Clock ………………………………………………………………3-228

Coat Hook ……………………………………………………….3-228

Conversation mirror ………………………………………….3-221

Cup Holder ………………………………………………………3-219

Floor Mat Anchor(s)………………………………………….3-229

Luggage Net Holder ………………………………………….3-230

Power Outlet…………………………………………………….3-222

Side Curtain……………………………………………………..3-232

Sunvisor…………………………………………………………..3-221

USB Charger …………………………………………………..3-225

Wireless Cellular Phone Charging System …………..3-226

Interior Overview……………………………………………………..1-4

ISG (Idle Stop and Go) system ………………………………..5-50

Calibrating the Battery Sensor ……………………………..5-54

ISG System Malfunction……………………………………..5-53

To Activate the ISG System …………………………………5-50

To Deactivate the ISG System …………………………….5-53

Jump Starting …………………………………………………………..6-4

Lane Following Assist (LFA) ………………………………..5-131

Lane Following Assist malfunction and limitations………………………………………………………5-134

Lane Following Assist operation…………………………5-132

Lane Following Assist settings …………………………..5-131

Lane Keeping Assist (LKA) ……………………………………5-78

Lane Keeping Assist malfunction and limitations …..5-82

Lane Keeping Assist operation …………………………….5-80

Lane Keeping Assist settings ………………………………5-78

LCD Display (Cluster type A and type B)………………..3-109

LCD Display Control ………………………………………..3-109

LCD Display Modes …………………………………………3-110

LCD Display (Cluster type C) ………………………………..3-127

LCD Display Control ………………………………………..3-127

View Modes ……………………………………………………3-128

Light bulbs …………………………………………………………….7-61

Headlamp, Parking lamp, Daytime Running Light, Turn signal lamp and Side marker ………………………7-61

High Mounted Stop Lamp Bulb Replacement………..7-66

Interior Light Bulb Replacement ………………………….7-67

License Plate Light Bulb Replacement …………………7-66

Rear combination lamp light replacement ……………..7-64

Side Repeater Lamp Replacement ………………………..7-64

Lighting……………………………………………………………….3-145

Exterior Lights………………………………………………….3-145

Interior Lights…………………………………………………..3-149

Welcome System ……………………………………………..3-152

Index

J

L

I-7

Maintenance services ………………………………………………..7-4

Owner Maintenance Precautions…………………………….7-4

Owner’s Responsibility………………………………………….7-4

Manual Climate Control System …………………………….3-184

Heating and Air Conditioning …………………………….3-185

Rear climate control ………………………………………….3-189

System Maintenance …………………………………………3-194

System Operation ……………………………………………..3-192

Mirrors ………………………………………………………………….3-39

Inside Rearview Mirror ……………………………………….3-39

Reverse Parking Aid Function ……………………………..3-54

Side View Mirrors ………………………………………………3-52

Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control (NSCC)………5-170

Limitations of Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control ……………………………………..5-174

Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control Operation .5-171

Navigation-based Smart Cruise Control Settings ….5-170

Option Menu (Cluster type C) ………………………………..3-132

Owner maintenance ………………………………………………….7-5

Owner Maintenance Schedule………………………………..7-6

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision Warning (RCCW)………..5-111

Rear Cross-Traffic Safety system operation ………..5-113

Rear Cross-Traffic Safety system malfunction and limitations ………………………………………………..5-115

Rear Cross-Traffic Safety system settings ……………5-112

Rear Cross-Traffic Collision-Avoidance Assist (RCCA) ……………………………………………………5-119

Rear Cross-Traffic Safety system malfunction and limitations………………………………………………..5-125

Rear Cross-Traffic Safety system operation …………5-121

Rear Cross-Traffic Safety system settings ……………5-120

Rear View Monitor (RVM) ……………………………………3-162

Rear View Monitor malfunction and limitations …..3-165

Rear View Monitor operation……………………………..3-163

Rear View Monitor settings ……………………………….3-162

Recommended Lubricants and Capacities……………………8-7

Recommended SAE Viscosity Number …………………..8-9

Reporting Safety Defects …………………………………………8-13

Reverse Parking Distance Warning (PDW)………………3-166

Reverse Parking Distance Warning malfunction and precautions……………………………………………….3-167

Reverse Parking Distance Warning operation……….3-166

Reverse Parking Distance Warning settings …………3-166

I

Index

M

N

R

O

I-8

Safe Exit Assist (SEA)…………………………………………….3-23

Rear Occupant Alert (ROA) System …………………….3-29

Safe Exit Assist malfunction and limitations ………….3-27

Safe Exit Assist operation ……………………………………3-25

Safe Exit Assist settings ………………………………………3-24

Scheduled maintenance services…………………………………7-7

Maintenance Under Severe Usage Conditions (3.8 GDI) ………………………………………..7-11

Normal Maintenance Schedule (3.8 GDI) ……………….7-8

Seat Belts ………………………………………………………………2-29

Additional Seat Belt Safety Precautions ………………..2-41

Care of Seat Belt ………………………………………………..2-44

Seat Belt Restraint System…………………………………..2-33

Seat Belt Safety Precautions ………………………………..2-29

Seat Belt Warning Light ………………………………………2-30

Seats ……………………………………………………………………….2-4

Front Seats…………………………………………………………..2-6

Head Restraints ………………………………………………….2-21

Rear Seats ………………………………………………………….2-13

Safety Precautions ………………………………………………..2-5

Seat Warmers and Air Ventilation Seats…………………2-26

Smart cruise control (SCC)…………………………………….5-151

Smart Cruise Control display and control…………….5-157

Smart Cruise Control malfunction and limitations ..5-163

Smart Cruise Control operation ………………………….5-156

Smart Cruise Control settings …………………………….5-152

Special driving conditions ……………………………………..5-178

Driving at Night ……………………………………………….5-179

Driving in Flooded Areas …………………………………..5-180

Driving in the Rain……………………………………………5-179

Hazardous Driving Conditions……………………………5-178

Highway Driving………………………………………………5-180

Reducing the Risk of a Rollover ………………………..5-181

Rocking the Vehicle ………………………………………….5-178

Smooth Cornering …………………………………………….5-179

Steering wheel………………………………………………………..3-36

Electric Power Steering (EPS) ……………………………..3-36

Heated Steering Wheel………………………………………..3-38

Horn………………………………………………………………….3-37

Tilt Steering / Telescopic Steering ………………………..3-37

Storage Compartment ……………………………………………3-217

Center Console Storage……………………………………..3-217

Glove Box ……………………………………………………….3-217

Luggage Tray ………………………………………………….3-218

Sunroof………………………………………………………………….3-59

Dual wide sunroof ………………………………………………3-59

Resetting the sunroof…………………………………………..3-63

Slide open/close (Front) ………………………………………3-61

Sunroof …………………………………………………………….3-59

Sunroof open warning …………………………………………3-65

Sunshade (Front)/Power sunshade (Rear)………………3-60

Tilt open/close (Front)…………………………………………3-61

Index

S

I-9

Surround View Monitor (SVM)………………………………3-176

Surround View Monitor malfunction and limitations………………………………………………………3-180

Surround View Monitor operation ………………………3-178

Surround View Monitor settings …………………………3-176

Theft-alarm System…………………………………………………3-31

Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) …………………..6-8

Changing a Tire with TPMS ………………………………..6-12

Check Tire Pressure………………………………………………6-8

Low Tire Pressure LCD Display with Position Indicator ………………………………………………………….6-10

Low Tire Pressure Telltale……………………………………6-10

Tire Pressure Monitoring System……………………………6-9

TPMS Malfunction Indicator ……………………………….6-11

Tire Specification and Pressure Label ……………………….8-11

Tires and wheels …………………………………………………….7-33

All Season Tires …………………………………………………7-46

Check Tire Inflation Pressure……………………………….7-35

Radial-Ply Tires………………………………………………….7-46

Recommended Cold Tire Inflation Pressures………….7-34

Snow Tires…………………………………………………………7-46

Tire Care……………………………………………………………7-33

Tire Maintenance………………………………………………..7-39

Tire Replacement ………………………………………………7-37

Tire Rotation………………………………………………………7-35

Tire Sidewall Labeling ………………………………………..7-39

Tire Terminology and Definitions…………………………7-43

Tire Traction ………………………………………………………7-38

Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance ………………………7-36

Wheel Replacement…………………………………………….7-38

Tires and Wheels………………………………………………………8-5

Towing ………………………………………………………………….6-22

Emergency Towing……………………………………………..6-24

Removable Towing Hook…………………………………….6-23

Towing Service…………………………………………………..6-22

Trailer towing……………………………………………………….5-186

Driving with a trailer…………………………………………5-189

If you decide to pull a trailer………………………………5-186

Maintenance when trailer towing ……………………….5-192

Trailer towing equipment …………………………………..5-188

Trip Computer (Cluster type A and type B) ……………..3-123

Trip modes……………………………………………………….3-123

I

Index

T

I-10

Vehicle Ccertification Label …………………………………….8-10

Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)………………………..8-10

Vehicle load limit ………………………………………………….5-194

Tire Loading Information Label………………………….5-195

Volume and Weight…………………………………………………..8-6

Washer fluid …………………………………………………………..7-22

Checking the Washer Fluid Level …………………………7-22

Windows ……………………………………………………………….3-55

Power Windows………………………………………………….3-56

Windshield Defrosting and Defogging …………………….3-211

Auto Defogging System (Additional Feature with Automatic Temperature Control System) …………..3-213

Rear Window Defroster……………………………………..3-215

Winter driving ………………………………………………………5-182

Snow or Icy Conditions……………………………………..5-182

Winter Precautions ……………………………………………5-184

Wiper blades ………………………………………………………….7-26

Blade Inspection…………………………………………………7-26

Blade Replacement……………………………………………..7-26

Wipers and Washers………………………………………………3-158

Front Windshi

Manualsnet FAQs

If you want to find out how the Palisade Hyundai works, you can view and download the Hyundai Palisade 2022 SUV Owner’s Manual on the Manualsnet website.

Yes, we have the Owner’s Manual for Hyundai Palisade as well as other Hyundai manuals. All you need to do is to use our search bar and find the user manual that you are looking for.

The Owner’s Manual should include all the details that are needed to use a Hyundai Palisade. Full manuals and user guide PDFs can be downloaded from Manualsnet.com.

The best way to navigate the Hyundai Palisade 2022 SUV Owner’s Manual is by checking the Table of Contents at the top of the page where available. This allows you to navigate a manual by jumping to the section you are looking for.

This Hyundai Palisade 2022 SUV Owner’s Manual consists of sections like Table of Contents, to name a few. For easier navigation, use the Table of Contents in the upper left corner.

You can download Hyundai Palisade 2022 SUV Owner’s Manual free of charge simply by clicking the “download” button in the upper right corner of any manuals page. This feature allows you to download any manual in a couple of seconds and is generally in PDF format. You can also save a manual for later by adding it to your saved documents in the user profile.

To be able to print Hyundai Palisade 2022 SUV Owner’s Manual, simply download the document to your computer. Once downloaded, open the PDF file and print the Hyundai Palisade 2022 SUV Owner’s Manual as you would any other document. This can usually be achieved by clicking on “File” and then “Print” from the menu bar.

инструкцияHyundai Palisade (2020)

OOWWNNEERRSS MMAANNUUAALL

OOppeerraattiioonn

MMaaiinntteennaannccee

SSppeecciiffiiccaattiioonnss

All information in this Owner’s Manual is current at the time of pub-

lication. However, HYUNDAI reserves the right to make changes at

any time so that our policy of continual product improvement may be

carried out.

This manual applies to all HYUNDAI models and includes descrip-

tions and explanations of optional as well as standard equipment.

As a result, you may find material in this manual that does not apply

to your specific vehicle.

Посмотреть инструкция для Hyundai Palisade (2020) бесплатно. Руководство относится к категории автомобили, 2 человек(а) дали ему среднюю оценку 9.4. Руководство доступно на следующих языках: английский. У вас есть вопрос о Hyundai Palisade (2020) или вам нужна помощь? Задайте свой вопрос здесь

  • LX2 HMA FOREWORD
  • LX2 HMA 1
  • LX2 HMA 2
  • LX2 HMA 3a(~131)
  • LX2 HMA 3b
  • LX2 HMA 4
  • LX2 HMA 5
  • LX2 HMA 6
  • LX2 HMA 7
  • LX2 HMA 8
  • LX2 HMA INDEX
Главная

Не можете найти ответ на свой вопрос в руководстве? Вы можете найти ответ на свой вопрос ниже, в разделе часто задаваемых вопросов о Hyundai Palisade (2020).

Как перевести мили в километры?

1 миля равна 1,609344 километрам, а 1 километр — 0,62137119 милям.

Где я могу узнать идентификационный номер транспортного средства Hyundai?

Место размещения идентификационного номера транспортного средства зависит от марки и типа транспортного средства. Номер может быть выбит на раме транспортного средства или указан на номерном знаке. Чтобы узнать место расположения идентификационного номера транспортного средства лучше всего ознакомиться с руководством по эксплуатации Hyundai Palisade (2020).

Что такое идентификационный номер транспортного средства (VIN)?

Идентификационный номер транспортного средства — уникальный для каждого транспортного средства идентификационный номер. Аббревиатура VIN расшифровывается как «Vehicle Identification Number» (Идентификационный номер транспортного средства).

Когда транспортному средству Hyundai требуется техническое обслуживание?

Регулярное техническое обслуживание необходимо всем транспортным средствам. С информацией о том, как часто необходимо проходить техническое обслуживание и чему именно стоит уделять особое внимание можно ознакомиться в инструкции по техническому обслуживанию. Как правило, транспортное средство требует технического обслуживания каждые 2 года или 30 000 километров пробега.

Когда следует заменять тормозную жидкость на Hyundai?

Тормозную жидкость рекомендуется менять каждые два года.

В чем разница между топливом E10 и E5?

В топливе E10 содержится до десяти процентов этанола, в то время как в E5 содержится менее пяти процентов. Соответственно, топливо E10 менее вредит окружающей среде.

Одна или несколько дверей не открываются изнутри. Что мне делать?

Скорее всего, замок оснащен защитой от детей и поэтому не может быть открыт изнутри. Процедура открытия замка с защитой от детей зависит от марки и типа замка.

Автомобильный радиоприемник не включается, что делать?

Если автомобильный радиоприемник не включен, на него не будет подаваться питание. Убедитесь, что красный провод подключен к контактному источнику питания, а желтый провод — к источнику питания постоянной мощности.

Инструкция Hyundai Palisade (2020) доступно в русский?

К сожалению, у нас нет руководства для Hyundai Palisade (2020), доступного в русский. Это руководство доступно в английский.

Не нашли свой вопрос? Задайте свой вопрос здесь

Понравилась статья? Поделить с друзьями:
  • Инструкция по хлорированию резервуаров с питьевой водой
  • Инструкция по хлорированию водопроводных сетей
  • Инструкция по химическому анализу воды прудов м 1984
  • Инструкция по химической завивке волос
  • Инструкция по фотошопу для начинающих на русском языке